Home
        2013 Nissan Maxima
         Contents
1.                                                                                    Adjust Clock Settings    Comfort  amp  Conv  12 00 Settings    Comfort  amp  Conv  8 00     n UP  jt E ir  E   Auto Interior Illumination   Selective Door Unlock    E E Auto Headlights Sensitivity    CIEL E Intelligent Key Lock   Unlock E  p p Auto Headlights Off Delay oO E Lift Steering Wheel on Exit    E E Speed Sensing Wiper Interval E Slide Driver Seat Back on Exit  o ON  E  i H Selective Door Unlock H Return All Settings to Default H        1 9 DOWN  F 5 9 DOWN  F    Select OK to accept the time change    Cabin lighting when unlocking doors   Off will activate all doors with one click  LHA1308 WHA1151 WHA1152                                           Adjust Clock     To adjust the time  select the   or   key for the  hour until the desired number is reached  Repeat  the process for the minutes on the line below     To accept the changes made and return to the  Clocks Settings screen  select the OK key     Comfort  amp  Convenience settings    Select the  Comfort  amp  Conv   key by using the  NISSAN controller  The comfort and conve   nience option screen will be displayed     You can set the following operating conditions by  highlighting the desired item using the NISSAN  controller  The amber indicator  box at the right of  the selected item  alternately turns on and off  each time the ENTER button is pressed     Indicator light is illuminated     ON  Indicator light is not illuminated 
2.                               Type B    LDI0456                                                 LDI2035       Extended storage switch    If any electrical equipment does not operate   remove the extended storage switch and check  for an open fuse     NOTE     The extended storage switch is used for  long term vehicle storage  Even if the ex   tended storage switch is broken it is not  necessary to replace it  Replace only the  open fuse in the switch with a new fuse     How to replace the extended storage switch     1  To remove the extended storage switch  be  sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or  LOCK position     2  Be sure the headlight switch is in the OFF  position     3  Remove the fuse box cover     4  Pinch the locking tabs  1  found on each  side of the storage switch     5  Pull the storage switch straight out from the  fuse box  2      Maintenance and do it yourself 8 25    BATTERY REPLACEMENT    A CAUTION    Be careful not to allow children to swallow  the battery or removed parts     NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY      Replace the battery in the Intelligent Key as fol   lows     1  Remove the mechanical key from the Intelli   gent Key     2  Insert a small screwdriver    into the slit  of the corner and twist it to separate the  upper part from the lower part  Use a cloth to  protect the casing     3  Replace the battery with a new one     Recommended battery  CR2032 or equiva   lent         Do nottouch the internal circuit and elec   tric terminals as doing so cou
3.                        WSD0233    To remove the Intelligent Key from the port  push  the ignition switch to the LOCK position and pull  the Intelligent Key out of the port           NOTE     The Intelligent Key port does not charge  the Intelligent Key battery  If you see the  low battery indicator  replace the battery as  soon as possible  See    Battery replace   ment    in the    Maintenance and do it   yourself    section     5 10 Starting and driving    ACAUTION    e Never place anything except the Intelli   gent Key in the Intelligent Key port  Do   ing sO may cause damage to the  equipment     e Make sure the Intelligent Key is in the  correct direction when inserting it to  the Intelligent Key port  The engine may  not start if it is in the wrong direction     e Remove the Intelligent Key from the  Intelligent Key port after the ignition  switch is pushed to the LOCK position     NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER  SYSTEM    The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer system will not  allow the engine to start without the use of the  registered key     If the engine fails to start using a registered key   for example  when interference is caused by  another registered key  an automated toll road  device or automatic payment device on the key  ring   restart the engine using the following pro   cedure     1  Leave the ignition switch in the ON position  for approximately 5 seconds     2  Place the ignition switch in the OFF or  LOCK position  and wait approximately  10 seconds     3  Repea
4.                    LPD0469  Type B   Without compass    Type B and Type C    The indicator light  2  will illuminate when the  automatic anti glare feature is operating     To turn off the automatic anti glare feature  press         the O button for inside mirrors without  compass    e the    button for inside mirrors with  compass     The indicator light will turn off     3 26 Pre driving checks and adjustments                         LPD0470  Type C   With compass    To turn on the automatic anti glare feature again   press         the   button for inside mirrors without  compass    e the    button for inside mirrors with  compass     The indicator light will turn on     Some vehicles are also equipped with automatic  anti glare outside mirrors  For additional informa   tion  see  Automatic anti glare outside mirrors  in  this section     For information on HomeLink  Universal Trans   ceiver operation  see the  HomeLink  Universal  Transceiver  in the  Instruments and controls   section of this manual     For information on the compass display  if so  equipped   see  Compass display  in the  Instru   ments and controls  section of this manual              e                  P             LPD0237       OUTSIDE MIRRORS    The outside mirror remote control will operate  only when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON  position     Move the small switch  1  to select the right or left  mirror  Adjust each mirror to the desired position  using the large switch  2      A  WARNI
5.                  LHA1252    8 00    Settings  gt  Camera             Predictive Course Lines                      Displays the vehicle path when showing the rear camera view                LHA1249       Select Units     Select the    US     mi    F  MPG  key or the    Metric      km    C  L 100 km  key to change the units  shown on the display     Voice Recognition     For Voice Recognition settings  refer to    NISSAN  Voice Recognition system    in this section     Camera settings    Select the    Camera    key  The Camera settings  screen will appear     When this option is on  indicator light illumi   nated   predictive course lines will be displayed  when the RearView monitor is displayed on the  screen  See  RearView Monitor  in this section  for more information     Image viewer settings    For information about these settings  refer to   Image viewer    in this section     4 30 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Navigation settings    Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner s  Manual for information regarding these settings     Audio settings    For audio settings  refer to  Audio System  in this  section     Phone settings    For phone settings refer to    Bluetooth   Hands   Free Phone System with Navigation System  in  this section     Bluetooth settings    For Bluetooth  amp  phone settings  refer to     Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone System with  Navigation System  in this section     For Bluetooth   audio settings  refer to     B
6.              LHA1341       Activating Alternate Command Mode    1  Press the SETTING button on the instru   ment panel     2  Select the  Others  key on the display     3  Select the  Voice Recognition  key       Select the  Alternate Command Mode  key     5  The confirmation message is displayed on    the screen  Select the  OK  key to activate  the Alternate Command Mode     6  Alternate Command Mode is activated and  the setting menu is expanded to include the  Alternate Command Mode options  See     Settings menu  in this section for an expla   nation of the options     Displaying the command list    If you are controlling the system by voice com   mands for the first time or do not know the  appropriate voice command  perform the follow   ing procedure for displaying the voice command  list  available only in Alternate Command Mode      Press the       Switch  listen for the tone and  say   Help   The system will respond by display   ing the command list main menu     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 143       Information  gt  Command List 8 00      Phone Commands          Navigation Commands       Information Commands          Audio Commands       l Help Commands    Push the TALK switch to start Voice Recognition             8 00    Information         Fuel Economy   Weather Info         Maintenance Map Update         Navigation Version      Where am 1        l Traffic Info   Others    Show distance to empty and fuel economy                
7.             000  1 18   Child safety   s oeste cet RE RT EROR EAR ege 1 18  Infants    2x bpRRXRq ERE ADI Ree ae 1 19  Srmall childreti        iot op ER RR eiokye ii 1 19  Larger children      zoo sore rene 1 19   Child restraints             0 00  eee eee eee ee 1 20  Precautions on child restraints              issues  1 20    LATCH  Lower Anchors and Tethers for   CHildren  System isse 6 0  c cece eee   Rear facing child restraint installation using   Ee ec PEE   Rear facing child restraint installation using   the seat belts      o etm mm   Forward facing child restraint installation   using  LATCH     e ox eren sane bbe Inte   Forward facing child restraint installation   using the seat belts           le esee eee   Installing top tether strap            isses   Booster Sats  ssa cesse rb et eR ERG EE gel  Supplemental restraint system                    0    Precautions on supplemental restraint   Syste M snes nri ueber plo x s   Supplemental air bag warning labels                 Supplemental air bag warning light                      SEATS                ARS1152          AWARNING      Do not ride in a moving vehicle when    the seatback is reclined  This can be  dangerous  The shoulder belt will not  be against your body  In an accident   you could be thrown into it and receive  neck or other serious injuries  You  could also slide under the lap belt and  receive serious internal injuries         For the most effective protection when    the vehicle is in motion  the 
8.            WSD0243       Manual shift mode    When the shift selector is in the Ds  Drive Sport   position  the transmission is ready for the manual  shift mode  Shift ranges can be selected manu   ally by moving the shift selector up or down  or  pulling the right side or left side paddle shifter   To cancel the Ds mode  return shift selector to the  D  Drive  position  The transmission returns to  automatic driving mode     When the shift selector is shifted from D  Drive   to the manual shift gate    with the vehicle  stopped or while driving  the transmission enters  the manual shift mode  Shift ranges can be se   lected manually  Shift ranges can also be se     Starting and driving 5 15                LSD0193    lected using the shift paddles  if so equipped  on  the steering wheel and  C   In the manual shift  mode  the shift range is displayed on the position  indicator in the meter  When shifting the shift  selector to the manual shift gate  the position  indicator displays 1  first  up to 6  sixth  depend   ing on vehicle speed        Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows   18283648586  M6  6th      Use this position for all normal forward driving at  highway speeds           5 16 Starting and driving    M5  5th      Use this position when driving up long slopes  or  for engine braking when driving down long  slopes     M4  4th   M3  3rd  and M2  2nd      Use for hill climbing or engine braking on downhill  grades     M1  First      Use this position when cli
9.           2 16  8 21  Parking brake operation            5 18  Self adjusting brakes              8 21  Brakes  xs mk RR RA XA 8 21  Breakin schedule                 5 21  Brightness contrast button          4 15  4 31  Brightness control  Instrument panel           iss  2 33  Bulb check instrument panel            2 10  Bulb replacement            sss 8 28  c  Capacities and recommended  fuel lubricants           llle 9 2  Cargo net  s c aec akisa chos meros e ones ow 2 42  Cargo  See vehicle loading information       9 12  Car phone or CBradio             4 104  CD care andcleaning              4 101  CD changer  See audio system          4 66  CD player  See audio system         4 72  4 80    Check tire pressure  Child restraints               Precautions on child    restraints           1 20  1 26  1 30  1 34   Top tether strap anchor point locations    1 24  Child safety rear doorlock             3 6  Chimes  audible reminders             2 16  Cleaning exterior and interior    2 2 2    7 2  Clock    models with navigation system      4 11  4 26  Clock S6t ao sesh ehh 3c uc 4 11  4 26  C M V S S  certification label      0 2    9 10  Cold weather driving                5 28  Compact disc  CD  player          4 72  4 80  Console box    2    leen 2 41    Continuously Variable Transmission  CVT      5 12  Continuously Variable Transmission     CVT  fluid  uo sog Dee 8 12   Driving with Continuously Variable   Transmission  CVT            Ls 5 12   Transmission shift selecto
10.          2 14  Seats  Adjustment  s te soa oie a 1 2  Automatic drive positioner            3 28  Erontseats     ne soma g ae  end 1 2    Heated seats               2 35  2 37   Rear seat ve cal ge ok ww eS ae ars 1 5  Security indicator light                2 16  Security system  NISSAN vehicle immobilizer  system   engine start         2 27  3 3  5 10  Self adjusting brakes             Ln  8 21  Service manual order form             9 27  Servicing air conditioner               4 47  Setting button            saasa 4 9  4 24  Shifting   Continuously Variable Transmission    nap MEM 5 14  Shift lock release            sese 5 17  Shoulder belt height adjustment           1 17  Spark plug replacement              8 18  Speedometer           0 00000008 2 4  Spotlights  See map light              2 52  SRS warning label               Ls  1 51  Starting   Before starting the engine           5 11   Jumpstating             sess 6 8   Precautions when starting and driving       5 2   Pushstarting   suono Rome a 6 10   Starting the engine             5 11  Steering   Heated steering wheel             2 37   Power steering fluid               8 13   Power steering system             5 24  Steering wheel audio control switch        4 102  Stoplight  ss aa ee ee ee ee kms 8 28  StOTdgex d ke eee ee wae eae 2 38  Sunglasses case               0004 2 39  Sunglasses holder                  2 39  Sunroof  see Moonroof               2 46  SUAVISONS  ss cook ee LE a 3 24    Supplemental air 
11.          Press the ENTER button to show the AUX  Menu     ANTENNA    Window antenna    The antenna pattern is printed inside the rear  window     A CAUTION      Do not place metalized film near the  rear window glass or attach any metal  parts to it  This may cause poor recep   tion or noise     e When cleaning the inside of the rear  window  be careful not to scratch or  damage the rear window antenna   Lightly wipe along the antenna with a  dampened soft cloth     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 103    CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO    When installing a CB  ham radio or car phone in  your vehicle  be sure to observe the following  precautions  otherwise  the new equipment may  adversely affect the engine control system and  other electronic parts     AWARNING      Acellular phone should not be used for  any purpose while driving so full atten   tion may be given to vehicle operation   Some jurisdictions prohibit the use of  cellular phones while driving        If you must make a call while your ve   hicle is in motion  the hands free cellu   lar phone operational mode  if so  equipped  is highly recommended  Ex   ercise extreme caution at all times so  full attention may be given to vehicle  operation         If you are unable to devote full attention  to vehicle operation while talking on  the phone  pull off the road to a safe  location and stop your vehicle     A CAUTION    Keep the antenna as far away as pos   sible from the electronic control  mod
12.         Bit rate     Bit rate denotes the number of  bits per second used by a digital video files   The size and quality of a compressed digital  audio file is determined by the bit rate used  when encoding the file     4 62 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Requirements for Supporting Video Playback      Meda   CD  CD R  CD RW  DVD  DVD R  DVD RW  DVD RW DL  USB 2 0 Memory  CD  CD R  CD RW  DVD  ISO9660 LEVEL1  ISO9660 LEVEL2  Romeo  Joliet  UDF Bridge  UDF1 02 ISO9660   UDF1 5  UDF2 0  DVD R  DVD RW  DVD RW    19SO9660 Level 3  packet writing  is not supported   File Systems   DL   Files saved using the Live File System component  on a Windows Vista based computer  are not supported     VDF1 5 VDF2 0  packet writing  is not supported     USB Memory FAT16  FAT32   divx   avi Video Codecs DivX3  DivX4  DivX5  DivX6    Audio Codecs MP3  MPEG2 5 Audio Layer3  AC3  LPCM  File Types  Audio Codec G 726    oi a 4 Mbps  Bit Rat   umm  Reimar redi                      svess  EXT 82 92  Resolution    720 x 480  as 52 32  720x576       Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 63       1 2 3                  gt   a       LOAD      9    10   11   12   13   14     SEEK CAT button  DISC button  RPT RDM button  SCAN button  AM FM button  DISP CLOCK button    90  9  9    9    AM FM    DISC    A    U    X       VOL  N KELE LOB        Mu          SONOS  DISP RPT SEEK    CLOCK   SCAN    RDM 3 CAT Er  gt i    14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6  LHA2104  1
13.        To exit  hold the TALK switch          LHA1334          Voice Recognition  gt Dial Num   Yal 8 00    2   Dial Number         Please say the entire number or groups  of numbers Manual Controls                      To exit  hold the TALK switch    LHA1335          Voice Recognition  gt Dial Num     full 8 00  5   800       99 Dial     47 Change Number J Help  Manual Controls                            Please say the next 3 digits   Dial   or  say  Change Number              To exit  hold the TALK switch       LHA1336       4  Say  Dial Number      5  Say  800      6  The system announces   Please say the next  three digits or dial  or say change number      7  Say    662        Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 139       Voice Recognition  gt Dial Num     Tull 8 00     99 Change Number       800 662                 Help  Manual Controls          Please say the last 4 digits or say   Change Number           To exit  hold the TALK switch             LHA1337          Voice Recognition  gt Dial Num   Yal 8 00    3   99 Dial   99 Change Number       800 662 6200                     Manual Controls         Please say  Dial  or say  Change  Number              To exit  hold the TALK switch          LHA1338       8  The system announces   Please say the last  four digits or say change number      9  Say  6200      10     11   12     The system announces   Dial or Change  Number      Say  Dial    The system makes a call to 800 662  6200     NOTE     Y
14.        WRS0763       Rear facing   step 6      After attaching the child restraint  test it be     fore you place the child in it  Push it from side  to side while holding the child restraint near  the seat belt path  The child restraint should  not move more than 1 inch  25 mm   from  side to side  Try to tug it forward and check  to see if the belt holds the restraint in place   If the restraint is not secure  tighten the seat  belt as necessary  or put the restraint in  another seat and test it again  You may need  to try a different child restraint  Not all child  restraints fit in all types of vehicles     7  Check to make sure that the child restraint is  properly secured prior to each use  If the  seat belt is not locked  repeat steps 1  through 6     After the child restraint is removed and the seat  belt fully retracted  the ALR mode  child restraint  mode  is canceled     FORWARD FACING CHILD  RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING  LATCH    Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the    Child  safety    and    Child restraints    sections before in   stalling a child restraint     Follow these steps to install a forward facing  child restraint using the LATCH system     1  Position the child restraint on the seat  Al   ways follow the child restraint manufactur   er s instructions                 Po WRS0788    Forward facing web mounted   step 2   2  Secure the child restraint anchor attach   ments to the LATCH lower anchors  Check  to make sure the LATCH attachment is prop   
15.       Information  gt  Command List 8 00      Phone Commands          Navigation Commands       Information Commands          Audio Commands       l Help Commands    Push the TALK switch to start Voice Recognition             LHA1342 LHA1231 LHA1342  Only manual controls such as the touchscreen 1  Press the INFO button on the instrument 5  Select a category using the NISSAN con   can navigate the command list menu  panel  troller  The command list for the category  As an alternative to the voice command  Help   2  Select the  Others  key using the NISSAN selected ie snowht  you may access the command list using the fol  controller  6  If necessary  scroll the screen using the    lowing steps     3  Select the    Voice Recognition    key using the  NISSAN controller     NOTE   You can skip steps 1 to 3 if you say    Help        4  Select the    Command List    key using the  NISSAN controller     4 144 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    NISSAN controller to view the entire list     7  Press the BACK button to return to the    previous screen     Alternate Command Mode command list    Phone Command     Makes an international call by allowing more than 10 digits to be spoken  as well as star      pound      and plus         Call  lt name gt  Makes a call to a contact that is stored in either the Vehicle Phonebook or Handset Phonebook  Please say    Call    followed by a stored  name     Incoming Calls Shows the last 5 incoming phone calls   Outgoing 
16.       When the ignition switch is placed in the ON or  START position  the supplemental air bag warn   ing light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then  turns off if the SRS air bag systems are opera   tional  This means the system is operational     2 14 Instruments and controls    If any of the following conditions occur  the air  bags and or pretensioner systems need servic   ing and your vehicle must be taken to a NISSAN  dealer       The supplemental air bag warning light re   mains on after approximately 7 seconds       The supplemental air bag warning light  flashes intermittently       The supplemental air bag warning light does  not come on at all     Unless checked and repaired  the supplemental  restraint systems  air bag systems  and or the  pretensioners may not function properly  For ad   ditional details see    Supplemental restraint sys   tem    in the    Safety   Seats  seat belts and  supplemental restraint system    section of this  manual     AWARNING    If the supplemental air bag warning light  is on  it could mean that the front air bag   side air bag  curtain air bag systems  and or pretensioner systems will not op   erate in an accident  To help avoid injury  to yourself or others  have your vehicle  checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as  possible     INDICATOR LIGHTS   CVT Continuously Variable  Transmission  CVT  indicator  light    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  the light comes on for 2 seconds     P Continuously Variable
17.      5  Tighten the tether strap according to the  manufacturer s instructions to remove any  slack           WRS0697       Forward facing     step 6    6  After attaching the child restraint  test it be   fore you place the child in it  Push it from side  to side while holding the child restraint near  the LATCH attachment path  The child re   straint should not move more than 1 inch   25 mm   from side to side  Try to tug it  forward and check to see if the LATCH at   tachment holds the restraint in place  If the  restraint is not secure  tighten the LATCH  attachment as necessary  or put the restraint  in another seat and test it again  You may  need to try a different child restraint  Not all  child restraints fit in all types of vehicles     1 30 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    7  Check to make sure the child restraint is  properly secured prior to each use  If the  child restraint is loose  repeat steps 1  through 6     FORWARD FACING CHILD  RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING  THE SEAT BELTS    AWARNING    The three point seat belt with Automatic  Locking Retractor  ALR  must be used  when installing a child restraint  Failure to  use the ALR mode will result in the child  restraint not being properly secured  The  restraint could tip over or be loose and  cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or  collision  Also  it can change the opera   tion of the front passenger air bag  See     Front passenger air bag and status light     later in this
18.      Position the lap belt as low and snug as  possible AROUND THE HIPS  NOT THE  WAIST  A lap belt worn too high could  increase the risk of internal injuries in  an accident     Be sure the seat belt tongue is securely  fastened to the proper buckle     Do not wear the seat belt inside out or  twisted  Doing so may reduce its  effectiveness     Do not allow more than one person to  use the same seat belt     Never carry more people in the vehicle  than there are seat belts     If the seat belt warning light glows con   tinuously while the ignition is placed in  the ON position with all doors closed  and all seat belts fastened  it may indi   cate a malfunction in the system  Have  the system checked by a NISSAN  dealer     No changes should be made to the seat  belt system  For example  do not modify  the seat belt  add material  or install  devices that may change the seat belt  routing or tension  Doing so may affect  the operation of the seat belt system   Modifying or tampering with the seat  belt system may result in serious per   sonal injury     e Once a seat belt pretensioner has acti     vated  it cannot be reused and must be  replaced together with the retractor   See your NISSAN dealer     Removal and installation of preten   sioner system components should be  done by a NISSAN dealer     All seat belt assemblies  including re   tractors and attaching hardware   should be inspected after any collision  by a NISSAN dealer  NISSAN recom   mends that all seat belt a
19.     8 00  S249    Settings  gt  Volume  amp  Beeps         Audio Volume        feceeese eee  EC  Guidance Volume C  lOssoccccossej    gt        Ringtone G  P cccccccccces    gt   Incoming Call G  bO ccesccccccoef    gt     Outgoing Call     toe  5      l going       1 7                                        Use volume knob to adjust during playback                LHA1253       CALL VOLUME    Adjusting the incoming or outgoing call volume  may improve clarity if reception between callers is  unclear       Incoming call     adjusting this setting allows  you to hear a difference in volume         Outgoing call     adjusting this setting allows  the person you are talking with to hear a  difference in volume     To access the settings  press the SETTING but   ton  then select  Volume  amp  Beeps        You can also adjust the volume of an incoming  voice during a call by pushing the volume control  switch on the steering wheel or by turning the  volume control knob on the instrument panel     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 129    NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITION  SYSTEM  if so equipped     NISSAN Voice Recognition allows hands free  operation of the systems equipped on this ve   hicle  such as phone and vehicle information     There are two voice recognition modes of opera   tion available  They are         Standard Mode      Alternate Command Mode    In Standard Mode  the factory default setting    commands that are available are always shown  on the di
20.     CD eject button 5  TUNE FOLDER and AUDIO control  2  VOL ON OFF control knob knob  Bass  Treble  Fade  Balance  SSV  3  Station and CD select  1   6  buttons  if so equipped   and Beep   4  LOAD CD button 6  AUX IN jack  7    AUX button  8  TRACK button    4 64 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    FM AM RADIO WITH COMPACT  DISC  CD  CHANGER  if so  equipped    For all operation precautions  see  Audio opera   tion precautions  in this section    Audio main operation   VOL ON OFF control     Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position and push the VOL ON OFF control knob  while the system is off to call up the mode  radio  or CD  that was playing immediately before the  system was turned off     To turn the system off  press the VOL ON OFF  control knob     Turn the VOL ON OFF control knob to adjust the  volume     AUDIO control knob  Bass  Treble  Fade   Balance and Beep      Press the AUDIO control knob to change the  mode as follows     Bass     Treble     Fade     Balance     Beep  ON OFF     Bass    To adjust Bass  Treble  Fade and Balance  press  the AUDIO control knob until the desired mode  appears on the display  Turn the TUNE FOLDER  knob to adjust Bass and Treble to the desired  level  You can also use the TUNE FOLDER knob  to adjust Fade and Balance modes  Fade adjusts  the sound level between the front and rear speak   ers and Balance adjusts the sound between the  right and left speakers     To change the Beep to ON or OFF 
21.     Child  Safety        Child Restraint    and    Booster Seats     sections before installing a child restraint     Follow these steps to install a booster seat in the  rear seat or in the front passenger seat           Po       WRS0699       1  If you must install a booster seat in the  front seat  move the seat to the rear   most position     2  Position the booster seat on the seat  Only    place it in a front facing direction  Always  follow the booster seat manufacturer s in   structions     1 36 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system                LRS0454  Front passenger position    3  The booster seat should be positioned on  the vehicle seat so that it is stable     If necessary  adjust or remove the head re   straint to obtain the correct booster seat fit  If  the head restraint is removed  store it in a  secure place  Be sure to reinstall the  head restraint when the booster seat is  removed  See  Head restraints  in this sec   tion for head restraint adjustment  removal  and installation information     If the seating position does not have an  adjustable head restraint and it is interfering  with the proper booster seat fit  try another  seating position or a different booster seat     4  Position the lap portion of the seat belt low  and snug on the child   s hips  Be sure to  follow the booster seat manufacturer s in   structions for adjusting the seat belt routing     5  Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belt  toward the retra
22.     Entry exit function                LRS2009  MEMORY STORAGE FUNCTION    Two positions for the driver s seat  steering col   umn  and outside mirrors can be stored in the  automatic drive positioner memory  Follow these  procedures to use the memory system        1  Set the Continuously Variable Transmission   CVT  shift selector to the P  Park  position     2  Place the ignition in the ON position     3  Adjust the driver s seat  steering column   and outside mirrors to the desired positions  by manually operating each adjusting  switch  For additional information  see   Seats  in the  Safety   Seats  seat belts and    supplemental restraint system  section and   Outside mirrors  in this section     During this step  do not place the ignition  Switch in any position other than ON     4  Push the SET switch and  within 5 seconds   push the memory switch  1 or 2      The indicator light for the pushed memory  switch will come on and stay on for approxi   mately 5 seconds after pushing the switch   After the indicator light goes off  the se   lected positions are stored in the selected  memory  1 or 2      If    new memory is stored in the same memory  Switch  the previous memory will be deleted     Linking a keyfob to a stored memory  position  Each keyfob can be linked to a stored memory    position  memory switch 1 or 2  with the follow   ing procedure     1  Follow the steps for storing a memory position     2  While the indicator light for the memory  switch being set is
23.     G           S                LIC1408       AUTOMATIC MOONROOF    The moonroof will only operate when the ignition  switch is placed in the ON position  The auto   matic moonroof is operational for a period of time   even if the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or  OFF position  If the driver s door or the front  passenger s door is opened during this period of  time  the power to the moonroof is canceled     Sliding the moonroof    To fully open the moonroof  push the switch    toward c    D     To fully close the moonroof  push the switch  toward eZ        2 46 Instruments and controls    To open or close the moonroof part way  push the  switch in any direction while the moonroof is  sliding to stop it in the desired position     Tilting the moonroof    Close the moonroof by pushing the switch  toward  lt  gt   2   Release the switch  then push    the switch toward  lt  gt   2  again to tilt the  moonroof up     To tilt the moonroof down  push the switch    toward c          AWARNING        In an accident you could be thrown from  the vehicle through an open moonroof   Always use seat belts and child restraints     e Do not allow anyone to stand up or  extend any portion of their body out of  the moonroof opening while the vehicle  is in motion or while the moonroof is  closing     A CAUTION    e Remove water drops  snow  ice or sand  from the moonroof before opening         Do not place heavy objects on the  moonroof or surrounding area     Auto reverse function  wh
24.     If this indicator illuminates  insert the Intelligent  Key into the Intelligent Key port in the correct  direction  See    Push button ignition switch    in  the    Starting and driving    section     NISSAN Intelligent Key   removal indica   tor    This indicator illuminates when the driver s door  is opened with the ignition switch placed in the  OFF position and the Intelligent Key placed in the  Intelligent Key port  A key reminder chime also  sounds     If this indicator illuminates  remove the Intelligent  Key from the Intelligent Key port and take it with  you when leaving the vehicle     NISSAN Intelligent Key   battery dis   charge indicator    This indicator illuminates when the Intelligent Key  battery is running out of power     If this indicator illuminates  replace the battery  with a new one  See    Battery replacement    in the     Maintenance and do it yourself    section     Loose fuel cap warning    This warning appears when the fuel filler cap is  not tightened correctly after the vehicle has been  refueled  See    Fuel filler cap  in the    Pre driving  checks and adjustments    section     Check tire pressure warning    This warning appears when the low tire pressure  warning light in the meter illuminates and low tire  pressure is detected  If this warning appears   stop the vehicle and adjust the tire pressure to  the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on  the Tire and Loading Information label  See    Low  tire pressure warning light    earlier 
25.     OFF    Auto Interior Illumination  Select to turn on or  turn off the illumination of the interior lights when  any door is unlocked     Auto Headlights Sensitivity  Select to adjust  the sensitivity of the automatic headlights higher   right  or lower  left      Auto Headlights Off Delay  Select to change  the duration of the automatic headlight off timer  from O   30   45   60   90   120   150  and  180 second periods    Speed Sensing Wiper Interval  Select to turn    on orturn off the wiper interval adjusted automati   cally according to the vehicle speed     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 13    Selective Door Unlock  When this item is  turned on  only the driver   s door is unlocked first  after the door unlock operation  When the door  handle request switch on the driver s or front  passenger s side door is pushed to be unlocked   only the corresponding door is unlocked first  All  the doors can be unlocked if the door unlock  operation is performed again within 1 minute     When this item is turned to off  all the doors will  be unlocked after the door unlock operation is  performed once     Intelligent Key Lock   Unlock  Select to turn  on or turn off the door lock unlock function by  pushing the door handle request switch     Lift Steering Wheel on Exit  Select to turn on  or turn off the steering wheel moving upward for  easy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFF  position and the driver s door is opened  After  getting into 
26.     Refill the fuel tank before the gauge regis   ters E  Empty      2 6 Instruments and controls    The   gp indicates that the fuel filler door is  located on the driver s side of the vehicle      A CAUTION     If the vehicle runs out of fuel     the  iene Malfunction Indicator Light    SOON   MIL  may come on  Refuel as soon as  possible  After a few driving trips     the ENGINE light should turn off  If the    light remains on after a few driving  trips  have the vehicle inspected by a  NISSAN dealer         For additional information  see    Mal   function Indicator Light  MIL     later in  this section     COMPASS DISPLAY  if so equipped     This unit measures terrestrial magnetism and in   dicates the heading direction of the vehicle     With the ignition placed in the ON position  press  the      button as described in the charts be   low to activate various features of the automatic  anti glare rearview mirror     Push and hold  the  N   Push button again for about 1 sec   button for about    ond to change settings     Compass display toggles on off    Feature     Compass zone can be changed to  8 seconds    correct false compass readings  Compass enters calibration mode    For information about the automatic anti glare  feature  refer to  Automatic anti glare rearview  mirror  in the  Pre driving checks and adjust   ments  section              ae    mener 1            N                LIC1487             COMPASS DISPLAY    Push the 4  button for about 1 second when 
27.     The driver supplemental front impact air bag is  located in the center of the steering wheel  The  passenger supplemental front impact air bag is  mounted in the instrument panel above the glove  box  The front air bags are designed to inflate in  higher severity frontal collisions  although they  may inflate if the forces in another type of collision  are similar to those of a higher severity frontal  impact  They may not inflate in certain frontal  collisions  Vehicle damage  or lack of it  is not  always an indication of proper front air bag sys   tem operation     The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dual  stage inflators  It also monitors information from  the crash zone sensor  the Air Bag Control Unit   ACU   seat belt buckle sensors and the occu   pant classification sensor  pattern sensor   Infla   tor operation is based on the severity of a colli   sion and seat belt usage for the driver  For the  front passenger  the occupant classification sen   sor is also monitored  Based on information from  the sensors  only one front air bag may inflate in a  crash  depending on the crash severity and  whether the front occupants are belted or un   belted  Additionally  the front passenger air bag  may be automatically turned OFF under some  conditions  depending on the weight detected on  the passenger seat and how the seat belt is used   If the front passenger air bag is OFF  the passen   ger air bag status light will be illuminated  if the  seat is unoccupied  the li
28.     Transmission  CVT  position  indicator light    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  the indicator light shows the shift selec   tor position  See  Driving the vehicle  in the   Starting and driving  section of this manual        CRUISE Cruise main switch indicator  light          The light comes on when the cruise control main  switch is pushed  The light goes out when the  main switch is pushed again  When the cruise  main switch indicator light comes on  the cruise  control system is operational     Front passenger air bag status  OFF light    The front passenger air bag status light will be lit  and the passenger front air bag will be OFF  depending on how the front passenger seat is  being used     For front passenger air bag status light operation   see    Front passenger air bag and status light    in  the    Safety     Seats  seat belts and supplemental  restraint system    section of this manual           High beam indicator light               blue   This blue light comes on when the headlight high    beams are on and goes out when the low beams  are selected        The high beam indicator light also comes on  when the passing signal is activated     SERVICE Ld    ENGINE Malfunction indicator light     MIL     If the malfunction indicator light comes on steady  or blinks while the engine is running  it may indi   cate a potential emission control and or CVT  malfunction        The malfunction indicator light may also come on  steady if the fue
29.     While connected to the vehicle  the iPod   can  only be operated by the vehicle audio controls     To disconnect the iPod   from the vehicle  re   move the USB end of the cable from the USB  jack on the vehicle  then remove the cable from  the iPod         iPod   is a trademark of Apple Inc   registered in  the U S  and other countries     Compatibility  The following models are compatible       iPod  5th Generation   version 1 2 1  iPod   Classic   version 1 1  iPod   Touch   version 2 1 0  iPod   Nano   1st generation version 1 3 1    iPod   Nano   2nd generation version 1 1 3    iPod   Nano   3rd generation version 1 0 2    Make sure that your iPod   firmware is updated to  the version indicated above         El iPod    8 00     amp  xxxxxx   9 XXXXXX  Jd XXXXXX  0 25  1 1    Shuffle Off  Repeat Off                LHA1395       Audio main operation    Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position  Press the AUX button repeatedly to  switch to the iPod   mode     If the system has been turned off while the iPod    was playing  pressing the VOL ON OFF control  knob will start the iPod       AUX button     When the AUX button is pressed with the system  off and the iPod   connected  the system will turn  on  If another audio source is playing and the  iPod   is connected  press the AUX button re   peatedly until the center display changes to the  iPod   mode     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 93                                       
30.     fA  iPod 8 00  9 Xxxxxx     9 XXXXXX Now Playing    4d XXXXXX Playlists    0    0  2 Artists E  Shuffle Off Albums E  Repeat One    Songs z  Men H  enu    Il 2 10 Down H     Use   or  buttons to move between left right menus     LHA1396             Interface     The interface for iPod   operation shown on the  vehicle center display is similar to the iPod    interface  Use the NISSAN controller and the  BACK button to play the iPod   with your favorite  settings     The following items can be chosen from the menu  list screen  For further information about each  item  see the iPod   Owner s Manual         Playlists      Podcasts    e Songs    Albums  Artists    Genres    Composers      Audiobooks    The following keys shown on the screen are also  available         MENU  returns to the previous screen     e Pil  plays pauses the music selected   SEEK CAT and TRACK buttons     When the M4     SEEK CAT button or Pl  TRACK button is pressed for less than 1 5 sec   onds while the iPod   is playing  the next track or  the beginning of the current track on the iPod    will be played     When the 44     SEEK CAT button or P    TRACK button is pressed for more than 1 5 sec   onds while the iPod   is playing  the iPod   will  play while fast forwarding or rewinding  When the  button is released  the iPod   will return to the  normal play speed     4 94 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems                LHA2030       iPod    PLAYER OPERATION WITH  NAVIGATIO
31.     key     5  Enter a PIN of your choice  It will be needed  by your Bluetooth  amp  audio device to com   plete the connection process  See the  Bluetooth   audio device s owner s manual  for more information     Audio main operation    To switch to the Bluetooth   audio mode  press  the DISC AUX button repeatedly until the  Bluetooth   audio mode is displayed on the  Screen     The controls for the Bluetooth  amp  audio are dis   played on the screen     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 99                Settings  gt  Bluetooth   o dm Yul 8 00 Settings  gt  connect Devic   Go GN Yul 8 00 Gozack  Settings  gt  Audio Player Sod Yul 8 00 acK                                         Bluetooth XXXXXXXX  Connect Bluetooth XXXXXXXX                      Connected Devices Handsfree Phone None                   Edit Bluetooth Info Audio Player None                Replace Connected Phone None                                           LHA1316 LHA1296 LHA1297    Bluetooth   audio settings 4  Select the  Audio Player  key  5  A list of the connected Bluetooth   audio  players is displayed  Select the name of the  device you wish to edit        To adjust the Bluetooth   audio settings  follow  the procedure below     1  Press the SETTING button on the instru   ment panel     2  Select the  Bluetooth  key     3  Select the  Connected Devices  key     4 100 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems             Settings  gt  Audio Player Sod Y
32.     l Display Album Cover Art          eon                          LHA1257         8 00  Artist TUNE  3 Folder  XXXXXXXX  Album  XXXXXXXX     Track  XXXXXXXX   Folder 1of4  Track 1ofi 0 40                LHA1258       For information on how to use the NISSAN con   troller  see  How to use the NISSAN controller  in  this section     Display album cover art     When an audio source encoded with album  cover art is played  the album cover art can be  displayed on the screen  To toggle this feature on  or off  touch the  Display Album Cover Art  key   When the feature is activated  the amber indica   tor next to the word ON will illuminate     CD  DVD or USB with compressed audio  files    While listening to a CD or compressed audio  files  certain text might be able to be displayed   when CD encoded with text is being used      Depending on how the CD or compressed audio  files are encoded  the following text might be  displayed         Folder displays the name of the current  folder being accessed         File displays the name of the file currently  playing     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 77        Song displays the ID3 encoded tag of the  song name         Album displays the ID3 encoded tag of the  album name         Artist displays the ID8 encoded tag of the  artist s name     Some of this text might not display while playing a  regular CD     FM AM SAT radio operation  FM AM band select     Pressing the FM AM button will change the band  
33.     s  8 32  Wheel tiresize         ee 9 8  Tire pressure  Low tire pressure warning light            2 12    Tire Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS        5 3  Towing    Flat towing  taane s ente Dosen 9 23   Towing load specification                   9 19   Towtrucktowing  o socu naca ea ad 6 11   Trailertowing  a e sa a meea ee d 9 16  Transceiver   HomeLink   Universal Transceiver        2 53    Transmission  Continuously Variable Transmission     CVT  fluid    um oe yx Reg 8 12  Driving with Continuously Variable  Transmission  CVT            Ls 5 12  Shift selector lock release              5 17  Travel  See registering your vehicle in another  COUNTY  43 x ose yum E RR aa aed 9 9  Tip odometer      atu y xo Re 2 4  Trunk access through the rear seat        1 5  1 6  Trunk lid lock opener lever            s  3 18  Tr  nklight  ss sa ee km 2 53  Turn signal switch           sess 2 34    U  Uniform tire quality grading             9 24  USB interface  Audio file operation            4 87  4 89  Video file operation               4 90  v  Vanity MINON 4 2 ie eee Wa ee ewe Ro on 3 24  Variable voltage control system           8 17  Vehicle dimensions and weights           9 8  Vehicle dynamic control  VDC  off switch      2 37  Vehicle dynamic control  VDC  system          5 26  Vehicle identification              s  9 9  Vehicle identification number  VIN    Chassis number             l l 9 9  Vehicle identification number  VIN  plate        9 9  Vehicle loading informatio
34.    FOREWORD    Welcome to the growing family of new NISSAN  owners  This vehicle is delivered to you with  confidence  It was produced using the latest  techniques and strict quality control     This manual was prepared to help you under   stand the operation and maintenance of your  vehicle so that you may enjoy many miles  kilome   ters  of driving pleasure  Please read through this  manual before operating your vehicle     A separate Warranty Information Booklet  explains details about the warranties cov   ering your vehicle  The    NISSAN Service  and Maintenance Guide    explains details  about maintaining and servicing your ve   hicle  Additionally  a separate Customer  Care Lemon Law Booklet  U S  only  will  explain how to resolve any concerns you  may have with your vehicle  as well as  clarify your rights under your state   s lemon  law     Your NISSAN dealership knows your vehicle  best  When you require any service or have any  questions  they will be glad to assist you with the  extensive resources available to them     In addition to factory installed options  your ve   hicle may also be equipped with additional ac   cessories installed by NISSAN or by your  NISSAN dealer prior to delivery  It is important  that you familiarize yourself with all disclosures     warnings  cautions and instructions concerning  proper use of such accessories prior to operating  the vehicle and or accessory  See a NISSAN  dealer for details concerning the particular ac   cessories w
35.    If the system has learned the command correctly   the voice command indicator on the screen turns  on     Speaker Adaptation function settings  Edit Name     Edit the user name using the keypad displayed on  the screen     Reset Result     Resets the user s voice that the Voice Recogni   tion system has learned     Continuous Learning     When this item is turned to ON  you can have the  system learn the voice commands in succession   without selecting commands one by one     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 151    TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE    The system should respond correctly to all voice  commands without difficulty  If problems are en   countered  follow the solutions given in this guide  for the appropriate error     Where the solutions are listed by number  try  each solution in turn  starting with number one   until the problem is resolved     Displays    COMMAND NOT RECOG    Ensure that the command format is valid  see    Standard Mode command list    or    Alternate Command Mode command list    in this  NIZED    or the system fails to interpret section     the command correctly    Speak clearly using your normal speech pattern and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level   Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive  for example  windows open or defrost on     NOTE     If it is too noisy to use the phone  it is likely that voice commands will not be recognized     The system consistently selects the 1  Ensure that the v
36.    Once a command is recognized  the system    will announce the recognized command and  perform the requested action     If the command is not recognized  the sys   tem repeats the announcement  Repeat the  command in a clear voice after the tone     Operating tips    Say a command after the tone  Voice com   mands cannot be accepted when the icon    IS       If the command is not recognized  the sys   tem repeats the announcement  Repeat the  command in a clear voice     Press the  amp  switch on the steering  wheel to return to the previous screen     If you want to cancel the command  press    and hold the     switch  The message    Voice cancelled  will be announced     If you want to adjust the volume of the sys   tem feedback  push the volume control  switch on the steering wheel or use the  audio system volume knob while the system  is making an announcement     To minimize the amount of prompts spoken  by the system in Alternate Command Mode   use the Minimize Voice Feedback function   To access the Minimize Voice Feedback  function press the SETTING button  then  select the  Others  key  Then select the   Voice Recognition  key     How to speak numbers    Voice Recognition requires a certain way to  speak numbers when giving voice commands   Refer to the following examples     General rule       Only single digits 0  zero  to 9 can be used         When saying the phone number 800 662   6200  the system will accept  eight   hundred  in addition to  eight zero zero  o
37.    To unlock the door without the key  move the  inside lock knob to the unlock position  2      uu  iA  CE    Q    WPD0381    LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR  LOCK SWITCH    To lock all the doors without a key  push the door  lock switch  driver s or front passenger s side  to  the lock position  1   When locking the door this  way  be certain not to leave the key inside the  vehicle              To unlock all the doors without a key  push the  door lock switch  driver s or front passenger s  side  to the unlock position        Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 5    Lockout protection    When the power door lock switch  driver   s or  front passenger s side  is moved to the lock  position with the Intelligent Key in the port and  any door open  all doors will lock and unlock  automatically  With the Intelligent Key left in the  vehicle  not in the Intelligent Key port  and any  door open  all doors will unlock automatically and  a chime will sound after the door is closed     AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS        All doors lock automatically when the vehicle  speed reaches 15 MPH  24 km h          All doors unlock automatically when the ig   nition is placed in the OFF position     The automatic unlock function can be de   activated or activated  To deactivate or acti   vate the automatic door unlock system  perform  the following procedure     1  Close all doors   2  Place the ignition switch in the ON position     3  Within 20 seconds of performing Step 2   push and hold the power door l
38.    audio device in  an area surrounded by metal or far away from  the in vehicle Bluetooth   module to prevent  tone quality degradation and wireless con   nection disruption     While an audio device is connected through  the Bluetooth   wireless connection  the  battery power of the device may discharge  quicker than usual     This system supports the Bluetooth   Audio  Distribution Profile  A2DP  AVRCP      BLUETOOTH   is a  trademark owned by  Bluetooth SIG  Inc   and licensed to  Clarion Co   Ltd       Bluetooth      CD or USB with Compressed Audio  Files  models without Navigation  System     The file types supported by this system are MP3  and WMA     Explanation of terms     MP3     MP3 is short for Moving Pictures  Experts Group Audio Layer 3  MP3 is the  most well known compressed digital audio  file format  This format allows for near    CD  quality    sound  but at a fraction of the size of  normal audio files  MP3 conversion of an  audio track from CD ROM can reduce the  file size by approximately a 10 1 ratio with  virtually no perceptible loss in quality  MP3  compression removes the redundant and  irrelevant parts of a sound signal that the  human ear doesn t hear     WMA     Windows Media Audio  WMA   is a  compressed audio format created by Micro   soft as an alternative to MP3  The WMA  codec offers greater file compression than  the MP8 codec  enabling storage of more  digital audio tracks in the same amount of  space when compared to MP3s at the same  lev
39.    ing a call         Do not place the cellular phone in an area  surrounded by metal or far away from the  in vehicle phone module to prevent tone  quality degradation and wireless connection  disruption       While a cellular phone is connected through  the Bluetooth   wireless connection  the  battery power of the cellular phone may dis   charge quicker than usual  The Bluetooth    Hands Free Phone System cannot charge  cellular phones       Ifthe hands free phone system seems to be  malfunctioning  see  Troubleshooting guide   in this section  You can also visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth for trouble   shooting help         Some cellular phones or other devices may  cause interference or a buzzing noise to  come from the audio system speakers  Stor   ing the device in a different location may  reduce or eliminate the noise         Refer to the cellular phone Owner s Manual  regarding the telephone charges  cellular  phone antenna and body  etc     REGULATORY INFORMATION    FCC Regulatory information      CAUTION  To maintain compliance with  FCC s RF exposure guidelines  use only the  supplied antenna  Unauthorized antenna   modification  or attachments could damage  the transmitter and may violate FCC regula   tions         Operation is subject to the following two con   ditions     1  This device may not cause interference and    2  this device must accept any interference   including interference that may cause unde   sired operation of the device     IC Regulatory i
40.   99 Call History           39 Intemational Call          To exit  hold the TALK switch       LHA1334       Example 2     Placing an international call  to the phone number 011 81 111 222 3333     1  Pressthe    switch located on the steer     ing wheel     2  The system announces   Would you like to  access Phone  Navigation  Information  Au   dio or Help      3  Say  Phone      4  Say  International Call      Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 141          Voice Recognition  gt  Internatio    Yul 8 00    E   International Call      Manual Controls                Say the entire number or groups of  numbers  Say 0 9  pound      star     or  plus            To exit  hold the TALK switch             LHA1339       Voice Recognition  gt  Internatio    Yul 8 00    3   99 Dial   47 Change Number       011811112223333                     Manual Controls              Please continue  or say  Dial           To exit  hold the TALK switch                LHA1340       5  Say  011811112223333      6  Say  Dial      7  The system makes a call to 011 81 111   222 3338     NOTE     Any digit input format is available in the  International Number input process  as  well as the special characters such as star       pound      and plus         4 142 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITION  ALTERNATE COMMAND MODE    The Alternate Command Mode enables control  of the audio and display systems as well as  additional comma
41.   AWARNING      Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo  area or on the rear seat when it is in the  fold down position  Use of these areas  by passengers without proper restraints  could result in serious injury in an acci   dent or sudden stop           LRS0863    Thigh extension  driver s side only  if  so equipped        Pull up and hold the lever to extend the front    portion to the desired position  e Properly secure all cargo with ropes or    straps to help prevent it from sliding or  shifting  Do not place cargo higher than  the seatbacks  In a sudden stop or col   WRSO0866 lision  unsecured cargo could cause    FOLDING REAR SEAT  if so personal injury   equipped                 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 5      When returning the seatbacks to the  upright position  be certain they are  completely secured in the latched posi   tion  If they are not completely secured   passengers may be injured in an acci   dent or sudden stop         Closely supervise children when they  are around cars to prevent them from  playing and becoming locked in the  trunk where they could be seriously in   jured  Keep the car locked  with the rear  seatback and trunk lid securely latched  when not in use  and prevent children s  access to car keys                 WRS0867                LPD0459       To fold down the driver side of the rear seat  reach  through the opening and pull on the strap  1   located behind the seat     The rear seats can be locke
42.   Add New  key at the top of the    3     Screen     Choose the method for entering the phone   book entry  For this example  select  Enter  Number by Keypad        Enter the digits and select the  OK  key  For    more information  see  How to use the  touchscreen  in this section     4 122 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems      Select the  Voicetag  key to record a name    to speak when using the Voice Recognition  System       Select the  Store  key and prepare to speak    the name after the tone       When the voicetag is successfully saved     GS    select the  OK  key to save the  phonebook entry       After the phonebook entry is saved  it will    show a screen that is ready to call the num   ber  Press the BACK button to return to the  Vehicle Phonebook            Copy from Call History  The system will show a list of your incoming   outgoing or missed calls that were down   loaded from your cell phone  depending on  your phone s compatibility   You may select  one of these entries to save in the vehicle  phonebook        Copy from the Handset fa  INFORMATION Delete Number XXX XXXX    The system will show your cell phone s ai Type E  phonebook that was downloaded  depend    Voicetag wh  ing on your phone s compatibility   You may   select one of these entries to save in the  vehicle phonebook              Phone  gt  Vehicle Phonebook  o dll iu 8 00 sack  Phone  gt  Vehicle Phonebook     8o HIN Yul Back                                S Call En
43.   An in   flating front air bag could seriously in   jure or kill your child  See  Child re   straints  earlier in this section for  details     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 41                Do not lean against the door         SS0101             Do not lean against the door     SSS0188          AWARNING    Front seat mounted side impact supple   mental air bags and roof mounted curtain  side impact supplemental air bags        The side air bags and curtain air bags  ordinarily will not inflate in the event of  a frontal impact  rear impact  rollover or  lower severity side collision  Always  wear your seat belts to help reduce the  risk or severity of injury in various kinds  of accidents     1 42 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    A WARNING        The seat belts  the side air bags and    curtain air bags are most effective when  you are sitting well back and upright in  the seat with both feet on the floor  The  side air bag and curtain air bag inflate  with great force  Do not allow anyone to  place their hand  leg or face near the  side air bag on the side of the seatback  of the front seat or near the side roof  rails  Do not allow anyone sitting in the  front seats or rear outboard seats to  extend their hand out of the window or  lean against the door  Some examples  of dangerous riding positions are  shown in the previous illustrations                          WRS0032 SSS0159 SSS0162       AA WARNING     
44.   Cruise control operations                     05 5 19  Break in schedule           0 0 cee eee eee eee 5 21  Fuel efficient driving tips    5 21  Increasing fuel economy    5 22  Parking parking on hills    22 22 00 2 ete e 5 23  Power Steering    se suvaie  re  ah er abe RE dae 5 24  Brake system usode sates eka Rd ert 5 24  Brake precautions         seen 5 24  Anti lock Braking System  ABS                su  5 25  Vehicle Dynamic Control  VDC  system               5 26  Cold weather driving    see e eee eee ee 5 28  Freeing a frozen door lock            0  cece eee 5 28  Antisfreeze     dc sse e pe ex 5 28  Batte                             eed avers eat 5 28  Draining of coolant water           00    eee eee 5 28  Tire equipment ers cadens rk e xa dx Take eee rs 5 28  Special winter equipment                     005 5 28  Driving on snow or ice cs 26  eee 5 28    Engine block heater  if so equipped               5 29       PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING  AND DRIVING    AWARNING        Do not leave children or adults who  would normally require the assistance  of others alone in your vehicle  Pets  should also not be left alone  They  could accidentally injure themselves or  others through inadvertent operation of  the vehicle  Also  on hot  sunny days   temperatures in a closed vehicle could  quickly become high enough to cause  severe or possibly fatal injuries to  people or animals         Closely supervise children when they  are around cars to prevent them from  playing a
45.   Emission control information label        9 10  Engine serial number              9 10  F M V S S  certification label             9 10  Tire and Loading Information label           9 11    Vehicle identification number  VIN  plate    9 9    Warning labels  for SRS             1 51  LATCH  Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren   SVSEBITI 2  iie eti eta eed 4 An a ee eG 1 22  License plate   Installing the license plate               9 11  Light   Air bag warning light            1 51  2 14   Brake light  See stop light               8 28   Bulb check instrument panel            2 10   Bulb replacement                8 28   Charge warning light              2 11   Fog light switch  s s os coro oma 2 34   Headlight and turn signal switch         2 30   Headlight control switch            2 31   Headlights z is xxi 8 27   Interior light   iis ee tee de ERR 2 50   Eight bulbs  4 ese Rec 8 27   Low tire pressure warning light           2 12   Low windshield washer fluid warning   lights su sd ak E ove dele ie whan ER 2 24   Passenger air bag and status light           1 46   Security indicator light              2 16   Spotlights  See map light            2 52   Trunk light  ss aaaea ee Rx eee es 2 53   Warning indicator lights and audible   reminders    s sae ee ee p 2 10  Lights   Maplights   s e448 pe ae ws 2 52  Lock   Child safety rear doorlock           3 6   Doorlocks   d aia ge ex eee eas 3 4   Gloverbox lock    i m si aego ham oe 2 41   Power door locks s isa i acy y i
46.   F   37   C   The  use of other types of coolant solutions  other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life  Antifreeze Coolant  blue  or equivalent  may damage the engine cooling  system     e The life expectancy of the factory fill    coolant is 105 000 miles  168 000 km  or  7 years  Mixing any other type of cool   ant other than Genuine NISSAN Long  Life Antifreeze Coolant  blue   includ   ing Genuine NISSAN Long Life  Antifreeze Coolant  green   or the use  of non distilled water will reduce the  life expectancy of the factory fill cool   ant  Refer to the Nissan Service and  Maintenance Guide for more details                    LDI0554    CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT  LEVEL    Check the coolant level in the reservoir when  the engine is cold  If the coolant level is below  the MIN level  B   add coolant to the MAX level    amp    If the reservoir is empty  check the coolant  level in the radiator when the engine is cold  If  there is insufficient coolant in the radiator  fill the  radiator with coolant up to the filler opening and  also add it to the reservoir up to the MAX level           This vehicle contains Genuine NISSAN Long Life  Antifreeze Coolant  blue   The life expectancy of  the factory fill coolant is 105 000 miles   168 000 km  or 7 years  Mixing any other type of  coolant or the use of non distilled water will re   duce the life expectancy of the factory fill coolant   Refer to the NISSAN Service and Maintenance  Guide for more details     If the cooling system frequentl
47.   Light Sensitivity C   re 1    gt  e  Light Off Delay  4                                  45 sec                         Speed Sensing Wiper Interval                   i Selective Door Unlock             Cabin lighting when unlocking doors             LHA1246    8 00        ON 5  ao        ON    Settings  gt  Comfort            Selective Door Unlock             Intelligent Key Lock Unlock          Lift Steering Wheel on Exit                       ON    5 9 e    Slide Driver Seat Back on Exit                l Return All Settings to Default          Off will activate all doors with one click             LHA1247       Comfort settings    Select the    Others    key using the NISSAN con   troller  then select the    Comfort    key  The Com   fort settings screen will be displayed     You can set the following operating conditions by  selecting the desired item using the NISSAN  controller  The indicator light  box at the right of  the selected item  alternately turns on and off  each time the item is touched or the ENTER  button is pressed     Indicator light is illuminated     ON  Indicator light is not illuminated     OFF    Auto Interior Illumination  Select to turn on or  turn off the illumination of the interior lights when  any door is unlocked     Light Sensitivity  Select to adjust the sensitivity  of the automatic headlights higher  right  or lower   left   After selecting the item  turn the NISSAN  controller or touch the         or     key to change  the setting     L
48.   Normal    Wide     Cinema  or  Full  display modes              LHA2030          iPod    PLAYER OPERATION  WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM  if  so equipped     Connecting iPod      A CAUTION    e Depending on size and shape of the  iPod   and iPod   cable  the console lid  may not fully close  Do not force con   sole lid closed as this may damage the  iPod   and iPod   cable     4 92 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    e Do not force the iPod   cable into the  USB port  Inserting the iPod   cable  tilted or up side down into the port may  damage the iPod   cable and the port   Make sure that the iPod   cable is con   nected correctly into the USB port    Some iPod   cables come with a Y  mark as a guide  Make sure that the  mark is facing the correct direction be   fore inserting the iPod   cable      e Do not locate objects near the iPod    cable to prevent the objects from lean   ing on the iPod   cable and the port   Pressure from the objects may damage  the iPod   cable and the port     To connect an iPod   to the vehicle so that the  iPod   can be controlled with the audio system  controls and display screen  use the USB jack  located in the center console  Connect the  iPod   specific end of the cable to the iPod    and the USB end of the cable to the USB jack on  the vehicle  1   If your iPod   supports charging  via a USB connection  its battery will be charged  while connected to the vehicle with the ignition  Switch in the ACC or ON position 
49.   SEEK CAT and TRACK    buttons                 When the SEEK CAT 4 button is pressed  while a compact disc is playing  the track being  played returns to its beginning  Press several times  to skip back through tracks  The compact disc will  go back the number of times the button is pressed     When the TRACK PP button is pressed while  the compact disc is playing  the next track will start  to play from its beginning  Press several times to  skip through tracks  The compact disc will advance  the number of times the button is pressed   When  the last track on the compact disc is skipped  through  the first track will be played         SEEK CAT and TRACK   Rewind Fast Forward   buttons         l         x          Press and hold the SEEK CAT M4  rewind   button or the TRACK P  fast forward  button  while a compact disc is playing  the compact disc  will play while rewinding or fast forwarding  When  the button is released  the compact disc will  return to normal play speed     TUNE FOLDER knob    While playing an MP3 WMA CD  turn the  TUNE FOLDER knob right or left to scan forward  or backward through available folders     CD select buttons     To play another CD that has been loaded  pressa  CD select button  1     6      RPT RDM button     When the RPT RDM button is pressed while the  compact disc is playing  the play pattern can be  changed as follows     CD     All Disc Repeat     1 Disc Repeat     1 Track  Repeat     All Disc Random     1 Disc Random      All Disc Repea
50.   The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning appears in the  vehicle information display when the fuel filler  cap is not tightened correctly after the vehicle has  been refueled  It may take a few driving trips for  the message to be displayed  To turn off the  warning  perform the following     1  Remove and install the fuel filler cap as soon  as possible  See  Fuel filler cap      2  Tighten the fuel filler cap until it clicks     3 22 Pre driving checks and adjustments      Press the O    next button    on the in   strument panel located behind the steering  wheel for about 1 second to turn off the  LOOSE FUEL CAP warning after tight   ening the fuel filler cap     TILT TELESCOPIC STEERING    A  WARNING    e Do not adjust the steering wheel while    driving  You could lose control of your  vehicle and cause an accident     Do not adjust the steering wheel any  closer to you than is necessary for  proper steering operation and comfort   The driver s air bag inflates with great  force  If you are unrestrained  leaning  forward  sitting sideways or out of posi   tion in any way  you are at greater risk of  injury or death in a crash  You may also  receive serious or fatal injuries from the  air bag if you are up against it when it  inflates  Always sit back against the  seatback and as far away as practical  from the steering wheel  Always use the  seat belts           LPD0457             LPD0458             MANUAL OPERATION  if so  equipped    Tilt and telescopic operation   Pull the lock
51.   The brake pedal should be depressed to  move the shift selector from N  Neutral  or  any drive position to P  Park   Apply the  parking brake  When parking on a hill  apply the  parking brake first  then move the shift selector  into the P  Park  position     R  Reverse      A CAUTION    To prevent transmission damage  use the  P  Park  or R  Reverse  position only when  the vehicle is completely stopped     Use the R  Reverse  position to back up  Make  sure the vehicle is completely stopped before  selecting the R  Reverse  position  The brake  pedal must be depressed to move the shift  selector from P  Park   N  Neutral  or any  drive position to R  Reverse      N  Neutral      Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged  The  engine can be started in this position  You may  shift to N  Neutral  and restart a stalled engine  while the vehicle is moving     D  Drive    Use this position for all normal forward driving   Ds  Drive Sport      When the shift selector is shifted from the D   Drive  position to the manual shift gate  the  transmission enters the Ds  Drive Sport  mode   Moving the shift selector to the Ds  Drive Sport   position allows you to enjoy    sporty    driving shift  operation on a winding road and feel smooth  acceleration or deceleration on a hilly road by    moving in a lower gear automatically  When can   celing the Ds mode  return the shift selector to  the D  Drive  position  The transmission returns to  the normal driving mode           OSOSOSO  
52.   Then  with the wheel  nut wrench  tighten the wheel nuts securely    in the sequence illustrated  CD   2                  Lower the vehicle completely     A  WARNING       Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly  tightened wheel nuts can cause the  wheel to become loose or come off   This could cause an accident        Do not use oil or grease on the wheel  studs or nuts  This could cause the nuts  to become loose     e Retighten the wheel nuts when the ve   hicle has been driven for 600 miles   1 000 km   also in cases of a flat tire   etc       As soon as possible  tighten the wheel nuts  to the specified torque with a torque  wrench     Wheel nut tightening torque   83 ft Ib  112 N m     The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to  specification at all times  It is recom   mended that wheel nuts be tightened to  specifications at each lubrication interval     Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure     COLD pressure  After vehicle has been  parked for three hours or more or driven  less than 1 mile  1 6 km      COLD tire pressures are shown on the Tire  and Loading Information label affixed to  the driver s door opening     5  Securely store the flat tire and jacking equip   ment in the vehicle     6  Place the spare tire cover and the trunk floor  carpeting over the damaged tire     7  Close the trunk     A WARNING      Always make sure that the spare tire  and jacking equipment are properly se   cured after use  Such items can become  dangerous projectiles in an accident or 
53.   To remove the high mounted stop light    D Push toward rear of vehicle    2 Lift to remove     The high mounted stop light must be properly  reinstalled before driving your vehicle     Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust film  from the glass surfaces  It is normal for glass to  become coated with a film after the vehicle is  parked in the hot sun  Glass cleaner and a soft  cloth will easily remove this film     A CAUTION    When cleaning the inside of the windows   do not use sharp edged tools  abrasive  cleaners or chlorine based disinfectant  cleaners  They could damage the electri   cal conductors  radio antenna elements or  rear window defroster elements     ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS    Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge damp   ened in a mild soap solution  especially during  winter months in areas where road salt is used  If  not removed  road salt can discolor the wheels     A CAUTION    Follow the directions below to avoid  staining or discoloring the wheels     e Do not use a cleaner that uses strong  acid or alkali contents to clean the  wheels     Appearance and care 7 3    e Do not apply wheel cleaners to the  wheels when they are hot  The wheel  temperature should be the same as am   bient temperature     e Rinse the wheel to completely remove  the cleaner within 15 minutes after the  cleaner is applied     CHROME PARTS    Clean all chrome parts regularly with a non   abrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish     TIRE DRESSINGS    NISSAN does not rec
54.   Windshield washer fluid               8 14  Windshield wiper and washer switch        2 28  Wiper   Windshield wiper and washer switch      2 28   Wiper blades               0 4  8 20    10 7    GAS STATION INFORMATION    RECOMMENDED FUEL     NISSAN recommends the use of unleaded pre   mium gasoline with an octane rating of at least  91 AKI  Anti Knock Index  number  Research  octane number 96   If unleaded premium gaso   line is not available  you may use unleaded regu   lar gasoline with an octane rating of at least  87 AKI number  Research octane number 91    but you may notice a decrease in performance     A CAUTION        Using a fuel other than that specified  could adversely affect the emission  control system  and may also affect the  warranty coverage     e Under no circumstances should a  leaded gasoline be used  because this  will damage the three way catalyst         Do not use E 15 or E 85 fuel in your  vehicle  Your vehicle is not designed to  run on E 15 or E 85 fuel  Using E 15 or  E 85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically  designed for E 15 or E 85 fuel can ad   versely affect the emission control de   vices and systems of the vehicle  Dam   age caused by such fuel is not covered  by the NISSAN new vehicle limited  warranty         U S  government regulations require  ethanol dispensing pumps to be identi   fied by a small  square  orange and  black label with the common abbrevia   tion or the appropriate percentage for  that region     For additional informa
55.   battery health     Brake fluid level  Make sure that the brake fluid  level is between the MIN and MAX lines on the  reservoir     Engine coolant level  Check the coolant level  when the engine is cold     Engine drive belts  Make sure the drive belts  are not frayed  worn  cracked or oily     Engine oil level  Check the level after parking  the vehicle on a level surface with the engine off   Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain  back into the oil pan     Exhaust system Make sure there are no loose  supports  cracks or holes  If the sound of the  exhaust seems unusual or there is a smell of  exhaust fumes  immediately have the exhaust    system inspected by a NISSAN dealer  See the  carbon monoxide warning in the    Starting and  driving    section of this manual     Fluid leaks Check under the vehicle for fuel  oil   water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle has  been parked for a while  Water dripping from the  air conditioner after use is normal  If you should  notice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident   check for the cause and have it corrected imme   diately     Power steering fluid level  and lines Check  the level when the fluid is cold  with the engine  off  Check the lines for proper attachment  leaks   cracks  etc     Radiator and hoses Check the front of the  radiator and clean off any dirt  insects  leaves   etc   that may have accumulated  Make sure the  hoses have no cracks  deformation  rot or loose  connections     Underbody The underbo
56.   be damaged and or vehicle handling and perfor   mance may be adversely affected     Tire chains must be installed only on the  front wheels and not on the rear wheels     Never install tire chains on a TEMPORARY USE  ONLY spare tire     Do not use tire chains on dry roads  Driving with  chains in such conditions can cause damage to  the various mechanisms of the vehicle due to  some overstress              WDIO0258    CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES    Tire rotation       NISSAN recommends rotating the tires  every 7 500 miles  12 000 km      See  Flat tire  in the  In case of emer   gency  section of this manual for tire re   placing procedures     As soon as possible  tighten the  wheel nuts to the specified torque  with a torque wrench     Wheel nut tightening torque     83 ft lb  112 N m     The wheel nuts must be kept tight   ened to specifications at all times  It  is recommended that wheel nuts be  tightened to specification at each  tire rotation interval     AWARNING    After rotating the tires  check and  adjust the tire pressure     Retighten the wheel nuts when  the vehicle has been driven for  600 miles  1 000 km   also in  cases of a flat tire  etc       Do not include the spare tire in  the tire rotation     For additional information re   garding tires  refer to    Important  Tire Safety Information     US  or     Tire Safety Information      Canada  in the Warranty Infor   mation Booklet              WDIO0259          1   2     Tire wear and damage    Wear indica
57.   changer                  4 64  FM AM SAT radio with CD DVD player    4 76  FM AM SAT radio with compact disc   CD  players aicr pd s ona hae Sake ad 4 69  Steering wheel audio control switch      4 102  Readiness for inspection maintenance   l M esb amp     vd  amp  Sek els REESE 9 26  Rear power windows                2 44  Rearseat     x echo 1 5  Rear s  n shade     os fe ace vs 2 49  RearView Monitor           llle  4 34    Rear window and outside mirror defroster    SWIERE uie esos er E eee donee E 2 29  Recorders  Event data e uem wee ace i 2 9 26  Refrigerant recommendation            9 6  Registering your vehicle in another country      9 9  Reporting safety defects  US only             9 25  Resetting the fueleconomy         4 7  4 21  S  Safety  Child safety rear door lock              3 6  Child seat belts         1 20  1 26  1 30  1 34  Reporting safety defects  US only           9 25  Seat adjustment  Front power seat adjustment          1 8  Seatback pockets             sss  2 39  Seat belt  Child safety    e s Rmi 1 18  Infants and small children                  1 19  InuredPerson         eee ees 1 14  Larger children    2    2      000  1 19  Precautions on seat belt usage         1 11  Pregnant women              5  1 14  Seat belt extenders               1 17  Seat belt maintenance             1 18  Oeat belts    a Get dea rg 1 11  Shoulder belt height adjustment          1 17  Three point type with retractor              1 14  Seat belt warning light    
58.   co 8 00  Artist TUNE  3 Folder  XXXXXXXX  Album  XXXXXXXX     Track  XXXXXXXX   Folder 1of4  Track tofi 0 40  LHA1258       CD  gt  Menu         8 00          Folder List       Track List          Play Mode                         LHA1259             CD  gt  Play Mode 8 00         Normal          1 Folder Repeat          1 Track Repeat             1 Disc Random                      1 Folder Random          L             LHA1262       CD menu    Touch the    Menu    key on the display while a CD  or CD with compressed audio files is playing to  bring up a list of options  Depending on the type  of CD being played  the following options may be  available         Play Mode    This option allows you to alter the play pattern of  the CD  Touch the key of the mode you wish to  apply  The modes change the play pattern as  follows     1 Track Repeat   the current track is repeated     1 Disc Random  tracks from the entire disc are  played randomly     1 Folder Repeat  compressed audio files CD  only    the current folder is repeated     1 Folder Random  compressed audio files CD  only    tracks from the current folder are played  randomly     Normal   Plays all tracks on the CD in sequential  order until stopped     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 81       CD  gt  Folder List 8 00      lg XXXXXXX  lg XXXXXXX             lig XXXXXXX       lg XXXXXXX                      LHA1260    CD    Track List 8 00    XXXXXXXX mp3  XXXXXXXX mp3  XXXXXXXX mp3  XXXXX
59.   command  Otherwise  the command will not  be received properly         Start speaking a command within 5 seconds  after the tone sounds         Speak in a natural voice without pausing  between words     Giving voice commands    To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition  press  and release the  4 button located on the  steering wheel  After the tone sounds  speak a  command     The command given is picked up by the micro   phone  and voice feedback is given when the  command is accepted          f you need to hear the available commands  for the current menu again  say    Help    and  the system will repeat them     If a command is not recognized  the system  announces   Command not recognized   Please try again   Make sure the command is  said exactly as prompted by the system and  repeat the command in a clear voice     If you want to go back to the previous com   mand  you can say  Go back  or  Correc   tion  any time the system is waiting for a  response     You can cancel a command when the sys   tem is waiting for a response by saying    Cancel  or  Quit   The system announces   Cancel  and ends the VR session  You can  also press and hold the      Dutton on the  steering wheel for 5 seconds at any time to  end the VR session  Whenever the VR ses   sion is cancelled  a double beep is played to  indicate you have exited the system     If you want to adjust the volume of the voice  feedback  press the volume control switches     or    on the steering wheel while being  provid
60.   console box for a phone or iPod   cord routing to  the power outlet     Instruments and controls 2 41                WIC1121       RN            LICO748                 PRs eyes   XS NX   SS  PERRY  SSE           LIC1226       Lower half    Pull up on the passenger s side latch to open the  lower half of the console box  A power outlet is  located inside the console box and there is stor   age for compact discs     2 42 Instruments and controls    GROCERY HOOKS    The grocery hooks are located in the trunk and  can be used to hang a standard size plastic  grocery bag     A CAUTION    Do not apply a total load of more than  20 Ibs  9 kg  to a single grocery hook     CARGO NET  if so equipped     AWARNING      Properly secure all cargo with ropes or  straps to help prevent it from sliding or  shifting  In a sudden stop or collision   unsecured cargo could cause personal  injury    The cargo net helps keep packages in the cargo    area from moving around while the vehicle is in  motion              LIC0802             To install a cargo net  attach the net to the retain   ers     To remove a cargo net  detach the net from the  retainers     WINDOWS    POWER WINDOWS    A  WARNING    e Make sure that all passengers have  their hands  etc  inside the vehicle while  it is in motion and before closing the  windows  Use the window lock switch  to prevent unexpected use of the power  windows         Do notleave children unattended inside  the vehicle  They could unknowingly ac   tiva
61.   detect objects close to the bumper or  on the ground     e The rear view camera is a convenience  but it is not a substitute for proper back   ing up  Always turn and check that it is  safe to do so before backing up  Always  back up slowly     e Objects viewed in the RearView Moni   tor differ from actual distance because  a wide angle lens is used     e Make sure that the trunk is securely  closed when backing up     e Underneath the bumper and the corner  areas of the bumper cannot be viewed  on the RearView Monitor because of its  monitoring range limitation     4 34 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems      Do not put anything on the rear view  camera  The rear view camera is in   stalled above the license plate       When washing the vehicle with high   pressure water  be sure not to spray it  around the camera  Otherwise  water  may enter the camera unit causing wa   ter condensation on the lens  a mal   function  fire or an electric shock     e Do not strike the camera  It is a preci   sion instrument  Otherwise  it may mal   function or cause damage resulting in a  fire or an electric shock     A CAUTION    Do not scratch the camera lens when  cleaning dirt or snow from the lens                 LHA1196    HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED  LINES  Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle width    and distances to objects with reference to the  vehicle body line    are displayed on the monitor        Distance guide lines    Indicate distances from the
62.   hands free phone system to enter the voice  adaptation mode or press the PHONE END   4h   button to select a different lan   guage        Press the CA button     For information on selecting a different lan   guage  see  Choosing a language  in this  section       Voice memory A or memory B is selected    automatically  If both memory locations are  already in use  the system will prompt you to  overwrite one  Follow the instructions pro   vided by the system       When preparation is complete and you are    ready to begin  press the  amp  amp  amp  button       The VA mode will be explained  Follow the    instructions provided by the system       When training is finished  the system will tell    you an adequate number of phrases have  been recorded     10  The system will announce that voice adap   tation has been completed and the system is  ready     The VA mode will stop if     e The l  button is pressed for more than  5 seconds in VA mode         The vehicle begins moving during VA mode         The ignition switch is placed in the OFF or  LOCK position     Training phrases    During the VA mode  the system instructs the  trainer to say the following phrases   The system  will prompt you for each phrase          phonebook transfer entry   dial three oh four two nine   delete call back number   incoming   transfer entry   eight pause nine three two pause seven    delete all entries    call seven two four zero nine        phonebook delete entry    Monitor  climate  audio
63.   ignition switch in the ON position  have  the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer  as soon as possible     e If the light illuminates while driving   avoid sudden steering maneuvers or  abrupt braking  reduce vehicle speed   pull off the road to a safe location and  stop the vehicle as soon as possible   Driving with under inflated tires may per   manently damage the tires and increase  the likelihood of tire failure  Serious ve   hicle damage could occur and may lead  to an accident and could result in serious  personal injury  Check the tire pressure  for all four tires  Adjust the tire pressure  to the recommended COLD tire pressure  shown on the Tire and Loading Informa   tion label located in the driver s door  opening to turn the low tire pressure  warning light OFF  If the light still comes  on while driving after adjusting the tire  pressure  a tire may be flat  If you have a  flat tire  replace it with a spare tire as  Soon as possible     e When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel  is replaced  tire pressure will not be  indicated  the TPMS will not function  and the low tire pressure warning light  will flash for approximately 1 minute   The light will remain on after 1 minute   Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as  possible for tire replacement and or  system resetting       Replacing tires with those not originally  specified by NISSAN could affect the  proper operation of the TPMS     A CAUTION    e The TPMS is not a substitute for the  regular tire pressure ch
64.   indicator light  flashes slowly and then rapidly  When the  indicator light flashes rapidly  both buttons  may be released  The rapid flashing indi   cates successful training    Proceed with  Programming HomeLink       step 3 to complete    If the device was unplugged during the pro   gramming procedure  remember to plug it  back in when programming is completed     OPERATING THE HOMELINK    UNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVER    The HomeLink   Universal Transceiver  after it is  programmed  can be used to activate the pro   grammed device  To operate  simply press and  release the appropriate programmed  HomeLink   Universal Transceiver button  The  amber indicator light will illuminate while the sig   nal is being transmitted     For convenience  the hand held transmitter of the  device may also be used at any time     Instruments and controls 2 55    PROGRAMMING TROUBLE   DIAGNOSIS    If the HomeLink   does not quickly learn the  hand held transmitter information         replace the hand held transmitter batteries  with new batteries        position the hand held transmitter with its  battery area facing away from the  HomeLink   surface       press and hold both the HomeLink   and  hand held transmitter buttons without inter   ruption         position the hand held transmitter 1    3 inches  26   76 mm  away from the  HomeLink   surface  Hold the transmitter in  that position for up to 15 seconds  If  HomeLink   is not programmed within that  time  try holding the transmitter in ano
65.   phone and voice recognition systems 4 115    next entry   dial star two one seven oh   yes   no   select   missed   dial eight five six nine two   Bluetooth on   outgoing   call three one nine oh two   nine seven pause pause three oh eight  cancel   call back number   call star two zero nine five   delete phone   dial eight three zero five one   record name   four three pause two nine pause zero    delete redial number    phonebook list names    call eight oh five four one  correction   connect phone   dial seven four oh one eight  previous entry   delete   dial nine seven two six six  call seven six three oh one  go back    call five six two eight zero    dial six six four three seven  MANUAL CONTROL    While using the voice recognition system  it is  possible to select menu options by using the  steering wheel controls instead of speaking voice  commands  The manual control mode does not  allow dialing a phone number by digits  The user  may select an entry from the Phonebook or Re   cent Calls lists  To re activate voice recognition   exit the manual control mode by pressing and  holding the PHONE END          button  At that  time  pressing the PHONE SEND   C4   button  will start the Hands Free Phone System     4 116 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Operating tips    To enter manual control mode  start the  voice recognition system and tilt the tuning          switch up or down  The system will  speak  Showing Manual Options    when  manu
66.   press the  PHONE button to display the  Call in  Progress  screen first  then press the  PHONE button again to hang up              Incoming Call     amp    a   Answer  0 00 Hold Call          B XXXXXXXX Reject Call  XXXXXXXX                                        LHA1323       RECEIVING A CALL    When you hear a phone ring  the display will  change to phone mode  To receive a call  follow  one of the procedures listed below     a  Select the    Answer    key on the display     b  Press the PHONE button on the instrument  panel     c  Pressthe phone          button on the steering  wheel switches     There are some options available when receiving  a call  Select one of the following displayed on  the screen     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 125    Answer   Accept an incoming call to talk     Hold Call   Put an incoming call on hold     Reject Call   Reject an incoming call     To finish the call  follow one of the procedures  listed below     a  Select the    Reject Call    key on the display     b  Press the PHONE button on the instrument  panel     c  Pressandholdthe phone          button on the  steering wheel switches           Got Yu 8 00                Call in Progress     amp  0 04       Hang up       Use Handset       B XXXXXXXX Mute  XXXXXXXX       Keypad    Switch Call  1 5                                     LHA2074       DURING A CALL    There are some options available during a call   Select one of the following displayed on th
67.   pull off the road to  a safe location and stop the vehicle as  soon as possible  Driving with under   inflated tires may permanently damage  the tires and increase the likelihood of  tire failure  Serious vehicle damage  could occur and may lead to an accident  and could result in serious personal in   jury  Check the tire pressure for all four  tires  Adjust the tire pressure to the rec   ommended COLD tire pressure shown on  the Tire and Loading Information label to  turn the low tire pressure warning light  OFF  If you have a flat tire  replace it with  a spare tire as soon as possible   See   Flat tire  in the  In case of emergency   section for changing a flat tire      When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is  replaced  tire pressure will not be indi   cated  the TPMS will not function and the  low tire pressure warning light will flash  for approximately 1 minute  The light will  remain on after 1 minute  Contact your  NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for  tire replacement and or system resetting       Replacing tires with those not originally  specified by NISSAN could affect the  proper operation of the TPMS       Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire  sealant into the tires  as this may cause a  malfunction of the tire pressure sensors     A CAUTION    Do not place metalized film or any metal  parts  antenna  etc   on the windows  This  may cause poor reception of the signals  from the tire pressure sensors  and the  TPMS will not function properly     
68.   restraint and insert it into the buckle until you  hear and feel the latch engage  Be sure to  follow the child restraint manufacturer s in   structions for belt routing     If the child restraint is equipped with a top  tether strap  route the top tether strap and  secure the tether strap to the tether anchor  point  rear seat installation only   See  In   stalling top tether strap  in this section  Do  not install child restraints that require the use  of a top tether strap in seating positions that  do not have a top tether anchor     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 31             LRS0667       Forward facing     step 4    4  Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully    extended  At this time  the seat belt retractor  is in the Automatic Locking Retractor  ALR   mode  child restraint mode   It reverts to  Emergency Locking Retractor  ELR  mode  when the seat belt is fully retracted        LRS0668       Forward facing     step 5    5  Allow the seat belt to retract  Pull up on the    shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt     1 32 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system       WRS0681       Forward facing     step 6      Remove any additional slack from the seat    belt  press downward and rearward firmly in  the center of the child restraint with your  knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion  and seatback while pulling up on the seat  belt       Tighten the tether strap according to the    manufacturer s in
69.   s ng        iz       K     nuum    LIC1381       oaRWON      Tachometer   Speedometer  Warning indicator lights   Fuel gauge   Odometer twin trip odometer  Trip odometer change button    N    Engine coolant temperature gauge  8  Vehicle information display    Instruments and controls 2 3                   KULU       n     SS Co     MPH  Ren  km h       E  nian        LIC1382          o Leo    H    ra       N   n AS    Oe          LIC1383       SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER    Speedometer    The speedometer indicates the vehicle speed     2 4 Instruments and controls    Odometer Twin trip odometer    The odometer twin trip odometer is displayed  when the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position     The odometer  1  records the total distance the  vehicle has been driven     The twin trip odometer    records the distance  of individual trips     Changing the display     Press the change button  3  to change the dis   play as follows              Tip  A      Tip  B_  Resetting the trip odometer         Trip  A    Press the change button  3  for more than 1 sec   ond to reset the currently displayed trip odometer  to zero     Elapsed time  driving distance and average  speed information is also available  Refer to   Control panel buttons  in the  Monitor  climate   audio  phone and voice recognition systems   section in this manual            T am Ming  WU mu  SS        2  Z  Un  7g    LIC1384          H7  ao         E    m  e                       LIC1386       TACHOMETER    T
70.   the air conditioner will automati   cally be turned on at outside temperatures  above 36  F  2  C   The air recirculate mode  automatically turns off  allowing outside air  to be drawn into the passenger compart   ment to further improve the defogging per   formance     MANUAL OPERATION   Fan speed control   Turn the   fan speed control dial to manually  control the fan speed    Press the AUTO button to return to automatic  control of the fan speed     Air recirculation    Press the C amp  air recirculation button to recir     culate interior air inside the vehicle  The C2   indicator light on the button will come on     The air recirculation cannot be activated when  the air conditioner is in the Y front defrosting  mode or the      front defrosting and foot out   let mode     Fresh air intake    Press the S fresh air intake button to draw  outside air into the passenger compartment   The  amp  gt  indicator light on the button will come on     Automatic intake air control    In the AUTO mode  the intake air will be controlled  automatically  To manually control the intake air   press the CS air recirculation button  To return  to the automatic control mode  press and hold  the    gt  air recirculation button or press and hold  the  gt  fresh air intake button for about 2 sec   onds  The indicator lights  both air recirculation and  fresh air intake buttons  will flash twice  and then  the intake air will be controlled automatically     Air flow control    Pressing the MOD
71.   the wiper arm to its original position   otherwise it may be damaged when the  hood is opened     e Make sure the wiper blades contact the    glass  otherwise the arms may be dam   aged from wind pressure                 Oo          WDI0570    Be careful not to let anything get into the washer  nozzle     This may cause clogging or improper  windshield washer operation  If something gets  into the nozzle  remove it with a needle or small    pin  B         BRAKES    If the brakes do not operate properly  have the  brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer     Self adjusting brakes    Your vehicle is equipped with self adjusting  brakes     The front and rear disc type brakes self adjust  every time the brake pedal is applied     AWARNING    See a NISSAN dealer for a brake system  check if the brake pedal height does not  return to normal     Brake pad wear indicators    The disc brake pads on your vehicle have audible  wear indicators  When a brake pad requires re   placement  a high pitched scraping or screech   ing sound will be heard when the vehicle is in  motion  The noise will be heard whether or not the  brake pedal is depressed  Have the brakes  checked as soon as possible if the wear indicator  sound is heard     Under some driving or climate conditions  occa   sional brake squeak  squeal or other noise may  be heard  Occasional brake noise during light to  moderate stops is normal and does not affect the  function or performance of the brake system     Proper brake inspect
72.   tightened  It may take a few driving trips  for the message to be displayed  Failure  to tighten the fuel filler cap properly  after the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning ap     pears may cause the GNE     Malfunc         P SOON  3  tion Indicator Light  MIL  to illuminate     Failure to tighten the fuel filler cap    properly may cause the Pic  Mal         P SQON   2  function Indicator Light  MIL  to illumi     nate  If the CINE light illuminates be     cause the fuel filler cap is loose or  missing  tighten or install the cap and    continue to drive the vehicle     The ENGINE light should turn off after a    few driving trips  If the NINE light    IN  does not turn off after a few driving  trips  have the vehicle inspected by a  NISSAN dealer        e For additional information  see the     Malfunction Indicator Light  MIL     in  the    Instruments and Controls    section  in this manual         If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body   flush it away with water to avoid paint  damage                 LPD0482       To remove the fuel filler cap     1  Turn the fuel filler cap counterclockwise to  remove     2  Put the fuel filler cap on the cap holder  1   while refueling     To install the fuel filler cap     1  Insert the fuel filler cap straight into the fuel   filler tube     2  Turn the fuel filler cap clockwise until a  single click is heard     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 21       WARNING  pr    LOOSE  FUEL    CAP                LRS2007       Loose Fuel Cap warning  
73.   when the RearView monitor is displayed on the  screen  See    RearView Monitor    in this section  for more information     Clock    The following display will appear after pressing  the SETTING button  then selecting the    Clock     key using the NISSAN controller     On screen Clock     When this item is enabled  indicator light illumi   nated   a clock is always displayed in the upper  right corner of the screen     Clock Format     Choose either the 12h  12 hour  clock display or  the 24h  24 hour  clock display     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 11    Daylight Savings Time     When this item is enabled  indicator light illumi   nated   daylight savings time is on  To turn off the  daylight savings time  touch the    ON    key  the  amber indicator light will go out                                   Settings  gt  Time Zone 12 00  UP  a  Pacific E  Mountain i  Central p  Eastern    Atlantic             H  Y 1 9 DOWN   2  Manually select time zone          LHA0933       Time Zone     Select the    Time Zone    key  the Time Zone  screen will appear     Select one of the following zones  depending on  the current location  by selecting the correct time  zone key to enable that time zone  indicator light  will illuminate for that location          Pacific       Mountain      Central       Eastern        Atlantic    4 12 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Newfoundland  Aleutian  Hawaii   Alaska                    
74.  2 to change       modes     2 4                                     LHA1239          Push the 3 2 switch to activate  the display             LHA2562       Brightness contrast     Select the    Brightness    key or the    Contrast    key  to adjust the brightness or contrast of the display  background  Use the NISSAN controller to adjust  the brightness to darker or brighter and the con   trast to lower or higher     The new settings are automatically saved when  you exit the setting screen by pressing the BACK  button or any other mode button     Display off     Select the  Display ON  key  The indicator of the   Display ON  turns off and the message above  will be displayed briefly  When the audio  HVAC   Heater and air conditioner   or any mode button  on the control panel is operated  the display turns  on for that operation  If one of the control panel  buttons is pressed  the display will not automati   cally turn off until that operation is finished  Oth   erwise  the screen turns off automatically after  5 seconds     To turn the screen on         Press the SETTING button and select the   Display  key and then select the  Display  ON  key  or    e Press the X  2 OFF button and the mes   sage  resuming display  will appear and the   Display ON  key will be automatically  turned on  no amber indicator      Background color     Select the  Background Color  key  the display  color changes between day and night     The new settings are automatically saved when  you exit 
75.  4 9     o om 9    4  XH   OFF brightness control button   P  4 15     4 4 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    A CAUTION      The glass display screen may break if it  is hit with a hard or sharp object  If the  glass screen breaks  do not touch it   Doing so could result in an injury        To clean the display  never use a rough  cloth  alcohol  benzine  thinner or any  kind of solvent or paper towel with a  chemical cleaning agent  They will  scratch or deteriorate the panel       Do not splash any liquid such as water  or car fragrance on the display  Contact  with liquid will cause the system to  malfunction     When you use this system  make sure the engine  is running     If you use the system with the engine not  running  ignition ON or ACC  for a long  time  it will discharge the battery  and the  engine will not start     Reference symbols     ENTER button     This is a button on the control  panel        Example        Words marked in quotes refer to a  key shown on the display  These keys can only be  selected using the NISSAN controller                 LHA2458       HOW TO USE THE NISSAN  CONTROLLER    Use the NISSAN controller to choose an item on  the display screen  Highlight an item on the dis   play using the main directional buttons  2  or the  center dial  3   Then press the ENTER button    to select the item or perform the action     The BACK button    has two functions         Go back to the previous display  cancel      If yo
76.  43  4 46  HomeLink   Universal Transceiver          2 53  Hood release  se ra o n e a ag 3 17  MOr o epia ad aae ur px i a 2 34   l   Ignition Switch   Push Button Ignition Switch            5 7  Image VIEWED  se se n ot kx ces 4 32  Immobilizer system            2 27  3 3  5 10  Important vehicle information label           9 10  In cabin microfilter              ss  8 19  Increasing fueleconomy              5 22    Indicator lights and audible reminders   See warning indicator lights and audible    reminders           llle 2 10  Inside automatic anti glare mirror               3 25  Instrument brightness control             2 33  Instrument panel         sess 0 6  2 2  Instrument panel dimmer switch           2 33    Intelligent Key system    Key operatingrange               3 8  Key operation     2    0 0 0 0  0005 3 10  Mechanical key              00   3 3  Remote keyless entry operation         3 13  Troubleshooting guide             3 16  Warning signals            0004 3 16  Interior light           llle 2 50  Interior trunk lid release    2    2 2  3 19  IPod amp   Player   a edd d 4 92  4 94  ISOFIX child restraints               1 22  J  Jump starting  wisn ba ak ee Re XS 6 8  K  Keyfob battery replacement             8 26    Keyless entry  With Intelligent Key system     See Intelligent Key system           3 13  Keys  For Intelligent Key system           3 2  L   Labels  Air conditioner specification label        9 11  C M V S S  certification label          9 10
77.  A C  at Higher  Vehicle Speeds        Below 40 MPH  64 km h   it is more  efficient to open windows to cool the  vehicle due to reduced engine load        Above 40 MPH  64 km h   it is more  efficient to use A C to cool the vehicle  due to increased aerodynamic drag        Recirculating the cool air in the cabin  when the A C is on reduces cooling load      Drive at Economical Speeds and Dis     tances        Observing the speed limit and not ex   ceeding 60 MPH  97 km h   where le   gally allowed  can improve fuel efficiency  due to reduced aerodynamic drag      Maintaining a safe following distance be   hind other vehicles reduces unnecessary  braking        Safely monitoring traffic to anticipate  changes in speed permits reduced brak   ing and smooth acceleration changes        Select a gear range suitable to road con   ditions       Use Cruise Control        Using cruise control during highway driv   ing helps maintain a steady speed        Cruise control is particularly effective in  providing fuel savings when driving on flat  terrains    Starting and driving 5 21      Plan for the Shortest Route        Utilize a map or navigation system to de   termine the best route to save time      Avoid Idling        Shutting off your engine when safe for  stops exceeding 30 60 seconds saves  fuel and reduces emissions      Buy an Automated Pass for Toll Roads        Automated passes permit drivers to use  special lanes to maintain cruising speed  through the toll and avoid stopp
78.  Additional information on the following  items with an         is found later in this sec   tion     Accelerator pedal Check the pedal for smooth  operation and make sure the pedal does not bind  or require uneven effort  Keep the floor mat away  from the pedal     Brake pedal Check the pedal for smooth opera   tion  If the brake pedal suddenly goes down fur   ther than normal  the pedal feels spongy or the  vehicle seems to take longer to stop  see a  NISSAN dealer immediately  Keep the floor mat  away from the pedal     Brakes Check that the brakes do not pull the  vehicle to one side when applied     Continuously Variable Transmission  CVT   P  Park  position mechanism  On a fairly  steep hill check that the vehicle is held securely  with the shift selector in the P  Park  position  without applying any brakes     Parking brake Check the parking brake opera   tion regularly  The vehicle should be securely held  on a fairly steep hill with only the parking brake  applied  If the parking brake needs adjustment   see a NISSAN dealer     Seats Check seat position controls such as seat  adjusters  seatback recliner  etc  to ensure they  operate smoothly and all latches lock securely in  every position  Check that the head restraints  move up and down smoothly and the lock knobs   if so equipped  hold securely in all adjustable  positions     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 3    Seat belts Check that all parts of the seat belt  system  for example  buckles  anchors  adjusters 
79.  Connect Phone               Handset Phonebook Connected Phones      J Dial Number J    Calls a phonebook entry saved to the vehicle                      LHA1322       MAKING A CALL    To make a call  follow the procedure below     1  Press the PHONE button on the instrument  panel or the     switch on the steering  wheel  The    Phone    screen will appear on  the display    2  Select one of the following options to make a  call         Vehicle Phonebook  Select the name from  an entry stored in the vehicle phonebook         Handset Phonebook  Select the name from  an entry stored in the handset phonebook     Call History  Select the name from the in   coming or outgoing call history     Dial Number  Input the phone number manu   ally using a keypad displayed on the screen   For information on how to use the touch   Screen  see  How to use the touchscreen  in  this section       Forall of the methods listed in Step 2 except     Dial Number   dialing commences when the  listed name is selected  Dialing commences  when  OK  is selected if the number is input   ted manually  The screen changes to the   Call in Progress  screen       After the call is over  perform one of the    following to finish the call        a  Select the  Hang up  key on the Call in  Progress screen     b  Press the   switch on the steering  wheel     c  When the  Call in Progress  screen is  displayed  press the PHONE button on the  instrument panel to hang up  If any other  screen is currently displayed
80.  DOT  Abbreviation for the  Depart   ment Of Transportation   The symbol  can be placed above  below or to the  left or right of the Tire Identification  Number     2  Two digit code   identification mark     Manufacturer s    3  Two digit code  Tire size   8 38 Maintenance and do it yourself    4     DOT XX XX XXX XXXX  XXX    XXX  XXXX    t t  5 6          WDI0396    Three digit code  Tire type code   Optional        Three digit code  Date of Manufac     ture       Four numbers represent the week    and year the tire was built  For ex   ample  the numbers 3103 means the  31st week of 2003  If these numbers  are missing  then look on the other  sidewall of the tire          Tire ply composition and material    The number of layers or plies of rubber   coated fabric in the tire  Tire manufactur   ers also must indicate the materials in the  tire  which include steel  nylon  polyester   and others      4  Maximum permissible inflation pres   sure    This number is the greatest amount of air  pressure that should be put in the tire  Do  not exceed the maximum permissible in   flation pressure      8  Maximum load rating    This number indicates the maximum load  in kilograms and pounds that can be car   ried by the tire  When replacing the tires  on the vehicle  always use a tire that has  the same load rating as the factory in   stalled tire        Term of    tubeless    or  tube type     Indicates whether the tire requires an in   ner tube     tube type     or not     tubeles
81.  ERE et 8 20  ll c  C 8 21  FUSES en repie hanhen edu delen teres water ke eee ad 8 22  Engine compartment         scene 8 22  Passenger compartment              0  e eee 8 24  Battery replacement               essen 8 26  NISSAN Intelligent Key                    0 00  8 26  Lights f2sccecctieeererhnede Geet eee eet eee ds 8 27  Headlights          2 eee peg he 8 27  Front park turn sidemarker light                   8 28  Fog lights  if so equipped             sess 8 28  Exterior and interior lights                 0 0008 8 28  Wheels  and tires    ne e ramen 8 32  Tire  pressure  scc een I eem ade mas 8 32  Tire labeling  2  iere m ru erc pea a 8 36  Iyp6es of tIT6S  s code  occ en eU RIEN Stein dms 8 39  Tire chainss   ceobsetoniibub cen ee vise ReEX TRES 8 40  Changing wheels and tires                   00  8 40       MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS    Your NISSAN has been designed to have mini   mum maintenance requirements with long ser   vice intervals to save you both time and money   However  some day to day and regular mainte   nance is essential to maintain your NISSAN s  good mechanical condition  as well as its emis   sions and engine performance     It is the owner s responsibility to make sure that  the scheduled maintenance  as well as general  maintenance  is performed     As the vehicle owner  you are the only one who  can ensure that your vehicle receives proper  maintenance  You are a vital link in the mainte   nance chain     Scheduled maintenance    For your c
82.  Intelligent    2  The hazard warning lights flash once        8  Pressthe   button again within 60 sec   onds to unlock all doors     All doors will be locked automatically unless one  of the following operations is performed within    1 minute after pressing the A button            Opening any doors         Pushing the ignition switch     3 14 Pre driving checks and adjustments    The interior light illuminates for a period of time  when a door is unlocked and the room light  switch is in the DOOR position     The light can be turned off without waiting by  performing one of the following operations         Placing the ignition switch in the ON posi   tion         Locking the doors with the remote controller         Switching the room light switch to the OFF  position     Opening windows    The Intelligent Key allows you to simultaneously  open windows equipped with automatic opera   tion         To open the windows  press the A but   ton on the Intelligent Key for longer than  3 seconds after all doors are unlocked        The door windows will open while pressing  the   button on the Intelligent Key        The door windows cannot be closed by  using the Intelligent Key                                      WPD0364       Releasing the trunk lid    Press the es button for longer than 0 5 sec   onds to open the trunk lid  The trunk release  button will not operate when the ignition switch is  in the ON position or when the trunk cancel  switch is in the OFF position  See  Canc
83.  Intelligent Key is too close to the door glass   handle or rear bumper  the request switches may  not function     When the Intelligent Key is within the operating  range  it is possible for anyone  even someone  who does not carry the Intelligent Key  to push the  request switch to lock unlock the doors              WPD0375          DOOR LOCKS UNLOCKS  PRECAUTION        Do not push the door handle request switch    with the Intelligent Key held in your hand as  illustrated  The close distance to the door  handle will cause the Intelligent Key system  to have difficulty recognizing that the Intelli   gent Key is outside the vehicle     After locking with the door handle request  switch  verify the doors are securely locked  by testing them         To prevent the Intelligent Key from being left    inside the vehicle  make sure you carry the  Intelligent Key with you and then lock the  doors     Do not pull the door handle before pushing  the door handle request switch  The door  will be unlocked but will not open  Release  the door handle once and pull it again to  open the door     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 9                WPD0376                            WPD0377             WPD0369       NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY    OPERATION    You can lock or unlock the doors without taking  the Intelligent Key out of your pocket or bag     When you carry the Intelligent Key with you  you  can lock or unlock all doors by pushing the door  handle request switch within the range 
84.  Maintenance and do it yourself    Maintenance requirements             0  cece eee eee 8 2  General maintenance                 200 eee eee eee 8 2  Explanation of general maintenance items           8 2  Maintenance precautions         n   0  cece eee eee 8 5  Engine compartment check locations                  8 6  Engine cooling system              esses 8 7  Checking engine coolant level                     8 9  Changing engine coolant                      55 8 9  Enginie oll    e uiu rm Dic en wee Rp een et 8 10  Checking engine oil level                    00  8 10  Changing engine oil                   0 0 0 eee ee 8 11  Changing engine oil filter                     0  8 12  Continuously Variable Transmission  CVT  fluid        8 12  Power steering fluid    iere eu 8 13  Brake fl  id      uerb pn Res m nep e an Rs cat 8 13  Brake fluid    22ue ne ERE UE Ere pt PW e 8 14  Windshield washer fluid              celles eese 8 14  Windshield washer fluid reservoir                 8 14  Battely   ics ici ee re REDE e EE MES ie 8 15  Jump startihg   cese yn mem dinners 8 16  Variable voltage control system               0  00s 8 17  Dor cm 8 17    Spaikipl  gs    d eerie ede needa ination ined 8 18    Replacing spark plugs              esses 8 18  Air cleaner    ice red P Ie epa EErEE S 8 19  In cabin microfilter       ce asa wine Er Rm 8 19  Windshield wiper blades              esses esses 8 20  Cleanifig     oder eaae eir m edd mee gea 8 20  Replacing  i2 oer prre RU em mE
85.  Manual     SEEK CAT and TRACK buttons     When the 4     SEEK CAT button or P    TRACK button is pressed for less than 1 5 sec   onds while the iPod   is playing  the next track or  the beginning of the current track on the iPod    will be played     When the 44     SEEK CAT button or P    TRACK button is pressed for more than 1 5 sec   onds while the iPod   is playing  the iPod   will  play while fast forwarding or rewinding  When the  button is released  the iPod   will return to the  normal play speed     The NISSAN controller can also be used to se   lect tracks when the iPod   is playing     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 97       iPod  gt  Artists 8 00                                     LHA1399       Scrolling menus     While navigating long lists of artists  albums or  songs in the music menu  it is possible to scroll  the list by the first letter  To activate letter index   ing  perform one of the following         Turn the NISSAN controller quickly         Press and hold the up down directional ar   rows on the NISSAN controller         Touch and hold the page up down arrows  on the touchscreen     To exitthe scrolling by letter mode  perform one of  the following         Press the ENTER button on the NISSAN  controller         Push the ENTER switch on the steering  wheel         Do not touch the controls for 2 seconds     BLUETOOTH   STREAMING AUDIO   if so equipped     If you have a compatible Bluetooth   audio de   vice that is ca
86.  Select the     Angle    key and use the         or     key to  change the angle     Angle Mark  DVD VIDEO    When this item is turned on  an angle mark  will be shown on the bottom of the screen if  the scene can be seen from a different angle     Menu Skip  DVD VIDEO    DVD menus are automatically configured  and the contents will be played directly  when the  Menu Skip  key is turned on  Note  that some discs may not be played directly  even if this item is turned on     CM Skip  DVD VIDEO    Select the  CM Skip  key to choose the  setting time for CM backward and forward  operations  Use the         or     key to choose  a setting time of 15  30 or 60 seconds     DRC  DVD VIDEO  DVD VR    DRC  Dynamic Range Compression  auto   matically adjusts the soundtrack volume  level to maintain a more even sound to the  speakers     DVD Language  DVD VIDEO  VIDEO CD   Select the  DVD Language  key to open the  number entry screen  Input the number cor   responding to the preferred language and  select the  OK  key  The DVD top menu  language will be changed to the one speci   fied     Display  Adjust the image quality of the screen by  selecting the preferred adjustment items     Audio   Choose the preferred language for the au   dio    Subtitle  DVD VIDEO  DVD VR     Choose the preferred language for the sub   titles     4 86 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Display Mode  DVD VIDEO  VIDEO CD   DVD VR    Choose from the  Full    Wide    Normal  or   C
87.  Steering wheel switch for audio control           4 102  AMLGNNA sane  ve tester lt age E wand 4 103  Car phone or CB radio    1 2 06    cece eee eee eee 4 104  Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone System without  Navigation System  if so equipped               4  4 104    Regulatory Information                     eee ee 4 106    Using the system    2v orte meee reli 4 106  Control buttons    er pnt eR eats 4 108  Getting started eean LE eb eias 4 109  List of voice commands             sslssssssss 4 111  Voice Adaptation  VA  mode          ssussuse  4 115  Manual control    oe rre mh Ree Exe 4 116  Troubleshooting guide  s sisrcrissisirirserss 4 117   Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone System with   Navigation System  if so equipped               Ls 4 118  Regulatory Information             sslseesseses 4 120  Voice comirnands   uec ner ER UE ERR 4 120  Connecting procedure           lssssssssesus  4 120  Vehicle phonebook              seeseeeeeeeeee 4 122  Handset phonebook              0 0 cece 4 124  Making a call  ics der eere ack E ent 4 125  Receiving a call   rm 4 125  Du  ring a call ceterae eu ere EDS 4 126  Ending call  error ERES 4 127  Phone settings osse bble ere Medel dahetar 4 127  Bluetooth settings             0 0c eee ee eee eee 4 128  Call volumeni   oscar anew ampie a eem 4 129   NISSAN Voice Recognition System    if so equipped        6    eect tenets 4 130    NISSAN Voice Recognition Standard Mode       4 130    Using the system    ies tea reme 4 133  Before Starti
88.  When sitting in the rear seat  do not  hold onto the seatback of the front seat   If the side air bag inflates  you may be  seriously injured  Be especially careful  with children  who should always be  properly restrained  Some examples of  dangerous riding positions are shown  in the illustrations     e Do not use seat covers on the front  seatbacks  They may interfere with side  air bag inflation     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 43                                  WRS0466  1   Roof mounted curtain side impact 4  Air bag Control Unit  ACU   supplemental air bag inflators 5  Supplemental front impact air bag mod   2   Roof mounted curtain side impact ules  supplemental air bags 6  Crash zone sensor  3  Front seat mounted side impact 7  Occupant classification system control    supplemental air bag modules unit    1 44 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    8  Seat belt buckle switches for driver s  and passenger s side   9  Occupant classification sensor  pattern  sensor    10  Seat belt with pretensioner   11  Side satellite sensor    NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System   front seats     This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Ad   vanced Air Bag System for the driver and front  passenger seats  This system is designed to  meet certification requirements under U S  regu   lations  It is also permitted in Canada  However   all of the information  cautions and warn   ings in this manual still apply and must be  followed 
89.  a  malfunction       You can individually set driver s and front    passenger s side temperature using each  temperature control button  When the DUAL  button or passenger s side temperature but   ton is pressed  the DUAL indicator will come  on  To turn off the passenger s side tempera   ture control  press the DUAL button     Heating  A C OFF     The air conditioner does not activate  When you  need to heat only  use this mode       Press the A C button   A C OFF will be    displayed and A C indicator will turn off      4 42 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems      Operate the temperature control buttons to    set the desired temperature     The temperature of the passenger compart   ment will be maintained automatically  Air  flow distribution and fan speed are also con   trolled automatically     Do not set the temperature lower than the  outside air temperature  Otherwise the sys   tem may not work properly         Notrecommended if windows fog up   Dehumidified defrosting or defogging    1  Press the Su front defroster button on      The indicator light on the button will come  on        Operate the temperature control buttons to    set the desired temperature     To quickly remove ice from the outside of the  windows  use the fan speed control dial to  set the fan speed to maximum     As soon as possible after the windshield is  clean  press the AUTO button to return to  the automatic mode         When the Sg front defroster button is  pressed
90.  a forward facing child re   straint with a harness  Refer to the manufactur   ers instructions for minimum and maximum  weight and height recommendations  NISSAN  recommends that small children be placed in  child restraints that comply with Federal Motor  Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Ve   hicle Safety Standards  You should choose a  child restraint that fits your vehicle and always  follow the manufacturer s instructions for instal   lation and use     LARGER CHILDREN    Children should remain in a forward facing child  restraint with a harness until they reach the maxi   mum height or weight limit allowed by the child  restraint manufacturer     Once a child outgrows the height or weight limit  of the harness equipped forward facing child re   straint  NISSAN recommends that the child be  placed in a commercially available booster seat to  obtain proper seat belt fit  For a seat belt to fit    Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 19    properly  the booster seat should raise the child  so that the shoulder belt is properly positioned  across the chest and the top  middle portion of  the shoulder  The shoulder belt should not cross  the neck or face and should not fall off the shoul   der  The lap belt should lie snugly across the  lower hips or upper thighs  not the abdomen  A  booster seat can only be used in seating posi   tions that have a three point type seat belt  The  booster seat should fit the vehicle seat and have  a label 
91.  after the  vehicle has been parked for 3 or more  hours  or driven less than 1 mile   1 6 km  at moderate speeds  The  recommended cold tire inflation is set  by the manufacturer to provide the  best balance of tire wear  vehicle  handling  driveability  tire noise  etc    up to the vehicle s GVWR      8  Tire size     refer to  Tire labeling  in  this section      6 Spare tire size  if so equipped               LDI0393          Checking tire pressure    1     2     Remove the valve stem cap from the  tire     Press the pressure gauge squarely  onto the valve stem  Do not press too  hard or force the valve stem side   ways  or air will escape  If the hissing  sound of air escaping from the tire is  heard while checking the pressure   reposition the gauge to eliminate this  leakage     3  Remove the gauge     4  Read the tire pressure on the gauge    stem and compare to the specifica   tion shown on the Tire and Loading  Information label       Add air to the tire as needed  If too    much air is added  press the core of  the valve stem briefly with the tip of  the gauge stem to release pressure   Recheck the pressure and add or  release air as needed       Install the valve stem cap       Check the pressure of all other tires     including the spare     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 35    Size Cold Tire Inflation Pres   sure    P245 45VR18 230 kPa  33 PSI  Front Original Tire P245 40VR19 230 kPa  33 PSI  P245 40WR19 230 kPa  33 PSI    Rear Original Tire          8 36 Main
92.  and corrosion inhibitors  Additional en   gine cooling system additives are not necessary     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 7    AWARNING    e Never remove the radiator or coolant    reservoir cap when the engine is hot   Wait until the engine and radiator cool  down  Serious burns could be caused  by high pressure fluid escaping from  the radiator  See precautions in    If your  vehicle overheats    found in the    In case  of emergency    section of this manual     The radiator is equipped with a pres   sure type radiator cap  To prevent en   gine damage  use only a genuine  NISSAN radiator cap     A CAUTION    Never use any cooling system additives  such as radiator sealer  Additives may  clog the cooling system and cause  damage to the engine  transmission  and or cooling system     8 8 Maintenance and do it yourself    e When adding or replacing coolant  be    sure to use only Genuine NISSAN Long  Life Antifreeze Coolant  blue  or  equivalent  Genuine NISSAN Long Life  Antifreeze Coolant  blue  is pre diluted  to provide antifreeze protection to  34    F   37   C   If additional freeze protec   tion is needed due to weather where  you operate your vehicle  add Genuine  NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze Coolant   blue  concentrate following the direc   tions on the container  If an equivalent  coolant other than Genuine NISSAN  Long Life Antifreeze Coolant  blue  is  used  follow the coolant manufacturer   s  instructions to maintain minimum anti   freeze protection to  34 
93.  and gauges  P  2 3     Driver supplemental air bag horn     P  1 37  P  2 34     Security indicator light  P  2 26   Cruise control main set switches     P  5 19     10     la    12     13   14     15     16     17     18   19     20   21   22     23     Shift paddles  if so equipped   P  5 15   Windshield wiper washer switch    P  2 28    Display screen Navigation system     if so equipped   P  4 16    Display screen Navigation system   controls  if so equipped   P  4 16   Front passenger supplemental air bag   P  1 51    Glove box  P  2 41    Display screen  models without  Navigation system   P  4 4    Climate controls  models without  Navigation system   P  4 41    Audio system controls  models without  Navigation system   P  4 47    Front passenger air bag status light   P  1 44    Audio system controls  P  4 47   Climate controls  models with Naviga   tion system   P  4 44    Shift selector  P  5 12    Hazard warning flasher switch  P  6 2   Ignition switch  behind the steering  wheel   P  5 7    Tilt telescopic steering wheel controls   if so equipped   P  3 22     24  Vehicle Dynamic Control  VDC  OFF  switch  P  2 37   Outside mirror controls  P  3 27   Heated steering wheel switch   if so equipped   P  2 37   Trunk lid release switch  P  3 19     Refer to the separate Navigation System Own   er s Manual  if so equipped      See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     METERS AND GAUGES                      writ      la        yy  MPH oe
94.  and retractors  operate properly and smoothly   and are installed securely  Check the belt web   bing for cuts  fraying  wear or damage     Steering wheel Check for changes in the steer   ing system  such as excessive freeplay  hard  steering or strange noises     Warning lights and chimes Make sure all  warning lights and chimes are operating properly     Windshield wiper and washer  Check that  the wipers and washer operate properly and that  the wipers do not streak     Windshield defroster Check that the air  comes out of the defroster outlets properly and in  sufficient quantity when operating the heater or  air conditioner     Under the hood and vehicle    The maintenance items listed here should be  checked periodically  for example  each time you  check the engine oil or refuel      Battery  Check the fluid level in each cell  It  should be between the MAX and MIN lines  Ve   hicles operated in high temperatures or under  severe conditions require frequent checks of the  battery fluid level     8 4 Maintenance and do it yourself    NOTE     Care should be taken to avoid situations  that can lead to potential battery discharge  and potential no start conditions such as     1  Installation or extended use of electronic  accessories that consume battery power  when the engine is not running  Phone char   gers  GPS  DVD players  etc      2  Vehicle is not driven regularly and or only  driven short distances  In these cases  the  battery may need to be charged to maintain
95.  and voice recognition systems 4 131    Tutorials on the operation of the Voice Rec   ognition system    If you choose  Finding a Street Address    Using  the Address Book    or    Placing Calls   you can  view tutorials on how to perform these operations  using Voice Recognition        8 00    Information  gt  User Guide    j   This test will analyze your speech  The system will  prompt you to say a phone number  After you say    the number  the system will provide feedback to  improve voice recongnition              When you are ready  push the TALK switch              When you are ready  push the Talk switch          LHA1327    8 00    Information  gt  User Guide         Digits were not recognized correctly  Please check analysis    of your speech for possible improvements  Soft Good   Loud       836 623          Volume of voice       Slow Good Fast  Speed       Start of speaking Ey    Gece ee                   Try Again Done                      LHA1328       Let   s Practice    The system is equipped with a tutorial that allows  you to practice saying commands and receive  feedback on the volume  speed and timing of your  speech     4 132 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    To initiate a practice session  access the User  Guide and select the  Let s Practice  key  Follow  the on screen prompts until the session is com   plete  After the session is completed  a screen  will be displayed that shows an analysis of differ   ent elements of your sp
96.  at the next  broadcasting station     SCAN tuning     Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad   casting station for 5 seconds  Pressing the  SCAN button again during this five second pe   riod will stop scan tuning and the radio will remain  tuned to that station  If the SCAN button is not  pressed within 5 seconds  scan tuning moves to  the next station     1 to 6 Station memory operations     Six stations can be set for the AM band  Twelve  stations can be set for the FM band  6 for FM1  6  for FM2   Eighteen stations can be set for the XM  band  6 for XM1  6 for XM2  6 for XM3      1  Choose the radio band AM  FM1 or FM2  using the FM AM select button or choose  the satellite band SAT1 or SAT2 using the  AUX button     2  Tune to the desired station using manual   SEEK or SCAN tuning  Press and hold any  of the desired station memory buttons  1      6  until a beep sound is heard     3  The channel indicator will then come on and  the sound will resume  Programming is now  complete     4  Other buttons can be set in the same man   ner     4 72 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    If the battery cable is disconnected  or if the fuse  opens  the radio memory will be canceled  In that  case  reset the desired stations     Radio data system  RDS      RDS stands for Radio Data System  and is a data  information service transmitted by some radio  stations on the FM band  not AM band   Cur   rently  most RDS stations are in large cities  but  many 
97.  blowing warm or cool air  from the surface of the seat  The climate control  switch is located on the center console     The climate controlled seat can be operated as  follows     1  Start the engine     2  Turn the control knob to the H  Heat  side or  to the C  Cool  side  as desired  The indica   tor light on the control knob will illuminate     3  Adjust the desired amount of air using the  control knob  The climate controlled seat  blower remains on low speed for approxi     2 36 Instruments and controls    mately 60 seconds after turning the switch  on or selecting the desired temperature     4  When the vehicle s interior is warmed or  cooled  or before you leave the vehicle  be  sure to turn the control knob to the Off   center  position    To check the air filter for the climate controlled  seat  contact a NISSAN dealer     AWARNING    Do not use or allow occupants to use the  climate controlled seats if you or the oc   cupants can not monitor seat tempera   tures or have an inability to feel pain in  those body parts in contact with the seat   Use of the climate controlled seats by  such people could result in serious injury     ACAUTION    e The battery could run down if the cli   mate control seat is operated while the  engine is not running        Do not use the climate control seat for  extended periods or when no one is  using the seat     Do not put anything on the seat which  insulates heat  such as a blanket  cush   ion  seat cover  etc  Otherwise  the sea
98.  button is pressed with the  compact disc loaded but the radio playing  the    radio will automatically be turned off and the  compact disc will start to play             x        gt  gt     SEEK CAT and TRACK  buttons        When the SEEK CAT M4 button is pressed  while a compact disc is playing  the track being  played returns to its beginning  Press several  times to skip back through tracks  The compact  disc will go back the number of times the button  is pressed     When the TRACK P button is pressed while  the compact disc is playing  the next track will  start to play from its beginning  Press several  times to skip through tracks  The compact disc  will advance the number of times the button is  pressed   When the last track on the compact  disc is skipped through  the first track will be  played      The NISSAN controller can also be used to se   lect tracks when a CD is being played     4 80 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems          TH        gt  gt    SEEK CAT and TRACK   Rewind and Fast  Forward  buttons        Press and hold the SEEK CAT M    rewind   button or the TRACK P  fast forward  button  while a compact disc is playing  the compact disc  will play while rewinding or fast forwarding  When  the button is released  the compact disc will  return to normal play speed     TUNE FOLDER knob    While playing a CD with compressed audio files   turn the TUNE FOLDER knob right or left to play  the next or previous folder                  
99.  continue to hold  D until the desired window position is reached    Rear power window switch    The rear power window switches open or close  only the corresponding windows  To open the  window  push the switch to the first detent and  continue to hold it down until the desired window  position is reached  1   To close the window  pull  the switch to the first detent and continue to hold  up until the desired window position is reached    Locking passengers    windows    When the window lock button is depressed  only  the driver s side window can be opened or  closed  Push it again to cancel the window lock  function        tf  E          LIC0410       Automatic operation    To fully open a window equipped with automatic  operation  press the window switch down to the  second detent and release it  it need not be held   The window automatically opens all the way  To  stop the window  lift the switch up while the  window is opening     To fully close a window equipped with automatic  operation  pull the switch up to the second detent  and release it  it need not be held  To stop the  window  press the switch down while the window  is closing     Auto reverse function    The auto reverse function can be activated when  a window is closed by automatic operation     Depending on the environment or driving  conditions  the auto reverse function may  be activated if an impact or load similar to  something being caught in the window oc   curs     AA WARNING    There are some small 
100.  does  not come on at all     Under these conditions  the front air bag  side air  bag  curtain air bag or pretensioner systems may  not operate properly  They must be checked and  repaired  Take your vehicle to the nearest  NISSAN dealer     AWARNING    If the supplemental air bag warning light  is on  it could mean that the front air bag   side air bag  curtain air bag and or preten   sioner systems will not operate in an ac   cident  To help avoid injury to yourself or  others  have your vehicle checked by a  NISSAN dealer as soon as possible     Repair and replacement procedure    The front air bags  side air bags  curtain air bags  and pretensioners are designed to inflate on a  one time only basis  As a reminder  unless it is  damaged  the supplemental air bag warning light  remains illuminated after inflation has occurred   Repair and replacement of these supplemental  air bag systems should be done only by a  NISSAN dealer     When maintenance work is required on the ve   hicle  the front air bags  side air bags  curtain air  bags  pretensioners and related parts should be  pointed out to the person performing the mainte   nance  The ignition switch should always be  placed in the LOCK position when working under  the hood or inside the vehicle     AWARNING        Once a front air bag  side air bag  or  curtain air bag has inflated  the air bag  module will not function again and  must be replaced  Additionally  the ac   tivated pretensioner must also be re   placed  
101.  engaged for  more than 10 seconds  If the engine does  not start right away  place the ignition  switch in the OFF position and wait 3 to  4 seconds before trying again     7  After starting the engine  carefully discon   nect the negative cable and then the positive  cable     8  Replace the vent caps  if so equipped   Be  sure to dispose of the cloth used to cover  the vent holes as it may be contaminated  with corrosive acid     In case of emergency 6 9    PUSH STARTING    A CAUTION        CVT models cannot be push started or  tow started  Attempting to do so may  cause transmission damage         Do not push start this vehicle  The  three way catalyst may be damaged     6 10 In case of emergency    IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS    If your vehicle is overheating  indicated by an  extremely high temperature gauge reading  or if  you feel a lack of engine power  detect abnormal  noise  etc   take the following steps     A  WARNING    e Do not continue to drive if your vehicle  overheats  Doing so could cause engine  damage or a vehicle fire         To avoid the danger of being scalded   never remove the radiator cap while the  engine is still hot  When the radiator  cap is removed  pressurized hot water  will spurt out  possibly causing serious  injury    e Do not open the hood if steam is com   ing out     1  Move the vehicle safely off the road  apply  the parking brake and move the shift selector  to P  Park      Do not stop the engine     2  Turn off the air conditioner  Op
102.  h   to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire  pressure warning light  Use a tire pressure  gauge to check the tire pressure     The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning ap   pears in the vehicle information display when  the low tire pressure warning light is illumi   nated and low tire pressure is detected  The  CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning turns off  when the low tire pressure warning light  turns off     The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning  does not appear if the low tire pressure  warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS  malfunction     5 4 Starting and driving        Tire pressure rises and falls depending on  the heat caused by the vehicle   s operation  and the outside temperature  Low outside  temperature can lower the temperature of  the air inside the tire which can cause a  lower tire inflation pressure  This may cause  the low tire pressure warning light to illumi   nate  If the warning light illuminates  check  the tire pressure for all four tires       The Tire and Loading Information label  also  referred to as the vehicle placard or tire  inflation pressure label  is located in the  driver s door opening     For additional information  see  Low tire pressure  warning light  in the  Instruments and controls   section and  Tire Pressure Monitoring System   TPMS   in the    In case of emergency  section     A  WARNING      If the low tire pressure warning light illu     minates while driving  avoid sudden  steering maneuvers or abrupt braking   reduce vehicle speed
103.  if a child is in the  front passenger seat  the Advanced Air Bag Sys   tem is designed to turn the passenger air bag  OFF in accordance with the regulations  Also  if a  child restraint of the type specified in the regula   tions is on the seat  its weight and the child s  weight can be detected and cause the air bag to  turn OFF  Occupant classification sensor opera   tion can vary depending on the front passenger  seat belt sensors     The front passenger seat belt sensors are de   signed to detect if the seat belt is buckled  Based  on the weight on the seat detected by the occu   pant classification sensor  the Advanced Air Bag  System determines whether the front passenger    air bag should be automatically turned OFF as  required by the regulations     Front passenger seat adult occupants who are  properly seated and using the seat belt as out   lined in this manual should not cause the passen   ger air bag to be automatically turned OFF  For  small adults it may be turned OFF  however if the  occupant takes his her weight off the seat cush   ion  for example  by not sitting upright  by sitting  on an edge of the seat  or by otherwise being out  of position   this could cause the sensor to turn  the air bag OFF  In addition  if the occupant  improperly uses the seat belt in the ALR mode   child restraint mode   this could cause the air  bag to be turned OFF  Always be sure to be  seated and wearing the seat belt properly for the  most effective protection by the seat b
104.  illuminated for 5 sec   onds  press the a button on the keyfob   The indicator light will blink  After the indica   tor light goes off  the keyfob is linked to that  memory setting        With the ignition switch placed in the OFF posi   tion  press the M button on the keyfob  The  driver s seat and outside mirrors will move to the  memorized position        NOTE     If a new memory position is saved to the  memory switch  the keyfob automatically  re links     Confirming memory storage        Place the ignition switch in the ON position  and push the SET switch  If the main memory  has not been stored  the indicator light will  come on for approximately 0 5 seconds   When the memory has stored the position   the indicator light will stay on for approxi   mately 5 seconds         Ifthe battery cable is disconnected  or if the  fuse opens  the memory storage function will  be canceled and must be restarted before a  stored memory position can be set again   Drive the vehicle over 25 MPH  40 km h  to  restart the memory storage function  You  can also restart the memory storage function  using the following procedure     1  Connect the battery cable or replace the  fuse     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 29    2  Open and close the driver s door more than  2 times with the ignition switch in the LOCK  position     Once the memory storage function has been  restarted  you can store a memory position   See  Memory storage function  in this sec   tion     Selecting the memo
105.  in an emergency  do not shift to  the N  Neutral  position while driving   Coasting with the transmission in the N   Neutral  position may cause serious  damage to the transmission     A CAUTION    When stopping the vehicle on an uphill  grade  do not hold the vehicle by depress   ing the accelerator pedal  The foot brake  should be used for this purpose     The CVT in your vehicle is electronically con   trolled to produce maximum power and smooth  operation     The CVT can operate in two different automatic  drive modes         D  Drive  mode   Move the shift selector to D   Drive   the transmission is in the normal  forward automatic driving mode  The posi   tion indicator in the meter shows a  D   The  D  Drive  mode does not produce a gear  change sensation like a traditional automatic  transmission         Ds  Drive Sport  mode   Move the shift se   lector over from D  Drive  to the left into the  manual shift gate  The position indicator in  the meter shows a  Ds   In Ds  Drive Sport   mode  transmission operation changes to   Sporty  driving shift operation  creating a  more aggressive acceleration feeling than  the D  Drive  mode and a gear change sen   sation when the driver accelerates quickly   When the driver selects M  Manual  mode  ratio with shift selector or shift paddles  if so  equipped  during Ds  Drive Sport  mode  operation  the driver must move the shift  selector from Ds mode to D mode and back  again to re select Ds  Drive Sport  mode         To canc
106.  in quality  The compression re   duces certain parts of sound that seem in   audible to most people     e WMA     Windows Media Audio  WMA  is a  compressed audio format created by Micro   soft as an alternative to MP3  The WMA  codec offers greater file compression than  the MP3 codec  enabling storage of more  digital audio tracks in the same amount of  space when compared to MP3s at the same  level of quality     AAC M4A     Advanced Audio Coding   AAC  is a lossy audio compression format   Audio files that have been encoded with  AAC are generally smaller in size and deliver  a higher quality of sound than MP3     ATRACS  ATRAC3 Plus     Adaptive Trans   form Acoustic Coding  ATRAC  is a lossy  audio compression format developed by  Sony     Bit rate     Bit rate denotes the number of  bits per second used by a digital music file   The size and quality of a compressed digital  audio file is determined by the bit rate used  when encoding the file     Sampling frequency     Sampling frequency  is the rate at which the samples of a signal  are converted from analog to digital  A D  conversion  per second     Multisession     Multisession is one of the  methods for writing data to media  Writing  data once to the media is called a single  session  and writing more than once is called  a multisession     4 58 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    e ID3 WMA Tag     The ID3 WMA tag is the  part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that  contains information 
107.  in the trailer to prevent  load shift while driving         Keep the cargo load as low as possible in  the trailer to keep the trailer center of gravity  low         Load the trailer so approximately 60  of the  trailer load is in the front half and 40  is in  the back half  Also make sure the load is  balanced side to side         Check your hitch  trailer tire pressure  ve   hicle tire pressure  trailer light operation  and  trailer wheel lug nuts every time you attach a  trailer to the vehicle         Becertain your rearview mirrors conform to  all federal  state or local regulations  If not   install any mirrors required for towing before  driving the vehicle         Determine the overall height of the vehicle  and trailer so the required clearance is  known     Trailer towing tips    In order to gain skill and an understanding of the  vehicle s behavior  you should practice turning   stopping and backing up in an area which is free  from traffic  Steering stability and braking perfor   mance will be somewhat different than under  normal driving conditions         Always secure items in the trailer to prevent  load shift while driving       Lock the trailer hitch coupler with a pin or  lock to prevent the coupler from inadver   tently becoming unlatched         Avoid abrupt starts  acceleration or stops       Avoid sharp turns or lane changes         Always drive your vehicle at a moderate  speed     Technical and consumer information 9 21    When backing up  hold the bo
108.  inflating can increase the  risk of injury if the occupant is too close to  or is  against  the front air bag module during inflation     The front air bags deflate quickly after a collision     The front air bags operate only when the  ignition switch is in the ON or START posi   tion     After placing the ignition switch in the ON  position  the supplemental air bag warning  light illuminates  The supplemental air bag  warning light will turn off after about 7 sec   onds if the system is operational     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 45       9   PY   OFF             Front passenger air bag and status light    AWARNING    The front passenger air bag is designed to  automatically turn OFF under some con   ditions  Read this section carefully to  learn how it operates  Proper use of the  seat  seat belt and child restraints is nec   essary for most effective protection  Fail   ure to follow all instructions in this  manual concerning the use of seats  seat  belts and child restraints can increase the  risk or severity of injury in an accident     1 46    Status light    The front passenger air bag status light       is  located above the radio  After the ignition switch  is placed in the  ON  position  the front passen   ger air bag status light on the instrument panel  illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off  or remains illuminated depending on the front  passenger seat occupied status  The light oper   ates as follows         Unoc
109.  injuries  You  could also slide under the lap belt and  receive serious internal injuries         For the most effective protection when  the vehicle is in motion  the seat should  be upright  Always sit well back in the  seat with both feet on the floor and  adjust the seat belt properly        Do not allow children to play with the  seat belts  Most seating positions are  equipped with Automatic Locking Re   tractor  ALR  mode seat belts  If the  seat belt becomes wrapped around a  child s neck with the ALR mode acti   vated  the child can be seriously injured  or killed if the seat belt retracts and  becomes tight  This can occur even if  the vehicle is parked  Unbuckle the seat  belt to release the child  If the seat belt  cannot be unbuckled or is already un   buckled  release the child by cutting the  seat belt with a suitable tool  such as a  knife or scissors  to release the seat  belt     1 14 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system                Front seat shown  Fastening the seat belts     D Adjust the seat  See    Seats    earlier in this  section     LRS2190       WRS0137              2 Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor  and insert the tongue into the buckle until  you hear and feel the latch engage         The retractor is designed to lock dur   ing a sudden stop or on impact  A  slow pulling motion permits the seat  belt to move  and allows you some  freedom of movement in the seat         Ifthe seat belt cannot be pulled fr
110.  is equipped with an auto   matic engine cooling fan  It may come  on at any time without warning  even if  the ignition switch is in the OFF posi   tion and the engine is not running  To  avoid injury  always disconnect the  negative battery cable before working  near the fan     If you must run the engine in an en   closed space such as a garage  be sure  there is proper ventilation for exhaust  gases to escape     Never get under the vehicle while it is  supported only by a jack  If it is neces   sary to work under the vehicle  support  it with safety stands     Keep smoking materials  flame and  sparks away from the fuel tank and  battery     On gasoline engine models  the fuel  filter or fuel lines should be serviced by  a NISSAN dealer because the fuel lines  are under high pressure even when the  engine is off     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 5    A CAUTION      Do not work under the hood while the  engine is hot  Turn the engine off and  wait until it cools down       Avoid contact with used engine oil and  coolant  Improperly disposed engine  oil  engine coolant and or other vehicle  fluids can damage the environment  Al   ways conform to local regulations for  disposal of vehicle fluid       Never leave the engine or automatic  transmission related component har   nesses disconnected while the ignition  switch is in the ON position       Never connect or disconnect the battery  or any transistorized component while  the ignition switch is in the ON position     
111.  lever  1  all the way towards you     wheel forward or back   to the desired position         Adjust the steerin  ward in direction        Adjust the steering wheel up or down in  direction  3  to the desired position     Lock the steering wheel by releasing the lock  lever  Make sure the lock lever has returned to its  original position to lock the steering wheel in  place     AUTOMATIC OPERATION  if so  equipped   Tilt operation    Push the switch  1  up or down to adjust the  steering wheel to the desired position     Telescopic operation    Push the switch  1  forward or backward to ad   just the steering wheel to the desired position     Entry Exit function    The automatic drive positioner system will make  the steering wheel move up automatically when  the driver s door is opened and the ignition  Switch is in the LOCK position  This lets the driver  get into and out of the seat more easily  The  steering wheel moves back into position when  the driver s door is closed and the ignition switch  is pushed     For more information  see  Automatic drive posi   tioner  in this section     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 23    SUN VISORS             WPD0297       3 24 Pre driving checks and adjustments       To block glare from the front  swing down the  sun visor      2 To block glare from the side  remove the sun  visor from the center mount and swing the  visor to the side        Slide the extension sun visor in or out as  needed   A CAUTION        Do not store the 
112.  moun   tainous area         Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it  from being dialed     When the radio wave condition is not ideal  or ambient sound is too loud  it may be  difficult to hear the other person s voice dur   ing a call     Immediately after the ignition switch is  placed in the ON position  it may be impos   sible to receive a call for a short period of  time     Do not place the cellular phone in an area  surrounded by metal or far away from the  in vehicle phone module to prevent tone  quality degradation and wireless connection  disruption     While a cellular phone is connected through  the Bluetooth   wireless connection  the  battery power of the cellular phone may dis   charge quicker than usual  The Bluetooth  Hands Free Phone System cannot charge  cellular phones     If the hands free phone system seems to be  malfunctioning  see  Troubleshooting guide   in this section  You can also visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth for trouble   shooting help     Some cellular phones or other devices may  cause interference or a buzzing noise to  come from the audio system speakers  Stor   ing the device in a different location may  reduce or eliminate the noise     Refer to the cellular phone owner s manual  regarding the telephone charges  cellular  phone antenna and body  etc     The signal strength display on the monitor  will not coincide with the signal strength  display of some cellular phones     If reception between callers is unclear  ad   justing t
113.  or  down to manually control the  phone system  if so equipped    GETTING STARTED    The following procedures will help you get  started using the Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System with NISSAN Voice Recognition  For ad   ditional command options  refer to  List of voice  commands  in this section     4      Choosing a language    You can interact with the Bluetooth   Hands   Free Phone System using English  Spanish or  French     To change the language  perform the following     1  Press and hold the   lt   than 5 seconds     2  The system announces     Press the  PHONE SEND  X    button for the  hands free phone system to enter the voice  adaptation mode or press the PHONE END          button to select a different lan   guage      button for more    3  Press the      button     For information on voice adaptation  see     Voice adaptation  VA  mode    in this section     4  The system announces the current language  and gives you the option to change the lan   guage to Spanish  in Spanish  or French  in  French   To select the current language   press the PHONE SEND  f    button  To  select a different language  tilt the tuning    switch         or  v  up or down     NOTE     You must press the  4 button within  5 seconds to change the language     5  If you decide not to change the language  do  not press either button  After 5 seconds  the  VR session will end  and the language will  not be changed     Connecting procedure    NOTE     The connecting procedure must be p
114.  predicted course  lines  B  enter the parking space        4  Maneuver the steering wheel to make the  vehicle width guide lines     parallel to the  parking space     while referring to the pre   dicted course lines     5  When the vehicle is parked in the space  completely  move the shift selector to the P   Park  position and apply the parking brake     DIFFERENCE BETWEEN  PREDICTED AND ACTUAL  DISTANCES    The distance guide line and the vehicle width  guide line should be used as a reference only  when the vehicle is on a level  paved surface  The  distance viewed on the monitor is for reference  only and may be different than the actual distance  between the vehicle and displayed objects                    Vs    7          WHA1504       Backing up on a steep uphill    When backing up the vehicle up a hill  the dis   tance guide lines and the vehicle width guide  lines are shown closer than the actual distance   For example  the display shows 3 ft  1 0 m  to the  place   amp    but the actual 3 ft  1 0 m  distance on    the hill is the place  B   Note that any object on  the hill is further than it appears on the monitor     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 37                WHA1505       Backing up on a steep downhill    When backing up the vehicle down a hill  the  distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide  lines are shown farther than the actual distance   For example  the display shows 3 ft  1 0 m  to the  place     but the actua
115.  pressed  the compact disc will auto   matically be turned off and the last radio station  played will come on     The FM stereo indicator ST will illuminate during  FM stereo reception  When the stereo broadcast  signal is weak  the radio will automatically change  from stereo to monaural reception     XM band select     Pressing the AUX button will change the band as  follows    USB     XM1      XM2      XM3      AUX     USB   satellite  if so equipped     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 71    When the AUX button is pressed while the igni   tion switch is in the ACC or ON position  the  radio will come on at the station last played     The last station played will also come on when  the VOL ON OFF control knob is pressed ON      When the AUX button is pressed  the satellite  radio mode will be skipped unless an optional  satellite receiver and antenna are installed and a  SiriusXM Satellite Radio service subscription is  active  Satellite radio is not available in Alaska   Hawaii and Guam     If a compact disc is playing when the AUX button  is pressed  the compact disc will automatically be  turned off and the last radio station played will  come on     TUNE FOLDER  Tuning  knob     To manually tune the radio  turn the  TUNE FOLDER knob to the right or left       4   Ppl   SEEK CAT and TRACK  tuning buttons                 Press the SEEK CAT M4 button or the    TRACK  gt     button to tune from high to low or  low to high frequencies and stop
116.  section        r           WRS0699  Forward facing  front passenger seat     step 1  Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the  Child  Safety  and  Child Restraints  sections before   installing a child restraint     Follow these steps to install a forward facing  child restraint using the vehicle seat belt in the  rear seats or in the front passenger seat     1  If you must install a child restraint in  the front seat  it should be placed in a  forward facing direction only  Move  the seat to the rearmost position  Child  restraints for infants must be used in  the rear facing direction and therefore  must not be used in the front seat     2  Position the child restraint on the seat  Al   ways follow the child restraint manufactur   er s instructions     The back of the child restraint should be  secured against the vehicle seatback     If necessary  adjust or remove the head re   straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit   If the head restraint is removed  store it in a  secure place  Be sure to reinstall the  head restraint when the child restraint  is removed  See  Head restraints  in this  section for head restraint adjustment  re   moval and installation information     If the seating position does not have an  adjustable head restraint and it is interfering  with the proper child restraint fit  try another  seating position or a different child restraint                       WRS0680  Forward facing     step 3    3  Route the seat belt tongue through the child
117.  select the  Fuel  Economy  key  then select the  Fuel Eco History   key using the NISSAN controller     The average fuel consumption history will be  displayed in a graph form along with the average  fuel for the previous Reset to Reset period     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 21       Information  gt  Maintenance 8 00        o 6000 12000 18000  Engine Oil L1 1 1    Oil Filter          Tire  Other Reminder    0 6000 12000 18000  miles                      LHA1234    Information  gt  Other Reminder 8 00    6000 12000 18000  Interval        lt   2j  9 mile                               Reminder          Reset Distance    0 6000 12000 18000  miles    1 3                LHA1235       Maintenance items    Press the INFO button and select the    Mainte   nance    key using the NISSAN controller  the  maintenance information will be displayed on the  screen     Changing the maintenance interval    Select one of the maintenance reminder keys  using the NISSAN controller to display the  screen to change the maintenance interval  You  can choose between Engine Oil  Oil Filter  Tire  and Other Reminder     Select the    Interval    key using the NISSAN con   troller  Touch the         or     keys or turn the  NISSAN controller to choose the desired dis   tance  To accept the changes  press the BACK  button     4 22 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Resetting the maintenance interval    To reset the reminder schedule  distan
118.  sudden stop     e The spare tire is designed for emer   gency use  See specific instructions un   der the heading    Wheels and tires  in  the    Maintenance and do it yourself     section of this manual     In case of emergency 6 7    JUMP STARTING    To start your engine with a booster battery  the  instructions and precautions below must be fol   lowed     AWARNING    e If done incorrectly  jump starting can  lead to a battery explosion  resulting in  severe injury or death  It could also  damage your vehicle     e Explosive hydrogen gas is always pres   ent in the vicinity of the battery  Keep all  sparks and flames away from the  battery       Do not allow battery fluid to come into  contact with eyes  skin  clothing or  painted surfaces  Battery fluid is a cor   rosive sulfuric acid solution which can  cause severe burns  If the fluid should  come into contact with anything  imme   diately flush the contacted area with  water         Keep battery out of the reach of  children         The booster battery must be rated at  12 volts  Use of an improperly rated  battery can damage your vehicle     6 8 In case of emergency      Whenever working on or near a battery     always wear suitable eye protectors  for  example  goggles or industrial safety  spectacles  and remove rings  metal  bands  or any other jewelry  Do not lean  over the battery when jump starting     Do not attempt to jump start a frozen  battery  It could explode and cause se   rious injury     Your vehicle 
119.  that a safety defect exists in a group of  vehicles  it may request that NISSAN con   duct a recall campaign  However  Trans   port Canada cannot become involved in  individual problems between you  your  dealer  or NISSAN     You may contact Transport Canada s De   fect Investigations and Recalls Division  toll free at 1 800 333 0510  You may  also report safety defects online at   https   wwwapps tc gc ca Saf Sec   Sur 7 PCDB BDPP Index aspx     Technical and consumer information 9 25    Additional information concerning motor  vehicle safety may be obtained from Trans   port Canada   s Road Safety Information  Centre at 1 800 333 0371 or online at  www tc gc ca roadsafety  English speak   ers  or www tc gc ca securiteroutiere   French speakers      To notify NISSAN of any safety concerns  please contact our Consumer Information  Centre toll free at 1 800 387 0122     9 26 Technical and consumer information    READINESS FOR INSPECTION   MAINTENANCE  I M  TEST    Due to legal requirements in some states and  Canadian Provinces  your vehicle may be re   quired to be in what is called the  ready condi   tion  for an Inspection Maintenance  I M  test of  the emission control system     The vehicle is set to the  ready condition  when it  is driven through certain driving patterns  Usually   the ready condition can be obtained by ordinary  usage of the vehicle     If a powertrain system component is repaired or  the battery is disconnected  the vehicle may be  reset to a  not r
120.  the  specified size of tires on all four  wheels       When installing a spare tire  make  sure that it is the proper size and type  as specified on the Tire and Loading  Information label  See    Tire and  Loading Information label  in the   Technical and consumer informa   tion  section of this manual       For detailed information  see     Wheels and tires    in the    Mainte   nance and do it yourself    section of  this manual     The Anti lock Braking System  ABS  controls the  brakes so the wheels do not lock during hard  braking or when braking on slippery surfaces   The system detects the rotation speed at each  wheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to pre   vent each wheel from locking and sliding  By  preventing each wheel from locking  the system  helps the driver maintain steering control and  helps to minimize swerving and spinning on slip   pery surfaces     Using the system    Depress the brake pedal and hold it down  De   press the brake pedal with firm steady pressure   but do not pump the brakes  The ABS will oper   ate to prevent the wheels from locking up  Steer  the vehicle to avoid obstacles     AWARNING  Do not pump the brake pedal  Doing so  may result in increased stopping  distances     Self test feature    The ABS includes electronic sensors  electric  pumps  hydraulic solenoids and a computer  The  computer has a built in diagnostic feature that  tests the system each time you start the engine  and move the vehicle at a low speed in forward o
121.  the camera         Do not use wax on the camera window   Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth damp   ened with mild detergent diluted with water     VENTS                                                                                                                         LHA1132  Center Side    Adjust air flow direction by moving the vent  slides              Open or close the vents by using the dial  Move  the dial toward the     to open the vents or  toward the B     to close them     4 40 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems             LHA1133       HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER   automatic   Type A                          ren                    I    Inm    Eu             aonan onn    D                                                                      pege   p   HH      e     VON          Rear       LHA1134       oar WON    N          ZEE  LONH                         11 10    8 7  LHA1139  Type A  Temperature control buttons  driver s 9      fan speed control  dial  ON OFF  side  button  AUTO climate control ON button 10  Gy  rear window defroster  button  QW  front defroster  button 11  A C  air conditioner  ON OFF button    S amp S Air recirculation button   MODE  manual air flow control  button  Temperature control buttons  passen   ger s side    DUAL  passenger side temperature  control  ON OFF button    amp  amp   gt  Fresh air intake button    Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 41    AWARNING      The air cond
122.  the ignition switch is placed in the ON position to  toggle the outside temperature and compass  direction display  1  on or off  The display will  indicate the direction that the vehicle is heading     N  North  E  East   S  South  W  West    If the display reads  C   calibrate the compass by  driving the vehicle in three complete circles at  less than 5 MPH  8 km h      You can also calibrate the compass by driving  your vehicle on your everyday route  The com   pass will be calibrated once it has tracked three  complete circles     Instruments and controls 2 7             WIC0355          2 8 Instruments and controls    Zone variation change procedure    The difference between magnetic north and geo   graphical north is known as variance  In some  areas  this difference can sometimes be great  enough to cause false compass readings  Follow  these instructions to set the variance for your  particular location if this happens     1  Press and hold the      button for about  8 seconds  The current zone number will  appear in the display  Release the button     2  Find your current location on the zone map   Refer to the illustration     3  Press the     button repeatedly to toggle  through the zone numbers until the desired  number appears in the display  Once you  have selected a zone number  the display  will show a compass direction within a few  seconds     NOTE   Use zone number 5 for Hawaii   Inaccurate compass direction     The compass display is equipped with automat
123.  the system will not heat the  steering wheel  This is not a malfunction     VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL  VDC   OFF SWITCH       E          OFF  ic                LIC1548       The vehicle should be driven with the Vehicle  Dynamic Control  VDC  system on for most driv   ing conditions    If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow  the VDC  system reduces the engine output to reduce  wheel spin  The engine speed will be reduced  even if the accelerator is depressed to the floor  If  maximum engine power is needed to free a stuck  vehicle  turn the VDC system off     To turn off the VDC system  push the VDC OFF  Switch  The 8 indicator will come on    Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the  engine to turn on the system  See  Vehicle Dy     namic Control  VDC  system  in the  Starting and  driving  section     Instruments and controls 2 37    POWER OUTLET                      LIC1392          Front center console    The power outlets are for powering electrical  accessories such as cellular telephones  They  are rated at 12 Volt  120 W  10A  maximum     The power outlets are powered only when the  ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position     2 38 Instruments and controls    ACAUTION    The outlet and plug may be hot during  or immediately after use    Only certain power outlets are designed  for use with a cigarette lighter unit  Do  not use any other power outlet for an  accessory lighter  See your NISSAN  dealer for additional information     Do not use with accessories tha
124.  the trailer lights may burn out     When towing a trailer  transmission fluid  should be changed more frequently  For  additional information  see the    Mainte   nance and do it yourself    section earlier in  this manual     FLAT TOWING    Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the  ground is sometimes called flat towing  This  method is sometimes used when towing a vehicle  behind a recreational vehicle  such as a motor  home     A CAUTION    e Failure to follow these guidelines can  result in severe transmission damage     e Whenever flat towing your vehicle  al   ways tow forward  never backward     e DO NOT tow any automatic transmis   sion vehicle with all four wheels on the  ground  flat towing   Doing so WILL  DAMAGE internal transmission parts  due to lack of transmission lubrication       For emergency towing procedures refer  to    Towing recommended by NISSAN     in the    In case of emergency  section of  this manual     Continuously Variable Transmission    To tow a vehicle equipped with a continuously  variable transmission  an appropriate vehicle  dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicle s  drive wheels  Always follow the dolly manufac   turer s recommendations when using their prod   uct     Technical and consumer information 9 23    UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING    DOT  Department of Transportation  Quality  Grades  All passenger car tires must conform to  federal safety requirements in addition to these  grades     Quality grades can be found wher
125.  turn the  TUNE FOLDER knob left or right  This will enable  or disable the beep sound heard during menu  selection     Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the  desired level  press the AUDIO control knob re   peatedly until the radio or CD display reappears   Otherwise  the radio or CD display will automati   cally reappear after about five seconds     Clock set    The clock displays the time when the ignition  switch is placed in the ACC or ON position     Adjusting the time    1  Push and hold the DISP CLOCK button for  more than 2 seconds until the display shows     Hour Adjust        2  Turn the TUNE FOLDER knob to adjust the  hour     3  Press the DISP CLOCK button again  the  display will show    Minute Adjust        4  Turn the TUNE FOLDER knob to adjust the  minutes     5  Press the DISP CLOCK button again to exit  the clock set mode     Press the DISP CLOCK button again to return to  the regular clock display  If no action is taken  the  display will return to the regular clock display  after 10 seconds     If the power supply is disconnected  the clock will  not indicate the correct time     Readjust the time   CD display mode    To change the text displayed while playing a CD  with text  press the DISP CLOCK button  The  DISP CLOCK button will allow you to scroll  through CD text as follows  Track number and  Track time     Album title     Song title       Track number displays the track number se   lected on the disc       Track time displays the amount o
126.  units  shown on the display     Xi   OFF BUTTON    To change the display brightness  press  the X   2  OFF button  Pressing the button again  will change the display to the day or the  night display  The brightness can then be  adjusted using the NISSAN controller     The display brightness can also be adjusted us   ing the    brighter  button or the      dimmer   button     If no operation is done within 10 seconds  the  display will return to the previous display     Press and hold the     2 OFF button for more  than 2 seconds to turn the display off  Press the  button again to turn the display on     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 15    CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS      COLOR SCREEN WITH NAVIGATION  SYSTEM  if so equipped        1 2 3 4    a  o  P                                        15 14 13 12 11 10       LHA1147          NISSAN controller  P  4 17   INFO button  P  4 20   PHONE button             ZOOM OUT button      STATUS button  P  4 20     DEST button      ROUTE button      gt A OND  ON 9        brightness control  button    4 16 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    9  X   OFF brightness control button   P  4 31     10     brightness control  button   11  VOICE button    12  SETTING button  P  4 24    13  MAP button    14     BACK  previous  button  P  4 17   15  ZOOM IN button      For Navigation system control buttons  refer to  the separate Navigation System Owner s  Manual       For information on the PHONE 
127.  use tire chains on a TEMPO   RARY USE ONLY spare tire  Tire chains  will not fit properly and may cause dam   age to the vehicle     Because the TEMPORARY USE ONLY  spare tire is smaller than the original  tire  ground clearance is reduced  To  avoid damage to the vehicle  do not  drive over obstacles  Also  do not drive  the vehicle through an automatic car  wash since it may get caught     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 43    MEMO    8 44 Maintenance and do it yourself    9 Technical and consumer information    Capacities and recommended fuel lubricants          9 2  Fuel Recommendation            0   seen ee eee 9 3  Engine oil and oil filter recommendations           9 5  Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil  recommendations               cece eee eee eee 9 6   SPSCHICATONS yi cde ene he daa eee widd ti eames bean 9 7  ENQING ec  sei eni eeren a bette PRI es 9 7  Wheels and tires            0 00 c eee eee eee ee 9 8  Dimensions and weights             000ce eee aee 9 8   When traveling or registering your vehicle in   another Couhlty    i2 hist pe phage bestens 9 9   Vehicle identification                cece eee eee eee eee 9 9  Vehicle identification number  VIN  plate            9 9  Vehicle identification number   chassis number     9 9  Engine serial number               000 eee eee ees 9 10  F M V S S  C M V S S  certification label           9 10  Emission control information label                 9 10    Tire and loading information label                 
128.  usually in conjunction with increased distance  from the station transmitter   static or flutter can  be heard  This can be reduced by adjusting the  treble control to reduce treble response     Multipath reception  Because of the reflective  characteristics of FM signals  direct and reflected  signals reach the receiver at the same time  The  signals may cancel each other  resulting in mo   mentary flutter or loss of sound     AM RADIO RECEPTION    AM signals  because of their low frequency  can  bend around objects and skip along the ground   In addition  the signals can be bounced off the  ionosphere and bent back to earth  Because of  these characteristics  AM signals are also sub   ject to interference as they travel from transmitter  to receiver     Fading  Occurs while the vehicle is passing  through freeway underpasses or in areas with  many tall buildings  It can also occur for several  seconds during ionospheric turbulence even in  areas where no obstacles exist     Static  Caused by thunderstorms  electrical  power lines  electric signs and even traffic lights     4 48 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    SATELLITE RADIO RECEPTION  if so  equipped     When the satellite radio is used for the first time  or the battery has been replaced  the satellite  radio may not work properly  This is not a mal   function  Wait more than 10 minutes with satellite  radio ON and the vehicle outside of any metal or  large building for satellite radio to 
129.  vehicle body   e Red line     approx  1 5 ft  0 5 m       Yellow line     approx  3 ft  1 m       Green line  3   approx  7 ft  2 m       Green line  4   approx  10 ft  3 m     Vehicle width guide lines  5    Indicate the vehicle width when backing up   Predicted course lines  8      Indicate the predicted course when backing up   The predicted course lines will be displayed on  the monitor when the shift selector is in the R   Reverse  position and the steering wheel is  turned  The predicted course lines will move de   pending on how much the steering wheel is  turned and will not be displayed while the steer   ing wheel is in the neutral position     The vehicle width guide lines and the width of the  predicted course lines are wider than the actual  width and course     HOW TO PARK WITH PREDICTED  COURSE LINES    A  WARNING    e Always turn and check that it is safe to  do so before backing up  Always back  up slowly     e Use the displayed lines as a reference   The lines are highly affected by the  number of occupants  fuel level  vehicle  position  road conditions and road  grade     e If the tires are replaced with different  sized tires  the predicted course lines  may be displayed incorrectly         On a snow covered or slippery road   there may be a difference between the  predicted course line and the actual  course line     e If the battery is disconnected or be   comes discharged  the predicted  course lines may be displayed incor   rectly  If this occurs  ple
130.  when the compartment tempera   ture is extremely high or low   Decrease increase the temperature  before use     Do not expose the CD to direct sun   light     CDs that are in poor condition or are  dirty  scratched or covered with finger   prints may not work properly     The following CDs may not work prop   erly         Copy control compact discs  CCCD   e Recordable compact discs  CD R   e Rewritable compact discs  CD RW     Do not use the following CDs as they  may cause the CD player to malfunction         3 1 in  8 cm  discs with an adapter      CDs that are not round  e CDs with a paper label        CDs that are warped  scratched  or  have abnormal edges    This audio system can only play pre   recorded CDs  It has no capability to  record or burn CDs     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 49        If the CD cannot be played  one of the    following messages will be displayed   CHECK DISC         Confirm that the CD is inserted cor   rectly  the label side is facing up   etc           Confirm that the CD is not bent or  warped and it is free of scratches     PRESS EJECT     This is an error due to excessive tem   perature inside the player  Remove the  CD by pressing the EJECT button  After  a short time  reinsert the CD  The CD  can be played when the temperature of  the player returns to normal     UNPLAYABLE     The file is unplayable in this audio sys   tem  only MP3 or WMA  if so equipped   CD      During cold weather or rainy days  
131.  when the finest equipment is used  These char   acteristics are completely normal in a given re   ception area and do not indicate any malfunction  in your NISSAN radio system     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 47    Reception conditions will constantly change be   cause of vehicle movement  Buildings  terrain   signal distance and interference from other ve   hicles can work against ideal reception  De   scribed below are some of the factors that can  affect your radio reception     Some cellular phones or other devices may  cause interference or a buzzing noise to come  from the audio system speakers  Storing the de   vice in a different location may reduce or elimi   nate the noise     FM RADIO RECEPTION    Range  FM range is normally limited to 25     30 mi   40     48 km   with monaural  single channel  FM  having slightly more range than stereo FM  Exter   nal influences may sometimes interfere with FM  station reception even if the FM station is within  25 mi  40 km   The strength of the FM signal is  directly related to the distance between the  transmitter and receiver  FM signals follow a line   of sight path  exhibiting many of the same char   acteristics as light  For example  they will reflect  off objects     Fade and drift  As your vehicle moves away from  a station transmitter  the signals will tend to fade  and or drift     Static and flutter  During signal interference from  buildings  large hills or due to antenna position  
132. 0         Navigation   Volume  amp  Beeps         Audio Display          Phone   Clock         Bluetooth    Adjust navigation settings      Others                LHA1236       CONNECTING PROCEDURE    1  Press the SETTING button on the instru   ment panel and select the    Bluetooth    key  on the display              Settings  gt  Bluetooth   o dm Yul 8 00                Bluetooth       Connect Bluetooth       Connected Devices       Edit Bluetooth Info          Replace Connected Phone          LHA1316       Settings  gt  Bluetooth  o i vu 8 00    E     d Are you connecting a Bluetooth device to     use with the handsfree phone system    q For audio devices  please select  No     H                                     L Yes J   No     Cancel      ics                      2 5       Connecis a phone using Bluetooth       LHA1317       8 00       The system is searching for your  phone  Using your handset  look  for a Bluetooth device called MY   CAR  When requested by the  handset  enter the PIN 1234   Exiting screen cancels search                    LHA1318       2  Select the    Connect Bluetooth    key     3  A popup box will appear on the screen     prompting you to confirm that the connec   tion is for the phone system  Select the    Yes     key     4  When a PIN code appears on the screen     operate the Bluetooth   cellular phone to  enter the PIN code     The connecting procedure of the cellular  phone varies according to each cellular  phone  See the cellular phone Owne
133. 0 247 5321  For Canada    To purchase a copy of a genuine NISSAN Ser   vice Manual or Owner s Manual  for this model  year and prior  please contact your nearest  NISSAN dealer  For the phone number and loca   tion of a NISSAN dealer in your area  call the  NISSAN Information Center at 1 800 387 0122  and a bilingual NISSAN representative will assist  you     Technical and consumer information 9 27    MEMO    9 28 Technical and consumer information    10 Index    A    Air bag  See supplemental restraint  System  x Gtk ate dae xA dox E xx d 1 37  Air bag system   Front  See supplemental front impact    airbag system                 1 44  Air bag warning light             1 51  2 14  Air cleaner housing filler                  8 19  Air conditioner   Air conditioner service            s  4 47   Air conditioner specification label          9 11   Air conditioner system refrigerant and   oil recommendations                9 6   Heater and air conditioner   controls  i  sus he ee ar 4 42  4 45   Servicing air conditioner            4 47  Alarm system   See vehicle security system            2 26  Anchor point locations               1 24  Antenna    sex xu osx oe ae baa aS 4 103  Anti lock brake warning light            2 10  2 11  Anti lock Braking System  ABS           5 25  Amrests  is ae a ke be ee Bee eee dks 1 7  Audible reminders               2 16  Audiosystem          deda desd pi 4 47   Bluetooth   audio             s  4 98   Compact Disc  CD  changer         4 66   Comp
134. 1 4   Displacement cu in  cm  213 45  3 498    Firing order 1 2 3 4 5 6          Idle speed   CVT  in    N    position    Ignition timing  degree B T D C  at idle speed   CO   at idle    Spark plug FXE22HR1 1  Spark plug gap  Nominal  0 043  1 1     No adjustment is necessary                 Camshaft operation Timing chain  This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES 002     Technical and consumer information 9 7    WHEELS AND TIRES    Wheels   Tires   Spare tire   Speed rating 18     19     19       18 x 8 0JJ  19 x 8 0JJ    P245 45VR18  P245 40VR19  P245 40WR19  T145 80D17   V   V   Ww    9 8 Technical and consumer information       DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS  Overall length in  mm  190 6  4 843   Overall width in  mm  73 2  1 860   Overall height in  mm  57 9  1 472   Front Track  18 inch tire in  mm  62 4  1 585   19 inch tire in  mm  62 4  1 585   Rear Track  18 inch tire in  mm  62 4  1 585   19 inch tire in  mm  62 4  1 585   Wheelbase in  mm  109 3  2 775   Gross vehicle weight rating lb  kg  See the    F M V S S  C M V   Gross axle weight rating S S  certification label    on  Front Ib  kg  the center pillar between the  Rear Ib  kg  driver s side front and rear  doors     WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERING  YOUR VEHICLE IN ANOTHER  COUNTRY    When planning to drive your NISSAN ve   hicle in another country  you should first find  out if the fuel available is suitable for your vehi   cle   s engine     Using fuel with an octane rating that is too low  
135. 1 9      5  Footer Information Line   Provides more information  if available   about the menu selection currently high   lighted  for example  Manually set the time  zone      HOW TO USE THE STATUS   BUTTON   To display the status of the audio  climate control  system and fuel consumption  press the STATUS  button     The following information will appear when the  STATUS button is pressed multiple times     Audio     Audio and climate control system      Audio and fuel consumption     Audio    4 6 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems          12 00    Information          EM          Fuel Economy       Maintenance                      SON oc e rt                WHA1149       HOW TO USE THE INFO BUTTON    Press the INFO button  The display screen  shows vehicle information for your convenience     The information shown on the screen should be a  guide to determine the condition of the vehicle   See the following for details                          Avg kkk    Fuel Econ    Conjo    MPG       Fuel Econ History    SLIT    3               LHA1301             Fuel economy    Press the INFO button  then select the  Fuel  Economy  key using the NISSAN controller to  display Average Fuel Economy  Distance to  Empty and Fuel Economy History     Distance to empty  MI or km     The Distance to Empty  DTE  mode provides you  with an estimation of the distance that can be  driven before refueling  The DTE is constantly  calculated based on the amount of fuel in th
136. 4 43  Heater and air conditioner  automatic   Type B         4 44  Automatic operation       0    0  cee cece eee 4 45  Manual operation               ec ee eee eee eee ee 4 46  Operating tipSiweccesciwaryaweesseeeas ER OR ees 4 46  Servicing air conditioner                     0 0005 4 47  A  dio SySteim     iso tales ote rat nh mra etn RE Enea 4 47  RadiO es uses suut ayanateralcane  noi iles arae eia asus 4 47  FM radio reception           0000  e cece eee 4 48  AM radio reception           lese esee 4 48  Satellite radio reception  if so equipped            4 48  Audio operation precautions               isses  4 49       FM AM radio with compact disc  CD     changer  if so equipped                eee eee 4 64  FM AM SAT radio with compact disc  CD   player  if so equipped         0    cece eee ee eee 4 69  FM AM SAT radio with CD DVD player   if so equipped        6    cee eee teens 4 76  Digital Versatile Disc  DVD  Player  Operation  models with Navigation System         4 84  USB interface  models without Navigation  System   if so equipped           0    cece eee eee 4 87  USB interface  models with Navigation  System  hend isine todos eek amare dated aes 4 88  iPod    player operation without Navigation  System  if so equipped              cece eee eee eee 4 92  iPod    player operation with Navigation  System  if so equipped            0  cece eee eee 4 94  Bluetooth   streaming audio  if so equipped        4 98  CD care and cleaning                    2 05  4 101 
137. 9 11    Air conditioner specification label                 9 11  Installing front license plate               sssssese 9 11  Vehicle loading information              0   eee eae 9 12   Tels   dorem sto Ud aue rote ied tare 9 12   Vehicle load capacity             eee 9 13   Loading TPS eessen dnine Dr enbr i EM e 9 15   Measurement of weights                  00s eee 9 15  Towing a traller    2  zen e ere Rene 9 16   Maximum load limits        0 0 00  cece eee eee 9 16   Towing load specification                   cee 9 19   TOWING safety erer esteri eie Rede pere ns 9 19   Flat ROWING se ioo deg een er RENE 9 23  Uniform tire quality grading             sss 9 24  Emission control system warranty              sssese 9 25  Reporting safety defects             0c  cece eee eee 9 25  Readiness for inspection maintenance  I M  test       9 26  Event Data Recorders  EDR              000ee eee 9 26    Owner s Manual Service Manual order information    9 27       CAPACITIES AND RECOMMENDED    FUEL LUBRICANTS    The following are approximate capacities  The actual refill capacities may be slightly different  When refilling  follow the procedure  described in the    Maintenance and do it yourself    section to determine the proper refill capacity                                Capacity  Approximate  Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  US measure Imp measure Liter  Fuel 20 gal 16 5 8 gal 75 6 Unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of at least 91 AKI  RON 96   1  Engine oil  7  Drain a
138. A CAUTION  Be careful not to burn yourself  The engine  oil may be hot     8 12 Maintenance and do it yourself    5  Wipe the engine oil filter sealing surface with  a clean rag     ACAUTION    Be sure to remove any old gasket material  remaining on the sealing surface of the  engine  Failure to do so could lead to  engine damage     6  Coat the gasket on the new filter with clean  engine oil    7  Screw on the oil filter until a slight resistance  is felt  then tighten an additional 2 3 turn     8  Start the engine and check for leakage  around the oil filter  Correct as required     9  Turn the engine off and wait more than  10 minutes  Check the oil level  Add engine  oil if necessary     CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE  TRANSMISSION  CVT  FLUID    A CAUTION        Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid  NS 2  Do not mix with other fluids         Using transmission fluid other than  Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS 2 will  damage the CVT  which is not covered  by the warranty     When checking or replacement of CVT fluid is  required  we recommend your NISSAN dealer for  servicing     POWER STEERING FLUID                      LDI0557    The fluid level should be checked using the HOT  MAX range on the power steering fluid reservoir  at fluid temperatures of 122    176 F  50     80  C  or using the COLD MAX range on the  power steering fluid reservoir at fluid tempera   tures of 32    86  F  0    30  C      If the fluid is at or below the MIN line  add Genu   ine NISSAN PSF to HOT MAX or COLD 
139. AT button is pressed to ac   cess satellite radio stations unless op   tional satellite receiver and antenna are  installed and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio  service subscription is active  Satellite  radio is not available in Alaska  Hawaii  and Guam     FM AM SAT RADIO WITH CD DVD  PLAYER  if so equipped     For all operation precautions  see  Audio opera   tion precautions    in this section     Audio main operation  VOL ON OFF control     Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position and push the VOL ON OFF control knob  while the system is off to call up the mode that  was playing immediately before the system was  turned off     To turn the system off  press the VOL ON OFF  control knob     Turn the VOL ON OFF control knob to adjust the  volume     This vehicle has Speed Sensitive Volume  SSV   for audio  The audio volume changes as the driv   ing speed changes     AUDIO control knob  Bass  Treble  Bal   ance and Fade      Press the AUDIO control knob to change the  mode as follows     Bass     Treble     Balance     Fade    To adjust Bass  Treble  Balance and Fade  press  the AUDIO control knob until the desired mode  appears in the display  Turn the tuning knob to  adjust Bass and Treble to the desired level  You  can also use the tuning knob to adjust Fade and  Balance modes  Fade adjusts the sound level  between the front and rear speakers and Balance  adjusts the sound between the right and left  speakers     Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the  de
140. Calls Shows the last 5 outgoing phone calls   Missed Calls Shows the last 5 missed phone calls     Navigation Command        Previous Destinations Sets a route to a previous destination     Minimize Freeway Route Recalculates a route to the current destination while minimizing freeway usage     Previous Start Point Calculates a route to your previous starting point of the last route       Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 145    Zoom Out  lt 1 to 13 gt  Changes the map scale to a larger number   Guidance Voice ON OFF Turns the navigation voice guidance on or off  Guide Voice Repeat Repeats the last navigation voice guidance     Information Command     Displays the current weather map     Audio Command     COMMAND ACTION  X    Zoom In   1 to 13   Changes the map scale to a smaller number           Turns to the AM band  selecting the station last played   Turns to the FM band  selecting the station last played      uk HemstemeAUXmp Sd    LEN Turns to the SAT band  selecting the station last played       AM  FM  M  CD  USB  AUX    4 146 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       Information  gt  User Guide 8 00    Getting Started          Let s Practice  Using the Address Book  Finding a Street Address                Placing Calls       Help on Speaking             LHA1343       Information   User Guide 8 00    Using the Address Book          Finding a Street Address       Placing Calls       Help on Speaking          Voice Re
141. DR data are recorded by  your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation  occurs  no data are recorded by the EDR under  normal driving conditions and no personal data   e g  name  gender  age and crash location  are  recorded  However  other parties  such as law  enforcement  could combine the EDR data with  the type of personally identifying data routinely  acquired during a crash investigation     To read data recorded by an EDR  special equip   ment is required and access to the vehicle or the  EDR is needed  In addition to the vehicle manu   facturer and NISSAN dealer  other parties  such  as law enforcement  that have the special equip   ment  can read the information if they have ac   cess to the vehicle or the EDR  EDR data will only  be accessed with the consent of the vehicle  owner or lessee or as otherwise required or per   mitted by law     OWNER   S MANUAL SERVICE  MANUAL ORDER INFORMATION    Genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for this model  year and prior can be purchased  A genuine  NISSAN Service Manual is the best source of  service and repair information for your vehicle   This manual is the same one used by the factory   trained technicians working at NISSAN dealer   ships  Genuine NISSAN Owner s Manuals can  also be purchased     For USA    For current pricing and availability of genuine  NISSAN Service Manuals  contact     1 800 450 9491  www nissan techinfo com    For current pricing and availability of genuine  NISSAN Owner   s Manuals  contact     1 80
142. Delete Phonebook       Download Handset Phonebook             Volume  amp  Ringtone                Auto Downloaded    Add or edit phonebook entries                   LHA1319       Transferring the handset phonebook    If your cellular phone supports automatic down   loading  the system transfers the handset phone   book automatically by default  To ensure that this  feature is activated  press the SETTING button  on the instrument panel and select the  Phone   key  The  Auto Downloaded  selection should  have the amber indicator next to the word ON  activated  Select the  Auto Downloaded  key to  toggle this feature on or off     To transfer the handset phonebook to the vehicle  manually  follow these steps     1  Press the SETTING button on the instru   ment panel     4 124 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    2  Select the  Phone  key     3  Select the  Download Handset Phonebook   key     Once the handset phonebook is transferred to  the vehicle  it can be accessed by pressing the  PHONE key on the instrument panel or the  amp   button on the steering wheel  then selecting the     Handset Phonebook    key     Whether the handset phonebook is transferred  manually or automatically  the process can take  up to five minutes to complete  depending on the  size of the handset phonebook  See the cellular  phone s owner s manual for more details           Phone dig Yu 8 00 aco                Vehicle Phonebook   Volume  amp  Ringtone         Call History
143. Do not operate the In   telligent Key while on an airplane  Make  sure the buttons are not operated unin   tentionally when the unit is stored for a  flight     The Intelligent Key system can operate all the  door locks using the remote controller function or  pushing the request switch on the vehicle without  taking the key out from a pocket or purse  The  operating environment and or conditions may af   fect the Intelligent Key system operation     Be sure to read the following before using the  Intelligent Key system     ACAUTION       Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with  you when operating the vehicle     e Never leave the Intelligent Key in the  vehicle when you leave the vehicle     The Intelligent Key is always communicating with  the vehicle as it receives radio waves  The Intel   ligent Key system transmits weak radio waves   Environmental conditions may interfere with the  operation of the Intelligent Key system under the  following operating conditions         When operating near a location where  strong radio waves are transmitted  such as  a TV tower  power station and broadcasting  station         When in possession of wireless equipment   such as a cellular telephone  transceiver   and CB radio         When the Intelligent Key is in contact with or  covered by metallic materials         When any type of radio wave remote control  is used nearby         When the Intelligent Key is placed near an  electric appliance such as a personal com   puter         Wh
144. E 3 27  Automatic drive positioner  if so equipped             3 28  Memory storage function                  eee 3 29  Entry exit function  i  osos erem ete 3 30    System Operation  cose ei uo rev eT 3 DPUPIES 3 30       KEYS                               WPD0427       1  Two Intelligent Keys   2  Mechanical keys with built in transpon   der chip  inside Intelligent Keys    3    Key number plate    NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY    Your vehicle can only be driven with the Intelligent  Keys which are registered to your vehicle   s Intel     ligent Key system components and NISSAN Ve   hicle Immobilizer System components     3 2 Pre driving checks and adjustments    Never leave these keys in the vehicle     As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered  and used with one vehicle  The new keys must be  registered by a NISSAN dealer prior to use with  the Intelligent Key system and NISSAN Vehicle  Immobilizer System of your vehicle  Since the  registration process requires erasing all memory  in the Intelligent Key components when register   ing new keys  be sure to take all Intelligent Keys  that you have to the NISSAN dealer     A key number plate is supplied with your keys   Record the key number and keep it in a safe place   such as your wallet   not in the vehicle  If you lose  your keys  see a NISSAN dealer for duplicates by  using the key number  NISSAN does not record  key numbers so it is very important to keep track  of your key number plate     A key number is only necessa
145. E button manually controls air  flow and selects the air outlet     ae        Air flows from center and side  vents     174     Air flows from center and side vents  and foot outlets    s     Air flows mainly from foot outlets    32      Air flows from defroster and foot    outlets   Air flows from defroster outlets     To turn system off  Press the OFF button   OPERATING TIPS        When the engine coolant temperature and  outside air temperature are low  the air flow  from the foot outlets may not operate for a  maximum of 150 seconds  However  this is  not a malfunction  After the coolant tempera   ture warms up  air flow from the foot outlets  will operate normally     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 43    HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER   automatic   Type B                    LHA1136       The sunload sensor  located on the top driver s  side of the instrument panel  helps the system  maintain a constant temperature  Do not put any   thing on or around this sensor                    Type B    A C  air conditioner  ON OFF button  MODE  manual air flow control  button   amp     amp 2 Fresh air intake button  Temperature control buttons  passen   ger s side  DUAL  passenger s side  temperature control  ON OFF button  GY  rear window defroster  button  7      fan speed control  dial  ON OFF  button  8  WV  front defroster  button    Oh c    o    4 44 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems             C   Air recirculation butto
146. ENANCE NOTICE screen will be au   tomatically displayed as shown when both of the  following conditions are met         Thevehicle is driven the set distance and the  ignition switch is placed in the OFF position         The ignition switch is placed in the ON po   sition the next time the vehicle is driven     To return to the previous display after the MAIN   TENANCE NOTICE screen is displayed  press  the BACK button     The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen displays  each time the key is turned ON until one of the  following conditions are met         The    Reset    key is selected         The  Interval Reminder ON  key is set to  OFF  indicator light not illuminated          The maintenance interval is set again        8 00    Settings       Up        Audio    Display       Switch Beeps    Camera       Clock    humanam S                 Adjust tone  amp  advanced audio settings    LHA1304          Settings  gt  Display  Auto Day  12 00    Display    Brightness       Contrast    Background Color       G Toggles display on and off       LHA0929             HOW TO USE THE SETTING  BUTTON    When the SETTING button is pressed  the Set   tings screen will appear on the display  You can  select and or adjust several functions  features  and modes that are available for your vehicle  Use  the NISSAN controller to select each item to be  set     Audio settings    For audio settings  refer to  Audio System  in this  section     Display settings    Select the  Display  key  The Display se
147. FFECTS    ENTER NEXT          LIC2178       Reset mode    The reset mode can be selected in any screen  that allows for preferences to be programmed   Once the screen is selected  you have the option  to reset the selected distances or time to a new  setting     Maintenance mode    The maintenance mode allows you to set alerts  for the reminding of maintenance intervals for the  following         engine oil      oil filter      tires        other    Set a desired interval by pushing O to high   light the maintenance field and pressing  The reset mode will open up and allow you to  enter the desired distance                 Options mode  The LANGUAGE UNIT EFFECTS screen will  appear when selecting the      Language   Unit Effects  key and pressing                Language  English  French or Spanish    Unit  US     mile    F  MPG  Metric     km   C  L 100 km    Effects  This changes effects of the indicator  needles when ON  The needles in the meter  sweep and the ring illumination will be brightened  gradually when the engine is started     Instruments and controls 2 21    You can select the language  unit or change the  dial effects by using the    button and  pressing                The settings are automatically saved when you  exit the menu by pressing the BACK button or  any other mode button     2 22 Instruments and controls        gt SKIP     gt DETAIL  OAENTER  NEXT             LIC1098       Warning mode    The warning mode can be selected to view any  warnings that ma
148. INTENANCE    During the normal day to day operation of the  vehicle  general maintenance should be per   formed regularly as prescribed in this section  If  you detect any unusual sounds  vibrations or  smells  be sure to check for the cause or have a  NISSAN dealer do it promptly  In addition  you  should notify a NISSAN dealer if you think that  repairs are required     When performing any checks or maintenance  work  closely observe the  Maintenance precau   tions  later in this section     EXPLANATION OF GENERAL  MAINTENANCE ITEMS    Additional information on the following  items with      is found later in this section     Outside the vehicle    The maintenance items listed here should be  performed from time to time  unless otherwise  specified     Doors and engine hood Check that the doors  and engine hood operate properly  Also ensure  that all latches lock securely  Lubricate hinges   latches  latch pins  rollers and links as necessary   Make sure that the secondary latch keeps the  hood from opening when the primary latch is  released     When driving in areas using road salt or other  corrosive materials  check lubrication frequently     Lights  Clean the headlights on a regular basis   Make sure that the headlights  stop lights  tail  lights  turn signal lights  and other lights are all  operating properly and installed securely  Also  check headlight aim     Road wheel nuts  lug nuts   When checking  the tires  make sure no wheel nuts are missing   and check for 
149. IOR LIGHT             m foo 0  Cos    C          WIC1550       The interior light has a three position switch and  operates regardless of ignition switch position         When the switch is in the ON position  1    the front and rear personal lights will illumi   nate  regardless of door position  The light  will go off after a period of time unless the  ignition switch is placed in the ON position         When the switch is in the center DOOR po   sition  2   the front and rear personal lights will  illuminate under the following conditions         Driver s door is unlocked while the igni   tion switch is placed in the OFF position   Lights remain on for a period of time         Driver s door is opened   Lights remain on for a period of time after  driver s door is closed         Ignition switch is placed in the OFF posi   tion     The lights will go off when the ignition switch is in  the ON position  or the driver s door is closed and  locked     The lights will also go off after a period of time  when all doors are open         When the switch is in the OFF position      the front and rear personal lights will not  illuminate  regardless of door position     NOTE     The footwell and doorstep lights illuminate  when the driver and passenger doors are  opened regardless of the interior light  switch position  These lights will turn off  automatically after a period of time while  doors are open to prevent the battery from  becoming discharged     A CAUTION    Do not use fo
150. Ib  907 kg      You may add Class   trailer hitch equipment that  has a 2 000 Ib  907 kg  maximum weight rating to  the vehicle  but your vehicle is only capable of  towing the maximum trailer weights shown in the  Towing Load Specification chart earlier in this  section     A CAUTION  e Do not use axle mounted hitches         The hitch should not be attached to or  affect the operation of the impact   absorbing bumper     e Do not modify the vehicle exhaust sys   tem  brake system  etc  to install a  trailer hitch     e To reduce the possibility of additional  damage if your vehicle is struck from  the rear  where practical  remove the  receiver when not in use         After the hitch is removed  seal the bolt  holes to prevent exhaust fumes  water  or dust from entering the passenger  compartment     e Regularly check that all trailer hitch  mounting bolts are securely mounted     9 20 Technical and consumer information    Tire pressures        When towing a trailer  inflate the ve   hicle tires to the recommended cold  tire pressure indicated on the Tire  and Loading Information label         Trailer tire condition  size  load rating  and proper inflation pressure should  be in accordance with the trailer and  tire manufacturer s specifications     Safety chains    Always use suitable safety chains between your  vehicle and the trailer  The safety chains should  be crossed and should be attached to the hitch   not to the vehicle bumper or axle  Be sure to leave  enough sla
151. MAX  depending on system fluid temperature  Remove  the cap and fill through the opening        A CAUTION  e DO NOT OVERFILL     e Recommended fluid is  NISSAN PSF or equivalent     Genuine    BRAKE FLUID    For further brake fluid specification information   refer to    Capacities and recommended  fuel lubricants  in the  Technical and consumer  information  section of this manual     A  WARNING      Use only new fluid from a sealed con   tainer  Old  inferior or contaminated  fluid may damage the brake system   The use of improper fluids can damage  the brake system and affect the vehi   cle s stopping ability     e Clean the filler cap before removing        Brake fluid is poisonous and should be  stored carefully in marked containers  out of reach of children     A CAUTION    Do not spill the fluid on any painted sur   faces  This will damage the paint  If fluid is  spilled  immediately wash the surface  with water     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 13    WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID                LDI0558             WDI0664       BRAKE FLUID    Check the brake fluid level in the reservoir  If the  fluid level is below the MIN line or the brake  warning light comes on  add Genuine NISSAN  Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT  3 fluid up to the MAX line  If fluid must be added  frequently  the system should be checked by a  NISSAN dealer     8 14 Maintenance and do it yourself    WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID  RESERVOIR    Fill the windshield washer fluid reservoir perio
152. N    Always carry the mechanical key installed  in the Intelligent Key slot     See    Doors    in this section and    Storage    in the   Instruments and controls  section of this manual     Valet hand off    When you have to leave a key with a valet  give  them the Intelligent Key itself and keep the me   chanical key with you to protect your belongings     To prevent the glove box and the trunk from being  opened during valet hand off  follow the proce   dures below     1  Push the trunk cancel switch to the OFF  position     2  Remove the mechanical key from the Intelli   gent Key     3  Lock the glove box and the trunk pass   through with the mechanical key     4  Hand the Intelligent Key to the valet and  keep the mechanical key with you     See  Trunk lid  in this section   Storage  in the   Instruments and controls  section and  Seats  in  the  Safety     seats  seat belts and supplemental  restraint system  section of this manual     NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER  SYSTEM KEYS    You can only drive your vehicle using the master  keys which are registered to the NISSAN Vehicle  Immobilizer System components in your vehicle   These keys have a transponder chip in the key  head     The master key can be used for all the locks     To protect belongings when you leave a key with  someone  give them the Intelligent Key only  not  the mechanical key     Never leave these keys in the vehicle   Additional or replacement keys     If you still have a key  the key number is not  nec
153. N HR aoe 7 4  Tire GhESSINGS eesi ossi dese ee hoe gna DER nus 7 4    Cleaning interior              00 2  a iri eee eee ee 7 4    Air freSh6netss isses e eave sav Rare dde hen 7 5   Flo  r Mats   nc  ceadiscerd idan ee eben ines 7 5   Seat belts    crnsateassigseteecebecalnee enna 7 6  Corrosion protection             00    cece eee eee ee 7 6   Most common factors contributing to vehicle   COMO SION Scu Eres e Ratt oe GARE BU Ru ecc LEM OMM ERN E 7 6   Environmental factors influence the rate of   COMOSION 1o sete RC s NC do Se Raps 7 6   To protect your vehicle from corrosion              7 6       CLEANING EXTERIOR    In order to maintain the appearance of your ve   hicle  it is important to take proper care of it     To protect the paint surfaces  please wash your  vehicle as soon as you can         after a rainfall to prevent possible damage  from acid rain         after driving on coastal roads         when contaminants such as soot  bird drop   pings  tree sap  metal particles or bugs get  on the paint surface         when dust or mud builds up on the surface     Whenever possible  store or park your vehicle  inside a garage or in a covered area     When it is necessary to park outside  park in a  shady area or protect the vehicle with a body  cover     Be careful not to scratch the paint surface  when putting on or removing the body  cover     WASHING    Wash dirt off with a wet sponge and plenty of  water  Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mild  soap  a special v
154. N SYSTEM  if so  equipped    Connecting iPod      A CAUTION      Depending on size and shape of the  iPod   and iPod   cable  the console lid  may not fully close  Do not force con   sole lid closed as this may damage the  iPod   and iPod   cable     e Do not force the iPod   cable into the  USB port  Inserting the iPod   cable  tilted or up side down into the port may  damage the iPod   cable and the port   Make sure that the iPod   cable is con   nected correctly into the USB port    Some iPod   cables come witha Y  mark as a guide  Make sure that the  mark is facing the correct direction be   fore inserting the iPod   cable      e Do not locate objects near the iPod    cable to prevent the objects from lean   ing on the iPod   cable and the port   Pressure from the objects may damage  the iPod   cable and the port     To connect an iPod   to the vehicle so that the  iPod   can be controlled with the audio system  controls and display screen  use the USB jack  located in the center console  Connect the  iPod   specific end of the cable to the iPod    and the USB end of the cable to the USB jack on  the vehicle  1   If your iPod   supports charging  via a USB connection  its battery will be charged  while connected to the vehicle with the ignition  Switch in the ACC or ON position     While connected to the vehicle  the iPod   can  only be operated by the vehicle audio controls     To disconnect the iPod   from the vehicle  re   move the USB end of the cable from the USB  ja
155. N position  the system will be  released     Vehicle security system activation    The vehicle security system will give the following  alarm         The headlights blink and the horn sounds  intermittently         The alarm automatically turns off after a pe   riod of time  However  the alarm reactivates if  the vehicle is tampered with again  The alarm  can be shut off by unlocking the driver s door  or trunk lid with the key  or by pressing  the   button on the Intelligent Key        The alarm is activated by         opening the door or trunk lid without using  the key or Intelligent Key  even if the door is  unlocked by releasing the door inside lock  switch      How to stop an activated alarm    The alarm stops only by unlocking the driver s  door or the trunk lid with the key  pressing  the M   button on the Intelligent Key  or press   ing the request switch on the driver s or passen   ger s door with the Intelligent Key in range of the  door handle     NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER  SYSTEM    The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not  allow the engine to start without the use of a  registered key        If the engine fails to start using a registered key   for example  when interference is caused by  another registered key  an automated toll road  device or automatic payment device on the key  ring   restart the engine using the following pro   cedures     1  Leave the ignition switch placed in the ON  position for approximately 5 seconds     2  Place the ignition sw
156. NG    e Objects viewed in the outside mirror on  the passenger side are closer than they  appear  Be careful when moving to the  right  Using only this mirror could cause  an accident  Use the inside mirror or  glance over your shoulder to properly  judge distances to other objects        Do not adjust the mirrors while driving   You could lose control of your vehicle  and cause an accident     Automatic anti glare outside mirror   Driver s side only   if so equipped     The driver s outside mirror will automatically dim  during nighttime conditions to reduce the glare  from the headlights of trailing vehicles  The auto   matic anti glare feature operates only when the  ignition switch is placed in the ON position     The automatic anti glare feature will be on when  starting the vehicle  The indicator light on the  automatic anti glare rearview mirror will illuminate  when the automatic anti glare feature is on     To turn off the automatic anti glare feature  press       the O button on rearview mirror without  compass  Type B    e the    button on rearview mirror with  compass  Type C    The indicator light will turn off     To turn on the automatic anti glare feature again   press         the   button on rearview mirror without  compass  Type B      e the    button on rearview mirror  equipped with compass  Type C      The indicator light will turn on     For information on the automatic anti glare rear   view mirror  see    Automatic anti glare rearview  mirror    in thi
157. O   Displays the operation keys for the specific  DVD menu         Select the directional keys to move the  cursor on the DVD menu         Select the  Enter  key to fix the selected  menu item         Select the  Move  key to move the loca   tion of the operation keys on the screen         Select the  Back  key to return to the  previous menu screen         Select the  Hide  key to hide the opera   tion keys     Title Menu  DVD VIDEO    Some menus specific to each disc will be  shown  For details  see the instructions at   tached to the disc     Title Search  DVD VIDEO  DVD VR    The scene with the specified title will be  displayed the number of times the         or      side is selected     Group Search  VIDEO CD    The scene with the specified group will be  displayed the number of times the         or      side is selected     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 85    10 Key Search  DVD VIDEO  VIDEO CD   CD DA  DVD VR    Select the    10 Key Search    key to open the  number entry screen  Input the number you  want to search for and select the    OK    key   The specified Title Chapter or Group Track  will be played     Select No   VIDEO CD    Select the  Select No   key to open the  number entry screen  Input the number you  want to search for and select the  OK  key   The specified scene will be played     Angle  DVD VIDEO    If the DVD contains different angles  such as  moving images   the current image angle  can be switched to another one 
158. PMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the  system is not operating properly  The TPMS mal   function indicator is combined with the low tire  pressure telltale  When the system detects a  malfunction  the telltale will flash for approxi   mately one minute and then remain continuously  illuminated  This sequence will continue upon  subsequent vehicle start ups as long as the mal   function exists  When the malfunction indicator is  illuminated  the system may not be able to detect  or signal low tire pressure as intended  TPMS  malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons   including the installation of replacement or alter   nate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent  the TPMS from functioning properly  Always  check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replac   ing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and  wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function    properly     Starting and driving 5 3    Additional information     The TPMS does not monitor the tire  pressure of the spare tire     The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle  is driven at speeds above 16 MPH   25 km h   Also  this system may not detect a  sudden drop in tire pressure  for example a  flat tire while driving      The low tire pressure warning light does not  automatically turn off when the tire pressure  is adjusted  After all 4 tires are inflated to the  recommended pressure  the vehicle must be  driven at speeds above 16 MPH  25 km
159. Rating shown  on the trailer and is not more than the calculated  available maximum towing capacity     Also weigh the front and rear axles on the scale to  make sure the Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear  Gross Axle Weight are not more than Front  Gross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight  on the F M V S S  C M V S S  certification label   The cargo in the trailer and vehicle may need to  be moved or removed to meet the specified rat   ings   Example        Gross Vehicle Weight  GVW  as weighed    on a scale   including passengers  cargo and  hitch   4 446 Ib   2016 kg          Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  GVWR  from  F M V S S  C M V S S  certification label    4 546 Ib   2062 kg        Maximum Towing Load from    Towing  Load Specification  chart   1 000 lb    454 kg      4 546 lb   2062 kg  GVWR        4 446 lb   2016 kg  GVW      100 Ib   45 kg  Available for tongue    weight    1 000 Ib   454 kg  Capacity available for    towing    100 Ib   45 kg  Available tongue weight      1 000 Ib   454 kg  Available capacity    10   tongue weight    The available towing capacity may be less than  the maximum towing capacity due to the passen   ger and cargo load in the vehicle     Remember to keep trailer tongue weight be   tween 10   15  of the trailer weight or within the  trailer tongue load specification recommended  by the trailer manufacturer  If the tongue load  becomes excessive  rearrange the cargo to ob   tain the proper tongue load  Do not exceed the  maximum tongue we
160. S   CERTIFICATION LABEL    The Federal Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  Standard  F M V S S  C M V S S   certification la   bel is affixed as shown  This label contains valu   able vehicle information  such as  Gross Vehicle  Weight Ratings  GVWR   Gross Axle Weight  Rating  GAWR   month and year of manufacture   Vehicle Identification Number  VIN   etc  Review  it carefully     EMISSION CONTROL  INFORMATION LABEL    The emission control information label is at   tached to the underside of the hood as shown     INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE                         WT10174                  gt              pr VOS       WTIO0167             LTI2012       TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION  LABEL    The cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire and  Loading Information label  The label is located as  shown     AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION  LABEL    The air conditioner specification label is affixed to  the underside of the hood as shown     To mount the front license plate  attach the li   cense plate bracket to the plastic finisher at the    location marks  small dimples  using the two  6 mm screws provided     Technical and consumer information 9 11       VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION    AWARNING    e It is extremely dangerous to ride  in a cargo area inside a vehicle  In  a collision  people riding in these  areas are more likely to be seri   ously injured or killed     e Do not allow people to ride in any  area of your vehicle that is not  equipped with seats and seat  belts     e Be s
161. SION        Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep the  vehicle clean         Always check for minor damage to the paint  and repair it as soon as possible         Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doors  open to avoid water accumulation         Check the underbody for accumulation of  sand  dirt or salt  If present  wash with water  as soon as possible     A CAUTION    e NEVER remove dirt  sand or other de   bris from the passenger compartment  by washing it out with a hose  Remove  dirt with a vacuum cleaner or broom       Never allow water or other liquids to  come in contact with electronic compo   nents inside the vehicle as this may  damage them     Chemicals used for road surface de icing are  extremely corrosive  They accelerate corrosion  and deterioration of underbody components  such as the exhaust system  fuel and brake lines   brake cables  floor pan and fenders     In winter  the underbody must be cleaned  periodically     For additional protection against rust and corro   sion  which may be required in some areas  con   sult a NISSAN dealer              LAI2001          License plate bracket padding  1  License plate  2  Trunk  3  License plate frame  4  Padding    A CAUTION    A license plate frame could vibrate and  cause noise or paint damage  To avoid  damage or noise  add a soft adhesive pad  with a maximum thickness of 1 8 in   4 mm  to the back lower edge of the  license plate frame     Appearance and care 7 7    MEMO    7 8 Appearance and care    8
162. Some devices and transmitters may temporarily  interfere with the operation of the TPMS and cause  the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate     Some examples are         Facilities or electric devices using similar radio  frequencies are near the vehicle         If a transmitter set to similar frequencies is  being used in or near the vehicle       If a computer  or similar equipment  or a  DC AC converter is being used in or near the  vehicle     FCC Notice   For USA     This device complies with Part 15 of the  FCC Rules  Operation is subject to the fol   lowing two conditions   1  This device may  not cause harmful interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference re   ceived  including interference that may  cause undesired operation     NOTE     Changes or modification not expressly ap   proved by the party responsible for compli   ance could void the user s authority to op   erate the equipment     For Canada     This device complies with RSS 210 of In   dustry Canada  Operation is subject to the  following two conditions   1  This device  may not cause interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference  in   clude interference that may cause unde   sired operation of the device     AVOIDING COLLISION AND  ROLLOVER    A WARNING    Failure to operate this vehicle in a safe  and prudent manner may result in loss of  control or an accident     Be alert and drive defensively at all times  Obey all  traffic regulations  Avoid excessive spe
163. TETHER STRAP    First  secure the child restraint with the LATCH  lower anchors  rear outboard seat positions only   or the seat belt  as applicable     1  Flip up the anchor cover  1  from the anchor  point which is located directly behind the  child seat     2  Position the top tether strap over the top of  the head rest     3  Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor  point on the rear parcel shelf     4  Refer to the appropriate child restraint in   stallation procedure steps in this section  before tightening the tether strap     If you have any questions when installing a  top tether strap  consult your NISSAN  dealer for details     BOOSTER SEATS    Precautions on booster seats    A WARNING    If a booster seat and seat belt are not used  properly  the risk of a child being injured  in a sudden stop or collision greatly  increases       Make sure the shoulder portion of  the belt is away from the child s face  and neck and the lap portion of the  belt does not cross the stomach       Make sure the shoulder belt is not  behind the child or under the child s  arm         A booster seat must only be installed  in a seating position that has a  lap shoulder belt     1 34 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system             LRS0455                   LRS0453             LRS0464       Booster seats of various sizes are offered by  several manufacturers  When selecting any  booster seat  keep the following points in mind         Choose only a booster se
164. The air bag module and preten   sioner should be replaced by a NISSAN  dealer  The air bag module and preten   sioner cannot be repaired     1 52 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system       The front air bag  side air bag  curtain  air bag systems and the pretensioner  system should be inspected by a  NISSAN dealer if there is any damage to  the front end or side portion of the  vehicle       If you need to dispose of the supple   mental air bag or pretensioner systems  or scrap the vehicle  contact a NISSAN  dealer  Incorrect disposal procedures  could cause personal injury     MEMO    Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 53    2 Instruments and controls    Instrument panel  erre Rem  2 2  Meters and gauges    cesses isses 2 8  Speedometer and odometer              iussisse  2 4  Tachometer   osos reikdbrea n a ent aes 2 5  Engine coolant temperature gauge                 2 5  Fuelgauge     oidevbberpREPRLRICR e S teed 2 6  Compass display  if so equipped               sisse 2 6  Compass display             sessssseleee esee 2 7  Warning indicator lights and audible reminders        2 10  Checking bulbs    me ore thea 2 10  Warning lights    sso eh eberexe Dens 2 10  Indicator lights    i szise rer nier RES eee 2 14  Audible reminders               elles 2 16  Vehicle information display              sssseesese 2 17  How to use the vehicle information display         2 17  Security SySIems   xs vere reris eH Bede iR ees 2 26  
165. The daytime running  lights operate with the headlight switch in the  OFF position or in the  P4  position  Turn the    headlight switch to the 2 position for full  illumination when driving at night     If the parking brake is applied before the engine is  started  the daytime running lights do not illumi   nate  The daytime running lights illuminate when  the parking brake is released  The daytime run   ning lights will remain on until the ignition switch  is placed in the OFF position     AWARNING    When the daytime running light system is  active  tail lights on your vehicle are not  on  It is necessary at dusk to turn on your  headlights  Failure to do so could cause  an accident injuring yourself and others           WIC1412             INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS  CONTROL    The instrument cluster illuminates when the igni   tion switch is in the ON position     The instrument brightness control operates when  the headlight control switch is in the  AUTO  2 PG  or 22  Turn the control left or right to adjust the bright     ness of the instrument panel lights when driving  at night     position     The instrument brightness control will not adjust  the brightness when the headlights or parking  lights are off     Instruments and controls 2 33    HORN          WIC1439          WIC1440                LIC1389       TURN SIGNAL SWITCH  Turn signal       Move the lever up or down to signal the  turning direction  When the turn is com   pleted  the turn signal cancels automaticall
166. This  Maintenance and do it yourself  section  gives instructions regarding only those items  which are relatively easy for an owner to perform     You should be aware that incomplete or improper  servicing may result in operating difficulties or  excessive emissions  and could affect warranty  coverage  If in doubt about any servicing   have it done by a NISSAN dealer     8 6 Maintenance and do it yourself    ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK  LOCATIONS          12          11             q  ja p  MY  Eid    4  7             CO7                                 10    9    8          WDIO662          1  Power steering fluid reservoir  2  Engine oil filler cap   3  Brake fluid reservoir   4  Air cleaner   5  Fuse block  Fusible links   6  Battery   7   Fusible links   8  Engine oil dipstick   9  Radiator cap   10  Drive belt location   11  Engine coolant reservoir   12  Windshield washer fluid reservoir  NOTE     Side covers removed for clarity     ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM                                                          LDI0734       To remove the engine compartment covers  un   hook the clips    located as illustrated     To remove the engine cover  pull the cover up   ward first  1  and then toward the front of the  vehicle        The engine cooling system is filled at the factory  with a pre diluted mixture of 50  Genuine  NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze Coolant  blue  and  50  water to provide year round anti freeze and  coolant protection  The antifreeze solution con   tains rust
167. Vehicle security system              lese esses 2 26  NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system               2 27  Windshield wiper and washer switch                 2 28  Switch operation                0s cee eee eee eee 2 28  Rear window and outside mirror  if so equipped   defroster switch    cen RR 2 29    Headlight and turn signal switch                issue  2 30    Xenon headlights  if so equipped                  2 30  Headlight control switch                 e eee ee 2 31  Daytime running light system  Canada only         2 33  Instrument brightness control              0  008 2 33  Turn signal SWIC o   2 crim eee 2 34  Fog light switch  if so equipped                   2 34  FIONN scree Hoek Rasdign sealants bee maaan curs amie wine 2 34  Heated seats  if so equipped             cece eee ee 2 35  Climate control seat switch  if so equipped            2 36  Heated steering wheel  if so equipped                2 37  Vehicle Dynamic Control  VDC  off switch            2 37  Power outlet ecis rere heo e maid ares Selden wish 2 38  SLOMAGS iiec bbe Dubois Reus ade Ge ak aad 2 38  Map pockets    ERR mega ea 2 38  Seatback pockets                  0 0c eee eee 2 39  Sunglasses holder                 00 e eee eae 2 39  Cup holders  2er I oe ma e E stp see 2 40  GIOVE  OX css ar eter ets wie gea epu ehe eta 2 41  CONSOLE DOK xsd iioi acere dr doas eda rupto rei 2 41  Grocery hooks    iie iee ge dentatis 2 42  Cargo net  if so equipped             ssssessss  2 42  WindOWS    eser k
168. XXX mp3  XXXXXXXX mp3                         XXXXXXXX mp3                LHA1261          LHA2031           Folder List    The folders on the disc are displayed  Select the  key of a folder name to begin playing tracks from  that folder         Track List    The tracks on the disc are displayed  Select the  key of a track name to begin playing that track     4A CD EJECT button              Whenthe   button is pressed with the com   pact disc loaded  the compact disc will be  ejected     When the  amp  button is pressed while the  compact disc is being played  the compact disc  will eject and the system will turn off     4 82 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    AUX  auxiliary  input jacks    The auxiliary input jacks are located inside the  center console  1   NTSC compatible devices  such as video games  camcorders and portable  video players can be connected to the auxiliary  input jacks  Audio devices  such as some MP3  players  can also be connected to the system  through the auxiliary input jacks     The auxiliary input jacks are color coded for iden   tification purposes         Red  right channel audio input    White     left channel audio input        Yellow     video input    Before connecting a device to the auxiliary input  jacks  turn off the power of the portable device     With a compatible device connected to the aux   iliary input jacks  press the DISC AUX button  repeatedly until the AUX mode appears in the  display  The output fro
169. abbrevia   tion or the appropriate percentage for  that region     Gasoline specifications    NISSAN recommends using gasoline that meets  the World Wide Fuel Charter  WWFC  specifi   cations where it is available  Many of the automo   bile manufacturers developed this specification  to improve emission control system and vehicle  performance  Ask your service station manager if  the gasoline meets the WWFC specifications     Reformulated gasoline    Some fuel suppliers are now producing reformu   lated gasolines  These gasolines are specially  designed to reduce vehicle emissions  NISSAN  supports efforts towards cleaner air and sug   gests that you use reformulated gasoline when  available     Gasoline containing oxygenates    Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxy   genates such as ethanol  MTBE and methanol  with or without advertising their presence   NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels of  which the oxygenate content and the fuel com     patibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily de   termined  If in doubt  ask your service station  manager     If you use oxygenate blend gasoline  please take  the following precautions as the usage of such  fuels may cause vehicle performance problems  and or fuel system damage         The fuel should be unleaded and have  an octane rating no lower than that  recommended for unleaded gasoline         If an oxygenate blend other than  methanol blend is used  it should con   tain no more than 10  oxygenate    MTBE may  
170. about the digital music  file such as song title  artist  album title   encoding bit rate  track time duration  etc   ID3 tag information is displayed on the  Album Artist Track title line on the display       Windows    Windows Media and Windows  Vista   are registered trademarks or trademarks  of Microsoft Corporation in the United States of  America and or other countries           Playback order     ROOT Music playback order of a CD  DVD or USB  device with compressed audio files is as illus   trated       The folder names of folders not containing  compressed audio files are not shown in the  display       f there is a file in the top level of the  disc USB     Root Folder    is displayed       The playback order is the order in which the  s files were written by the writing software  so       the files might not play in the desired order        J   FOLDER  IO    COMPRESSED    AUDIO FILES       WHA1374       Playback order chart    Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 59    Specification chart     Supported media CD  CD R  CD RW  DVD ROM  DVD R  DVD RW  DVD R DL  USB 2 0    CD  CD R  CD RW  DVD ROM  DVDER  DVD RW  DVD R DL  ISO9660 LEVEL1  ISO9660 LEVEL2  Romeo  Joliet     SO9660 Level 3  packet writing  is not supported     Files saved using the Live File System component  on a Windows Vista   operating system based computer  are not    Supported file systems supported   UDF Bridge  UDF 1 02   ISO9660   UDF 1 5  UDF 2 0    VDF 1 5 VDF 2 0  pack
171. act disc  CD  player        4 72  4 80   FM AM radio with compact disc    CD  changer             04  4 64    FM AM SAT radio with CD DVD player   4 76    FM AM SAT radio with compact disc  CD     player ck ee dhe nee narat iid 4 69  Audio System   iPod   Player               4 92  4 94  Audio system   Radio  32m shea ek Be pex 4 47  Audio System   Settings      ss asda ete ad 4 70  4 76    Audio system  Steering wheel audio control switch     4 102    USB interface              4 87  4 88  Autolight switch  sewa deee ta te dara 2 31  Automatic   Automatic drive positioner             3 28   Automatic power window switch       2 45   Automatic transmission position indicator    fo  r epp p 2 14   Transmission shift selector lock release   5 17  Automatic anti glare inside mirror            3 25  Automatic door locks           sss 3 6  AUX jack i    a ea ee 4 68   B  Battery    uus ac Hat Bo E Got ade ad 8 15   Charge warning light              2 11  Before starting the engine             5 11  Belt  See drive belt                 8 17  Block heater   Engine    s eee a aes uo ws 5 29  Bluetooth   audio              sss  4 98    Bluetooth   hands free phone    SYSTEM    dos aol e sodes ttu t d 4 104  4 118  Booster Seats acs suo rms 1 34  Brake  Anti lock Braking System  ABS           5 25  Brake fluid  ceco coraco creca  8 13  Brake light  See stop light              8 28  Brake system    sa cp rentea tin 5 24  Brake warninglight               2 11  Brake wear indicators      
172. ad  This  information is located on the Tire and  Loading Information label     Cargo capacity   permissible weight  of cargo  the subtracted weight of  occupants from the load limit     VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY    Do not exceed the load limit of your ve   hicle shown as    The combined weight of  occupants and cargo    on the Tire and  Loading Information label  Do not exceed  the number of occupants shown as     Seating Capacity    on the Tire and Load   ing Information label     To get    the combined weight of occu   pants and cargo     add the weight of all  occupants  then add the total luggage  weight  Examples are shown in the follow   ing illustration     Technical and consumer information 9 13       Load limit  1 400 Ib     640 kg     Load limit  1 400 Ib   640 kg                 Occupants Luggage    RR CA      150 Ib x 2   300 Iib 30 Ib x 2   60 ib   70 kg   135 kg   14 kg     Occupants    RR      150 Ib x 2   300 Ib    Trailer Tongue    Weight  EE    300 Ib     27 kg   135 kg     Luggage    mm    30 Ib x 2   60 Ib    Remaining available  cargo and luggage  load capacity     740 Ib    336 kg     Remaining available  cargo and luggage  load capacity            9 14 Technical and consumer information    1 040 Ib   70 kg   135 kg   14 kg   27 kg   472 kg   Occupants Luggage  Load limit Remaining available   640 kg  load capacity    150 Ib x 5   750 Ib 30 Ib x 5   150 Ib 500 Ib   70 kg   340 kg   14 kg   70 kg   227 kg   LTIO152  Example    Steps for determining correct l
173. ag status  light will take a few seconds to register a change  in the passenger seat status  For example  if a  large adult who is sitting in the front passenger  seat exits the vehicle  the passenger air bag  status light will go from OFF to ON for a few  seconds and then to OFF  This is normal system  operation and does not indicate a malfunction     If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air  bag system  the supplemental air bag warning  light Tf located in the meter and gauges area    Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 47    on the driver   s side of the instrument panel  will  blink  Have the system checked by a NISSAN  dealer     Other supplemental front impact air bag  precautions    AWARNING      Do not place any objects on the steer   ing wheel pad or on the instrument  panel  Also  do not place any objects  between any occupant and the steering  wheel or instrument panel  Such ob   jects may become dangerous projec   tiles and cause injury if the front air  bags inflate       e Immediately after inflation  several  front air bag system components will be  hot  Do not touch them  you may se   verely burn yourself         No unauthorized changes should be  made to any components or wiring of  the supplemental air bag system  This is  to prevent accidental inflation of the  supplemental air bag or damage to the  supplemental air bag system         Do not make unauthorized changes to  your vehicle s electrical system  sus   pension sy
174. ake  sure it locks into place     AWARNING    e Make sure the hood is completely    closed and latched before driving  Fail   ure to do so could cause the hood to fly  open and result in an accident         If you see steam or smoke coming from    the engine compartment  to avoid injury  do not open the hood     TRUNK LID    A  WARNING      Do not drive with the trunk lid open  This    could allow dangerous exhaust gases  to be drawn into the vehicle  See  Ex   haust gas    in the    Starting and driving   section of this manual     Closely supervise children when they  are around cars to prevent them from  playing and becoming locked in the  trunk where they could be seriously in   jured  Keep the car locked  with the rear  seatback and trunk lid securely latched  when not in use  and prevent children s  access to car keys     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 17                              LPD0394             OPENER OPERATION    A WARNING      Do notdrive with the trunk lid open  This  could allow dangerous exhaust gases  to be drawn into the vehicle  See  Ex   haust gas    in the    Starting and driving   section of this manual     3 18 Pre driving checks and adjustments        Closely supervise children when they  are around cars to prevent them from  playing and becoming locked in the  trunk where they could be seriously in   jured  Keep the car locked  with the rear  seatback and trunk lid securely latched  when not in use  and prevent children   s  access to car ke
175. al  The child restraint will not  be secured properly if the lower an   chors are obstructed        WRSO700  LATCH lower anchor location  LATCH lower anchor location          The LATCH lower anchors are located at the rear  of the seat cushion near the seatback  A label is  attached to the seatback to help you locate the  LATCH lower anchors        LRS0661          LATCH webbing mounted attachment    Installing child restraint LATCH lower  anchor attachments    LATCH compatible child restraints include two  rigid or webbing mounted attachments that can  be connected to two anchors located at certain  seating positions in your vehicle  With this sys   tem  you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to  secure the child restraint  Check your child re   straint for a label stating that it is compatible with  LATCH  This information may also be in the in   structions provided by the child restraint manu   facturer           LRS0662       LATCH rigid mounted attachment  When installing a child restraint  carefully read  and follow the instructions in this manual and  those supplied with the child restraint     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 23                LRS0243       Top tether anchor point locations    The child restraint top tether strap must be used  when installing the child restraint with the LATCH  lower anchor attachments or seat belts  See  In   stalling top tether strap  later in this section     If you have any questions when installi
176. al controls are initially activated     To browse the menu options  tilt the tuning        switch up or down  The system will  always speak the current menu option  De   pending on the audio display  it will also  show the current menu option     To select the current menu option  press the  PHONE SEND   amp    button     To go back to the previous menu  press the  PHONE END        button  If the current  menu is the Main Menu  pressing the    PHONE END       h   button will exit the  Phone system     To exit the manual control mode  press and    hold the PHONE END  4 h   button for  5 seconds     TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE    The system should respond correctly to all voice  commands without difficulty  If problems are en   countered  try the following solutions     Where the solutions are listed by number  try  each solution in turn  starting with number 1  until  the problem is resolved     Symptom    System fails to interpret the command correctly     The system consistently selects the wrong entry from the  phone book     1  Ensure that the command is valid  See  List of voice commands  in this section     4  Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive  for example  windows open or defroster on   NOTE  If it is too  noisy to use the phone  it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized     5  If more than one command was said at a time  try saying the commands separately     6  If the system consistently fails to recognize commands  the voice training pr
177. al restraint system  section of this manual     AA WARNING    Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in the  retractor  NEVER use bleach  dye or  chemical solvents to clean the seat belts   since these materials may severely  weaken the seat belt webbing     7 6 Appearance and care    CORROSION PROTECTION    MOST COMMON FACTORS  CONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLE  CORROSION        The accumulation of moisture retaining dirt  and debris in body panel sections  cavities   and other areas         Damage to paint and other protective coat   ings caused by gravel and stone chips or  minor traffic accidents     ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS  INFLUENCE THE RATE OF  CORROSION    Moisture    Accumulation of sand  dirt and water on the ve   hicle body underside can accelerate corrosion   Wet floor coverings will not dry completely inside  the vehicle and should be removed for drying to  avoid floor panel corrosion     Relative humidity    Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high  relative humidity  especially those areas where  the temperatures stay above freezing and where  atmospheric pollution exists and road salt is  used     Temperature    High temperatures accelerate the rate of corro   sion to those parts which are not well ventilated     Air pollution    Industrial pollution  the presence of salt in the air  in coastal areas  or heavy road salt use acceler   ates the corrosion process  Road salt also accel   erates the disintegration of paint surfaces     TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE  FROM CORRO
178. aler     For further details  see  Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations  in this section   For further details  see  Engine Oil  in the  Maintenance and do it yourself  section of this manual      6    by    8  DEXRON    VI type ATF may also be used    9 2 Technical and consumer information    FUEL RECOMMENDATION    NISSAN recommends the use of unleaded pre   mium gasoline with an octane rating of at least  91 AKI  Anti Knock Index  number  Research  octane number 96   If unleaded premium gaso   line is not available  you may use unleaded regular  gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI  number  Research octane number 91   but you  may notice a decrease in performance     A CAUTION    e Using a fuel other than that specified  could adversely affect the emission  control system  and may also affect the  warranty coverage         Under no circumstances should a  leaded gasoline be used  because this  will damage the three way catalyst     e Do not use E 15 or E 85 fuel in your  vehicle  Your vehicle is not designed to  run on E 15 or E 85 fuel  Using E 15 or  E 85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically  designed for E 15 or E 85 fuel can ad   versely affect the emission control de   vices and systems of the vehicle  Dam   age caused by such fuel is not covered  by the NISSAN new vehicle limited  warranty     e U S  government regulations require  ethanol dispensing pumps to be identi   fied by a small  square  orange and  black label with the common 
179. an improve the recognition of phone num   bers by saying the phone number in three groups  of numbers  For example  when you try to call  800 662 6200  say  eight zero zero  first  and  the system will then ask you for the next three  digits  Then  say  six six two   After recognition   the system will then ask for the last four digits   Say   six two zero zero   Using this method of  phone digit entry can improve recognition perfor   mance     NOTE     When speaking a house number  speak the  number    0    as    zero    or    oh     If the letter   O  is included in the house number  it will  not be recognized as    0    even if you speak     oh    instead of    zero        Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 135    Standard Mode command list    Category Command     COMMAND ACTION  Displays Phone function commands   Displays Navigation function commands     Displays Vehicle Information   Displays Audio commands  Displays User Guide    Phone Command     Navigation Command     COMMAND ACTION  Sets a route to your home that is stored in the Address Book   Searches for a location by the street address specified  and sets a route  for continental US and Canada only            Sets a route to a facility near the current vehicle location   Address Book Searches for a location stored in the Address Book   Previous Destinations Sets a route to a previous destination        4 136 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Vehicle Inform
180. aning is necessary  use a  small amount of neutral detergent with a soft  cloth  Never spray the screen with water or de   tergent  Dampen the cloth first  and then wipe the  Screen                                                                          1 2 3  a  gt  Comfort 8 00 Saar    Auto interior tumination eon  Vx   Light Sensitivity  J to  DIO   Light Off Delay        4 45 sec  gt  gt       Speed Sensing Wiper Interval     ON         Selective Door Unlock     ON Je                            Cabin lighting when unlocking doors  I          LHA1229    HOW TO SELECT MENUS ON THE  SCREEN    Vehicle functions are viewed on the center dis   play screen in menus  Whenever a menu selec   tion is made or menu item is highlighted  different  areas on the screen provide you with important  information  See the following for details     1  Header   Shows the path used to get to the current  screen  for example  press the SETTING  button  gt  then select the  Comfort  key         Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 19    2  Menu Selections   Shows the options to choose within that  menu screen  for example  Auto Interior Illu   mination  etc       3  Up Down Movement Indicator   Shows that the NISSAN controller may be  used to move up or down on the screen and  select more options     4  Screen Count   Shows the number of menu selections avail   able for the current menu  even if they are on  multiple pages  for example  1 9      5  Footer Information Li
181. any loose wheel nuts  Tighten if  necessary     Tire rotation  Tires should be rotated every  7 500 miles  12 000 km      Tires  Check the pressure with a gauge often  and always prior to long distance trips  If neces   sary  adjust the pressure in all tires  including the  spare  to the pressure specified  Check carefully  for damage  cuts or excessive wear     Tire Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS   transmitter components Replace the TPMS  transmitter grommet seal  valve core and cap  when the tires are replaced due to wear or age     Wheel alignment and balance If the vehicle  should pull to either side while driving on a  straight and level road  or if you detect uneven or  abnormal tire wear  there may be a need for wheel    alignment  If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at  normal highway speeds  wheel balancing may be  needed       For additional information regarding tires   refer to    Important Tire Safety Information      US  or    Tire Safety Information     Canada  in  the Warranty Information Booklet     Windshield Clean the windshield on a regular  basis  Check the windshield at least every six  months for cracks or other damage  Have a dam   aged windshield repaired by a qualified repair  facility     Windshield wiper blades  Check for cracks or  wear if they do not wipe properly     Inside the vehicle    The maintenance items listed here should be  checked on a regular basis  such as when per   forming periodic maintenance  cleaning the ve   hicle  etc    
182. ar as shown   the ground  It may cause the vehicle to correct placement and jack up points for your Also fit the groove of the jack head between  move  specific vehicle model and jack type  the notches as shown   Carefully read the caution label attached to The jack should be used on firm and  the jack body and the following instruc  level ground   tions  3  Toliftthe vehicle  securely hold the jack lever    and rod with both hands  Carefully raise the  vehicle until the tire clears the ground  Re   move the wheel nuts  and then remove the  tire     1  Loosen each wheel nut one or two turns by  turning counterclockwise with the wheel nut  wrench  Do not remove the wheel nuts  until the tire is off the ground     2  Place the jack directly under the jack up  point as illustrated so the top of the jack  contacts the vehicle at the jack up point   Align the jack head between the two    6 6 In case of emergency                SCE0661       Installing the spare tire    The spare tire is designed for emergency  use  See specific instructions under the  heading    Wheels and tires    in the    Mainte   nance and do it yourself    section of this  manual     1  Clean any mud or dirt from the surface be   tween the wheel and hub     2  Carefully put the spare tire on and tighten  the wheel nuts finger tight     3  With the wheel nut wrench  tighten wheel  nuts alternately and evenly as illustrated until  they are tight     4  Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire  touches the ground
183. are and hardware combination might not match  or the writing speed  writing depth  writing width  etc   might not match the  specifications  Try using the slowest writing speed     Skipping with high bit rate Skipping may occur with large quantities of data  such as for high bit rate data    files   Moves immediately to the If an unsupported compressed audio file has been given a supported extension like   MP3   or when play is prohibited by copyright protection  the  next song when playing player will skip to the next song     Songs do not play back in The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software  Therefore  the files might not play in the desired order   the desired order Random Shuffle may be active on the audio system or on the USB device     Music cuts off or skips       Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 57    CD  DVD or USB with Compressed  Audio Files  models with Navigation  System     The file types supported by this system are MP3   WMA  AAC MAA and ATRAC3     Explanation of terms         MP3     MP3 is short for Moving Pictures  Experts Group Audio Layer 3  MP3 is the  most well known compressed digital audio  file format  This format allows for near    CD  quality    sound  but at a fraction of the size of  normal audio files  MP3 conversion of an  audio track can reduce the file size by ap   proximately 10 1 ratio  Sampling  44 1 kHz   Bit rate  128 kbps  with virtually no percep   tible loss
184. arily will not    inflate in the event of a side impact  rear  impact  rollover  or lower severity fron   tal collision  Always wear your seat  belts to help reduce the risk or severity  of injury in various kinds of accidents         The front passenger air bag will not    inflate if the passenger air bag status  light is lit or if the front passenger seat  is unoccupied  See    Front passenger air  bag and status light  later in this  section     1 38 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system        The seat belts and the front air bags are  most effective when you are sitting well  back and upright in the seat  The front  air bags inflate with great force  Even  with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag Sys   tem  if you are unrestrained  leaning  forward  sitting sideways or out of posi   tion in any way  you are at greater risk of  injury or death in a crash  You may also  receive serious or fatal injuries from the  front air bag if you are up against it  when it inflates  Always sit back against  the seatback and as far away as practi   cal from the steering wheel or instru   ment panel  Always use the seat belts              The driver and front passenger seat belt  buckles are equipped with sensors that  detect if the seat belts are fastened  The  Advanced Air Bag System monitors the  severity of a collision and seat belt us   age then inflates the air bags as  needed  Failure to properly wear seat  belts can increase the risk or severity of  injury in an ac
185. as follows     AM     FM1     FM2     AM    When the FM AM button is pressed while the  ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position  the  radio will come on at the station last played     The last station played will also come on when  the VOL ON OFF control knob is pressed ON     If    compact disc is playing when the FM AM  button is pressed  the compact disc will auto   matically be turned off and the last radio station  played will come on     The FM stereo indicator STEREO will illuminate  during FM stereo reception  When the stereo    broadcast signal is weak  the radio will automati   cally change from stereo to monaural reception     SAT band select     Pressing the SAT button will change the band as  follows     XM1      XM2      XM3      XM1  satellite  if so  equipped     When the SAT button is pressed while the igni   tion switch is in the ACC or ON position  the  radio will come on at the station last played     The last station played will also come on when  the VOL ON OFF control knob is pressed ON      When the SAT button is pressed  the satellite  radio reception will not be available unless an  optional satellite receiver and antenna are in   stalled and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio service  subscription is active  Satellite radio is not avail   able in Alaska  Hawaii and Guam     If a compact disc is playing when the SAT button  is pressed  the compact disc will automatically be  turned off and the last radio station played will  come on     TUNE FOLDER  Tun
186. ase perform the  following procedures         Turn the steering wheel from lock to  lock while the engine is running         Drive the vehicle on a straight road  for more than 5 minutes       When the steering wheel is turned with  the ignition switch in the ACC position   the predicted course lines may be dis   played incorrectly     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 35      The distance guide line and the vehicle  width line should be used as a refer   ence only when the vehicle is on a level  paved surface  The distance viewed on  the monitor is for reference only and  may be different than the actual dis   tance between the vehicle and dis   played objects       When backing up the vehicle up a hill   objects viewed in the monitor are fur   ther than they appear  When backing up  the vehicle down a hill  objects viewed  in the monitor are closer than they ap   pear  Use the inside mirror or glance  over your shoulder to properly judge  distances to other objects     The vehicle width and predicted course  lines are wider than the actual width and  course                 LHA1197          LHA1198       1  Visually check that the parking space is safe  before parking your vehicle     2  The rear view of the vehicle is displayed on  the screen when the shift selector is  moved to the R  Reverse  position     4 36 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    3  Slowly back up the vehicle adjusting the  steering wheel so that the
187. at with a label  certifying that it complies with Federal Motor  Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian  Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213         Check the booster seat in your vehicle to be  sure it is compatible with the vehicle s seat  and seat belt system       Make sure the child s head will be properly  supported by the booster seat or vehicle  seat  The seatback must be at or above the  center of the child s ears  For example  if a  low back booster seat  1  is chosen  the  vehicle seatback must be at or above the  center of the child s ears  If the seatback is  lower than the center of the child s ears  a  high back booster seat  2  should be used          f the booster seat is compatible with your  vehicle  place the child in the booster seat  and check the various adjustments to be  sure the booster seat is compatible with the  child  Always follow all recommended pro   cedures     All U S  states and Canadian provinces or  territories require that infants and small  children be restrained in an approved child  restraint at all times while the vehicle is  being operated     The instructions in this section apply to booster  seat installation in the rear seats or the front  passenger seat     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 35    Booster seat installation    A CAUTION    Do not use the lap shoulder belt in the  Automatic Locking Retractor mode when  using a booster seat with the seat belts     Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the
188. atellite Radio  Select a category  to select the first channel for that category         Direct Tune   Tune to a channel by entering  the channel number     Radio data system  RDS      RDS stands for Radio Data System  and is a data  information service transmitted by some radio  stations on the FM band  not AM band   Cur   rently  most RDS stations are in large cities  but  many stations are now considering broadcasting  RDS deta     RDS can display       Station call sign  such as  WHFR 98 3        Station name  such as  The Groove        Music or programming type such as  Clas   sical      Country   or  Rock          Station specific text     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 79    If the station broadcasts RDS information  the  text information is automatically displayed     Compact disc  CD  player operation    Place the ignition in the ACC or ON position and  insert the compact disc into the slot with the label  side facing up  The compact disc will be guided  automatically into the slot and start playing     If the radio is already operating  it will automati   cally turn off and the compact disc will play     If the system has been turned off while the com   pact disc was playing  pressing the  VOL ON OFF control knob will start the compact  disc     DISC AUX button     When the DISC AUX button is pressed with the  system off and the compact disc loaded  the  system will turn on and the compact disc will start  to play    When the DISC AUX
189. ation Command     COMMAND ACTION  Fuel Economy Displays Fuel Economy information     Displays Maintenance information   Traffic Info  Turns the traffic information system on and off   Where am    Displays current vehicle location     Audio Command     COMMAND ACTION    Changes the audio system mode to AM radio   Changes the audio system mode to FM radio   Changes the audio system mode to satellite radio     Changes the audio system mode to CD           Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 137    Voice command examples    Some basic voice command examples are de   scribed here     For navigation system commands  see the sepa   rate Navigation System Owner s Manual           n    Y             WHA1332       8 00    Voice Recognition     Sw                                         49 Phone J    39 Navigation J     4 Information J Practice     4 Audio J    4 Help J       To exit  hold the TALK switch          LHA1333       Example 1     Placing a call to the phone  number 800 662 6200     1  Pressthe    amp   ing wheel     switch located on the steer     4 138 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems      The system announces   Would you like to    access Phone  Navigation  Information  Au   dio or Help        Say  Phone            Voice Recognition  gt Phone Yall 8 00            4 Dial Number     39 Vehicle Phonebook J   4 Handset Phonebook ne     39 Call History     4 Intemational Call J       Phone                                   
190. audio system can be operated using the  controls on the steering wheel     POWER on switch    With the ignition switch in the ACC or ON posi   tion  push the SOURCE switch to turn the audio  system on     4 102 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    SOURCE select switch    Push the source select switch to change the  mode in the following sequence     Models without Navigation System    AM     FM1     FM2     XM1     XM2     XM3   satellite radio  if so equipped      USB iPod     if  so equipped      CD DVD      AUX      AM     Models with Navigation System    AM     FM1     FM2     XM1     XM2     XM3   satellite radio  if so equipped      CD DVD   gt   USB iPod        Bluetooth   Audio       AUX       AM       These modes are only available when compat   ible media storage is inserted into the device     Volume control switch    Push the volume control switch to increase or  decrease the volume     v         A Menu control  switch ENTER button    While the display is showing a MAP  STATUS or  Audio screen  tilt the Menu Control switch up   ward or downward to select a station  track  CD  or folder  For most audio sources  tilting the  switch up down for more than 1 5 seconds pro              vides a different function than a tilting up down  for less than 1 5 seconds     AM and FM       Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the preset station       Tilt up down for more than 1 5 seconds to  seek up or down to the next stati
191. bag warning light      1 51  2 14  10 5    Supplemental front impact air bag system     1 44  Supplemental restraint system  Information and warning labels            1 51  Precautions on supplemental restraint  System    cg SEE LUN d Need 1 37  Supplemental restraint system   Supplemental air bag system                 1 37  Switch  Autolight switch            iss 2 31  Automatic power window switch        2 45  Fog light switch             00  2 34  Hazard warning flasher switch           6 2  Headlight and turn signal switch          2 30  Headlight control switch            2 31  Power door lock switch              3 5  Rear window and outside mirror defroster  SWiteli  silk e dor Re C3 RUN ed 2 29  Turn signal switch                2 34  Vehicle dynamic control  VDC  off  SWICK 2c ae js euim mon m UN  ee 2 37  Windshield wiper and washer switch      2 28  T  Tachometer sa   ox eee  e ee ew 2 5  Temperature gauge  Engine coolant temperature gauge       2 5  Theft  NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system    engine stat               2 27  3 3  5 10  Three way catalyst        less 5 2  Tire  Flatitite  2 nons beh a a ha ee we a aed 6 3  Spare tire   seas a s kd 6 4  8 43  Tire and Loading Information label        9 11  Tire chains  ae ot  als a atom oa 8 40    10 6    Tire placard     a oed d 9 11    Tire pressure        lees 8 32  Tirerotation           less 8 40  Types oFtires  2   de xem hune E 8 39  Uniform tire quality grading              9 24  Wheels and tires             
192. bel  If  weight ratings are exceeded  move or re   move items to bring all weights below the  ratings     Technical and consumer information 9 15    TOWING A TRAILER    AWARNING    Overloading or improper loading of a  trailer and its cargo can adversely affect  vehicle handling  braking and perfor   mance and may lead to accidents     A CAUTION      Do nottow a trailer or haul a heavy load  for the first 500 miles  800 km   Your  engine  axle or other parts could be  damaged         For the first 500 miles  800 km  that you  tow a trailer  do not drive over 50 mph   80 km h  and do not make starts at full  throttle  This helps the engine and other  parts of your vehicle wear in at the  heavier loads     Your new vehicle was designed to be used pri   marily to carry passengers and cargo  Remember  that towing a trailer places additional loads on  your vehicle s engine  drive train  steering  brak   ing and other systems     A NISSAN Towing Guide  U S  only  is available  on the website at www nissanusa com  This  guide includes information on trailer towing ca   pability and the special equipment required for  proper towing     9 16 Technical and consumer information    MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS  Maximum trailer loads    Never allow the total trailer load to exceed the  value specified in the  Towing  Load Specification  chart found later in this sec   tion  The total trailer load equals trailer weight  plus its cargo weight     e When towing a trailer load of 1 000 Ibs    454 kg  
193. brakes       When the trailer sway stops  gently apply the  brakes and pull to the side of the road in a  safe area       Try to rearrange the trailer load so it is bal   anced as described earlier in this section     Be careful when passing other vehicles   Passing while towing a trailer requires con   siderably more distance than normal pass   ing  Remember  the length of the trailer must  also pass the other vehicle before you can  safely change lanes     Downshift the transmission to a lower gear  for engine braking when driving down steep  or long hills  This will help slow the vehicle  without applying the brakes     Avoid holding the brake pedal down too long  or too frequently  This could cause the  brakes to overheat  resulting in reduced  braking efficiency     Increase your following distance to allow for  greater stopping distances while towing a  trailer  Anticipate stops and brake gradually     NISSAN recommends that the cruise con   trol not be used while towing a trailer         Some states or provinces have specific  regulations and speed limits for vehicles that  are towing trailers  Obey the local speed  limits         Check your hitch  trailer wiring harness con   nections  and trailer wheel lug nuts after  50 miles  80 km  of travel and at every break         When launching a boat  don t allow the wa   ter level to go over the exhaust tail pipe or  rear bumper       Make sure you disconnect the trailer lights  before backing the trailer into the water or 
194. button  see   Bluetooth amp  Hands Free Phone System with  Navigation System  in this section     When you use this system  make sure the engine  is running     If you use the system with the engine not  running  ignition ON or ACC  for a long  time  it will discharge the battery  and the  engine will not start     Reference symbols     ENTER button     This is a button on the control  panel        Example        Words marked in quotes refer to a  key shown only on the display  These keys can be  selected by touching the screen or using the  NISSAN controller                 WHA1210       HOW TO USE THE NISSAN  CONTROLLER    Use the NISSAN controller to choose an item on  the display screen  Highlight an item on the dis   play using the main directional buttons  2   cer   tain Navigation System functions use the addi   tional directional buttons     or the center dial   3   Then press the ENTER button   to select  the item or perform the action     The BACK button  4  has two functions         Go back to the previous display  cancel      If you press the BACK button  2  during setup   the setup will be canceled and or the display will  return to the previous screen         Finish setup     In some screens  pressing the BACK button  4   accepts the changes made during setup     For the VOICE button     functions  refer to the  separate Navigation System Owner s Manual     HOW TO USE THE TOUCH  SCREEN    A CAUTION       The glass display screen may break if it  is hit with a ha
195. buttons can be set in the same man   ner     If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse  opens  the radio memory will be canceled  In that  case  reset the desired stations     Compact disc  CD  changer operation    Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position and press the LOAD button  then press  one of the CD insert  1     6  slots  Insert the  compact disc into the slot with the label side  facing up  The compact disc will be guided auto   matically into the slot and start playing     If the radio is already operating  it will automati   cally turn off and the compact disc will play     If the system has been turned off while a compact  disc was playing  pressing the VOL ON OFF  control knob will start the compact disc     LOAD button     To insert a CD in the CD changer  press the  LOAD button for less than 1 5 seconds  Select  the loading slot by pressing the CD insert select  button  1     6   then insert the CD     To insert 6 CDs to the CD changer  press the  LOAD button for more than 1 5 seconds     The slot numbers  1     6  will illuminate on the  display when CDs are loaded into the changer     DISC button     When the DISC button is pressed with the sys   tem off and a compact disc loaded  the system  will turn on and the compact disc will start to play     When the DISC button is pressed with a com   pact disc loaded with the radio playing  the radio  will automatically be turned off and the compact  disc will start to play     lt  lt        l 
196. cIehr E tats gue teat erede ku eas 2 43  Power windows 2 200008 ill erbe xen 2 43    Moonroof  if so equipped          6 0 cee eee eee eee 2 46    Automatic moonroof             00 cece eee eee 2 46  Dual Panel Moonroof  if so equipped                  2 47  Automatic moonroof           0  ccc cece eee 2 47  Rear power sun shade  if so equipped                2 49  Interior light  51e hc eee    2 50  Gonsole   light       ce Rr bre AR 2 51  Personal lights  2  eter teh cease 2 51  Map  lighis coenensis naana anaes 2 52    TRUNK light se scu pero e AEE RON DEEE 2 53    HomeLink   universal transceiver  if so equipped        Programming HomeLink                 0000 00s  Programming HomeLink   for Canadian  customers and gate openers               00 eee  Operating the HomeLink   universal  transcelver    iisccsssch e rece RISE E LER ds  Programming trouble diagnosis                 Clearing the programmed information               Reprogramming a single HomeLink   button         If your vehicle is stolen             eese       INSTRUMENT PANEL                                                                                                    2    u                      1918 17                   WIC1535          2     3     2 2    Side and center vents  P  4 40   Headlight fog light  if so equipped  turn  signal switch  P  2 30    Steering wheel switch for audio control  and Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System  P  4 102  4 104     Instruments and controls    o9 B    D    Meters
197. cator lights and audible reminders     in the    Instruments and controls    section and   Tire Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS   in the   Starting and driving  section     A WARNING    e Radio waves could adversely affect  electric medical equipment  Those who  use a pacemaker should contact the  electric medical equipment manufac   turer for the possible influences before  use     e If the low tire pressure warning light  illuminates while driving  avoid sudden  steering maneuvers or abrupt braking   reduce vehicle speed  pull off the road  to a safe location and stop the vehicle  as soon as possible  Driving with under   inflated tires may permanently damage  the tires and increase the likelihood of  tire failure  Serious vehicle damage  could occur and may lead to an acci   dent and could result in serious per   sonal injury  Check the tire pressure for  all four tires  Adjust the tire pressure to  the recommended COLD tire pressure  shown on the Tire and Loading Informa   tion label to turn the low tire pressure  warning light OFF  If you have a flat tire   replace it with a spare tire as soon as  possible     e Whena sparetire is mounted or a wheel  is replaced  tire pressure will not be  indicated  the TPMS will not function  and the low tire pressure warning light  will flash for approximately 1 minute   The light will remain on after 1 minute   Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as  possible for tire replacement and or  system resetting       Replacing tires with th
198. ce  to O mi   km   select the  Reset Distance  key using the  NISSAN controller              LHA0839    Displaying the maintenance notice re   minder       Select the    Interval Reminder ON    key to display  the MAINTENANCE INFORMATION automati   cally at the set maintenance interval  The indica   tor light will illuminate when it is ON     The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen will be au   tomatically displayed as shown when both of the  following conditions are met         The vehicle is driven the set distance and the  ignition switch is placed in the OFF position         The ignition switch is placed in the ON po   sition the next time the vehicle is driven     To return to the previous display after the MAIN   TENANCE NOTICE screen is displayed  press  the BACK button     The MAINTENANCE NOTICE screen displays  each time the key is turned ON until one of the  following conditions are met         The  Reset  key is selected         The  Interval Reminder ON  key is set to  OFF  indicator light not illuminated          The maintenance interval is set again     Where am I     Refer to the separate Navigation System Own   er s Manual for information regarding this item     Traffic Info    Refer to the separate Navigation System Own   er s Manual for information regarding this item     Weather Info    Refer to the separate Navigation System Own   er s Manual for information regarding this item     Map Update    Refer to the separate Navigation System Own   er s Manual for informati
199. ce opera   tors are generally familiar with the applicable laws  and procedures for towing  To assure proper  towing and to prevent accidental damage to your  vehicle  NISSAN recommends having a service  operator tow your vehicle  It is advisable to have  the service operator carefully read the following  precautions     AWARNING    e Never ride in a vehicle that is being  towed     e Never get under your vehicle after it has  been lifted by a tow truck     A CAUTION    e When towing  make sure that the trans   mission  axles  steering system and  powertrain are in working condition  If  any of these conditions apply  dollies or  a flatbed tow truck must be used     e Always attach safety chains before  towing     For information about towing your vehicle behind  a recreational vehicle  RV   refer to  Flat towing   in the  Technical and consumer information  sec   tion of this manual     In case of emergency 6 11                ACE0511                SCE0199A          TOWING RECOMMENDED BY  NISSAN    NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towed  with the driving  front  wheels off the ground or  place the vehicle on a flat bed truck as illustrated     6 12 Incase of emergency    ACAUTION    Never tow CVT models with the front  wheels on the ground or four wheels on  the ground  forward or backward   as  this may cause serious and expensive  damage to the transmission  If it is nec   essary to tow the vehicle with the rear  wheels raised always use towing dollies  under the fr
200. certifying that it complies with Federal  Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Mo   tor Vehicle Safety Standards  Once the child has  grown so the shoulder belt is no longer on or near  the face and neck and the lap belt can be posi   tioned properly across the lower hips or upper  thighs use the seat belt without the booster seat     AWARNING    Never let a child stand or kneel on any  seat and do not allow a child in the cargo  area  The child could be seriously injured  or killed in a sudden stop or collision     CHILD RESTRAINTS       ARS1098                WRS0256       PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD  RESTRAINTS    1 20 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    A WARNING    e Failure to follow the warnings and in   structions for proper use and installa   tion of child restraints could result in  serious injury or death of a child or  other passengers in a sudden stop or  collision         The child restraint must be used and  installed properly  Always follow all  of the child restraint manufacturer s  instructions for installation and use            Infants and children should never be  held on anyone   s lap  Even the stron   gest adult cannot resist the forces of  a collision         Do not put a seat belt around both a  child and another passenger       NISSAN recommends that all child  restraints be installed in the rear  seat  Studies show that children are  safer when properly restrained in the  rear seat than in the front seat  If you  must ins
201. cident         The front passenger seat is equipped  with an occupant classification sensor   pattern sensor  that turns the front  passenger air bag OFF under some Sit upright and well back   conditions  This sensor is only used in ARS1133  this seat  Failure to be properly seated  and wearing the seat belt can increase  the risk or severity of injury in an acci   dent  See    Front passenger air bag and  status light  later in this section                   Keep hands on the outside of the steer   ing wheel  Placing them inside the  steering wheel rim could increase the  risk that they are injured when the front  air bag inflates     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 39                   ARS1041 ARS1042          ARS1043       AWARNING AWARNING      Never let children ride unrestrained or     Children may be severely injured or  extend their hands or face out of the killed when the front air bags  side air  window  Do not attempt to hold them in bags or curtain air bags inflate if they  your lap or arms  Some examples of are not properly restrained  Pre teens  dangerous riding positions are shown and children should be properly re   in the illustrations strained in the rear seat  if possible     1 40 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system                ARS1044          ARS1045          WRS0256       A WARNING        Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air  Bag System  never install a rear facing  child restraint in the front seat
202. ck in the chains to permit turning  corners     Trailer lights    A CAUTION    When splicing into the vehicle electrical  system  a commercially available power   type module converter must be used to  provide power for all trailer lighting  This  unit uses the vehicle battery as a direct  power source for all trailer lights while  using the vehicle tail light  stoplight and  turn signal circuits as a signal source  The  module converter must draw no more  that 15 milliamps from the stop and tail  lamp circuits  Using a module converter  that exceeds these power requirements  may damage the vehicle   s electrical sys   tem  See a reputable trailer dealer to ob   tain the proper equipment and to have it  installed     Trailer lights should comply with federal and or  local regulations  For assistance in hooking up  trailer lights  contact a NISSAN dealer or repu   table trailer dealer     Trailer brakes    If your trailer is equipped with a braking system   make sure it conforms to federal and or local  regulations and that it is properly installed     AWARNING    Never connect a trailer brake system di   rectly to the vehicle brake system     Pre towing tips        Be certain your vehicle maintains a level  position when a loaded and or unloaded  trailer is hitched  Do not drive the vehicle if it  has an abnormal nose up or nose down  condition  check for improper tongue load   overload  worn suspension or other possible  causes of either condition         Always secure items
203. ck on the vehicle  then remove the cable from  the iPod         iPod   is a trademark of Apple Inc   registered in  the U S  and other countries     Compatibility  The following models are compatible         iPod   5th Generation  firmware version  1 2 3 or later         iPod   Classic  firmware version 1 1 1 or  later         iPod   Touch  firmware version 2 0 0 or  later          iPod   Nano   1st generation  firmware ver   sion 1 3 1 or later       iPod   Nano   2nd generation  firmware ver   sion 1 1 3 or later         iPod   Nano   3rd generation  firmware ver   sion 1 1 3 or later         iPod   Nano   4th generation  firmware ver   sion 1 0 4 or later       iPod   Nano   5th generation  firmware ver   sion 1 0 1 or later             Some features of this iPod   may not be fully  functional     Make sure that your iPod   firmware is updated to  the version indicated above     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 95       8 00    Artist  XXXXXX  Album  XXXXXX  Track  XXXXXX    jS                Shuffle Songs  Repeat All    2 10                      LHA1397       Audio main operation    Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position  Press the DISC AUX button repeatedly  to switch to the iPod   mode     If the system has been turned off while the iPod    was playing  pressing the VOL ON OFF control  knob will start the iPod       DISC AUX button     When the DISC AUX button is pressed with the  system off and the iPod   connected  the syste
204. clean  the meter and gauge lens     A WARNING    Do not use water or acidic cleaners  hot  steam cleaners  on the seat  This can  damage the seat or occupant classifica   tion sensor  This can also affect the opera   tion of the air bag system and result in  serious personal injury     A CAUTION      Never use benzine  thinner or any simi   lar material     e Small dirt particles can be abrasive and  damaging to leather surfaces and  should be removed promptly  Do not  use saddle soap  car waxes  polishes   oils  cleaning fluids  solvents  deter   gents or ammonia based cleaners as  they may damage the leather s natural  finish       Never use fabric protectors unless rec   ommended by the manufacturer       Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on  meter or gauge lens covers  It may dam   age the lens cover     AIR FRESHENERS    Most air fresheners use a solvent that could affect  the vehicle interior  If you use an air freshener   take the following precautions       Hanging type air fresheners can cause per   manent discoloration when they contact ve   hicle interior surfaces  Place the air fresh   ener in a location that allows it to hang free  and not contact an interior surface         Liquid type air fresheners typically clip on  the vents  These products can cause imme   diate damage and discoloration when  spilled on interior surfaces     Carefully read and follow the manufacturer s in   structions before using the air fresheners     FLOOR MATS    AA WARNING    To avoi
205. climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Operating tips    Say a command after the tone  Voice com   mands cannot be accepted when the icon  is B   Commands that are available are always  shown on the display and spoken through  voice menu prompts  Commands other than  those that are displayed are not accepted   Please follow the prompts given by the sys   tem     If the command is not recognized  the sys   tem repeats the announcement  Repeat the  command in a clear voice     Press the  amp  switch on the steering  wheel to return to the previous screen     If you want to cancel the command  press  and hold the  amp  switch  The message    Voice cancelled  will be announced          f you want to adjust the volume of the sys   tem feedback  push the volume control  switch on the steering wheel or use the  audio system volume knob while the system  is making an announcement     How to speak numbers    Voice Recognition requires a certain way to  speak numbers when giving voice commands   Refer to the following examples     General rule     Only single digits 0  zero  to 9 can be used       When saying the phone number 800 662   6200  the system will accept  eight   hundred  in addition to  eight zero zero  or   eight oh oh   500  700  and 900 are also  supported     Examples       1 800 662 6200         One eight zero zero six six two six two  zero zero          One eight hundred six six two six two  zero zero     Improving Recognition of Phone numbers     You c
206. cognition Settings       Adapting the System to Your Voice             LHA1344       Displaying user guide    You can confirm how to use voice commands by  accessing a simplified User Guide  which con   tains basic instructions and tutorials for several  voice commands     1  Press the INFO button on the instrument  panel     2  Select the  Others  key   3  Select the  Voice Recognition  key   4  Select the  User Guide  key     5  Select an item   Available items       Getting Started    Describes the basics of how to operate the  Voice Recognition system         let s Practice    Initiates a practice session that demon   strates how to improve recognition by the  System         Using the Address Book  Tutorial for using the Address Book         Finding a Street Address  Tutorial for Finding a Street Address       Placing Calls    Tutorial for making a phone call by voice  command operation         Help on Speaking    Displays useful tips for how to correctly  speak commands in order for them to be  properly recognized by the system         Voice Recognition Settings    Describes the available Voice Recognition  settings         Adapting the System to Your Voice    Tutorial for adapting the system to your  voice     USING THE SYSTEM    Initialization    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized   which takes a few seconds  When completed   the system is ready to accept voice commands  If  the  amp      switch is pressed be
207. could affect the system  function       Do not drop the Intelligent Key       Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply  against another object       Do not change or modify the Intelligent  Key     e Wetting may damage the Intelligent  Key  If the Intelligent Key gets wet  im   mediately wipe until it is completely dry       Do not place the Intelligent Key for an  extended period in an area where tem   peratures exceed 140 F  60 C      e Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a  key holder that contains a magnet       Do not place the Intelligent Key near  equipment that produces a magnetic  field  such as a TV  audio equipment and  personal computers     3 8 Pre driving checks and adjustments    If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen  NISSAN  recommends erasing the ID code of that Intelli   gent Key from the vehicle  This may prevent the  unauthorized use of the Intelligent Key to operate  the vehicle  For information regarding the erasing  procedure  contact a NISSAN dealer                 WPD0403       OPERATING RANGE    The Intelligent Key functions can only be used  when the Intelligent Key is within the specified  operating range from the request switch  1      When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged or  strong radio waves are present near the operat   ing location  the Intelligent Key operating range  becomes narrower  and the Intelligent Key may  not function properly     The operating range is within 31 50 in  BO cm   from each request switch  1      If the
208. ct discs  CD R    e Rewritable compact discs  CD RW   4 50 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Disc Read Error         Confirm that the CD DVD is inserted  correctly  the label side is facing up   etc           Confirm that the CD DVD is not bent  or warped and it is free of scratches     Please Eject Disc     This error may be due to the tempera   ture inside the player getting too high   Remove the CD DVD by pushing the  EJECT button  and after a short time  reinsert the CD DVD  The CD DVD can  be played when the temperature of the  player returns to normal  If the error  persists  consult your local dealership     Unplayable File       The file may be copy protected         The file is not MP3  WMA  AAC  M4A  or DIVX type     Region Invalid    e The DVD is not for region 1 or all  regions     e Use DVDs with a region code    1         ALL    or    1 included  for your DVD  entertainment system   The region  code    is displayed as a small sym   bol printed on the top of the DVD   B  This vehicle installed DVD  player cannot play DVDs with a re   gion code other than    1    or    ALL                          LHA0484       Copyright and trademark      The technology protected by the U S     patent and other intellectual property  rights owned by Macrovision  Corporation and other right holders is  adopted for this system     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 51        This copyright protected technology  cannot be use
209. ction for  more information     To transfer a phone number stored in the cellular  phone s memory     Say  Transfer entry   The system acknowledges  the command and asks you to initiate the transfer  from the phone handset  The new contact phone  number will be transferred from the cellular  phone via the Bluetooth   communication link     The transfer procedure varies according to each  cellular phone  See the cellular phone Owner s    Manual for details  You can also visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth for instructions  on transferring phone numbers from NISSAN  recommended cellular phones     The system repeats the number and prompts you  for the next command  When you have finished  entering numbers or transferring an entry  choose     Store        The system confirms the name  location and  number        Delete Entry       Use the Delete Entry command to erase one  entry from the phonebook  After the system rec   ognizes the command  speak the name to delete  or say    List Names    to choose an entry        List Names          Use the List Names command to hear all the  names in the phonebook     The system recites the phonebook entries but  does not include the actual phone numbers   When the playback of the list is complete  the  system goes back to the main menu     You can stop the playback of the list at any time    by pressing the      button on the steering  wheel  The system ends the VR session        Phonebook     phones with automatic  phonebook download functi
210. ction on icy roads  studded  tires may be used  However  some U S   states and Canadian provinces prohibit their  use  Check local  state and provincial laws  before installing studded tires     Skid and traction capabilities of studded  snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be  poorer than that of non studded snow tires     3  Tire chains may be used  For details  see     Tire chains    in the    Maintenance and do it   yourself    section of this manual     SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT    It is recommended that the following items be  carried in the vehicle during winter         Ascraper and stiff bristled brush to remove  ice and snow from the windows and wiper  blades         A sturdy  flat board to be placed under the  jack to give it firm support         Ashovelto dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts         Extra washer fluid to refill the windshield   washer fluid reservoir     DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE    A  WARNING      Wet ice  32  F  0  C and freezing rain    very cold snow or ice can be slick and  very hard to drive on  The vehicle will  have much less traction or  grip  under  these conditions  Try to avoid driving on  wet ice until the road is salted or  sanded     Whatever the condition  drive with cau   tion  Accelerate and slow down with  care  If accelerating or downshifting too  fast  the drive wheels will lose even  more traction     Allow more stopping distance under  these conditions  Braking should be  started sooner than on dry pavement     Allow greater follow
211. ctor to take up extra slack   Be sure the shoulder belt is positioned  across the top  middle portion of the child s  shoulder  Be sure to follow the booster seat  manufacturer s instructions for adjusting the  seat belt routing     6  Follow the warnings  cautions and instruc   tions for properly fastening a seat belt  shown in  Three point type seat belt with  retractor  earlier in this section           9   PY   OFF          7  If the booster seat is installed in the front  passenger seat  place the ignition switch in  the ON position  The front passenger air bag  status light  amp  may or may not illuminate   depending on the size of the child and the  type of booster seat being used  See  Front  passenger air bag and status light  later in  this section     SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT  SYSTEM    PRECAUTIONS ON SUPPLEMENTAL  RESTRAINT SYSTEM    This Supplemental Restraint System  SRS  sec   tion contains important information concerning  the following systems         Driver and passenger supplemental front   impact air bag  NISSAN Advanced Air Bag  System         Front seat mounted side impact supple   mental air bag        Roof mounted curtain side impact supple   mental air bag        Seat belt with pretensioner    Supplemental front impact air bag system   The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can help  cushion the impact force to the head and chest of  the driver and front passenger in certain frontal  collisions     Front seat mounted side impact supple   mental air bag syst
212. cupied passenger s seat  The 7 is  OFF and the front passenger air bag is OFF  and will not inflate in a crash         Passenger  seat occupied by a small adult     child or child restraint as outlined in this  section  The   illuminates to indicate  that the front passenger air bag is OFF and  will not inflate in a crash         Occupied passenger seat and the passen   ger meets the conditions outlined in this  section  The light   is OFF to indicate  that the front passenger air bag is opera   tional     Front passenger air bag    The front passenger air bag is designed to auto   matically turn OFF when the vehicle is operated  under some conditions as described below in  accordance with U S  regulations  If the front    Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    passenger air bag is OFF  it will not inflate in a  crash  The driver air bag and other air bags in your  vehicle are not part of this system     The purpose of the regulation is to help reduce  the risk of injury or death from an inflating air bag  to certain front passenger seat occupants  such  as children  by requiring the air bag to be auto   matically turned OFF  Certain sensors are used  to meet the requirements     One sensor used is the occupant classification  sensor  pattern sensor   It is in the bottom of the  front passenger seat cushion and is designed to  detect an occupant and objects on the seat by  weight  It works together with seat belt sensors  described later  For example 
213. cured to the designated an   chor point on the vehicle           WRS0718          LATCH system lower anchor locations  LATCH  Lower Anchors and Tethers  for CHildren  SYSTEM    Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor  points that are used with LATCH  Lower Anchors  and Tethers for CHildren  system compatible  child restraints  This system may also be referred  to as the ISOFIX or ISOFIX compatible system   With this system  you do not have to use a vehicle  seat belt to secure the child restraint     The LATCH anchor points are provided to install  child restraints in the rear outboard seating posi   tions only  Do not attempt to install a child restraint  in the center position using the LATCH anchors     1 22 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    LATCH lower anchor    AWARNING    Failure to follow the warnings and instruc   tions for proper use and installation of  child restraints could result in serious in   jury or death of a child or other passen   gers in a sudden stop or collision       Attach LATCH system compatible  child restraints only at the locations  shown in the illustration       Do not secure a child restraint in the  center rear seating position using  the LATCH lower anchors  The child  restraint will not be secured properly         Inspect the lower anchors by insert   ing your fingers into the lower anchor  area  Feel to make sure there are no  obstructions over the anchors such  as seat belt webbing or seat cushion  materi
214. d   The light will not illuminate when the front pas   senger seat is unoccupied     If an adult occupant is in the seat but the passen   ger air bag status light is illuminated  indicating  that the air bag is OFF   it could be that the  person is a small adult  or is not sitting on the seat  properly or not using the seat belt properly     If a child restraint must be used in the front seat   the passenger air bag status light may or may not  be illuminated  depending on the size of the child  and the type of child restraint being used  If the air    bag status light is not illuminated  indicating that  the air bag might inflate in a crash   it could be  that the child restraint or seat belt is not being  used properly  Make sure that the child restraint is  installed properly  the seat belt is used properly  and the occupant is positioned properly  If the air  bag status light is not illuminated  reposition the  occupant or child restraint in a rear seat     If the passenger air bag status light will not illu   minate even though you believe that the child  restraint  the seat belts and the occupant are  properly positioned  the system may be sensing  an unoccupied seat  in which case the air bag is  OFF   Your NISSAN dealer can check that the  system is OFF by using a special tool  However   until you have confirmed with your dealer that  your air bag is working properly  reposition the  occupant or child restraint in a rear seat     The air bag system and passenger air b
215. d  park in secure  well lit areas whenever possible     Many devices offering additional protection  such  as component locks  identification markers  and  tracking systems  are available at auto supply  stores and specialty shops  Your NISSAN dealer  may also offer such equipment  Check with your  insurance company to see if you may be eligible  for discounts for various theft protection features     How to arm the vehicle security  system    1  Close all windows   The system can be  armed even if the windows are open      2  Remove the Intelligent Key from the vehicle     3  Close all doors  hood and trunk  Lock all  doors  The doors can be locked with the  Intelligent Key  door handle request switch  or power door lock switch     4  Confirm that the security indicator light  comes on  The security light stays on for  about 30 seconds  The vehicle security sys   tem is now pre armed  After about 30 sec   onds the vehicle security system automati   cally shifts into the armed phase  The    security light begins to flash once every  3 seconds  If  during the 30 second pre arm  time period  the driver s door is unlocked by  the key or the keyfob  or the ignition switch is  placed in the ACC or ON position  the sys   tem will not arm         Even when the driver and or passen   gers are in the vehicle  the system will  activate with all the doors  hood and  trunk lid locked with the ignition  Switch placed in the LOCK position   When placing the ignition switch in the  ACC or O
216. d in the ACC position when the shift selec   tor is moved to the P  Park  position     See    Shift P warning    in this section for additional  information     To turn off the Push warning  place the ignition  switch in the ON position and then to the LOCK  position     Low fuel warning    This warning illuminates when the fuel level in the  fuel tank is getting low  Refuel as soon as it is  convenient  preferably before the fuel gauge  reaches E  Empty   There will be a small re   serve of fuel in the tank when the fuel  gauge needle reaches E  Empty      2 24 Instruments and controls    Low windshield washer fluid warning    This warning illuminates when the windshield   washer fluid is at a low level  Add windshield   washer fluid as necessary  See    Windshield   washer fluid    in the    Maintenance and do it   yourself    section of this manual     No key warning    This warning illuminates following two condi   tions     1  When the ignition switch is pushed and the  Intelligent Key cannot be recognized by the  system  If this warning illuminates  you can   not start the engine     Check for the following causes and perform  the assigned remedies         The battery of the Intelligent Key carried  with you is discharged completely  Re   place the battery with a new one         The Intelligent Key carried with you is not  registered to the system  Use the regis   tered Intelligent Key         You do not have an Intelligent Key with  you  Carry an Intelligent Key with y
217. d potential pedal interference that  may result in a collision or injury     e NEVER place a floor mat on top of an   other floor mat in the driver front  position     e Use only genuine NISSAN floor mats  specifically designed for use in your ve   hicle model  See your NISSAN dealer  for more information     e Properly position the mats in the floor   well using the floor mat positioning aid   See  Floor mat positioning aid  in this  section     The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats can ex   tend the life of your vehicle carpet and make it  easier to clean the interior  Mats should be main   tained with regular cleaning and replaced if they  become excessively worn        NSZ          LPD0477       Floor mat positioning aid    This vehicle includes a front floor mat bracket to  act as a floor mat positioning aid  Genuine  NISSAN floor mats have been specially designed  for your vehicle model  The driver s and passen   ger s side floor mats have a grommet hole incor   porated in them  Position the mat by placing the  floor mat bracket hook through the floor mat  grommet hole while centering the mat in the  floorwell     Periodically check to make certain the mats are  properly positioned     Appearance and care 7 5    SEAT BELTS    The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them  with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution   Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade  before using them  See    Seat belt maintenance     in the  Safety     Seats  seat belts and supplemen   t
218. d using the mechani   cal key to prevent unauthorized access     1 6 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    Secondary trunk lid release  if so  equipped   For models with a rear center console  the trunk    can be accessed through the access panel be   tween the rear seats  as shown         Fold down the center arm rest         Insert the mechanical key into the trunk com   partment access lid lock  Fold down the  trunk compartment access lid  For more in   formation on the mechanical key  see     NISSAN Intelligent Key     in the Pre   driving checks and adjustments chapter         Pullthe rear seat trunk release handle  1                  WRS0868       Center armrest    Pull the armrest down until it rests on the seat  cushion     HEAD RESTRAINTS    AWARNING    Head restraints supplement the other ve   hicle safety systems  They may provide  additional protection against injury in cer   tain rear end collisions  Adjust the head  restraints properly  as specified in this  section  Check the adjustment after  someone else uses the seat  Do not attach  anything to the head restraint stalks or  remove the head resiraint  Do not use the  seat if the head restraint has been re   moved  If the head restraint was removed   reinstall and properly adjust the head re   straint before an occupant uses the seat   ing position  Failure to follow these in   structions can reduce the effectiveness of  the head restraints  This may increase the  risk of serious inju
219. d without a permit from  Macrovision Corporation  It is limited  to personal use  etc   as long as the  permit from Macrovision Corporation  is not issued     e Modifying or disassembling is prohib   ited       Dolby digital is manufactured under li   cense from Dolby Laboratories  Inc     are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories   Inc     e DTS and DTS Digital Surround  E        are registered trademarks of Digital  Theater Systems  Inc     USB  Universal Serial Bus  memory  if  so equipped     A WARNING    Do not connect or disconnect the USB  device while driving  Doing so can be a  distraction  If distracted you could lose  control of your vehicle and cause an acci   dent or serious injury     A CAUTION    Do not force the USB device into the  USB port  Inserting the USB device  tilted or up side down into the port may  damage the USB device and the port   Make sure that the USB device is con   nected correctly into the USB port     Do not grab the USB port cover  if so  equipped  when pulling the USB device  out of the port  This could damage the  port and the cover     Do not leave the USB cable in a place  where it can be pulled unintentionally   Pulling the cable may break the wire   USB device or the port     To avoid damage and loss of function  when using a USB device  note the fol   lowing precautions       Do not bend the cable excessively   1 6 in  40 mm   radius minimum       Do not twist the cable excessively   more than 180 degrees          Do not pull or drop th
220. der the following conditions may  require more frequent oil and filter changes       repeated short distance driving at cold out   side temperatures    driving in dusty conditions  extensive idling    towing a trailer    stop and go commuting    Refer to the    NISSAN Service and Maintenance  Guide  for the maintenance schedule     AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  REFRIGERANT AND OIL  RECOMMENDATIONS   The air conditioner system in your NISSAN  vehicle must be charged with the refriger     ant HFC 134a  R 134a  and NISSAN A C  system oil Type S or the exact equivalents     9 6 Technical and consumer information    A CAUTION    The use of any other refrigerant or oil will  cause severe damage to the air condition   ing system and will require the replace   ment of all air conditioner system  components     The refrigerant HFC 134a  R 134a  in your  NISSAN vehicle does not harm the earth s ozone  layer  Although this refrigerant does not affect the  earth s atmosphere  certain government regula   tions require the recovery and recycling of any  refrigerant during automotive air conditioner sys   tem service  A NISSAN dealer has the trained  technicians and equipment needed to recover  and recycle your air conditioner system refriger   ant     Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing your air  conditioner system     SPECIFICATIONS    ENGINE    Model VO35DE   Type Gasoline  4 cycle  DOHC  Cylinder arrangement 6 cylinder  V block  Slanted at 60    Bore x Stroke in mm  3 760 x 3 205  95 5 x 8
221. di   cally  Add windshield washer fluid when the low  windshield washer fluid warning light comes on     To fill the windshield washer fluid reservoir  lift  the cap off the reservoir and pour the windshield   washer fluid into the reservoir opening     Add a washer solvent to the washer for better  cleaning  In the winter season  add a windshield   washer antifreeze  Follow the manufacturer s in   structions for the mixture ratio     Refill the reservoir more frequently when driving  conditions require an increased amount of  windshield washer fluid     Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN Wind   shield Washer Concentrate Cleaner  amp  Anti   freeze or equivalent     ACAUTION    e Do not substitute engine anti freeze  coolant for windshield washer fluid   This may result in damage to the paint     e Do not fill the windshield washer fluid  reservoir with washer fluid concen   trates at full strength  Some methyl al   cohol based washer fluid concentrates  may permanently stain the grille if  spilled while filling the windshield   washer reservoir         Pre mix washer fluid concentrates with  water to the manufacturer s recom   mended levels before pouring the fluid  into the windshield washer fluid reser   voir  Do not use the windshield washer  fluid reservoir to mix the washer fluid  concentrate and water     BATTERY      Keep the battery surface clean and dry   Clean the battery with a solution of baking  soda and water       Make certain the terminal connections are  cl
222. distances immedi   ately before the closed position which  cannot be detected  Make sure that all  passengers have their hands  etc   inside  the vehicle before closing the window     If the vehicle s battery is disconnected  replaced   or jump started  the power window auto reverse  function may not operate properly  If this occurs   please contact the dealer to re initialize the  power window auto reverse system     If the control unit detects something caught in a  window equipped with automatic operation as it  is closing  the window will be immediately low   ered     If the windows do not close  automatically    If the power window automatic function  closing  only  does not operate properly  perform the fol   lowing procedure to initialize the power window  System     1  Place the ignition switch in the ON position   2  Close the door     3  Open the window more than halfway by  operating the power window switch     4  Pull the power window switch and hold it to  close the window  and then hold the switch  for more than 3 seconds after the window is  closed completely     5  Release the power window switch  Operate  the window by automatic function to confirm  the initialization is complete     6  Perform steps 2 through 5 above for other  windows     If the power window automatic function does not  operate properly after performing the above pro   cedure  have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN  dealer     Instruments and controls 2 45    MOONROOF  if so equipped        
223. down hooks for towing or  vehicle recovery     Rocking a stuck vehicle    A WARNING  e Stand clear of a stuck vehicle         Do not spin your tires at high speed   This could cause them to explode and  result in serious injury  Parts of your  vehicle could also overheat and be  damaged     If your vehicle is stuck in sand  snow  mud  etc    use the following procedure     1  Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control  VDC   System     2  Make sure the area in front and behind the  vehicle is clear of obstructions     3  Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear  an area around the front tires     4  Slowly rock the vehicle forward and back   ward         Shift back and forth between R  Reverse   and D  Drive        Apply the accelerator as little as possible  to maintain the rocking motion       Release the accelerator pedal before  shifting between R  Reverse  and D   Drive        Do not spin the tires above 35 MPH   55 km h      5  If the vehicle cannot be freed after a few  tries  contact a professional towing service  to remove the vehicle     In case of emergency 6 13    MEMO    6 14 Incase of emergency    7 Appearance and care    Cleaning exterior              00 00  e cece eee eee 7 2  Washing 2a cccreseee es e teat Rex GG ates 7 2  WAXING  oux es Geode STRE pO EE I ER RR 7 2  Removing SpotS     i seee een m nnn 7 3  Underbody   i eue deett nre nma Re x nes 7 3   CIC cr  7 8  Aluminum alloy wheels              000s eee eee 7 3  Chrome  Parts being yt won te tan Ie v R
224. dy is frequently ex   posed to corrosive substances such as those  used on icy roads or to control dust  It is very  important to remove these substances from the  underbody  otherwise rust may form on the floor  pan  frame  fuel lines and exhaust system  At the  end of winter  the underbody should be thor   oughly flushed with plain water  in those areas    where mud and dirt may have accumulated  See  the    Appearance and care    section of this  manual     Windshield washer fluid  Check that there is  adequate fluid in the reservoir     MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS    When performing any inspection or maintenance  work on your vehicle  always take care to prevent  serious accidental injury to yourself or damage to  the vehicle  The following are general precau   tions which should be closely observed     AWARNING        Park the vehicle on a level surface  ap   ply the parking brake securely and  block the wheels to prevent the vehicle  from moving  Move the shift selector to  P  Park      e Besure the ignition switch is in the OFF  or LOCK position when performing any  parts replacement or repairs         If you must work with the engine run   ning  keep your hands  clothing  hair  and tools away from moving fans  belts  and any other moving parts     e It is advisable to secure or remove any  loose clothing and remove any jewelry   such as rings  watches  etc  before  working on your vehicle     e Always wear eye protection whenever  you work on your vehicle     Your vehicle
225. e   turns to normal play speed     144     gt  gt    SEEK CAT and TRACK  buttons                 Press the SEEK CAT button M4 while an au   dio file on the USB device is playing to return to  the beginning of the current track  Press the  SEEK CAT button M   several times to skip  backward several tracks     Press the TRACK button I while an audio  file on the USB device is playing to advance one  track  Press the TRACK button 99     several  times to skip forward several tracks  If the last  track in a folder on the USB device is skipped  the  first track of the next folder is played     Folder selection     To change to another folder in the USB memory   turn the TUNE FOLDER knob or choose a folder  displayed on the screen     RPT RDM button     When the RPT RDM button is pressed while the  USB memory is playing  the play pattern can be  changed as follows     Normal     1 Folder Repeat     1 Track Repeat      All Random     1 Folder Random     Normal    Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 89       8 00    USB  gt  Menu               Folder List       Track List  Play Mode                                        LHA1294       Menu     There are some options available during play   back  Select one of the following that are dis   played on the screen  if necessary  Refer to the  following information for each item         Movie Playback  Switch to the movie playback mode  This  item is displayed only when the USB  memory contains movie files   The s
226. e  Screen  if necessary     Hang up   Finish the call     Use Handset   Transfer the call to the cellular phone     Mute   Mute your voice to the person     4 126 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Keypad    Brings up a keypad  enter digits when needed   For example  entering your PIN number for voice   mail     NOTE     Pushing the TALK     switch on the  steering wheel during a call allows num   bers and digits to be sent using Voice Rec   ognition     Cancel Mute   This will appear after the  Mute  key is selected   Mute will be cancelled     Switch Call    Select  Switch Call  to answer another incoming  call  By selecting  Hang Up     you can end a call  and can speak to a caller who is on hold again         This function may not be useable  depend   ing on the model of phone     To adjust the person s voice to be louder or  quieter  press the volume control switch located  on the steering wheel switches or turn the volume  control knob on the instrument panel while talking  on the phone  This adjustment is also available in  the SETTING mode        Go fm xu 8 00          Call in Progress     amp  0 04 ore _        Use Handset    B XXXXXXXX Mute  XXXXXXXX          Keypad                                     LHA1324       ENDING A CALL    To finish the call  perform one of the following  procedures         Select the  Hang up  key on the  Call in  Progress  display     e Push the     wheel     switch on the steering    When the  Call in Progres
227. e  or lack of it  is not always an  indication of proper side air bag and curtain air  bag operation     When the side air bags and curtain air bags  inflate  a fairly loud noise may be heard  followed  by release of smoke  This smoke is not harmful  and does not indicate a fire  Care should be taken  not to inhale it  as it may cause irritation and  choking  Those with a history of a breathing con   dition should get fresh air promptly     Side air bags  along with the use of seat belts   help to cushion the impact force on the chest and  pelvic area of the front occupants  Curtain air  bags help to cushion the impact force to the head  of occupants in the front and rear outboard seat   ing positions  They can help save lives and re   duce serious injuries  However  an inflating side  air bag and curtain air bags may cause abrasions  or other injuries  Side air bags and curtain air  bags do not provide restraint to the lower body     The seat belts should be correctly worn and the  driver and passenger seated upright as far as  practical away from the side air bag  Rear seat  passengers should be seated as far away as    practical from the door finishers and side roof  rails  The side air bags and curtain air bags inflate  quickly in order to help protect the occupants   Because of this  the force of the side air bag and  curtain side impact air bag inflating can increase  the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to  or  is against  these air bag modules during inflat
228. e HomeLink    button that was just programmed  This procedure  will not affect any other programmed HomeLink    buttons     IF YOUR VEHICLE IS STOLEN    If your vehicle is stolen  you should change the  codes of any non rolling code device that has  been programmed into HomeLink    Consult the  Owner s Manual of each device or call the manu   facturer or dealer of those devices for additional  information     When your vehicle is recovered  you will  need to reprogram the HomeLink   Univer   sal Transceiver with your new transmitter  information     FCC Notice   For USA     This device complies with Part 15 of the  FCC Rules  Operation is subject to the fol   lowing two conditions   1  This device may  not cause harmful interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference re   ceived  including interference that may  cause undesired operation     NOTE     Changes or modifications not expressly ap   proved by the party responsible for compli   ance could void the user   s authority to op   erate the equipment     For Canada     This device complies with RSS 210 of In   dustry Canada  Operation is subject to the  following two conditions   1  this device  may not cause interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference  in   cluding interference that may cause unde   sired operation of the device     Instruments and controls 2 57    MEMO    2 58 Instruments and controls    3 Pre driving checks and adjustments    LC M esata conde arene aera 3 2  NISSAN In
229. e applicable on  the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and  maximum section width  For example     Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  Treadwear    The treadwear grade is a comparative rating  based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  under controlled conditions on a specified gov   ernment test course  For example  a tire graded  150 would wear one and one half  1 1 2  times  as well on the government course as a tire graded  100  The relative performance of tires depends  upon the actual conditions of their use  however   and may depart significantly from the norm due to  variations in driving habits  service practices and  differences in road characteristics and climate     Traction AA  A  B and C    The traction grades  from highest to lowest  are  AA  A  B  and C  Those grades represent the  tire s ability to stop on wet pavement as mea   sured under controlled conditions on specified  government test surfaces of asphalt and con   crete  A tire marked C may have poor traction  performance     A  WARNING    The traction grade assigned to this tire is  based on straight ahead braking traction  tests  and does not include acceleration   cornering  hydroplaning  or peak traction  characteristics     Temperature A  B and C    The temperature grades are A  the highest   B   and C  representing the tire s resistance to the  generation of heat  and its ability to dissipate heat  when tested under controlled conditions on a  specified indoor laboratory test wheel  S
230. e cable       Do not hit or press the USB port or  USB device with hands  feet  or  objects     4 52 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems      Do not store objects with sharp  edges in the storage area where the  cable is stored       Do not leave the USB device and  attached devices in the vehicle com   partment  When not in use for ex   tended periods of time  store the  cable and USB device in a clean  dust  free environment at room tempera   ture and without direct sun exposure       Do not use the cable for any other  purposes than its intended use in the  vehicle     The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device   USB devices should be purchased separately as  necessary     This system cannot be used to format USB de   vices  To format a USB device  use a personal  computer     In some states area  the USB device for the front  seats plays only sound without images for regu   latory reasons  even when the vehicle is parked     This system supports various USB memory de   vices  USB hard drives and iPod   players  Some  USB devices may not be supported by this sys   tem         Partitioned USB devices may not play cor     rectly     Some characters used in other languages   Chinese  Japanese  etc   may not appear  properly in the display  Using English lan   guage characters with a USB device is rec   ommended     General notes for USB use         The USB device may not function when the    passenger compartment temperature is ex   tremely high  L
231. e door handle request switch  1   again within 60 seconds to unlock all doors     If    door handle is pulled while unlocking the  doors  that door may not be unlocked  Returning  the door handle to its original position will unlock  the door  If the door does not unlock after return   ing the door handle  push the door handle re   quest switch to unlock the door     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 11                WPD0369    All doors will be locked automatically unless one  of the following operations is performed within  60 seconds after pushing the request switch          Opening any door       Pushing the ignition switch     The interior light timer illuminates for a period of  time when a door is unlocked and the room light  Switch is in the DOOR position     3 12 Pre driving checks and adjustments    The interior light can be turned off without waiting  by performing one of the following operations         Placing the ignition switch in the ON posi   tion         Locking the doors with the remote controller         Switching the room light switch to the OFF  position                 LPD0478       Opening the trunk lid    1  Push the trunk opener request switch    for  more than 1 second while carrying the Intel   ligent Key with you     2  The trunk will unlatch  A chime will sound 4  times     3  Raise the trunk lid to open the trunk   Lockout protection    To prevent the Intelligent Key from being acci   dentally locked in the trunk  lockout protection is  equi
232. e fuel  tank and the actual fuel consumption  The display  is updated every 30 seconds  When the fuel level  is low  the DTE display will change to         NOTE         If the amount of fuel added while the  ignition switch is OFF is small  the dis   play just before the ignition switch is  placed in the OFF position may con   tinue to be displayed     e When driving uphill or rounding curves   the fuel in the tank shifts  which may  momentarily change the display     Average fuel economy  MPG or L 100 km     The Average Fuel Economy is calculated based  on fuel consumption since the last reset  The  display is updated every 30 seconds and 1 3 mi   500 m   After a reset or connecting the battery  cables  the display might show            Resetting fuel economy    The average fuel economy calculation can be  reset to O  Press the INFO button and select the   Fuel Economy  key  then select the  Reset  key  using the NISSAN controller           12 00    Information  gt  Fuel Economy Record    EM                           Reset Interval Latest        Push BACK for previous screen                   LHA0922       Fuel economy record    Press the INFO button  then select the    Fuel  Economy    key  then select the    View    key using  the NISSAN controller     The average fuel consumption history will be  displayed in a graph form along with the average  fuel for the previous reset to reset period     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 7                
233. e is  wait until the condensation is gone  about 1 hour  before using the player    If there is a temperature increase error  the player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature    If there is a mixture of music CD files  CD DA data  and compressed audio files on a CD  only the music CD files  CD DA data  will be played     Cannot play Files with extensions other than   MP3     WMA      AAC     M4A  or     AA3    cannot be played  In addition  the character codes and number of charac   ters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications     Check if the disc or file is generated in an irregular format  This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of the compressed audio file writ   ing application or other text editing applications     Check if the finalization process  such as session close and disc close  is done for the disc   Check if the CD DVD USB device is protected by copyright     Poor sound quality Check if the CD DVD is scratched or dirty     It takes a relatively long time   If there are many folders or file levels on the CD DVD USB device  or if it is a multisession disc  some time may be required before the music starts  before the music starts playing     playing     The writing software and hardware combination might not match  or the writing speed  writing depth  writing width  etc   might not match the  specifications  Try using the slowest writing speed     Skipping with high bit rate Skippi
234. e playback order is the order in which the  files were written by the writing software   Therefore  the files might not play in the  desired order     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 55    Specification chart     Supported media CD  CD R  CD RW  USB 2 0   CD  CD R  CD RW  ISO9660 LEVEL1  ISO9660 LEVEL2  Romeo  Joliet      SO9660 Level 3  packet writing  is not supported      Files saved using the Live File System component  on a Windows Vista   operating system based  Supported file systems computer  are not supported     VDF 1 5 VDF 2 0  packet writing  is not supported   MPEG1  MPEG2  MPEG2 5  Sampling frequency 8 kHz   48 kHz  Supported 8 kbps   320 kbps  VBR 2  versions WMA7  WMA8  Bkz  48 ks    Kops   520 Kbps  VBR    Tag inf tion  S titl Grist   ID3 tag VER1 0  VER1 1  VER2 2  VER2 3  VER 2 4  MP3 only   ag information  Song title and artist name    WMA tag  WMA only  OSES tag  WMA only     Folder levels Folder levels  8  Folders  255  including root folder   Files  512  Max  255 files for one folder   Text character number limitation 64 characters  01  ASCII  02  ISO 8859 1  03  UNICODE  UTF 16 LE   04  UNICODE  UTF 16 BE   05  UNI     Displayable character codes 3 CODE  UTF 8         1 Protected WMA files  DRM  cannot be played    2 When VBR files are played  the playback time may not be displayed correctly      3 Available codes depend on what kind of media  versions and information are going to be displayed     4 56 Monitor  climate  a
235. e system ends the VR session  See the     Record name    command in this section for infor   mation about recording custom voice tags for list  entries that the system has difficulty pronounc   ing       Record Name       The system allows you to record custom voice  tags for contact names in the phonebook that the  vehicle has difficulty recognizing  This feature can  also be used to record voice tags to directly dial  an entry with multiple numbers  Up to 40 voice  tags can be recorded to the system        Recent Calls       Main Menu       Recent Calls        Outgoing       Incoming    Missed   C        Use the Recent Calls command to access out   going  incoming or missed calls        Outgoing     A     Use the Outgoing command to list the outgoing  calls made from the vehicle      Incoming     Use the Incoming command to list the incoming  calls made to the vehicle      Missed   C     Use the Missed command to list the calls made to  the vehicle that were not answered     4 114 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems     Connect Phone     NOTE     The Add Phone command is not available  when the vehicle is moving   Main Menu   Connect Phone    Add Phone         Select Phone    Delete Phone   C    Turn Bluetooth OFF   D        Use the Connect Phone commands to manage  the phones connecting to the vehicle or to enable  the Bluetooth   function on the vehicle        Add Phone   A     Use the Add Phone command to add a phone to  the vehicle  See  Connect
236. e the vehicle and a warning is displayed in  the instrument panel     When a chime or beep sounds or a warning is  displayed  be sure to check the vehicle and the  Intelligent Key     See the  Troubleshooting guide  that follows and   Vehicle information display  in the  Instruments  and controls  section of this manual     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 15    TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE    Verify the location of all Intelligent Keys that are  programmed for the vehicle  If another Intelligent  Key is in range or inside the vehicle  the vehicle  system may respond differently than expected     Symptom Possible    PossbeCase       Remdy OE    When pushing the ignition switch to stop ise utu e E The shift selector is not in the P  Park  den  shift selector to the P  Park   the engine continuously  position   When opening the driver s door to get out   The inside warning chime sounds E ferri   port  gent Key port     The NO KEY warning appears on the Place the ignition switch in the OFF  display  the outside chime sounds 3 times   The ignition switch is placed in the ACC or   position    and the inside warning chime sounds for ON position    approximately 3 seconds     When closing the door after getting out of   The NO KEY warning appears on the dis  The ignition switch is placed in the ACC Move the shift selector to the P  Park  posi   the vehicle play and the outside chime sounds position and the shift selector is not in the P   tion and place the ignition switch in the    co
237. eady  condition  Before taking the  I M test  check the vehicle   s  inspection maintenance test readiness condi   tion  Place the ignition switch in the ON position  without starting the engine  If the Malfunction  Indicator Light  MIL  comes on steady for 20 sec   onds and then blinks for 10 seconds   the I M test  condition is    not ready     If the MIL does not blink  after 20 seconds  the I M test condition is     ready     Contact a NISSAN dealer to set the     ready condition    or to prepare the vehicle for  testing     EVENT DATA RECORDERS  EDR     This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data Re   corder  EDR   The main purpose of an EDR is to  record  in certain crash or near crash like situa   tions  such as an air bag deployment or hitting a  road obstacle  data that will assist in understand   ing how a vehicle   s systems performed  The EDR  is designed to record data related to vehicle  dynamics and safety systems for a short period of  time  typically 30 seconds or less  The EDR in this  vehicle is designed to record such data as         How various systems in your vehicle were  operating         Whether or not the driver and passenger  safety belts were buckled fastened         How far  if at all  the driver was depressing  the accelerator and or brake pedal  and         How fast the vehicle was traveling         Sounds are not recorded     These data can help provide a better understand   ing of the circumstances in which crashes and  injuries occur  NOTE  E
238. ean and securely tightened         Ifthe vehicle is not to be used for 30 days or  longer  disconnect the negative     battery  terminal cable to prevent discharge     NOTE     Care should be taken to avoid situations  that can lead to potential battery discharge  and potential no start conditions such as   1  Installation or extended use of electronic  accessories that consume battery power  when the engine is not running  Phone char   gers  GPS  DVD players  etc      2  Vehicle is not driven regularly and or only  driven short distances  In these cases  the  battery may need to be charged to maintain  battery health     AWARNING    Do not expose the battery to flames  an  electrical spark or a cigarette  Hydro   gen gas generated by the battery is ex   plosive  Explosive gases can cause  blindness or injury  Do not allow battery  fluid to contact your skin  eyes  fabrics  or painted surfaces  Sulfuric acid can  cause blindness or injury  After touch   ing a battery or battery cap  do not  touch or rub your eyes  Thoroughly  wash your hands  If the acid contacts  your eyes  skin or clothing  immediately  flush with water for at least 15 minutes  and seek medical attention     Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in  the battery is low  Low battery fluid can  cause a higher load on the battery  which can generate heat  reduce bat   tery life  and in some cases lead to an  explosion     When working on or near a battery  al   ways wear suitable eye protection and  remove al
239. eason  tires are identified by ALL SEASON and or M amp S  on the tire sidewall  Snow tires have better snow  traction than All Season tires and may be more  appropriate in some areas     Summer tires    NISSAN specifies summer tires on some models  to provide superior performance on dry roads   Summer tire performance is substantially re   duced in snow and ice  Summer tires do not have  the tire traction rating  M amp S  on the tire sidewall     If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or icy  conditions  NISSAN recommends the use of  SNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all four  wheels     Snow tires    If snow tires are needed  it is necessary to select  tires equivalent in size and load rating to the  original equipment tires  If you do not  it can  adversely affect the safety and handling of your  vehicle     Generally  snow tires have lower speed ratings  than factory equipped tires and may not match  the potential maximum vehicle speed  Never ex   ceed the maximum speed rating of the tire     If you install snow tires  they must be the same  size  brand  construction and tread pattern on all  four wheels     For additional traction on icy roads  studded tires  may be used  However  some U S  states and  Canadian provinces prohibit their use  Check  local  state and provincial laws before installing    Maintenance and do it yourself 8 39    studded tires  Skid and traction capabilities of  studded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be  poorer than that of non studd
240. eath     During the programming procedure  your garage door or security gate will  open and close  if the transmitter is  within range   Make sure that people or  objects are clear of the garage door   gate  etc  that you are programming     Your vehicle s engine should be turned  off while programming the HomeLink amp   Universal Transceiver     Instruments and controls 2 53    PROGRAMMING HOMELINK      If you have any questions or are having difficulty  programming your HomeLink   buttons  refer to  the HomeLink   web site at  www homelink com  or call 1 800 355 3515     NOTE     Place the ignition switch in the ACC posi   tion when programming HomeLink    It is  also recommended that a new battery be  placed in the hand held transmitter of the  device being programmed to HomeLink    for quicker programming and accurate  transmission of the radio frequency     1  Position the end of your hand held transmit   ter 1 3 inches  2 8 cm  away from the  HomeLink   surface  keeping the  HomeLink   indicator light  1  in view     2 54 Instruments and controls             LIC2365             LIC2366       2  Using both hands  simultaneously press and  hold the desired HomeLink   button and  handheld transmitter button  DO NOT re   lease until the HomeLink   indicator light  1   flashes slowly and then rapidly  When the  indicator light flashes rapidly  both buttons  may be released   The rapid flashing indi   cates successful programming      NOTE     Some devices may require you to 
241. eck  Be sure to  check the tire pressure regularly         If the vehicle is being driven at speeds  of less than 16 MPH  25 km h   the  TPMS may not operate correctly       Be sure to install the specified size of  tires to the 4 wheels correctly     Master warning light    When the ignition is in the ON position  the master  warning light illuminates if any of the following are  displayed on the vehicle information display       No key warning   Low fuel warning   Low windshield washer fluid warning  Parking brake release warning  Door trunk open warning    Loose fuel cap    Check tire pressure warning    Instruments and controls 2 13       iA Seat belt warning light and  chime       The light and chime remind you to fasten your  seat belts  The light illuminates whenever the  ignition switch is placed in the ON or START  position and remains illuminated until the driver s  seat belt is fastened  At the same time  the chime  sounds for about 6 seconds unless the driver s  seat belt is securely fastened     The seat belt warning light may also illuminate if  the front passenger s seat belt is not fastened  when the front passenger s seat is occupied  For  7 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in  the ON position  the system does not activate the  warning light for the front passenger     Refer to  Seat belts  in the  Safety   Seats  seat  belts and supplemental restraint system  section  for precautions on seat belt usage     a Supplemental air bag warning  light    
242. ect the ride  braking   handling  VDC system  ground clear   ance  body to tire clearance  tire chain  clearance  speedometer calibration   headlight aim and bumper height   Some of these effects may lead to acci   dents and could result in serious per   sonal injury         If your vehicle was originally equipped  with 4 tires that were the same size and  you are only replacing 2 of the 4 tires   install the new tires on the rear axle   Placing new tires on the front axle may  cause loss of vehicle control in some  driving conditions and cause an acci   dent and personal injury     8 42 Maintenance and do it yourself    e If the wheels are changed for any rea   son  always replace with wheels which  have the same off set dimension   Wheels of a different off set could  cause premature tire wear  degrade ve   hicle handling characteristics  affect  the VDC system and or interference  with the brake discs  Such interference  can lead to decreased braking effi   ciency and or early brake pad shoe  wear  Refer to  Wheels and tires  in the   Technical and consumer information   section of this manual for wheel off set  dimensions     e When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel  is replaced  tire pressure will not be  indicated  the TPMS will not function  and the low tire pressure warning light  will flash for approximately 1 minute   The light will remain on after 1 minute   Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as  possible for tire replacement and or  system resetting     e Replaci
243. ed  high  Speed cornering  or sudden steering maneuvers   because these driving practices could cause you  to lose control of your vehicle  As with any ve   hicle  loss of control could result in a colli   sion with other vehicles or objects or cause  the vehicle to roll over  particularly if the loss  of control causes the vehicle to slide side   ways  Be attentive at all times  and avoid driving  when tired  Never drive when under the influence of  alcohol or drugs  including prescription or over   the counter drugs which may cause drowsiness    Always wear your seat belt as outlined in the   Safety     Seats  seat belts and supplemental re   straint system  section of this manual  and also  instruct your passengers to do so     Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in collisions  and rollovers  In a rollover crash  an unbelted  or improperly belted person is significantly  more likely to be injured or killed than a  person properly wearing a seat belt     Starting and driving 5 5    OFF ROAD RECOVERY    If the right side or left side wheels unintentionally  leave the road surface  maintain control of the  vehicle by following the procedure below  Please  note that this procedure is only a general guide   The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based  on the conditions of the vehicle  road and traffic     1  Remain calm and do not overreact     2  Do not apply the brakes     3  Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with  both hands and try to hold a straight cour
244. ed snow tires     TIRE CHAINS    A CAUTION    Tire chains cables should not be installed  on P245 40VR19 size tires  Installation of  the tire chains cables on P245 40VR19  size tires will cause damage to the ve   hicle  If you plan to use tire chains cables   you should install P245 45VR18 size tires  on your vehicle     Use of tire chains may be prohibited according to  location  Check the local laws before installing  tire chains  When installing tire chains  make sure  they are the proper size for the tires on your  vehicle and are installed according to the chain  manufacturer s suggestions  Use only SAE  class    S    chains  Class  S  chains are used on  vehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance   Vehicles that can use Class  S  chains are de   signed to meet the minimum clearances between  the tire and the closest vehicle suspension or  body component required to accommodate the  use of a winter traction device  tire chains or  cables   The minimum clearances are determined  using the factory equipped tires  Other types may  damage your vehicle  Use chain tensioners when    8 40 Maintenance and do it yourself    recommended by the tire chain manufacturer to  ensure a tight fit  Loose end links of the tire chain  must be secured or removed to prevent the pos   sibility of whipping action damage to the fenders  or underbogy  If possible  avoid fully loading your  vehicle when using tire chains  In addition  drive  at a reduced speed  Otherwise  your vehicle may
245. ed with feedback  You can also use  the radio volume control knob     In most cases you can interrupt the voice  feedback to speak the next command by  pressing the f  button on the steering  wheel         To use the system faster  you may speak the  second level commands with the main menu  command on the main menu  For example     press the  4 button and after the tone  say   Call Redial      How to say numbers    NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certain  way to speak numbers in voice commands  Refer  to the following rules and examples         Either  zero  or  oh  can be used for  O    Example  1 800 662 6200         One eight oh oh six six two six two oh  oh   or         One eight zero zero six six two six two oh  oh         Words can be used for the first 4 digits  places only     Example  1 800 662 6200         One eight hundred six six two six two oh  oh         NOT  One eight hundred six six two sixty  two hundred     and        NOT  One eight oh oh six six two sixty two  hundred       Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 107           Numbers can be spoken in small groups    NOTE   The system will prompt you to continue en     Gnd    E   For best results  say phone numbers as  tering digits  if desired  single digits            Example  1 800 662 6200 The voice command  Help  is available at any        One eight zero zero  time  Please use the  Help  command to get  information on how to use the system    The system repeats the numbers a
246. eech  Select the  Try  Again  to repeat the session if improvement is  needed  Select the  Done  key to return to the  User Guide screen        Information  gt  User Guide 8 00    Tips on Speaking Commands         Say commands when there are minimal  background sounds      Say voice commands clearly      Avoid talking slow or with long pauses       Say commands after the tone                 LHA1330    8 00    Settings  gt  Voice Recognition          User Guide       Alternate Command Mode                         Guide the usage of Voice Recognition                LHA1331       Useful tips for correct operation    You can display useful speaking tips to help the  system recognize your voice commands cor   rectly     1  Select    Help on Speaking        2  You can confirm the page by scrolling the  screen using the NISSAN controller or  touching the page down key     Voice recognition settings    The available settings of the NISSAN Voice Rec   ognition system are described     1  Select    Voice Recognition        2  You can confirm the page by scrolling the  screen using the NISSAN controller     USING THE SYSTEM  Initialization    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized   which takes a few seconds  When completed   the system is ready to accept voice commands  If  the  amp      switch is pressed before the initializa   tion completes  voice commands will not be ac   cepted  Please wait until the NISSAN Voice Rec   ogni
247. eel   P  5 7    Tilt telescopic steering wheel controls   if so equipped   P  3 22     24  Vehicle Dynamic Control  VDC  OFF  switch  P  2 37   Outside mirror controls  P  3 27   Heated steering wheel switch   if so equipped   P  2 37   Trunk lid release switch  P  3 19     Refer to the separate Navigation System  Owner s Manual  if so equipped      See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     Illustrated table of contents 0 7    ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK  LOCATIONS                pA    KY    4    p     N    NS    2 1     32    R          e       LS     3  WS    CE    EN    S       m     gt   27        e    LA    NL                                                 0 8 Illustrated table of contents    Power steering fluid reservoir  P  8 13   Engine oil filler cap  P  8 10    Brake fluid reservoir  P  8 14    Air cleaner  P  8 19    Fuse block  P  8 22    Battery  P  8 15    Fuse fusible link box  P  8 22   Engine oil dipstick  P  8 10    9  Radiator cap  P  8 7    10  Drive belt location  P 8 1 7    11  Engine coolant reservoir    P  8 7   12  Windshield washer fluid reservoir     P  8 14     NOTE       Side covers removed for clarity     ouocgnrom     See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     WARNING INDICATOR LIGHTS    Warning Name Page  light  2 11    Anti lock Braking       System  ABS  warn   ing light          Brake warning light          V       Engine oil pressure  warning light   Low tire pressure  warning li
248. eel  slip on one slipping drive wheel so power is  transferred to a non slipping drive wheel on  the same axle         Controls brake pressure and engine output  to reduce drive wheel slip based on vehicle  speed  traction control function          Controls brake pressure at individual wheels  and engine output to help the driver maintain  control of the vehicle in the following condi   tions         understeer  vehicle tends to not follow  the steered path despite increased steer   ing input         oversteer  vehicle tends to spin due to  certain road or driving conditions     The VDC system can help the driver to maintain  control of the vehicle  but it cannot prevent loss of  vehicle control in all driving situations     When the VDC system operates  the R indi   cator in the instrument panel flashes so note the  following       The road may be slippery or the system may  determine some action is required to help  keep the vehicle on the steered path       You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal  and hear a noise or vibration from under the  hood  This is normal and indicates that the  VDC system is working properly         Adjust your speed and driving to the road  conditions     See  Slip indicator light  and  Vehicle Dynamic  Control  VDC  off indicator light  in the  Instru   ments and controls  section     If a malfunction occurs in the system  the 8  indicator light comes on in the instrument panel   The VDC system automatically turns off when the  indicator lig
249. efer to the HomeLink   web site at   www homelink com or call 1 800 355   3515     PROGRAMMING HOMELINK   FOR  CANADIAN CUSTOMERS AND  GATE OPENERS    Canadian radio frequency laws require transmit   ter signals to    time out     or quit  after several  seconds of transmission     which may not be long  enough for HomeLink   to pick up the signal  during training  Similar to this Canadian law   some U S  gate operators are designed to    tim   eout    in the same manner     If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties  training a gate operator or garage door opener  by using the    Training    procedures  replace     Programming HomeLink      Step 2 with the fol   lowing     NOTE     When programming a garage door opener   etc   unplug the device during the    cycling     process to prevent possible damage to the  garage door opener components     1  See    Programing HomeLink      step 1 earlier  in this section     2  Using both hands  simultaneously press and  hold the desired HomeLink   button and the  hand held transmitter button  During train   ing  your hand held transmitter may auto   matically stop transmitting  Continue to    press and hold the desired HomeLink   but   ton while you press and re press     cycle      your hand held transmitter every two sec   onds until the frequency signal has been  learned  The HomeLink   indicator light will  flash slowly and then rapidly after several  seconds upon successful training  DO NOT  release until the HomeLink 
250. ehicle soap or general purpose  dishwashing liquid mixed with clean  lukewarm   never hot  water     7 2 Appearance and care    A CAUTION    e Do not use car washes that use acid in  the detergent  Some car washes  espe   cially brushless ones  use some acid for  cleaning  The acid may react with some  plastic vehicle components  causing  them to crack  This could affect their  appearance  and also could cause them  not to function properly  Always check  with your car wash to confirm that acid  is not used     e Do not wash the vehicle with strong  household soap  strong chemical deter   gents  gasoline or solvents     e Do not wash the vehicle in direct sun   light or while the vehicle body is hot  as  the surface may become water spotted         Avoid using tight napped or rough  cloths  such as washing mitts  Care  must be taken when removing  caked on dirt or other foreign sub   stances so the paint surface is not  scratched or damaged     Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of clean  water     Inside flanges  seams and folds on the doors   hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to    the effects of road salt  Therefore  these areas  must be cleaned regularly  Take care that the  drain holes in the lower edge of the door are  open  Spray water under the body and in the  wheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash away  road salt     A damp chamois can be used to dry the vehicle to  avoid water spots     WAXING    Regular waxing protects the paint surface and  help
251. el  switch  in this section                                   WPD0361                   WPD0362       Using the panic alarm  If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened   you may activate the panic alarm to call attention    by pressing and holding the M button on the  Intelligent Key for longer than 0 5 seconds     The panic alarm and headlights will stay on for a  period of time     The panic alarm stops when        thas run for a period of time  or      Any button is pressed on the Intelligent Key         The request switch on the driver or passen   ger door has been pushed and the Intelligent  Key is in range of the door handle     Silencing the horn beep feature    If desired  the horn beep feature can be deacti   vated using the Intelligent Key     To deactivate  Press and hold the  and a buttons for at least 2 seconds        The hazard warning lights will flash 3 times to  confirm that the horn beep feature has been  deactivated     To activate  Press and hold the    and a buttons for at least 2 seconds  once more        The hazard warning lights will flash once and the  horn will sound once to confirm that the horn  beep feature has been reactivated     Deactivating the horn beep feature does not si   lence the horn if the alarm is triggered     WARNING SIGNALS    To help prevent the vehicle from moving unex   pectedly by erroneous operation of the Intelligent  Key or to help prevent the vehicle from being  stolen  a chime or buzzer sounds from inside and  outsid
252. el of quality     4 54 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems        Bit rate     Bit rate denotes the number of  bits per second used by a digital music file   The size and quality of a compressed digital  audio file is determined by the bit rate used  when encoding the file         Sampling frequency     Sampling frequency  is the rate at which the samples of a signal  are converted from analog to digital  A D  conversion  per second       Multisession     Multisession is one of the  methods for writing data to media  Writing  data once to the media is called a single  session  and writing more than once is called  a multisession     e ID3 WMA Tag     The ID3 WMA tag is the  part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that  contains information about the digital music  file such as song title  artist  encoding bit  rate  track time duration  etc  ID3 tag infor   mation is displayed on the Artist song title  line on the display       Windows    Windows Media and Windows  Vista   are registered trademarks and trade   marks in the United States of America and other  countries of Microsoft Corporation of the USA              FJ  FOLDER  lo   MP3 or WMA    WHA1078          Playback order chart    Playback order     Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or WMA  files is as illustrated       The names of folders not containing MP3 or  WMA files are not shown in the display          f there is a file in the top level of the disc    Root Folder  is displayed         Th
253. el the Ds mode  return the shift se   lector to the D  Drive  position  The trans   mission returns to the automatic drive mode     The CVT can operate in two manual drive modes     e M  Manual  mode   With the shift selector in  the manual shift gate Ds  Drive Sport  mode   M  Manual  mode can be selected by mov   ing the shift selector up     or down     or  using the shift paddles  if so equipped  up      or down      In M mode  the transmission  will produce noticeable upshifts and down   shifts  The position indicator in the meter  shows a  M          Temporary M  Manual  shift mode   With the  shift selector in the D  Drive  mode and if the  shift paddle is moved    up  or    down   the  transmission will temporarily switch to the M   Manual  mode  If the shift paddles are not  used after 5   10 seconds  the transmission  will return to the D  Drive  mode         Tocancel the M  Manual  mode and return to  the D  Drive  mode  press and hold either  shift paddle for 3   5 seconds     Follow these procedures for maximum vehicle  performance and driving enjoyment     NOTE     Engine power may be automatically re   duced to protect the CVT if the engine  speed increases quickly when driving on  slippery roads or while being tested on  some dynamometers     Starting the vehicle    1  After starting the engine  fully depress the  foot brake pedal before moving the shift  selector out of the P  Park  position     2  Keep the foot brake pedal depressed and  move the shift selec
254. elect the  Speaker Adaptation  key     4 150 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    4  Select the user whose voice is to be memo   rized by the system           8 00    Ko    Settings  gt  Speaker Adaptation             Setting          User 1          Start Speaker Adaptation Learning                le       1 2          Push the ENTER switch to select       LHA1347    Settings  gt  Speaker Adaptation 8 00  2S          FM  Changes the source of the audio system to FM    Alternate Command Mode ON    To exit  hold the TALK switch             LHA2457    8 00    Ko    Settings  gt  Speaker Adaptation                         Edit Name User 1  Reset Result  Continuous Learning   ON                le       1 3          User Name can be edited          LHA1349       5  Select a category to be learned by the sys   tem from the following list         Phone       Navigation      Information      Audio       Help    The voice commands in the category are  displayed     6  Select a voice command to train     The Voice Recognition system starts     7  The system requests that you repeat a com   mand after a tone  This command is also  displayed on the screen     8  After the tone sounds and the icon on the             screen changes from  3 to Ly  speak  the command that the system requested        9  When the system has recognized the voice  command  the voice of the user is learned     Press the       switch or the BACK button to  return to the previous screen  
255. elt and  supplemental air bag     NISSAN recommends that pre teens and chil   dren be properly restrained in a rear seat   NISSAN also recommends that appropriate child  restraints and booster seats be properly installed  in a rear seat  If this is not possible  the occupant  classification sensor and seat belt sensors are  designed to operate as described above to turn  the front passenger air bag OFF for specified  child restraints as required by the regulations   Failing to properly secure child restraints and to  use the ALR mode  child restraint mode  may  allow the restraint to tip or move in an accident or    sudden stop  This can also result in the passen   ger air bag inflating in a crash instead of being  OFF  See  Child restraints  earlier in this section  for proper use and installation     If the front passenger seat is not occupied the  passenger air bag is designed not to inflate in a  crash  However  heavy objects placed on the  seat could result in air bag inflation  because of  the object s weight detected by the occupant  classification sensor  Other conditions could also  result in air bag inflation  such as if a child is  standing on the seat  or if two children are on the  Seat  contrary to the instructions in this manual   Always be sure that you and all vehicle occupants  are seated and restrained properly     Using the passenger air bag status light  you can  monitor when the front passenger air bag is au   tomatically turned OFF with the seat occupie
256. em  This system can help  cushion the impact force to the chest and pelvic  area of the driver and front passenger in certain  side impact collisions  The side air bags are de   signed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is  impacted     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 37    Roof mounted curtain side impact supple   mental air bag system  This system can help  cushion the impact force to the head of occu   pants in front and rear outboard seating positions  in certain side impact collisions  The curtain air  bags are designed to inflate on the side where  the vehicle is impacted     These supplemental restraint systems are de   signed to supplement the crash protection pro   vided by the driver and front passenger seat belts  and are not a substitute for them  Seat belts  should always be correctly worn and the occu   pant seated a suitable distance away from the  steering wheel  instrument panel and door finish   ers   See    Seat belts    earlier in this section for  instructions and precautions on seat belt usage      The supplemental air bags operate only  when the ignition switch is in the ON or  START position     After placing the ignition switch in the ON  position  the supplemental air bag warning  light illuminates  The supplemental air bag  warning light will turn off after about 7 sec   onds if the system is operational              a  TEM  Sit upright and well back        WRS0031       AA WARNING        The front air bags ordin
257. em  To re   duce or avoid emission control system dam   age         do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH   72 km h          avoid hard acceleration or deceleration       avoid steep uphill grades         if possible  reduce the amount of cargo  being hauled or towed     The malfunction indicator light may stop blinking  and come on steady  Have the vehicle inspected  by a NISSAN dealer  You do not need to have  your vehicle towed to the dealer     Instruments and controls 2 15    A CAUTION    Continued vehicle operation without hav   ing the emission control system checked  and repaired as necessary could lead to  poor driveability  reduced fuel economy   and possible damage to the emission con   trol system     Security indicator light    This light blinks when the ignition switch is  placed in the OFF  LOCK or ACC position     The blinking security indicator light indicates that  the security systems equipped on the vehicle are  operational     For additional information  see    Security sys   tems  later in this section     Side light and headlight    indicator light  green     The side light and headlight indicator light illumi   nates when the side light or headlight position is  selected  See    Headlight and turn signal switch     later in this section for further details     2 16 Instruments and controls    IR Slip indicator light    This indicator will blink when the VDC system or  the traction control system is operating  thus  alerting that the vehicle is nearing it
258. en all the  windows  move the heater or air conditioner  temperature control to maximum hot and fan  control to high speed     3  Get out of the vehicle  Look and listen for  steam or coolant escaping from the radiator  before opening the hood   If steam or cool   ant is escaping  turn off the engine   Do not  open the hood further until no steam or  coolant can be seen     4  Open the engine hood     A  WARNING    If steam or water is coming from the en   gine  stand clear to prevent getting  burned     5  Visually check drive belts for damage or  looseness  Also check if the cooling fan is  running  The radiator hoses and radiator  should not leak water  If coolant is leaking   the water pump belt is missing or loose  or  the cooling fan does not run  stop the en   gine     A WARNING    Be careful not to allow your hands  hair   jewelry or clothing to come into contact  with  or get caught in  engine belts or the  engine cooling fan  The engine cooling  fan can start at any time     6  After the engine cools down  check the cool   ant level in the engine coolant reservoir tank  with the engine running  Add coolant to the  engine coolant reservoir tank if necessary   Have your vehicle repaired at a NISSAN  dealer     TOWING YOUR VEHICLE    When towing your vehicle  all State  Provincial in  Canada  and local regulations for towing must be  followed  Incorrect towing equipment could dam   age your vehicle  Towing instructions are avail   able from a NISSAN dealer  Local servi
259. en closing or  tilting down the moonroof     The auto reverse function can be activated when  the moonroof is closed or tilted down by auto   matic operation when the ignition switch is  placed in the ON position or for a period of time  after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF  position     Depending on the environment or driving  conditions  the auto reverse function may  be activated if an impact or load similar to  something being caught in the moonroof  occurs     AWARNING    There are some small distances immedi   ately before the closed position which  cannot be detected  Make sure that all  passengers have their hands  etc   inside  the vehicle before closing the moonroof     When closing     If the control unit detects something caught in the  moonroof as it moves to the front  the moonroof  will immediately open backward     When tilting down     If the control unit detects something caught in the  moonroof as it tilts down  the moonroof will im   mediately tilt up     If the auto reverse function malfunctions and re   peats opening or tilting up the moonroof  keep  pushing the tilt down switch within 5 seconds  after it happens  the moonroof will fully close  gradually  Make sure nothing is caught in the  moonroof     AWARNING       In an accident you could be thrown from  the vehicle through an open moonroof   Always use seat belts and child  restraints       Do not allow anyone to stand up or  extend any portion of their body out of  the moonroof opening wh
260. en the vehicle is parked near a parking  meter     In such cases  correct the operating conditions  before using the Intelligent Key function or use  the mechanical key     Although the life of the battery varies depending  on the operating conditions  the battery s life is  approximately 2 years  If the battery is dis   charged  replace it with a new one     When the Intelligent Key battery is almost dis   charged  insert the Intelligent Key into the Intelli   gent Key port to start the engine  Replace the  discharged battery with a new one as soon as  possible  For additional information  see  Push  Button Ignition Switch  in the  Starting and driv   ing  section     Since the Intelligent Key is continuously receiving  radio waves  if the key is left near equipment  which transmits strong radio waves  such as sig   nals from a TV and personal computer  the bat   tery life may become shorter     For information regarding replacement of a bat   tery  see  Battery replacement  in the  Mainte   nance and do it yourself  section     As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered  and used with one vehicle  For information about  the purchase and use of additional Intelligent  Keys  contact a NISSAN dealer     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 7    A CAUTION    Listed below are conditions or occur   rences which will damage the Intelligent  Key       Do not allow the Intelligent Key  which  contains electrical components  to  come into contact with water or salt  water  This 
261. equire the use of approved child restraints  for infants and small children  See  Child re   straints  later in this section     A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle by  using either the LATCH  Lower Anchor and Teth   ers for CHildren  system or with the vehicle seat  belt  See  Child restraints  later in this section for  more information     NISSAN recommends that all pre teens  and children be restrained in the rear seat   Studies show that children are safer when  properly restrained in the rear seat than in  the front seat     This is especially important because your  vehicle has a supplemental restraint sys   tem  air bag system  for the front passen   ger  See  Supplemental restraint system   later in this section     INFANTS    Infants up to at least 1 year old should be placed  in a rear facing child restraint  NISSAN recom   mends that infants be placed in child restraints  that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  Standards  You should choose a child restraint  that fits your vehicle and always follow the manu   facturer s instructions for installation and use     SMALL CHILDREN    Children that are over 1 year old and weigh at  least 20 Ibs  9 kg  should remain in a rear facing  child restraint as long as possible up to the height  or weight limit of the child restraint  Children who  outgrow the height or weight limit of the rear   facing child restraint and are at least 1 year old  should be secured in
262. er   formed when the vehicle is stationary  If the  vehicle starts moving during the procedure   the procedure will be cancelled     Main Menu     Connect phone             Add phone     Initiate from handset      Name phone  D        1  Press the  4 button on the steering  wheel  The system announces the available  commands     2  Say     Connect phone        The system ac   knowledges the command and announces  the next set of available commands     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 109    3  Say     Add phone   B   The system acknowl   edges the command and asks you to initiate  connecting from the phone handset         The connecting procedure of the cellular  phone varies according to each cellular  phone model  See the cellular phone Own   er s Manual for details  You can also visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth for instruc   tions on connecting NISSAN recommended  cellular phones     When prompted for a Passkey code  enter   1234  from the handset  The Passkey code     1234    has been assigned by NISSAN and  cannot be changed     4  The system asks you to say a name for the  phone  D      If the name is too long or too short  the  system tells you  then prompts you for a  name again     Also  if more than one phone is connected  and the name sounds too much like a name  already used  the system tells you  then  prompts you for a name again     Making a call by entering a phone  number    Main Menu     Call         Phone Number   Speak the d
263. erly attached to the lower anchors     If the child restraint is equipped with a top  tether strap  route the top tether strap and  secure the tether strap to the tether anchor  point  See  Installing top tether strap  in this  section  Do not install child restraints that  require the use of a top tether strap in seat   ing positions that do not have a top tether  anchor           WRS0800    Forward facing rigid mounted     step 2    3  The back of the child restraint should be  secured against the vehicle seatback     If necessary  adjust or remove the head re   straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit  If  the head restraint is removed  store it in a  secure place  Be sure to reinstall the head  restraint when the child restraint is re   moved  See    Head restraints    in this section  for head restraint adjustment information     If the seating position does not have an  adjustable head restraint and it is interfering  with the proper child restraint fit  try another  seating position or a different child restraint     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 29       LRS0671          Forward facing     step 4    4  For child restraints that are equipped with  webbing mounted attachments  remove any  additional slack from the anchor attach   ments  Press downward and rearward firmly  in the center of the child restraint with your  knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion  and seatback while tightening the webbing  of the anchor attachments
264. essary when you need extra NISSAN Vehicle  Immobilizer System keys  Your dealer can dupli   cate your existing key  As many as four NISSAN  Vehicle Immobilizer System keys can be used  with one vehicle  You should bring all NISSAN  Vehicle Immobilizer System keys that you have to  your NISSAN dealer for registration  This is be   cause the registration process will erase the  memory of all key codes previously registered  into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System   After the registration process  these components  will only recognize keys coded into the NISSAN  Vehicle Immobilizer System during registration     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 3    Any key that is not given to your dealer at the time  of registration will no longer be able to start your  vehicle     A CAUTION    Do not allow the immobilizer system key   which contains an electrical transponder   to come into contact with water or salt  water  This could affect system function     3 4 Pre driving checks and adjustments    DOORS    When the doors are locked using one of the  following methods  the doors can not be opened  using the inside or outside door handles  The  doors must be unlocked to open the doors     AWARNING    e Always have the doors locked while  driving  Along with the use of seat belts   this provides greater safety in the event  of an accident by helping to prevent  persons from being thrown from the  vehicle  This also helps keep children  and others from unintentionally open   ing the d
265. et writing  is not supported     USB memory  FAT16  FAT32    MPEG1  MPEG2  MPEG2 5  MP3 Sampling frequency   8 kHz   48 kHz    Kops  320 Kops  VERA  Susie   WMAP WMAT  WMA8  WMAS  upporte Sampling frequency   32 kHz   48 kHz  versions 1  32 kbps   192 kbps  VBR 4  AAC Sampling frequency   8 kHz   96 kHz    16 kbps   320 kbps  VBR 4  ATRAC ATRAC3  ATRAC3 Plus    ID3 tag VER1 0  VER1 1  VER2 2  VER2 3  VER 2 4  MP3 only   WMA tag  WMA only     Folder levels Folder levels  8  Folders  255  including root folder   Files  512  Max  255 files for one folder   Text character number limitation 128 characters     128 characters ooo   01  ASCII  02  ISO 8859 1  03  UNICODE  UTF 16 BOM Big Endian   04  UNICODE  UTF 16 Non BOM Big Endian   05   UNICODE  UTF 8   06  UNICODE  Non UTF 16 BOM Little Endian   07  SHIFT JIS   1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played    2 Protected WMA files  DRM  cannot be played    3 Available codes depend on what kind of media  versions and information are going to be displayed    4 When VBR files are played  the playback time may not be displayed correctly   4 60 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Tag information  Song title and artist name        Troubleshooting guide     Symptom     Cause and Countermeasure    Check if the CD DVD USB device was inserted correctly    Check if the CD DVD is scratched or dirty    Check if there is condensation inside the player  If ther
266. ey  hole or use the remote keyless entry function on  the Intelligent Key     ANTI FREEZE    In the winter when it is anticipated that the tem   perature will drop below 32  F  0  C   check the  anti freeze to assure proper winter protection   For details  see    Engine cooling system    in the     Maintenance and do it yourself    section of this  manual     BATTERY    If the battery is not fully charged during extremely  cold weather conditions  the battery fluid may  freeze and damage the battery  To maintain maxi   mum efficiency  the battery should be checked  regularly  For details  see    Battery    in the    Main   tenance and do it yourself    section of this  manual     5 28 Starting and driving    DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER    If the vehicle is to be left outside without anti   freeze  drain the cooling system  including the  engine block  Refill before operating the vehicle   For details  see    Changing engine coolant    in the     Maintenance and do it yourself    section of this  manual     TIRE EQUIPMENT    1  SUMMER tires have a tread designed to  provide superior performance on dry pave   ment  However  the performance of these  tires will be substantially reduced in snowy  and icy conditions  If you operate your ve   hicle on snowy or icy roads  NISSAN recom   mends the use of MUD  amp  SNOW or ALL  SEASON TIRES on all four wheels  Please  consult a NISSAN dealer for the tire type   size  speed rating and availability informa   tion     2  For additional tra
267. f and others  Additionally  if you  are injured in an accident  alcohol can  increase the severity of the injury     NISSAN is committed to safe driving  However   you must choose not to drive under the influence  of alcohol  Every year thousands of people are  injured or killed in alcohol related accidents  Al   though the local laws vary on what is considered  to be legally intoxicated  the fact is that alcohol  affects all people differently and most people  underestimate the effects of alcohol     Remember  drinking and driving don   t mix  That is  true for drugs  too  over the counter  prescrip   tion  and illegal drugs   Don t drive if your ability to  operate your vehicle is impaired by alcohol   drugs  or some other physical condition     PUSH BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH    AWARNING    Do not operate the push button ignition  switch while driving the vehicle except in  an emergency   The engine will stop when  the ignition switch is pushed 3 consecu   tive times in quick succession or the igni   tion switch is pushed and held for more  than 2 seconds   If the engine stops while  the vehicle is being driven  this could lead  to a crash and serious injury                 LSD2000  When the ignition switch is pushed without de   pressing the brake pedal  the ignition switch po   sition will illuminate as follows        Push the ignition switch center       once to change to ACC       two times to change to ON       three times to return to OFF     The ignition switch will aut
268. f the Intelligent Key is within the operating range   itis possible for anyone  even someone who does  not carry the Intelligent Key  to turn the ignition  switch to start the engine     The operating range of the engine start function  is inside of the vehicle  1          The luggage area is not included in the op   erating range  but the Intelligent Key may  function       If the Intelligent Key is placed on the instru   ment panel  inside the glove box  storage bin  or door pocket  the Intelligent Key may not  function         If the Intelligent Key is placed near the door  or window outside the vehicle  the Intelligent  Key may function     PUSH BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH  POSITIONS    LOCK  Normal parking position      The ignition switch can only be locked in this  position     The ignition switch will be unlocked when it is  pushed to the ACC position while carrying the  Intelligent Key or with the Intelligent Key inserted  in the port     The ignition switch will lock when any door is  opened or closed with the ignition switched off     OFF     The ignition switch is in the OFF position when  the engine is turned off using the ignition switch   No lights will illuminate on the ignition switch     ACC  Accessories      This position activates electrical accessories   such as the radio  when the engine is not running     ACC has a battery saver feature that will turn the  ignition switch to the OFF position after 30 min   utes under the following conditions         all door
269. f time the  track has played         Album title displays the title of the CD being  played         Song title displays the title of the selected  CD track     MP3 display mode    To change the text displayed when listening to a  CD with MP8s and ID3 tags  press the  DISP CLOCK button  The DISP CLOCK button  will scroll through the CD text as follows  Disc  number  Track number and Folder number     gt   Folder title     Song title     Artist name         Album title         Disc number displays the number of the  current disc playing       Track number displays the number of the  track playing on the selected disc         Folder number displays the number of the  current folder on the MP3 CD         Folder title displays the title of the folder         Song title displays the title of the song play   ing     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 65        Artist name displays the name of the artist of  the song playing        Album title displays the title of the album of  the song playing     FM AM radio operation  FM AM band select     Pressing the AM FM button will change the band  as follows     AM     FM1     FM2     AM    When the AM FM button is pressed while the  ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position  the  radio will come on at the station last played     The last station played will also come on when  the VOL ON OFF control knob is pressed ON     If a compact disc is playing when the AM FM  button is pressed  the compact disc will aut
270. f you did not receive a Warranty Information  Booklet  or it is lost  you may obtain a replace   ment by writing to         Nissan Canada Inc   5290 Orbitor Drive  Mississauga  Ontario  L4W 4Z5    REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS    For USA    If you believe that your vehicle has a de   fect which could cause a crash or could  cause injury or death  you should immedi   ately inform the National Highway Traffic  Safety Administration  NHTSA  in addi   tion to notifying NISSAN     If NHTSA receives similar complaints  it  may open an investigation  and if it finds  that a safety defect exists in a group of  vehicles  it may order a recall and remedy  campaign  However  NHTSA cannot be   come involved in individual problems be   tween you  your dealer  or NISSAN     To contact NHTSA  you may call the Ve   hicle Safety Hotline toll free at 1 888   327 4236  TTY  1 800 424 9153   go  to http   www safercar gov  or write to   Administrator  NHTSA  400 Seventh  Street  SW   Washington  D C  20590   You can also obtain other information  about motor vehicle safety from  http   www safercar gov     You may notify NISSAN by contacting our  Consumer Affairs Department  toll free  at  1 800 NISSAN 1     For Canada    If you believe that your vehicle has a de   fect which could cause a crash or could  cause injury or death  you should immedi   ately inform Transport Canada in addition  to notifying NISSAN     If Transport Canada receives complaints   it may open an investigation  and if it finds 
271. fication label               9 10    Fog light Switch ss a sioa os oto 60848 es 2 34  Folding rearseat   2    0 2 2 2  0000  1 5  Front air bag system   See supplemental restraint system           1 44  Front Seats    31 9 cle eree e mds d 1 2  Fuel  Capacities and recommended  fuel lubric  nts    s   sx m Rz 9 2  Fueleconomy so    s s o RR 5 22  Fuel fillerdoorandcap            3 20  Fuel gauge    x sx ace eee exem 2 6  Fueloctanerating           sss 9 4  Loose fuel cap warning         2 25  3 20  F  s68   sa e e kr dom ROS x RR ya 8 22  Fusible links    nk om x RR 8 24  G  Garage door opener  HomeLink   Universal  Transcelver  s s sro o or x 2 53  Gas 68D  ios ie a wh anie x doce rer ee qe 3 20  Gauge  Engine coolant temperature gauge       2 5  Fuel gauges s emo x ems 2 6  Odometer   ccc cate o RR mex 2 4  Speedometer           a 2 4  Tachometer jcc sce domos 2 5  Trip odometer           less 2 4  General maintenance             sss  8 2  Glove box  fee xe y a 2 41  Glove boxlock  a ea oe a a 2 41  Grocery hooks    iso ee eed 2 42    H   Hands free phone system   Bluetooth                 4 4 104  4 118  Hazard warning flasher switch            6 2  Headlight and turn signal switch           2 30  Headlight control switch              2 31  Headlights 2 3 22 x onm edie baka 8 27  Heated seats    2 2      lis  2 35  2 37  Heated steering wheel               2 37  Heater   Heater and air conditioner   COnttolS   cru sias acre iced 4 42  4 45   Heater operation              4
272. find  some information that does not apply to your  vehicle     All information  specifications and illustrations in  this manual are those in effect at the time of  printing  NISSAN reserves the right to change  specifications or design without notice and with   out obligation     IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT  THIS MANUAL    You will see various symbols in this manual  They  are used in the following ways     AWARNING    This is used to indicate the presence of a  hazard that could cause death or serious  personal injury  To avoid or reduce the  risk  the procedures must be followed  precisely     ACAUTION    This is used to indicate the presence of a  hazard that could cause minor or moder   ate personal injury or damage to your ve   hicle  To avoid or reduce the risk  the pro   cedures must be followed carefully              APD1005    If you see this symbol  it means    Do not do this     or    Do not let this happen        Ve  amp     If you see a symbol similar to these in an illustra   tion  it means the arrow points to the front of the  vehicle     6S          Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these  indicate movement or action     9                Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these  call attention to an item in the illustration        CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65  WARNING    AWARNING    Engine exhaust  some of its constituents   and certain vehicle components contain  or emit chemicals known to the State of  California to cause cancer and bir
273. fore the initializa   tion completes  the display will show the mes   sage   System not ready   or a beep sounds     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 147    Before starting    To get the best performance from NISSAN Voice  Recognition  observe the following         Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as  possible  Close the windows to eliminate the  surrounding noises  traffic noises  vibration  sounds  etc    which may prevent the system  from recognizing the voice commands cor   rectly         When the climate control is in the AUTO  mode  the fan speed decreases automati   cally for easy recognition         Wait until a tone sounds before speaking a  command         Speak in a natural voice without pausing  between words           n    Y             WHA1332       8 00    Voice Recognition     Sw                                         49 Phone J    39 Navigation J     9 Information J Practice     9 Audio      4 Help J       Alternate Command Mode ON  To exit  hold the TALK switch          LHA1345       Giving voice commands    1  Press and release the         button located    on the steering wheel     4 148 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems      A list of commands appears on the screen     and the system announces   Please say a  command from the displayed list or say Help  to show all commands        After the tone sounds and the icon on the             screen changes from     to  3    speak  a command       
274. fresh air intake buttons  will flash twice  and then  the intake air will be controlled automatically     Air flow control    Pressing the MODE button manually controls air  flow and selects the air outlet     ae        Air flows from center and side  vents     174     Air flows from center and side vents  and foot outlets    s     Air flows mainly from foot outlets    32      Air flows from defroster and foot    outlets   Air flows from defroster outlets     Sy         4 46 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    To turn system off  Press the OFF button   OPERATING TIPS        When the engine coolant temperature and  outside air temperature are low  the air flow  from the foot outlets may not operate for a  maximum of 150 seconds  However  this is  not a malfunction  After the coolant tempera   ture warms up  air flow from the foot outlets  will operate normally                    LHA1136    The sunload sensor  located on the top driver s  side of the instrument panel  helps the system  maintain a constant temperature  Do not put any   thing on or around this sensor        SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER    The air conditioner system in your NISSAN ve   hicle is charged with a refrigerant designed with  the environment in mind     This refrigerant does not harm the earth   s  ozone layer     Special charging equipment and lubricant is re   quired when servicing your NISSAN air condi   tioner  Using improper refrigerants or lubricants  will cause severe dama
275. from your  face and neck  but not falling off your shoulder   Release the adjustment button to lock the shoul   der belt anchor into position     A  WARNING        After adjustment  release the adjust   ment button and try to move the shoul   der belt anchor up and down to make  sure it is securely fixed in position       The shoulder belt anchor height should  be adjusted to the position best for you   Failure to do so may reduce the effec   tiveness of the entire restraint system  and increase the chance or severity of  injury in an accident     SEAT BELT EXTENDERS    If  because of body size or driving position  it is  not possible to properly fit the lap shoulder belt  and fasten it  an extender that is compatible with  the installed seat belts is available that can be  purchased  The extender adds approximately 8 in   200 mm  of length and may be used for either  the driver or front passenger seating position   See a NISSAN dealer for assistance with pur   chasing an extender if an extender is required     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 17    AWARNING      Only NISSAN seat belt extenders  made  by the same company which made the  original equipment seat belts  should  be used with NISSAN seat belts       e Adults and children who can use the  standard seat belt should not use an  extender  Such unnecessary use could  result in serious personal injury in the  event of an accident     e Never use seat belt extenders to install  child restrai
276. g a hill  as this reduces their effec   tiveness and could cause overheating  Shift   ing the manual shift mode to M5  5th  pro   vides  engine braking  and reduces the need  to brake as frequently     If the engine coolant temperature rises to a  high temperature  refer to  If your vehicle  overheats  in the  In case of emergency   section of this owner s manual     Trailer towing requires more fuel than normal  circumstances     Avoid towing a trailer for your vehicle s first  500 miles  805 km      For the first 500 miles  805 km  that you do  tow  do not drive over 50 MPH  80 km h      Have your vehicle serviced more often than  at intervals specified in the recommended  Maintenance Schedule in the    NISSAN Ser   vice and Maintenance Guide      When making a turn  your trailer wheels will  be closer to the inside of the turn than your  vehicle wheels  To compensate for this   make a larger than normal turning radius  during the turn     Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely  affect vehicle trailer handling  possibly caus   ing vehicle sway  When being passed by  larger vehicles  be prepared for possible  changes in crosswinds that could affect ve   hicle handling     Do the following if the trailer begins to sway     1  Take your foot off the accelerator pedal to    allow the vehicle to coast and steer as  straight ahead as the road conditions allow   This combination will help stabilize the ve   hicle         Do not correct trailer sway by steering or  applying the 
277. ge to your air conditioner  system  See    Air conditioner system refrigerant  and oil recommendations    in the    Technical and  consumer information    section of this manual     ANISSAN dealer is able to service your    environ   mentally friendly    air conditioning system     AWARNING    The air conditioner system contains re   frigerant under high pressure  To avoid  personal injury  any air conditioner ser   vice should be done only by an experi   enced technician with proper equipment     AUDIO SYSTEM    RADIO    Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position and press the VOL  volume  ON OFF   power  knob to turn the radio on  If you listen to  the radio with the engine not running  the ignition  switch should be placed in the ACC position     Radio reception is affected by station signal  strength  distance from radio transmitter  build   ings  bridges  mountains and other external influ   ences  Intermittent changes in reception quality  normally are caused by these external influences     Using a cellular phone in or near the ve   hicle may influence radio reception quality     Radio reception    Your NISSAN radio system is equipped with  state of the art electronic circuits to enhance ra   dio reception  These circuits are designed to  extend reception range  and to enhance the qual   ity of that reception     However  there are some general characteristics  of both FM and AM radio signals that can affect  radio reception quality in a moving vehicle  even 
278. ght    Master warning light    T  5          Charge warning 2 11  light    Warning Name Page  light  K   Seat belt warning 2 14  T light and chime  e  Supplemental air 2 14  N bag warning light   Indicator Name P  light    age  Continuously Vari  2 14  able Transmission     CVT  indicator light    Continuously Vari   able Transmission   CVT  position indi   cator light    Cruise main switch  CRUISE indicator light  3 Front passenger air  bag status light    Indicator  light  ENGINE    ENGINE          High beam indicator 2 15  light  blue   Malfunction Indica  2 15  tor Light  MIL    2 16    Security indicator  light    Side light and head   light indicator light   green     Slip indicator light 2 16  Turn signal hazard 2 16  indicator lights    Vehicle Dynamic  Control OFF indica   tor light       Illustrated table of contents 0 9    MEMO    0 10 Illustrated table of contents    1 Safety   Seats  seat belts and  supplemental restraint system    Seats     cuscxa pde ep ecu eR e RIPE AU AS raus 1 2  Front power seat adjustment                 000  1 3  Folding rear seat  if so equipped                    1 5  Head restraints    inei rrr mers 1 7   Seat belts  dei sine vee eph RE eee eh dae rng 1 11  Precautions on seat belt usage                005 1 11  Pregnant Women    sessile edri eh e 1 14  Injured persons  si   eint meter 1 14  Three point type seat belt with retractor           1 14  Seat belt extenders                  0 cee eee eee 1 17  Seat belt maintenance          
279. ght will not be illumi   nated  but the air bag will be off   See    Front  passenger air bag and status light    later in this  section for further details  One front air bag inflat   ing does not indicate improper performance of  the system     If you have any questions about your air bag  system  please contact NISSAN or your NISSAN  dealer  If you are considering modification of your  vehicle due to a disability  you may also contact  NISSAN  Contact information is contained in the  front of this Owner s Manual     When a front air bag inflates  a fairly loud noise  may be heard  followed by the release of smoke   This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a  fire  Care should be taken to not inhale it  as it may  cause irritation and choking  Those with a history  of a breathing condition should get fresh air  promptly     Front air bags  along with the use of seat belts   help to cushion the impact force on the face and  chest of the front occupants  They can help save  lives and reduce serious injuries  However  an  inflating front air bag may cause facial abrasions  or other injuries  Front air bags do not provide  restraint to the lower body     Even with NISSAN advanced air bags  seat belts  should be correctly worn and the driver and pas   senger seated upright as far as practical away  from the steering wheel or instrument panel  The  front air bags inflate quickly in order to help  protect the front occupants  Because of this  the  force of the front air bag
280. h       Connect Bluetooth       Connected Devices       Edit Bluetooth Info          Replace Connected Phone                LHA1316       Volume  amp  Ringtone    Adjust the volume level of the ringtone  incoming  call sound and outgoing call sound  When the     Automatic Hold    option is turned on  an incom   ing call will be placed on hold automatically after  several rings  When the    Vehicle Ringtone    op   tion is turned on  a specific ringtone that is differ   ent from the cellular phone   s will sound when  receiving a call     Auto Downloaded   See    Handset Phonebook    in this section for  information about automatically downloading the  handset phonebook     4 128 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    BLUETOOTH SETTINGS    To set up the Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System to your preferred settings  press the SET   TING button on the instrument panel and select  the    Bluetooth    key on the display     Bluetooth   Turn the Bluetooth   system on or off     Connect Bluetooth   See    Connecting procedure    in this section for  more information about connecting a phone     Connected Devices   Display a list of the Bluetooth   devices con   nected to the system     Edit Bluetooth Info   Check information about the device name  device  address and device PIN     Replace Connected Phone    Replace the phone currently connected to the  system  This option allows you to keep any voic   etags that were recorded using the previous  phone    
281. h and hold the push button ignition switch  for more than 2 seconds     6 2 Incase of emergency    HAZARD WARNING FLASHER  SWITCH       P          LIC0394       Push the switch on to warn other drivers when  you must stop or park under emergency condi   tions  All turn signal lights flash     A  WARNING    e If stopping for an emergency  be sure to  move the vehicle well off the road     e Do not use the hazard warning flashers  while moving on the highway unless  unusual circumstances force you to  drive so slowly that your vehicle might  become a hazard to other traffic         Turn signals do not work when the haz   ard warning flasher lights are on     The flashers will operate with the ignition switch  placed in any position     Some state laws may prohibit the use of  the hazard warning flasher switch while  driving     FLAT TIRE    TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING  SYSTEM  TPMS     This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure  Monitoring System  TPMS   It monitors tire pres   sure of all tires except the spare  When the low  tire pressure warning light is lit  and the CHECK  TIRE PRESSURE warning appears in the vehicle  information display  one or more of your tires is  significantly under inflated  If the vehicle is being  driven with low tire pressure  the TPMS will acti   vate and warn you of it by the low tire pressure  warning light  This system will activate only when  the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH   25 km h   For more details  refer to     Warning indi
282. has an automatic engine  cooling fan  It could come on at any  time  Keep hands and other objects  away from it               ae PS CN        Cloth    Vehicle with    Cartes for di  N SN booster       K  i     wcEO054       AA WARNING    Always follow the instructions below    Failure to do so could result in damage to   the charging system and cause personal   injury    1  If the booster battery is in another vehicle   position the two vehicles to bring their bat   teries near each other     Do not allow the two vehicles to touch     2  Apply the parking brake  Move the shift se   lector to P  Park   Switch off all unnecessary  electrical systems  lights  heater  air condi   tioner  etc       3  Remove the vent caps on the battery  if so    equipped   Cover the battery with an old  cloth to reduce explosion hazard     4  Connect the jumper cables in the sequence    illustrated                    A CAUTION    e Always connect positive     to positive        and negative       to body ground  for  example  strut mounting bolt  engine  lift bracket  etc       not to the battery     e Make sure the jumper cables do not  touch moving parts in the engine com   partment and that the cable clamps do  not contact any other metal     5  Start the engine of the booster vehicle and  let it run for a few minutes     6  Keep the engine speed of the booster ve   hicle at about 2 000 rpm and start the en   gine of the vehicle being jump started     A CAUTION    Do not keep the starter motor
283. he floor  your chances  of being injured or killed in an accident and or the  severity of injury may be greatly reduced   NISSAN strongly encourages you and all of your  passengers to buckle up every time you drive   even if your seating position includes a supple   mental air bag     Most U S  states and Canadian provinces  orterritories specify that seat belts be worn  at all times when a vehicle is being driven     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    1 11             Sit upright and weil back                           27    4       1277        EN  ps    TAN     7          Ju          SSS0016       AA WARNING    e Every person who drives or rides in this  vehicle should use a seat belt at all  times  Children should be properly re   strained in the rear seat and  if appro   priate  in a child restraint     1 12 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    A WARNING        The seat belt should be properly ad   justed to a snug fit  Failure to do so may  reduce the effectiveness of the entire  restraint system and increase the  chance or severity of injury in an acci   dent  Serious injury or death can occur  if the seat belt is not worn properly                 SSS0014          AA WARNING        Always route the shoulder belt over  your shoulder and across your chest   Never put the belt behind your back   under your arm or across your neck  The  belt should be away from your face and  neck  but not falling off your shoulder    
284. he incoming or outgoing call volume  may improve the clarity  See  Call volume  in  this section     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 119    REGULATORY INFORMATION    FCC Regulatory information        CAUTION  To maintain compliance with  FCC s RF exposure guidelines  use only the  supplied antenna  Unauthorized antenna   modification  or attachments could damage  the transmitter and may violate FCC regula   tions         Operation is subject to the following two con   ditions     1  This device may not cause interference and    2  this device must accept any interference   including interference that may cause unde   sired operation of the device     IC Regulatory information        Operation is subject to the following two con   ditions   1  this device may not cause interfer   ence  and  2  this device must accept any  interference  including interference that may  cause undesired operation of the device       This Class B digital apparatus meets all re   quirements of the Canadian Interference   Causing Equipment Regulations     BLUETOOTH   is a  trademark owned by    OBluetooth  Bluetooth SIG  Inc   and licensed to  Clarion   VOICE COMMANDS    You can use voice commands to operate various  Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone System features  using the NISSAN Voice Recognition system  For  more details  see    NISSAN Voice Recognition  System    in this section     4 120 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       Settings 8 0
285. he key is se   lected  Press and hold the key to fast for   ward the chapter           4 Previous Chapter Rewind              USB  gt  settings    Select the M4 key to skip the chapter s                                                     of the disc backward  The chapters will go     Audio File Play Back  back the number of times the key is selected  Play Mode Normal  Press and hold the key to rewind the chap  10Key Search  ter  Display   List  DRG   Select the    List    key on the movie file operation   Audio                      screen to display the file list              LHA1380       Settings     Select the    Settings    key to adjust the following  settings       Audio File Playback  Switch to the audio playback mode  This    item is displayed only when the USB  memory contains audio files         Play Mode  Choose between the  Normal  or  1 Track  Repeat  play modes     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 91        10 Key Search  Select the    10 Key Search    key to open the  number entry screen  Input the number you  want to search for and the specified file or  folder will be played         Display  Adjust the image quality of the screen     e DRC  DRC  Dynamic Range Compression  auto   matically adjusts the soundtrack volume  level to maintain a more even sound to the  speakers     e Audio  Choose the preferred language of the audio     e Subtitle  Choose the preferred language of the sub   titles     e Display Mode  Choose between the
286. he previous display     Press and hold the Xt 2 OFF button for more  than two seconds to turn the display off  Press  the button again to turn the display on     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 31    IMAGE VIEWER  if so equipped     USING THE IMAGE VIEWER    When a compatible portable storage device is  plugged into the USB jack located in the center  console  compatible image files stored on the  device can be viewed on the control panel de   vice     Connecting the portable storage  device    To connect a portable storage device to the sys   tem so that images stored on it can be viewed   insert the device into the USB jack located in the  center console        Settings  gt  Image Viewer    1 XXXXXXX jpg          2 XXXXXXX jpg           8 00          3 XXXXXXX jpa       4 XXXXXXX jpg J    e Full Screen Display                            LHA1309       Viewing images    To view an image  press the SETTING button and  then select the  Image Viewer  key with the  NISSAN controller  The Image Viewer screen will  be displayed     A list of compatible images on the storage device  is displayed on the left side of the screen  while  the selected image is displayed on the right side  of the screen  To choose a different picture from  the list  use the NISSAN controller to scroll  through the list once the desired image is high   lighted     4 32 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Select the  Full Screen Display  key and pre
287. he same operations as those  for the NISSAN controller are possible using the  touch screen operation     Selecting the item     Touch an item to select  To select the    Naviga   tion    key  touch the  Navigation  key  1  on the  screen  Touch the  BACK  key  2  to return to the  previous screen     4 18 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Adjusting the item     Touch the         key  1  or the       key  2  to adjust  the settings of an item     Touch the up arrow  3  to scroll up the page one  item at a time  or touch the double up arrow   to  scroll up an entire page     Touch the down arrow  9  to scroll down the  page one item at a time  or touch the double  down arrow     to scroll down an entire page           Phone  gt  Device Name    8 00                OQO  Qoo                  66e  ee6ee   0800  8800  00O  QO     0666                            Lowercase OK          Delete Space                         LHA1230       Inputting characters   Touch the letter or number key  1      There are some options available when inputting  characters         Uppercase   Shows uppercase characters         Lowercase   Shows lowercase characters        Space   Inserts a space         Delete   Deletes the last inputted character with one  touch  Touch and hold the  Delete  key to  delete all of the characters     e OK   Completes the character input     Touch screen maintenance    If you clean the display screen  use a dry  soft  cloth  If additional cle
288. he tachometer indicates engine speed in revo   lutions per minute  rpm   Do not rev the engine  into the red zone  1     A CAUTION    When engine speed approaches the red  zone  shift to a higher gear or reduce en   gine speed  Operating the engine in the  red zone may cause serious engine  damage     ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE  GAUGE    The gauge indicates the engine coolant tempera   ture  The engine coolant temperature is within the  normal range  1  when the gauge needle points  within the zone shown in the illustration     The engine coolant temperature varies with the  outside air temperature and driving conditions     A CAUTION    If the gauge indicates coolant tempera   ture near the hot  H  end of the normal  range  reduce vehicle speed to decrease  temperature  If the gauge is over the nor   mal range  stop the vehicle as soon as  safely possible  If the engine is over   heated  continued operation of the ve   hicle may seriously damage the engine   See    If your vehicle overheats    in the    In  case of emergency  section for immediate  action required     Instruments and controls 2 5                LIC1385       FUEL GAUGE    The gauge indicates the approximate fuel level  in the tank     The gauge may move slightly during braking   turning  acceleration  or going up or down hills     The gauge needle returns to E  Empty  after the  ignition is placed in the OFF position     The low fuel warning light comes on when the  amount of fuel in the tank is getting low 
289. hift selector must be in Park  P  with  the parking brake engaged to watch movies  from a USB device         Folder List Track List    Displays the folder or track list  The    Movie  Playback    key is also displayed in this list  screen and enables you to switch to the  movie playback mode     Play Mode  Choose the preferred play mode using the  NISSAN controller or the touchscreen     4 90 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       M4 Skip                LHA1379       Movie file operation    Park the vehicle in a safe location for the  front seat occupants to operate the USB  memory while watching the images     DISC AUX button     When the DISC AUX button is pushed with the  system off and the USB memory inserted  the  system will turn on  If another audio source is  playing and the USB memory is inserted  press  the DISC AUX button repeatedly until the center  display changes to the USB memory mode     Operation keys     To operate the USB memory  select the desired  key displayed on the display screen     e  aM   Pause     Selectthe Il key to pause the movie file   To resume playing the movie file  use  the P key     De     Select the 9 key to start playing the  movie file or resume the movie file if it has  been paused      WI    Select the M     key to stop playing the  movie file         l       Next Chapter Fast Forward           Select the PPI key to skip the chapter s   of the disc forward  The chapters will ad   vance the number of times t
290. hild restraint     Follow these steps to install a rear facing child  restraint using the vehicle seat belts in the rear  seats     1  Child restraints for infants must be  used in the rear facing direction and  therefore must not be used in the front  seat  Position the child restraint on the seat   Always follow the restraint manufacturer   s  instructions           WRSO761       Rear facing     step 2    2  Route the seat belt tongue through the child    restraint and insert it into the buckle until you  hear and feel the latch engage  Be sure to  follow the child restraint manufacturer   s in   structions for belt routing        LRSO669       Rear facing   step 3    3  Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully    extended  At this time  the seat belt retractor  is in the Automatic Locking Retractor  ALR   mode  child restraint mode   It reverts to the  Emergency Locking Retractor  ELR  mode  when the seat belt is fully retracted     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 27             LRS0670       Rear facing     step 4    4  Allow the seat belt to retract  Pull up on the    shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt        WRS0762       Rear facing   step 5    5  Remove any additional slack from the seat    belt  press downward and rearward firmly in  the center of the child restraint to compress  the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while  pulling up on the seat belt     1 28 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system
291. hnical and consumer information    orange and black label with the common abbre   viation or the appropriate percentage for that  region     E 85 fuel    E 85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85  fuel  ethanol and 1596 unleaded gasoline  E 85 can  only be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle  FFV   Do  not use E 85 in your vehicle  U S  government  regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing  pumps to be identified by a small  square  orange  and black label with the common abbreviation or  the appropriate percentage for that region     Aftermarket fuel additives    NISSAN does not recommend the use of any  aftermarket fuel additives  for example  fuel injec   tor cleaner  octane booster  intake valve deposit  removers  etc   which are sold commercially   Many of these additives intended for gum  varnish  or deposit removal may contain active solvents or  similar ingredients that can be harmful to the fuel  system and engine     Octane rating tips    Using unleaded gasoline with an octane  rating lower than recommended can cause  persistent  heavy  spark knock     Spark  knock  is a metallic rapping noise   If se   vere  this can lead to engine damage  If you  detect a persistent heavy spark knock even  when using gasoline of the stated octane  rating  or if you hear steady spark knock  while holding a steady speed on level  roads  have a NISSAN dealer correct the  condition  Failure to correct the condition  is misuse of the vehicle  for which NISSAN  is not responsible     Inc
292. how Settings screen will be dis   played  The following settings can be accessed     Slideshow speed     To change the interval of time at which images are  changed during a slideshow  select the desired  interval key  The indicator light to the right of the  interval will come on to show that it is selected     If the option  No Auto Change  is chosen  the  slideshow will not change images automatically   The slideshow can then only be operated using  the manual controls     To return to the slideshow screen  select the   Back  key or press the BACK button on the  control panel     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 33       Settings  gt  Slideshow Order 8 00                Random             Order List                                  LHA1313       Slideshow order     Select the  Random  key to display the images in  a random order during a slideshow  Select the   Order List  key to display the images in the order  in which they are stored on the storage device     Select the  Back  key or press the BACK button  on the control panel to return to the slideshow  Screen     REARVIEW MONITOR  if so  equipped     When the shift selector is shifted into the R   Reverse  position  the monitor display shows a  rearward view from the vehicle     A WARNING    e The system is designed as an aid to the  driver in detecting large stationary ob   jects to help avoid damaging the ve   hicle  The system will not detect small  objects below the bumper and may not
293. however  be added up to  15           E 15 fuel contains more than 10  oxy   genate  E 15 fuel will adversely affect  the emission control devices and sys   tems of the vehicle and should not be  used  Damage caused by such fuel is  not covered by the NISSAN new ve   hicle limited warranty     Technical and consumer information 9 3        If a methanol blend is used  it should  contain no more than 5  methanol   methyl alcohol  wood alcohol   It  should also contain a suitable amount  of appropriate cosolvents and corro   sion inhibitors  If not properly formu   lated with appropriate cosolvents and  corrosion inhibitors  such methanol  blends may cause fuel system damage  and or vehicle performance problems   At this time  sufficient data is not avail   able to ensure that all methanol blends  are suitable for use in NISSAN ve   hicles     If any driveability problems such as engine stall   ing and difficult hot starting are experienced after  using oxygenate blend fuels  immediately  change to a non oxygenate fuel or a fuel with a  low blend of MTBE     Take care not to spill gasoline during refu   eling  Gasoline containing oxygenates can  cause paint damage     E 15 fuel    E 15 fuel is a mixture of approximately 15  fuel  ethanol and 85  unleaded gasoline  E 15 can  only be used in vehicles designed to run on E 15  fuel  Do not use E 15 in your vehicle  U S  gov   ernment regulations require fuel ethanol dispens   ing pumps to be identified with small  square     9 4 Tec
294. ht is off     The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the VDC  system  The 8 indicator illuminates to indi   cate the VDC system is off     When the VDC switch is used to turn off the  system  the VDC system still operates to prevent  one drive wheel from slipping by transferring  power to a non slipping drive wheel  The  indicator flashes if this occurs  All other VDC  functions are off and the ff     indicator will not  flash     The VDC system is automatically reset to on  when the ignition switch is placed in the off  position then back to the on position     The computer has a built in diagnostic feature  that tests the system each time you start the  engine and move the vehicle forward or in reverse  at a slow speed  When the self test occurs  you  may hear a clunk noise and or feel a pulsation in  the brake pedal  This is normal and is not an  indication of a malfunction     AWARNING        The VDC system is designed to help the  driver maintain stability but does not  prevent accidents due to abrupt steer   ing operation at high speeds or by care   less or dangerous driving techniques   Reduce vehicle speed and be especially  careful when driving and cornering on  slippery surfaces and always drive  carefully     e Do not modify the vehicle   s suspension   If suspension parts such as shock ab   Sorbers  struts  springs  stabilizer bars   bushings and wheels are not NISSAN  recommended for your vehicle or are  extremely deteriorated  the VDC system  may not operate pro
295. i _ Information  gt  Maintenance        000 12000 18000    Engine Oil       Oil Filter       Tire       Other Reminder          5000 12000 18000  miles                   MUL e          LHA1302                i  Information  gt  Other Reminder       o  000 12000 18000    Reset Distance       Interval    Cemie 5 8   Reminder    o ON    C 1 1  gt   C L 1      o 5000 12000 18000  miles                umma e e  SHO Oc Oro e Le          LHA1303          LHA0839       Maintenance items    Press the INFO button and select the    Mainte   nance    key using the NISSAN controller  the  maintenance information will be displayed on the  screen     Changing the maintenance interval    Select one of the Reminder keys  Engine Oil  Oil  Filter  Tire or Other Reminder  using the NISSAN  controller to display the screen to change the  maintenance interval     Select the    Interval    key using the NISSAN con   troller  Use the NISSAN controller to change the  maintenance interval  To accept the changes   press the BACK button     Resetting the maintenance interval    To reset the reminder schedule  distance  to O mi   km   select the  Reset Distance  key using the  NISSAN controller     4 8 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Displaying the maintenance notice re   minder    Select the  Interval Reminder ON  key to display  the MAINTENANCE INFORMATION automati   cally at the set maintenance interval  The indica   tor light will illuminate when it is ON     The MAINT
296. ic  correction function  If the correct direction is not  shown  follow this procedure     1  With the display turned on  press and hold    the 4  for about 10 seconds  The    C     icon in the compass display will illuminate     2  Calibrate the compass by driving the vehicle  in three complete circles at a maximum  speed of 5 MPH  8 km h      3  After completing the circles  the display  should return to normal     A CAUTION    e Do not install a ski rack  antenna  etc    which are attached to the vehicle by  means of a magnet  They affect the op   eration of the compass       When cleaning the mirror  use a paper  towel or similar material dampened  with glass cleaner  Do not spray glass  cleaner directly on the mirror as it may  cause the liquid cleaner to enter the  mirror housing     Instruments and controls 2 9    WARNING INDICATOR LIGHTS AND  AUDIBLE REMINDERS         amp     Anti lock Braking System  ABS     warning light         Brake warning light                Charge warning light    Engine oil pressure warning light    Low tire pressure warning light    Master warning light    Seat belt warning light and chime          CHECKING BULBS    With all doors closed  apply the parking brake  and place the ignition switch in the ON position  without starting the engine  The following lights  will come on     EA  ence of  D  7  BE A A    2 10 Instruments and controls    Supplemental air bag warning light    Continuously Variable Transmission  CVT   indicator light    Cont
297. ight Off Delay  Select to change the duration  of the automatic headlight off timer  After select   ing the item  turn the NISSAN controller or touch  the         or     key to change the setting  The  available delays are 0  30  45  60  90  120  150  and 180 seconds     4 28 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Speed Sensing Wiper Interval  Select to turn  on orturn off the wiper interval adjusted automati   cally according to the vehicle speed     Selective Door Unlock  When this item is  turned on  only the driver s door is unlocked first  after the door unlock operation  When the door  handle request switch on the driver s or front  passenger s side door is pushed to be unlocked   only the corresponding door is unlocked first  All  the doors can be unlocked if the door unlock  operation is performed again within one minute     When this item is turned to off  all the doors will  be unlocked after the door unlock operation is  performed once     Intelligent Key Lock   Unlock  Select to turn  on or turn off the door lock unlock function by  pushing the door handle request switch     Lift Steering Wheel on Exit  Select to turn on  or turn off the steering wheel moving upward for  easy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFF  position and the driver s door is opened  After  getting into the vehicle and placing the ignition  switch in the ACC position  the steering wheel  moves to the previous position     Slide Driver Seat Back on Exit  Select t
298. ight specification shown in  the  Towing load specification  chart even if the  calculated available tongue weight is greater  than 15   If the calculated tongue weight is less  than 1096   reduce the total trailer weight to  match the available tongue weight     Always verify that available capacities are within  the required ratings     TOWING LOAD SPECIFICATION    TOWING LOAD   SPECIFICATION  UNIT  Ib  kg     LOAD  1 1 000  454   MAXIMUM TONGUE  LOAD 100  45      1  The towing capacity values are calculated  assuming a base vehicle with driver and any  options required to achieve the rating  Additional  passengers  cargo and or optional equipment  will add weight to the vehicle and reduce your  vehicle s maximum towing capacity     TOWING SAFETY  Trailer hitch    Choose a proper hitch for your vehicle and trailer   Make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached to  the vehicle  to help avoid personal injury or prop   erty damage due to sway caused by crosswinds   rough road surfaces or passing trucks     MAXIMUM TOWING       A  WARNING    Trailer hitch components have specific  weight ratings  Your vehicle may be ca   pable of towing a trailer heavier than the  weight rating of the hitch components   Never exceed the weight rating of the  hitch components  Doing so can cause  serious personal injury or property  damage     Hitch ball    Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and weight  rating for your trailer         The required hitch ball size is stamped on  most trai
299. igits  C    Dial   D     1  Press the F    wheel  A tone will sound        button on the steering    2  Say   Call     The system acknowledges  the command and announces the next set of  available commands     3  Say  Phone Number   B   The system ac   knowledges the command and announces  the next set of available commands     Say   Special Number  to dial more than 10  digits or any special characters     4  Saythe number you wish to call starting with  the area code in single digit format  C   If the  system has trouble recognizing the correct  phone number  try entering the number in  the following groups  3 digit area code   3 digit prefix and the last 4 digits  For ex   ample  555 121 3354 can be said as  five  five five  as the 1st group  then  one two  one  as the 2nd group  and  three three five    4 110 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    four  as the 3rd group  For dialing more than  10 digits or any special characters  say   Special Number   See  How to say num   bers    in this section for more information     5  When you have finished speaking the phone  number  the system repeats it back and an   nounces the available commands     6  Say   Dial   D   The system acknowledges  the command and makes the call     For additional command options  see  List of  voice commands  in this section     Receiving a call    When you hear the ring tone  press the    button on the steering wheel     Once the call has ended  press the      button  on 
300. il type is used and main   tenance intervals are followed     Oil which may contain foreign matter or has been  previously used should not be used     Oil viscosity    The engine oil viscosity or thickness changes  with temperature  Because of this  it is important  to select the engine oil viscosity based on the  temperatures at which the vehicle will be oper   ated before the next oil change  Choosing an oil  viscosity other than that recommended could  cause serious engine damage     Selecting the correct oil filter    Your new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with a  high quality genuine NISSAN oil filter  When re   placing  use a genuine NISSAN oil filter or its  equivalent for the reason described in    Change  intervals        Change intervals    The oil and oil filter change intervals for your  engine are based on the use of the specified  quality oils and filters  Using engine oil and filters  that are not of the specified quality  or exceeding  recommended oil and filter change intervals  could reduce engine life  Damage to the engine  caused by improper maintenance or use of incor   rect oil and filter quality and or viscosity is not  covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited war   ranty     Technical and consumer information 9 5    Your engine was filled with a high quality engine  oil when it was built  You do not have to change  the oil before the first recommended change  interval  Oil and filter change intervals depend  upon how you use your vehicle     Operation un
301. ile the vehicle  is in motion or while the moonroof is  closing     A CAUTION    e Remove water drops  snow  ice or sand  from the moonroof before opening         Do not place heavy objects on the  moonroof or surrounding area     Sunshade    Open and close the sunshade by sliding it for   ward or backward     If the moonroof does not close    Have your NISSAN dealer check and repair the  moonroof     DUAL PANEL MOONROOF  if so  equipped                       a   1  OPEN       A  PUSH     tir     SZ  C   2 CLOSE       LIC1411  AUTOMATIC MOONROOF    The moonroof will only operate when the ignition  switch is in the ON position  The automatic  moonroof is operational for a period of time  even  if the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or OFF  position  If the driver s door or the front passen   ger s door is opened during this period of time   the power to the moonroof is canceled     Instruments and controls 2 47    Sliding the moonroof  To slide the moonroof       To fully open the moonroof  push the switch     toward the open position until it reaches  the second detent  If the switch   is  pushed to the first detent  only the sunshade  will open       To fully close the moonroof  push the switch     toward the close position until it reaches  the second detent  If the switch  2  is  pushed to the first detent  the moonroof will  close but the sunshade will remain open         To open or close the moonroof part way   release the switch  1  or  2  while the moon   roof is 
302. ile warming it  up    e Do not push or tow your vehicle to start  the engine     TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING  SYSTEM  TPMS     Each tire  including the spare  if provided    should be checked monthly when cold and in   flated to the inflation pressure recommended by  the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard  or tire inflation pressure label   If your vehicle has  tires of a different size than the size indicated on  the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label   you should determine the proper tire inflation  pressure for those tires      As an added safety feature  your vehicle has been  equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system   TPMS  that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale  when one or more of your tires is significantly  under inflated  Accordingly  when the low tire  pressure telltale illuminates  you should stop and  check your tires as soon as possible  and inflate  them to the proper pressure  Driving on a signifi   cantly under inflated tire causes the tire to over   heat and can lead to tire failure  Under inflation  also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life  and  may affect the vehicle   s handling and stopping  ability     Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for  proper tire maintenance  and it is the driver s  responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure   even if under inflation has not reached the level to  trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure  telltale     Your vehicle has also been equipped with a  T
303. in this section  and    Tire Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS      in the    Starting and driving    section     Tire pressure warning    This screen will show the actual pressure of each  tire  Any low tire pressure will be highlighted  The  screen does not indicate which pressure corre   sponds with which tire     The numbers do not automatically update after  tire pressure is adjusted  After the tire is inflated  to the recommended pressure  the vehicle must  be driven at speeds above 16 MPH  25 km h  to  update the numbers  Refer to    Tire Pressure  Monitoring System    in the    Starting and driving     section     Instruments and controls 2 25    SECURITY SYSTEMS                LICO301       Your vehicle has two types of security systems       Vehicle security system      NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System    VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM    The vehicle security system provides visual and  audible alarm signals if someone opens the doors  or trunk lid when the system is armed  It is not   however  a motion detection type system that  activates when a vehicle is moved or when a  vibration occurs     The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannot  prevent it  nor can it prevent the theft of interior or  exterior vehicle components in all situations  Al     2 26 Instruments and controls    ways secure your vehicle even if parking for a  brief period  Never leave your Intelligent Key in  the vehicle  and always lock the vehicle when  unattended  Be aware of your surroundings  an
304. inema  mode     Title List  DVD VR   Choose the preferred title from the list     Play Mode  Choose the preferred play mode     PG PL Mode  DVD VR   Choose from the  PG  or  PL  mode              LHA2030          USB INTERFACE  models without  Navigation System   if so equipped     Connecting a device to the USB input  jack    A CAUTION    e Depending on size and shape of USB  device  the console lid may not fully  close  Do not force console lid closed  as this may damage USB device     e Do not force the USB device into the  USB port  Inserting the USB device  tilted or up side down into the port may  damage the USB device and the port   Make sure that the USB device is con   nected correctly into the USB port    Some USB devices come with a Y  mark as a guide  Make sure that the  mark is facing the correct direction be   fore inserting the device          Do not locate objects near the USB de   vice to prevent the objects from leaning  on the USB device and the port  Pres   sure from the objects may damage the  USB device and the port     The USB input jack is located in the center con   sole  Insert the USB device into the jack  1      When a compatible storage device is plugged  into the jack  compatible audio files on the stor   age device can be played through the vehicle s  audio system     Audio file operation  AUX button     Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC  position and press the AUX button to switch to  the USB input mode  If another audio source is  pla
305. ing  knob     To manually tune the radio  turn the  TUNE FOLDER knob to the right or left     4 78 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       SEEK CAT and TRACK  tuning buttons         l       Ha          For AM or FM    Press the SEEK CAT M4 button or the  TRACK P button to tune from high to low or  low to high frequencies and stop at the next  broadcasting station     For XM   Press the SEEK CAT M4 button or the    TRACK Pi button to go to the first channel of  the previous or next category     SCAN tuning     Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad   casting station for 5 seconds  Pressing the  SCAN button again during this five second pe   riod will stop scan tuning and the radio will remain  tuned to that station  If the SCAN button is not  pressed within 5 seconds  scan tuning moves to  the next station     1 to 6 Station memory operations     Six stations can be set for the AM band  Twelve  stations can be set for the FM band  6 for FM1  6  for FM2   Eighteen channels can be set for the  SAT radio  6 for XM1  6 for XM2  6 for XM3   if so  equipped      1  Choose the radio band AM  FM1 or FM2  using the FM AM select button  or choose  the satellite band XM1  XM2 or XM3 using  the SAT button     2  Tune to the desired station using manual   SEEK or SCAN tuning  Press and hold any  of the desired station memory buttons  1      6  until the preset number is updated on the  display and the sound is briefly muted     3  The channel indicator will 
306. ing and  starting      Winter Warm Up        Limit idling time to minimize impact to fuel  economy        Vehicles typicaly need no more than  30 seconds of idling at start up to effec   tively circulate the engine oil before driv   ing        Your vehicle will reach its ideal operating  temperature more quickly while driving  versus idling    5 22 Starting and driving    10  Keeping your Vehicle Cool        Park your vehicle in a covered parking  area or in the shade whenever possible        When entering a hot vehicle  opening the  windows will help to reduce the inside  temperature faster  resulting in reduced  demand on your A C system    INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY    Keep your engine tuned up     Follow the recommended scheduled main   tenance     Keep the tires inflated to the correct pres   sure  Low tire pressure increases tire wear  and lowers fuel economy     Keep the wheels in correct alignment  Im   proper alignment increases tire wear and  lowers fuel economy     Use the recommended viscosity engine oil   See  Engine oil and oil filter recommenda   tions  in  Technical and consumer informa   tion  in this manual     PARKING PARKING ON HILLS       Cs  BS     m                           WSD0050  AWARNING e Never leave the engine running while     Do not stop or park the vehicle over MOS UE  flammable materials such as dry grass  e Do not leave children unattended inside  waste paper or rags  They may ignite the vehicle  They could unknowingly ac   and cause a fire  ti
307. ing distances on  slippery roads     Watch for slippery spots  glare ice    These may appear on an otherwise  clear road in shaded areas  If a patch of  ice is seen ahead  brake before reach   ing it  Try not to brake while on the ice   and avoid any sudden steering  maneuvers     Do not use the cruise control on slip   pery roads     Snow can trap dangerous exhaust  gases under your vehicle  Keep snow  clear of the exhaust pipe and from  around your vehicle     ENGINE BLOCK HEATER  if so  equipped     Engine block heaters are used to assist with cold  temperature starting     The engine block heater should be used when  the outside temperature is 20  F   7  C  or lower     AWARNING    e Do not use your engine block heater  with an ungrounded electrical system  or a 2 pronged adapter  You can be se   riously injured by an electrical shock if  you use an ungrounded connection     e Disconnect and properly store the en   gine block heater cord before starting  the engine  Damage to the cord could  result in an electrical shock and can  cause serious injury         Use a heavy duty 3 wire  3 pronged ex   tension cord rated for at least 10 A  Plug  the extension cord into a Ground Fault  Interrupt  GFI  protected  grounded  110 VAC outlet  Failure to use the  proper extension cord or a grounded  outlet can result in a fire or electrical  shock and cause serious personal  injury     To use the engine block heater     is  2     Turn the engine off     Open the hood and unwrap the e
308. ing procedure  in this  section for more information      Select Phone     Use the Select Phone command to select from a  list of phones connected to the vehicle  The sys   tem will list the names assigned to each phone  and then prompt you for the phone you wish to  select  Only one phone can be active at a time        Delete Phone          Use the Delete Phone command to delete a  phone that is connected to the vehicle  The sys   tem will list the names assigned to each phone  and then prompt you for the phone you wish to  delete  Deleting a phone from the vehicle will also  delete that phonebook for that phone        Turn Bluetooth OFF     D     Use the Turn Bluetooth OFF command to prevent  a wireless connection to your phone     VOICE ADAPTATION  VA  MODE    Voice Adaptation allows up to two out of dialect  users to train the system to improve recognition  accuracy  By repeating a number of commands   the users can create a voice model of their own  voice that is stored in the system  The system is  capable of storing a different voice adaptation  model for each connected phone     Training procedure  The procedure for training a voice is as follows     1  Position the vehicle in a reasonably quiet  outdoor location     2  Sit in the driver s seat with the engine run   ning  the parking brake on  and the transmis   sion in P  Park        Press and hold the   lt       The system announces     button for more  than 5 seconds        Press the  PHONE SEND  X   button for the
309. ing the seat belt with a suitable tool   such as a knife or scissors  to release the  seat belt     Children need adults to help protect them   They need to be properly restrained     In addition to the general information in this  manual  child safety information is available from  many other sources  including doctors  teachers   government traffic safety offices  and community  organizations  Every child is different  so be sure  to learn the best way to transport your child     There are three basic types of child restraint  systems         Rear facing child restraint      Forward facing child restraint      Booster seat    The proper restraint depends on the child s size   Generally  infants up to about 1 year and less  than 20 Ibs  9 kg  should be placed in rear facing  child restraints  Forward facing child restraints  are available for children who outgrow rear   facing child restraints and are at least 1 year old   Booster seats are used to help position a vehicle  lap shoulder belt on a child who can no longer  use a forward facing child restraint     AA WARNING    Infants and children need special protec   tion  The vehicle s seat belts may not fit  them properly  The shoulder belt may  come too close to the face or neck  The  lap belt may not fit over their small hip  bones  In an accident  an improperly fit   ting seat belt could cause serious or fatal  injury  Always use appropriate child  restraints     All U S  states and Canadian provinces or terri   tories r
310. inuously Variable Transmission  CVT   position indicator light       Cruise main switch indicator light    CRUISE    eos    f  OF      Front passenger air bag status light          High beam indicator light  blue     ENGINE   Malfunction Indicator Light  MIL   SOON       If equipped  the following lights come on briefly  and then go off     ABS    rQ  26 A 8 oTt OO       Security indicator light    Side light and headlight indicator light  green     Slip indicator light    Turn signal hazard indicator lights    Vehicle Dynamic Control OFF indicator light          If any light fails to come on  it may indicate  a burned out bulb or an open circuit in the  electrical system  Have the system repaired  promptly     WARNING LIGHTS    For additional information on warnings and indi   cators  see  Vehicle information display  later in  this section        ABS               amp     Anti lock Braking  System  ABS     warning light       When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  the Anti lock Braking System  ABS   warning light illuminates and then turns off  This  indicates the ABS is operational     If the ABS warning light illuminates while the  engine is running or while driving  it may indicate  the ABS is not functioning properly  Have the  system checked by a NISSAN dealer     If an ABS malfunction occurs  the anti lock func   tion is turned off  The brake system then operates  normally  but without anti lock assistance  See   Brake system  in the  Starting and dri
311. ion   The side air bag and curtain air bags will deflate  quickly after the collision is over     The side air bags and curtain air bags op   erate only when the ignition switch is  placed in the ON or START position     After placing the ignition switch in the ON  position  the supplemental air bag warning  light illuminates  The supplemental air bag  warning light will turn off after about 7 sec   onds if the system is operational     A  WARNING    e Do not place any objects near the seat   back of the front seats  Also  do not  place any objects  an umbrella  bag   etc   between the front door finisher  and the front seat  Such objects may  become dangerous projectiles and  cause injury if a side air bag inflates     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 49    e Right after inflation  several side air bag  and curtain air bag system components  will be hot  Do not touch them  you may  severely burn yourself         No unauthorized changes should be  made to any components or wiring of  the side air bag and curtain air bag  systems  This is to prevent damage to or  accidental inflation of the side air bag  and curtain air bag or damage to the  side air bag and curtain air bag systems     e Do not make unauthorized changes to  your vehicle s electrical system  sus   pension system or side panel  This  could affect proper operation of the  side air bag and curtain air bag system     e Tampering with the side air bag system  may result in serious perso
312. ion intervals should  be followed  For more information regarding  brake inspections  see the appropriate mainte   nance schedule information in the    NISSAN Ser   vice and Maintenance Guide      Maintenance and do it yourself 8 21    FUSES                      2  6                    i                   LDI0455                                                                   LDI0457             LDIO560       Two types of fuses are used  Type    is used in  the fuse boxes in the engine compartment  Type  is used in the passenger compartment fuse  box     Type A fuses are provided as spare fuses  They  are stored in the passenger compartment fuse  box     Type A fuses can be installed in the engine com   partment and passenger compartment fuse  boxes     8 22 Maintenance and do it yourself             If a type A fuse is used to replace a type B fuse   the type A fuse will not be level with the fuse  pocket as shown in the illustration  This will not  affect the performance of the fuse  Make sure the  fuse is installed in the fuse box securely     Type B fuses cannot be installed in the under   hood fuse boxes  Only use type A fuses in the  underhood fuse boxes     ENGINE COMPARTMENT    A CAUTION    Never use a fuse of a higher or lower  amperage rating than specified on the  fuse box cover  This could damage the  electrical system or cause a fire     If any electrical equipment does not come on   check for an open fuse     1  Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight  s
313. ise control system malfunctions  it  cancels automatically     A  WARNING    Do not use the cruise control when driving  under the following conditions       When it is not possible to keep the  vehicle at a set speed       In heavy traffic or in traffic that varies in  speed       On winding or hilly roads       On slippery roads  rain  snow  ice  etc       In very windy areas     Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle  control and result in an accident     CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS    The cruise control allows driving at a speed be   tween 25   89 MPH  40   144 km h  without  keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal     To turn on the cruise control  push the  ON OFF switch on  The CRUISE indicator light in  the instrument panel will illuminate     Starting and driving 5 19    To set cruising speed  accelerate the vehicle to  the desired speed  push the COAST SET switch  and release it  Take your foot off the accelerator  pedal  Your vehicle maintains the set speed         To pass another vehicle  depress the ac   celerator pedal  When you release the  pedal  the vehicle returns to the previously  set speed      The vehicle may not maintain the set speed  when going up or down steep hills  If this  happens  drive without the cruise control     To cancel the preset speed  use one of the  following three methods         Push the CANCEL button       Tap the brake pedal         Push the ON OFF switch off  The CRUISE  indicator light in the instrument panel goes  out     The c
314. isplay reappears   If the control knob is not pressed for approxi   mately 10 seconds  the radio or CD display will  automatically reappear        8 00    Settings       Up        Audio    Display       Switch Beeps    Camera       Clock        humanam S             Adjust tone  amp  advanced audio settings          LHA1304                Settings  gt  Audio 8 0  zm Cz Cx     Tee COMO     Baance COM CO l   E Cr MM CE                 Corr     Speed Sensitive Vol                    LHA1314       Speed Sensitive Volume  SSV      To change the SSV mode from OFF to 5  press  the SETTING button  Then select the    Audio    key  using the NISSAN controller  the audio settings  screen will be displayed  Select the       key or          key to change the SSV     While in this screen you can also adjust the other  audio settings by selecting the corresponding  key     Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the  desired level  press the BACK button     4 70 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    For information on how to use the NISSAN con   troller  see    How to use the NISSAN controller    in  this section     Clock operation    For additional information on setting the clock   see    Adjusting the time    in this section           1 I Root Folder  2 Em xxxxx       AXXXXXXX    3B xxxxxx       0 28    4 EE xxxxxx       5  E xxxxxx  1 DISC RPT MP3             minm CEE rre per    6 Bm xxxxxx                WHA0949       CD    Text  poc UU    XXXXXXX  Xxxxxx
315. itch in the OFF or  LOCK position and wait approximately  10 seconds     3  Repeat steps 1 and 2     4  Restart the engine while holding the device   which may have caused the interference   separate from the registered key     If the no start condition re occurs  NISSAN rec   ommends placing the registered key on a sepa   rate key ring to avoid interference from other  devices     FCC Notice   For USA     This device complies with part 15 of the  FCC Rules  Operation is subject to the fol   lowing two conditions   1  This device may  not cause harmful interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference re   ceived  including interference that may  cause undesired operation of the device     NOTE     Changes or modifications not expressly ap   proved by the party responsible for compli   ance could void the user s authority to op   erate the equipment     For Canada     This device complies with RSS 210 of In   dustry Canada  Operation is subject to the  following two conditions   1  This device  may not cause harmful interference  and  2   this device must accept any interference  received  including interference that may  cause undesired operation of the device     Instruments and controls 2 27    WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER  SWITCH             LIC0474             WIC1434       Security indicator light    The security indicator light blinks whenever the  ignition switch is placed in the OFF  LOCK or ACC  position  This function indicates the NISSAN Ve   hicle Im
316. ith which your vehicle is equipped     READ FIRST   THEN DRIVE SAFELY    Before driving your vehicle  please read this  Owner s Manual carefully  This will ensure famil   iarity with controls and maintenance require   ments  assisting you in the safe operation of your  vehicle     AWARNING    IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION RE   MINDERS FOR SAFETY     Follow these important driving rules to  help ensure a safe and comfortable trip  for you and your passengers     e NEVER drive under the influence of al   cohol or drugs         ALWAYS observe posted speed limits  and never drive too fast for conditions     e ALWAYS give your full attention to driving  and avoid using vehicle features or taking  other actions that could distract you     e ALWAYS use your seat belts and appro   priate child restraint systems  Preteen  children should be seated in the rear seat     e ALWAYS provide information about the  proper use of vehicle safety features to  all occupants of the vehicle     e ALWAYS review this Owner s Manual  for important safety information     MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE    This vehicle should not be modified   Modification could affect its    performance  safety or durability  and    may even violate governmental  regulations  In addition  damage or per   formance problems resulting from modi   fications may not be covered under  NISSAN warranties        WHEN READING THE MANUAL    This manual includes information for all options  available on this model  Therefore  you may 
317. ition switch while depressing  the brake pedal with the ignition switch in  any position          f the engine is very hard to start in ex   tremely cold weather or when restarting   depress the accelerator pedal a little  ap   proximately 1 3 to the floor  and while  holding  crank the engine  Release the  accelerator pedal when the engine starts        f the engine is very hard to start because  it is flooded  depress the accelerator  pedal all the way to the floor and hold it   Push the ignition switch to the ON posi   tion to start cranking the engine  After 5 or  6 seconds  stop cranking by pushing the  ignition switch to LOCK  After cranking  the engine  release the accelerator pedal   Crank the engine with your foot off the    accelerator pedal by depressing the  brake pedal and pushing the push button  ignition switch to start the engine  If the  engine starts  but fails to run  repeat the  above procedure     A CAUTION    Do not operate the starter for more than  15 seconds at a time  If the engine does  not start  push the ignition switch to the  OFF position and wait 10 seconds before  cranking again  otherwise the starter  could be damaged     4  Warm up    Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 sec   onds after starting  Do not race the engine  while warming it up  Drive at moderate  speed for a short distance first  especially in  cold weather  In cold weather  keep the en   gine running for a minimum of 2   3 minutes  before shutting it off  Starting and stop
318. itioner cooling function op   erates only when the engine is running       Do notleave children or adults who would  normally require the assistance of others  alone in your vehicle  Pets should also not  be left alone  They could accidentally in   jure themselves or others through inad   vertent operation of the vehicle  Also  on  hot  sunny days  temperatures in a closed  vehicle could quickly become high  enough to cause severe or possibly fatal  injuries to people or animals       Do not use the recirculation mode for  long periods as it may cause the interior  air to become stale and the windows to  fog up     Start the engine and operate the controls to  activate the air conditioner     AUTOMATIC OPERATION    Cooling and or dehumidified heating   AUTO     This mode may be used all year round as the  system automatically works to keep a constant  temperature  Air flow distribution and fan speed  are also controlled automatically       Press the AUTO button on   The indicator on    the button will illuminate and AUTO will be  displayed        Operate the driver s side temperature con     trol buttons     Adjust the temperature display to about  75  F  24  C  for normal operation     The temperature of the passenger compart   ment will be maintained automatically  Air  flow distribution and fan speed are also con   trolled automatically     A visible mist may be seen coming from the  ventilators in hot  humid conditions as the air  is cooled rapidly  This does not indicate
319. king System  ABS  warning  indicator    When the parking brake is released and the  brake fluid level is sufficient  if both the brake  warning light and the Anti lock Braking System   ABS  warning light illuminate  it may indicate the  ABS is not functioning properly  Have the brake  system checked  and if necessary  repaired by a  NISSAN dealer promptly  Avoid high speed driv   ing and abrupt braking   See  Anti lock Braking  System  ABS  warning light  in this section        Charge warning light             If this light comes on while the engine is running   it may indicate the charging system is not func   tioning properly  Turn the engine off and check  the generator belt  If the belt is loose  broken   missing  or if the light remains on  see a NISSAN  dealer immediately     Instruments and controls 2 11    A CAUTION      Do not ground electrical accessories  directly to the battery terminal  Doing  so will bypass the variable control sys   tem and the vehicle battery may not  charge completely  Refer to    Variable  voltage control system  if so equipped     in the    Maintenance and do it   yourself  section later in this manual       Do not continue driving if the generator  belt is loose  broken or missing    5    Engine oil pressure warning           light       This light warns of low engine oil pressure  If the  light flickers or comes on during normal driving   pull off the road in a safe area  stop the engine  immediately and call    NISSAN dealer or other  au
320. l 3 ft  1 0 m  distance on    the hill is the place  B   Note that any object on  the hill is closer than it appears on the monitor     4 38 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems                         LHA1201  Backing up near a projecting object       The predicted course lines   amp   do not touch the  object in the display  However  the vehicle may hit  the object if it projects over the actual backing up  course                       WHA1506       Backing up behind a projecting object    The position    is shown farther than the position  in the display  However  the position    is  actually at the same distance as the position      The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to    the position    if the object projects over the  actual backing up course     HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN    To adjust the Display ON OFF  Brightness  Tint   Color  Contrast and Black Level of the RearView  Monitor  press the SETTING button with the  RearView Monitor on and select the    Display     key  Select one of the items and change the value  by touching the         or     key or by turning the  NISSAN controller     Do not adjust the Brightness  Tint  Color  Con   trast and Black Level of the RearView Monitor  while the vehicle is moving  Make sure the park   ing brake is firmly applied     OPERATING TIPS    A CAUTION    e Do not use alcohol  benzine or thinner  to clean the camera  This will cause  discoloration  To clean the camera   wipe with a cloth dampened 
321. l child  restraint anchor system  referred to as the LATCH   Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren  sys   tem  Some child restraints include rigid or  webbing mounted attachments that can be con   nected to these anchors  For details  see    LATCH   Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren  sys   tem    later in this section     If you do not have a LATCH compatible child  restraint  the vehicle seat belts can be used     Several manufacturers offer child restraints for  infants and children of various sizes  When se   lecting any child restraint  keep the following  points in mind         Choose only a restraint with a label certifying  that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle  Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor  Vehicle Safety Standard 213         Check the child restraint in your vehicle to be  sure it is compatible with the vehicle   s seat  and seat belt system         Ifthe child restraint is compatible with your  vehicle  place your child in the child restraint  and check the various adjustments to be  sure the child restraint is compatible with  your child  Choose a child restraint that is  designed for your child   s height and weight   Always follow all recommended procedures     1 21    All U S  states and Canadian provinces or  territories require that infants and small  children be restrained in an approved child  restraint at all times while the vehicle is  being operated  Canadian law requires the  top tether strap on forward facing child  restraints be se
322. l filler cap is loose or missing  or if  the vehicle runs out of fuel  Check to make sure  the fuel filler cap is installed and closed tightly   and that the vehicle has at least 3 gallons  11 4 li   ters  of fuel in the fuel tank     RVICE    After a few driving trips  the  8M  light should  turn off if no other potential emission control  system malfunction exists     If this indicator light comes on steady for 20 sec   onds and then blinks for 10 seconds when the  engine is not running  it indicates that the vehicle  is not ready for an emission control system  inspection maintenance test  See  Readiness for  inspection maintenance  I M  test  in the    Tech   nical and consumer information  section of this  manual     Operation    The malfunction indicator light will come on in  one of two ways     e Malfunction indicator light on steady     An  emission control system and or CVT mal   function has been detected  Check the fuel   filler cap if the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning  appears in the vehicle information display  If  the fuel filler cap is loose or missing  tighten  or install the cap and continue to drive the    vehicle  The  iF light should turn off after  a few driving trips  If the 9 light does not  turn off after a few driving trips  have the  vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer  You  do not need to have your vehicle towed to  the dealer       Malfunction indicator light blinking     An en   gine misfire has been detected which may  damage the emission control syst
323. l jewelry     Battery posts  terminals and related ac   cessories contain lead and lead com   pounds  Wash hands after handling         Keep battery out of the reach of    children       Do not tip the battery  Keep the vent    caps tight and the battery level     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 15          WDIO0224          1  Remove the vent caps with a screwdriver as  shown  Use a cloth to protect the battery  case     8 16 Maintenance and do it yourself             WDIO0529       2  Check the fluid level in each cell  If it is  necessary to add fluid  add only distilled  water to bring the level up to the bottom of  the filler opening  Do not overfill  Reinstall  the vent caps     Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under  severe conditions require frequent checks of the  battery fluid level     JUMP STARTING    If jump starting is necessary  see    Jump starting     in the    In case of emergency    section of this  manual  If the engine does not start by jump  starting  the battery may have to be replaced   Contact a NISSAN dealer     VARIABLE VOLTAGE CONTROL  SYSTEM             LDI0694          A CAUTION    e Do not ground accessories directly to  the battery terminal  Doing so will by   pass the variable voltage control sys   tem and the vehicle battery may not  charge completely     e Use electrical accessories with the en   gine running to avoid discharging the  vehicle battery     Your vehicle is equipped with a variable voltage  control system  This system 
324. l lubricants            llle  9 2  Changing engineoil            s  8 11  Changing engine oil filter                 8 12  Checking engine oillevel           8 10  Engine oil  s soa zzz nr RR 8 10  Engine oil and oil filter recommendation     9 5  Engine oil viscosity                9 5  Outside mirror control               ss  3 27  Outside mirrors          lens 3 27  Overheat  If your vehicle overheats               6 10  Owner s manual order form             9 27  Owner s manual service manual order  Term ruo REPE  9 27  P  Parking  Parking brake operation             5 18  Parking parking on hills               5 23  Phone  Bluetooth   hands free  System      oie Ye ee any o oS GS 4 104  4 118  Power  Power door locks              4 4 3 5    Power outlet           llle 2 38    Power rear windows               2 44  Power steering fluid               8 13  Power steering system             5 24  Power windows          sess 2 43  Rear power windows              2 44  Precautions  Maintenance precautions             8 5  Precautions on child  restraints             1 20  1 26  1 30  1 34  Precautions on seat belt usage           1 11  Precautions on supplemental restraint  SYSTEM   i a m m oko Bu RR OR RR 1 37  Precautions when starting and driving       5 2  Programmable features            4 9  4 24  Pushistarting s 2 454 420 wae Wak eae ee ed 6 10  R  Radio  Car phone or CB radio            4 104  Compact Disc  CD  changer          4 66  FM AM radio with compact disc   CD
325. layed immediately  When  the vehicle is driven  the pressures will automati   cally be displayed     In case of a low tire pressure  a warning message  will also appear in the vehicle information display   See    Check tire pressure warning    later in this  section     Instruments and controls 2 19       OUTSIDE TEMP  71           LIC2176    SETTING   gt SKIP     gt MAINTENANCE   gt ALERT  gt OPTIONS    IaENTER  NEXT       LIC1541       ALERT    SBACK as TO REST   gt ICY    ENTER        NEXT          LIC1044       Exterior temperature mode    The exterior temperature mode can be selected  to provide you with the temperature outside of  your vehicle     2 20 Instruments and controls    Setting mode    The setting mode allows you to set reminders or  preferences for alerts  maintenance intervals or  language displays     In the setting mode screen press O  to     to move        Alert      Maintenance        Options                and press to select the menu     Alert mode    The alert mode allows you to set alerts notifying  you of time to rest or icy conditions     The time to rest alert lets you know when you    have been traveling for a long time and may need  a break     The icy alert notifies you that icy driving condi   tions may exist        XXXX    Bed                      gt SETTING  GAENTER     gt RESET   NEXT          LIC1046    MAINTENANCE   gt TIRE     gt OIL  gt FILTER  ENTER     gt OTHER  NEXT             LIC2177    OPTIONS    SBACK  gt LANGUAGE   gt UNIT  gt E
326. ld cause a  malfunction         Hold the battery by the edges  Holding  the battery across the contact points will  seriously deplete the storage capacity         Make sure that the   side faces the bot   tom of the case     8 26 Maintenance and do it yourself                LDI2001    tA    WDIO568                   4  Close the lid securely as illustrated  C   D    5  Operate the buttons to check the operation     See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for  replacement     FCC Notice     For USA    This device complies with Part 15 of the  FCC Rules  Operation is subject to the fol   lowing two conditions   1  This device may  not cause harmful interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference re   ceived  including interference that may  cause undesired operation  Note  Changes    or modifications not expressly approved by  the party responsible for compliance could  void the user   s authority to operate the  equipment     For Canada    This device complies with RSS 210 of In   dustry Canada  Operation is subject to the  following two conditions   1  this device  may not cause interference  and  2  this  device must accept any interference  in   cluding interference that may cause unde   sired operation of the device     LIGHTS    HEADLIGHTS  Replacing the xenon headlight bulb  if  so equipped     A WARNING   NHIGH VOLTAGE    When xenon headlights are on  they pro   duce a high voltage  To prevent an electric  shock  never attempt to modify or disas   se
327. ld not be  modified or disconnected  Unauthor   ized electrical test equipment and prob   ing devices should not be used on the  air bag system       e A cracked windshield should be re   placed immediately by a qualified re   pair facility  A cracked windshield could  affect the function of the supplemental  air bag system      The SRS wiring harness connectors are  yellow and orange for easy identification     When selling your vehicle  we request that you  inform the buyer about the front air bag system  and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections  in this Owner s Manual               ur  IE          LRS0259       Front seat mounted side impact  supplemental air bag and roof   mounted curtain side impact  supplemental air bag systems    The side air bags are located in the outside of the  seatback of the front seats  The curtain air bags  are located in the side roof rails  These systems  are designed to meet voluntary guidelines to help  reduce the risk of injury to out of position occu   pants  However  all of the information  cau   tions and warnings in this manual still ap   ply and must be followed  The side air bags  and curtain air bags are designed to inflate in  higher severity side collisions  although they may    inflate if the forces in another type of collision are  similar to those of a higher severity side impact   They are designed to inflate on the side where the  vehicle is impacted  They may not inflate in cer   tain side collisions     Vehicle damag
328. lder Repeat  The folder that is currently being  accessed will be repeated    1 Track Repeat  The track that is currently playing  will be repeated    1 Disc Random  The tracks on the disc that is  currently playing will be played in a mixed order   1 Folder Random  The tracks in the folder that is  currently playing will be played in a mixed order       A CD EJECT button              When the  amp  button is pressed with the com   pact disc loaded  the compact disc will be  ejected     When the  amp  button is pressed while the  compact disc is being played  the compact disc  will eject and the system will turn off     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 73             LHA2031          AUX  auxiliary  input jacks    The auxiliary input jacks are located inside the  center console  1   NTSC compatible devices  such as video games  camcorders and portable  video players can be connected to the auxiliary  input jacks  Audio devices  such as some MP3  players  can also be connected to the system  through the auxiliary input jacks     The auxiliary input jacks are color coded for iden   tification purposes         Red   right channel audio input    White     left channel audio input        Yellow     video input    Before connecting a device to the auxiliary input  jacks  turn off the power of the portable device     With a compatible device connected to the aux   iliary input jacks  press the AUX button until the  AUX mode appears in the display  The o
329. learn the  specific sounds of your voice  See    Speaker ad   aptation function    in this section     Alternate Command Mode     For advanced operation  an Alternate Command  Mode is provided  This setting enables control of  the audio system as well as additional commands  for the Phone and Navigation systems  With this  setting active  the system does not announce or  display the available commands at each step   When this mode is activated  the Voice Recogni   tion Settings will change to show more options     Minimize Voice Feedback     Reduces the amount of the information spoken  for each voice instruction        Settings  gt  Voice Recognition 8 00      Command List    User Guide             Speaker Adaptation             Alternate Command Mode                   l Minimize Voice Feedback          Change the mode of Voice Recognition             LHA1341       8 00    1e    Settings  gt  Speaker Adaptation                            User 1 None  User 2 None  User 3 None                      le       1 3    Learning result can be stored  deleted  edited             LHA1346       SPEAKER ADAPTATION FUNCTION    The Voice Recognition system has a function to  learn the user s voice for better voice recognition  performance  The system can memorize the  voices of up to three persons     Having the system learn the user s  voice    1  Press the SETTING button on the instru   ment panel  select the  Others  key on the  display     2  Select the  Voice Recognition  key     3  S
330. lect the    Voice Recognition    key     NOTE     You can skip steps 1 to 3 by pressing  the    button and saying    Help        4  Select the    User Guide    key     5  Select an item     Available items       Getting Started    Describes the basics of how to operate the  Voice Recognition system         let s Practice    Initiates a practice session that demon   strates how to improve voice recognition by  the system         Using the Address Book  Tutorial for using the Address Book    Finding a Street Address    Tutorial for entering a destination by street  address         Placing Calls    Tutorial for making a phone call by voice  command operation         Help on Speaking    Displays useful tips of speaking for correct  command recognition by the system        8 00    Information  gt  User Guide    Using Voice Recognition       With voice recognition  you TALK  can use voice commands to switch  control navigation audio    phone and other functions    To start the voice   recognition system  push the   TALK switch on the steering   wheel  Then say a command   after the tone                    LHA1329       Getting started    Before using the Voice Recognition system for  the first time  you can confirm how to use com   mands by viewing the Getting Started section of  the User Guide     1  Select the  Getting Started  key     2  You can confirm the page by scrolling the  screen using the NISSAN controller or  touching the page down key     Monitor  climate  audio  phone
331. ler couplers  Most hitch balls also  have the size printed on the top of the ball         Choose the proper class hitch ball based on  the trailer weight         The diameter of the threaded shank of the  hitch ball must be matched to the ball mount  hole diameter  The hitch ball shank should  be no more than 1 16  smaller than the hole  in the ball mount     Technical and consumer information 9 19      The threaded shank of the hitch ball must be  long enough to be properly secured to the  ball mount  There should be at least 2  threads showing beyond the lock washer  and nut     Ball mount    The hitch ball is attached to the ball mount and  the ball mount is inserted into the hitch receiver   Choose a proper class ball mount based on the  trailer weight  Additionally  the ball mount should  be chosen to keep the trailer tongue level with the  ground     Sway control device    Sudden maneuvers  wind gusts  and buffeting  caused by other vehicles can affect trailer han   dling  Sway control devices may be used to help  control these affects  If you choose to use one   contact a reputable trailer hitch supplier to make  sure the sway control device will work with the  vehicle  hitch  trailer and the trailer s brake sys   tem  Follow the instructions provided by the  manufacturer for installing and using the sway  control device     Class   hitch    Class   trailer hitch equipment  receiver  ball  mount and hitch ball  can be used to tow trailers  of a maximum weight of 2 000 
332. level is below  the L  Low  mark   amp    remove the oil filler cap  and pour recommended oil through the  opening  Do not overfill        6  Recheck oil level with the dipstick     It is normal to add some oil between oil  maintenance intervals or during the  break in period  depending on the severity  of operating conditions     A CAUTION    Oil level should be checked regularly  Op   erating the engine with an insufficient  amount of oil can damage the engine  and  such damage is not covered by warranty                       LDI0641       CHANGING ENGINE OIL    1  Parkthe vehicle on a level surface and apply  the parking brake     2  Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches  operating temperature       Turn the engine off and wait more than    10 minutes       Place a large drain pan under the drain plug          under the body        Remove the oil filler cap  inside the en     gine compartment  by turning it counter   clockwise       Remove the drain plug    with a wrench by    turning it counterclockwise and completely  drain the oil     If the oil filter is to be changed  remove and  replace it at this time  See  Changing engine  oil filter  later in this section     Waste oil must be disposed of prop   erly     Check your local regulations     A WARNING        Prolonged and repeated contact with    used engine oil may cause skin cancer         Try to avoid direct skin contact with    used oil  If skin contact is made  wash  thoroughly with soap or hand cleane
333. ll be reset  to    off    for the next call so the other party  can hear your voice     4 112 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       Phonebook     phones without  automatic phonebook download  function     NOTE     The    Transfer Entry    command is not avail   able when the vehicle is moving   Main Menu     Phonebook        Transfer Entry           Delete Entry        List Names             For phones that do not support automatic down   load of the phonebook  PBAP Bluetooth   pro   file   the    Phonebook    command is used to manu   ally add entries to the vehicle phonebook     The phonebook stores up to 40 names for each  phone connected to the system     NOTE     Each phone has its own separate phone   book  You cannot access Phone A   s phone   book if you are currently connected with  Phone B        Transfer Entry   A     Use the Transfer Entry command to store a new  name in the system     When prompted by the system  say the name you  would like to give the new entry     For example  say   Mary      If the name is too long or too short  the system  tells you  then prompts you for a name again     Also  if the name sounds too much like a name  already stored  the system tells you  then prompts  you for a name again     The system will ask you to transfer a phone  number stored in the cellular phone s memory     Enter a phone number by voice command     For example  say   five five five one two one two    See  How to say numbers  in this se
334. lly turning the heater on and off   The indicator light will remain on as long as  the switch is on     3  When the seat is warmed or before you  leave the vehicle  be sure to turn the switch  off     A WARNING    Do not use or allow occupants to use the  seat heater if you or the occupants cannot  monitor elevated seat temperatures or  have an inability to feel pain in body parts  that contact the seat  Use of the seat  heater by such people could result in se   rious injury     A CAUTION        Do not use the seat heater for extended  periods or when no one is using the  seat     e Do not put anything on the seat which  insulates heat  such as a blanket  cush   ion  seat cover  etc  Otherwise  the seat  may become overheated     e Do not place anything hard or heavy on  the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar  object  This may result in damage to the  heater       Any liquid spilled on the heated seat  should be removed immediately with a  dry cloth     e When cleaning the seat  never use  gasoline  benzine  thinner  or any simi   lar materials         If any malfunctions are found or the  heated seat does not operate  turn the  switch off and have the system checked  by your NISSAN dealer     e The battery could run down if the seat  heater is operated while the engine is  not running     Instruments and controls 2 35    CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT SWITCH  if  so equipped                       LIC1410       The climate controlled seat warms up or cools  down the front seat by
335. ls to protect against road salt in areas  where it is used during winter     Spare tire  TEMPORARY USE ONLY  spare tire    Observe the following precautions if the TEM   PORARY USE ONLY spare tire must be used     Otherwise  your vehicle could be damaged or  involved in an accident     A  WARNING    The spare tire should be used for emer   gency use only  It should be replaced  with the standard tire at the first oppor   tunity to avoid possible tire or differen   tial damage     Drive carefully while the TEMPORARY  USE ONLY spare tire is installed  Avoid  sharp turns and abrupt braking while  driving     Periodically check spare tire inflation  pressure  Always keep the pressure of  the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire  at 60 psi  420 kPa  4 2 bar      With the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare  tire installed do not drive the vehicle at  speeds faster than 50 MPH  80 km h      When driving on roads covered with  snow or ice  the TEMPORARY USE  ONLY spare tire should be used on the  rear wheels and the original tire used  on the front wheels  drive wheels   Use  tire chains only on the front  original   tires     Tire tread of the TEMPORARY USE  ONLY spare tire will wear at a faster rate  than the standard tire  Replace the  spare tire as soon as the tread wear  indicators appear     Do not use the spare tire on other  vehicles     Do not use more than one spare tire at  the same time     Do not tow a trailer when the TEMPO   RARY USE ONLY spare tire is installed     A CAUTION    Do not
336. luetooth   streaming audio  in this section     Volume  amp  beeps settings  Navigation volume    For navigation volume settings  refer to the sepa   rate Navigation System Owner s Manual for infor   mation regarding these settings     Phone volume    For phone volume settings refer to    Bluetooth    Hands Free Phone System with Navigation Sys   tem  in this section        8 00  S249    Settings  gt  Volume  amp  Beeps         Audio Volume           eeeeeeeseees DO  Guidance Volume C  lOssoccccossej    gt        Ringtone G  P cccccccccces    gt   Incoming Call G  bO ccesccccccoef    gt     Outgoing Call Gliese  5      l going S    1 7                                           Use volume knob to adjust during playback             LHA1253                                                                         Settings  gt  Volume  amp  Beeps 8 00    Ringtone C  pe  Incoming Call C   T TTPPPPTPPPPR     gt      Outgoing Call     pee     Switch Beeps  ON    Gudance Voice   ON     a7     Use volume knob to adjust during playback  LHA1254          Switch beeps    With this option on  indicator light illuminated   a  beep will sound if any control panel button is  pressed     xd   OFF BUTTON    To change the display brightness  press  the 5 9 OFF button  Pressing the button again  will change the display to the day or the    night display  The brightness can then be  adjusted using the NISSAN controller     If no operation is performed within 5 seconds  the  display will return to t
337. ly   Map light   Rear personal lights   Fog light  if so equipped    Step light   High mounted stop light  Type A   Trunk light   High mounted stop light  Type B   License plate light   0  Rear combination light      OMONOoaRWN  gt              WDI0666       Maintenance and do it yourself 8 29          WDIO0263             Replacement procedures    All other lights are either type A  B  C or D  When  replacing a bulb  first remove the lens  lamp  and or cover     8 30 Maintenance and do it yourself    ft  t    Indicates bulb removal    Indicates bulb installation                Ii  00  o D o           WDI0667    Map lights  Use a cloth  1  to protect the housing              Vanity mirror light  Use a cloth  1  to protect the housing           a             t D  glee       LDI0341  Step light  Use a cloth  1  to protect the housing                   WDI0670  Personal light  Use a cloth  1  to protect the housing     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 31          e     SON    Trunk light          LDI2135    8 32 Maintenance and do it yourself       WHEELS AND TIRES    If you have a flat tire  see    Flat tire    in the     In case of emergency    section of this  manual     TIRE PRESSURE    Tire Pressure Monitoring System   TPMS     This vehicle is equipped with the Tire  Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS   It  monitors tire pressure of all tires except  the spare  When the low tire pressure  warning light is lit and the CHECK TIRE  PRESSURE warning appears in the ve   hicle info
338. ly the  parking brake     AWARNING        The driver must not attempt to operate  the DVD system or wear the head   phones while the vehicle is in motion so  that full attention may be given to ve   hicle operation       Do not attempt to modify the system to  display a movie on the front screen  while the vehicle is being driven  Doing  so may distract the driver and may  cause a collision and serious personal  injury or death     A CAUTION    e Only operate the DVD while the vehicle  engine is running  Operating the DVD  for extended periods of time with the  engine OFF can discharge the vehicle  battery     e Do not allow the system to get wet   Excessive moisture such as spilled liq   uids may cause the system to  malfunction     e While playing VIDEO CD media  this  DVD player does not guarantee com   plete functionality of all VIDEO CD  formats     4 84 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems                      LHA1376       Playing a DVD  DISC AUX button    Park the vehicle in a safe location for the front  seat occupants to operate the DVD drive while  watching the images     Press the DISC AUX button until the DVD mode  is active on the display     When a DVD is loaded  it will be replayed auto   matically     The operation screen will be turned on when the  DISC AUX button is pressed while a DVD is  playing  The operation screen will turn off auto   matically after a period of time  To turn it on again   press the DISC AUX button     DVD opera
339. m  will turn on  If another audio source is playing and  the iPod   is connected  press the DISC AUX  button repeatedly until the center display  changes to the iPod   mode     4 96 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems          Now Playing       Playlists       Artists       Albums          Songs       Podcasts                LHA1398       Interface     The interface for iPod   operation shown on the  vehicle center display is similar to the iPod    interface  Use the NISSAN controller and the  BACK button to play the iPod with your favorite  settings  The touchscreen can also be used to  control your favorite settings     The following items can be chosen from the menu  list screen  For further information about each  item  see the iPod   Owner s Manual         Now Playing      Playlists  9 Artists    Albums  Songs  Podcasts  Genres  Composers  Audiobooks   e Shuffle Songs    The following keys shown on the screen are also  available       MENU  returns to the previous screen     e Pil  plays pauses the music selected        iPod    Play Mode 8 00             Shuffle Songs          Repeat All             Audiobooks Normal                                  LHA1315       Play mode     While the iPod   is playing  touch the    Menu    key  to display the iPod   menu  Touch the    Play  Mode    key to display the Play Mode screen and  adjust the settings for Shuffle  Repeat and Audio   books  For further information about each item   see the iPod   Owner s
340. m the device will be played  through the display  when the vehicle is in the  P   Park position and the parking brake engaged   and audio system                                                                     F gt  AUX AUX  gt  Menu 8 00  oco  Display Mode  Volume Setting  Display  WHA1393 LHA1394  AUX settings For more information about the USB interface    Select the  Settings  key using the NISSAN con   troller     The display mode can be set to Normal  Wide or  Cinema  The volume setting can be set to Low   Medium or High     Additional features    For more information about the iPod   player  available with this system  see    iPod   player  operation with Navigation System    in this section     available with this system  see  USB interface   models with Navigation System   in this section     For more information about the Bluetooth    streaming audio feature available with this sys   tem  see    Bluetooth   streaming audio  in this  section     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 83    DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC  DVD   PLAYER OPERATION  models with  Navigation System     Precautions    Start the engine when using the DVD entertain   ment system     Movies will not be shown on the front display  while the vehicle is in any drive position to reduce  driver distraction  Audio is available when a movie  is played  To view movies on the front display   stop the vehicle in a safe location  move the shift  selector to the P  Park  position and app
341. may cause engine damage  All gasoline vehicles  must be operated with unleaded gasoline  There   fore  avoid taking your vehicle to areas where  appropriate fuel is not available     When transferring the registration of your  vehicle to another country  state  province  or district  it may be necessary to modify the  vehicle to meet local laws and regulations     The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emis   sion control and safety standards vary according  to the country  state  province or district  there   fore  vehicle specifications may differ     When any vehicle is to be taken into an   other country  state  province or district  and registered  its modifications  transpor   tation  and registration are the responsibil   ity of the user  NISSAN is not responsible  for any inconvenience that may result     VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION             WTI0171             LTIOO70       VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER   VIN  PLATE    The vehicle identification number  VIN  plate is  attached as shown  This number is the identifica   tion for your vehicle and is used in the vehicle  registration     VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER   chassis number     The vehicle identification number is located as  shown     Technical and consumer information 9 9             WTI10049                            WTI0172    COR cq  t  De a                WT10173       ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER    The number is stamped on the engine as shown     9 10 Technical and consumer information    F M V S S  C M V S 
342. mbing steep hills slowly  or driving slowly through deep snow  sand or  mud  or for maximum engine braking on steep  downhill grades         Remember not to drive at high speeds for  extended periods of time in lower than 6  range  This reduces fuel economy     When shifting up     Move the shift selector to the    up  side   Shifts  to higher range      When shifting down     Move the shift selector to the      down  side    Shifts to lower range        Moving the shift selector rapidly to the same  side twice will shift the ranges in succession     When canceling the manual shift mode     Return the shift selector to the D  Drive  position  to return the transmission to the normal driving  mode         Inthe manual shift mode  the transmis   sion may not shift to the selected gear   This helps maintain driving perfor   mance and reduces the chance of ve   hicle damage or loss of control         Inthe manual shift mode  the transmis   sion may shift up automatically to a  higher range than selected if the en   gine speed is too high  When the ve   hicle speed decreases  the transmis   sion automatically shifts down and  shifts to 1st gear before the vehicle  comes to a stop         CVT operation is limited to automatic drive  mode when CVT fluid temperature is ex   tremely low even if manual shift mode is  selected  This is not a malfunction  When  CVT fluid warms up  manual mode can be  selected       When the CVT fluid temperature is high  the  shift range may upshift in l
343. mble  Always have your xenon head   lights replaced at a NISSAN dealer  For  additional information  see    Headlight  and turn signal switch  in the  Instru   ments and controls  section     Replacing the halogen headlight bulb   if so equipped     The headlight is a semi sealed beam type which  uses a replaceable headlight  halogen  bulb  Be   cause the headlight assembly must be removed  from the vehicle for bulb replacement  see your  NISSAN dealer     A CAUTION      Aiming is not necessary after replacing  the bulb  When aiming adjustment is  necessary  contact a NISSAN dealer       Do not leave the headlight assembly  open without a bulb installed for a long  period of time  Dust  moisture  smoke   etc  entering the headlight body may  affect bulb performance  Remove the  bulb from the headlight assembly just  before a replacement bulb is installed       Only touch the base when handling the  bulb  Never touch the glass envelope   Touching the glass could significantly  affect bulb life and or headlight  performance     e High pressure halogen gas is sealed  inside the halogen bulb  The bulb may  break if the glass envelope is scratched  or the bulb is dropped     Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of the  exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash  A  temperature difference between the inside and  the outside of the lens causes the fog  This is not  a malfunction  If large drops of water collect  inside the lens  contact a NISSAN dealer     Maintenance and do i
344. measures the  amount of electrical discharge from the battery  and controls voltage generated by the generator     The current sensor is located near the battery  along the negative battery cable  If you add elec   trical accessories to your vehicle  be sure to  ground them to a suitable body ground such as  the frame or engine block area     DRIVE BELT       ae  N       LDI0564          Power steering fluid pump  Generator   Air conditioner compressor  Crankshaft pulley    A WARNING    Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or  LOCK position before servicing drive belt   The engine could rotate unexpectedly     RON    1  Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual  wear  cuts  fraying or looseness  If the belt is  in poor condition or is loose  have it replaced  or adjusted by a NISSAN dealer     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 17    2  Have the belt checked regularly for condi   tion and tension in accordance with the  maintenance schedule found in the   NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide      8 18 Maintenance and do it yourself    SPARK PLUGS    a E    SDI1895                   REPLACING SPARK PLUGS  Iridium tipped spark plugs    It is not necessary to replace iridium tipped   amp    spark plugs as frequently as conventional type  spark plugs because they last much longer  Fol   low the maintenance log shown in the  NISSAN  Service and Maintenance Guide   Do not service  iridium tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regap   ping        Always replace spark plugs with 
345. mobilizer System is operational     If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is mal   functioning  the light will remain on while the  ignition switch is placed in the ON position     If the light still remains on and or the en   gine will not start  see a NISSAN dealer for  NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ser   vice as soon as possible  Please bring all  registered keys that you have when visiting  your NISSAN dealer for service     2 28 Instruments and controls    SWITCH OPERATION    The windshield wiper and washer operates when  the ignition switch is in the ON position     Push the lever down to operate the wiper at the  following speed        Intermittent     intermittent operation can be  adjusted by turning the knob toward      Slower  or  Faster   Also  the intermit   tent operation speed varies in accordance  with the vehicle speed   For example  when  the vehicle speed is high  the intermittent  operation speed will be faster      NOTE     You can turn on or turn off the driving  speed dependent intermittent wiper func   tion for vehicles with navigation system   Refer to    Comfort settings    in the    Monitor   climate  audio  phone and voice recogni   tion systems    section        Low     continuous low speed operation   3  High     continuous high speed operation    Push the lever up  4  to have one sweep opera   tion of the wiper     Pull the lever toward you     to operate the  washer  The wiper will also operate several times     A WARNING    In freezing 
346. move and result in personal injury     Getting the spare tire and tools    Open the trunk  Remove the floor carpeting and  spare tire cover                    WCE0189                WCE0188       Jack up point and  placing jack    CFO   VEA    WC UE    CE1089       ae          Remove the jack    and wheel nut wrench     from the tool box on the right side of the trunk  compartment     Remove the spare tire     Jacking up vehicle and removing the  damaged tire    AWARNING    e Never get under the vehicle while it is  supported only by the jack  If it is nec   essary to work under the vehicle  sup   port it with safety stands       Use only the jack provided with your  vehicle to lift the vehicle  Do not use the  jack provided with your vehicle on other  vehicles  The jack is designed for lifting  only your vehicle during a tire change     In case of emergency 6 5            Use the correct jack up points  Never  use any other part of the vehicle for jack  support     e Never jack up the vehicle more than  necessary     e Never use blocks on or under the jack       Do not start or run the engine while  vehicle is on the jack  It may cause the  vehicle to move  This is especially true                for vehicles with limited slip Raise the  differentials  by hand pom vehicle    Do not allow passengers to stay in the  vehicle while it is on the jack  LCE0020  e Never run the engine with a wheel s  off Always refer to the proper illustrations for the notches in the front or the re
347. ms  Starting and driving   In case of emergency   Appearance and care   Maintenance and do it yourself    Technical and consumer information    0 Illustrated table of contents    Air bags  seat belts and child restraints                0 2  Exterior frOrit esiste pe binyin tsn na ewan ganas 0 3  Exterior rG  I  ui dE d RR ER Dn EBE DEA 0 4    Passenger compartment      sisrseriresresieercres 0 5    Instrument panel      2i m Rn een  Engine compartment check locations                   Warning indicator lights    eese       AIR BAGS  SEAT BELTS AND CHILD  RESTRAINTS       Top tether strap anchor  P  1 34   Head restraints  P  1 7   Rear seat belts  P  1 11   Roof mounted curtain side impact  supplemental air bag  P  1 37   Front seat mounted side impact  supplemental air bags  P  1 37   6  Head Restraints  P  1 7   Front seat belts  P  1 11   8  Supplemental front impact air bags   P  1 37     Seats  P  1 2   10  Occupant classification sensor   pattern sensor   P 1 44   11  Seat belts with pretensioners  P  1 50   12  LATCH  Lower Anchors and Tethers for  CHildren  system  P  1 22   See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     Aoc       e    N                      LII0065       0 2 Illustrated table of contents    EXTERIOR FRONT                            WII0155          Engine hood  P  3 17    Windshield wiper and washer switch   P  2 28    Windshield  P  8 20    Moonroof  if so equipped   P  2 46   Power windows  P  2 43    Door locks  NISSAN I
348. n              9 12  Vehicle recovery        00  ee eee 6 13  Vehicle security system           04  2 26  Vehicle security system  NISSAN vehicle immobi   lizer system   engine start          2 27  3 3  5 10  Ventilators    e ey eco exe RS GS 4 40  VISOS  3 sa s oo odo Re WU UR TR 3 24  Voice recognition system             4 130  Ww  Warning  Air bag warning light            1 51  2 14  Anti lock brake warning light          2 10  2 11  Battery charge warning light          2 11  Brake warning light               2 11    Engine oil pressure warning light         2 12    Hazard warning flasher switch          6 2  Low fuel warning light           2 13  2 24  Low tire pressure warning light           2 12  Low windshield washer fluid warning  Gt  Pit tthe ded Geen pud 2 24  Passenger air bag and status light           1 46  Seat belt warning light               2 14  Vehicle security system             2 26  Warning indicator lights and audible  reminders    xe kv Ris 2 10  Warning labels  for SRS             1 51  Waminglights           leen 2 10    Washer switch  Windshield wiper and washer switch      2 28    Weights  See dimensions and weights           9 8  Wheels and tires          less  8 32  Wheel tire size    s cec eese 9 8  When traveling or registering your vehicle  inanothercountty           lee 9 9  Windows   Locking passengers    windows          2 44   Power rear windows              2 44   Power windows             005 2 43   Rear power windows              2 44
349. n 9     LHA2018    Temperature control dial  driver s side    AUTO  automatic  climate control ON       AWARNING      The air conditioner cooling function op   erates only when the engine is running       Do notleave children or adults who would  normally require the assistance of others  alone in your vehicle  Pets should also not  be left alone  They could accidentally in   jure themselves or others through inad   vertent operation of the vehicle  Also  on  hot  sunny days  temperatures in a closed  vehicle could quickly become high  enough to cause severe or possibly fatal  injuries to people or animals       Do not use the recirculation mode for  long periods as it may cause the interior  air to become stale and the windows to  fog up     Start the engine and operate the controls to  activate the air conditioner     AUTOMATIC OPERATION    Cooling and or dehumidified heating   AUTO     This mode may be used all year round as the  system automatically works to keep a constant  temperature  Air flow distribution and fan speed  are also controlled automatically       Press the AUTO button on   The indicator on    the button will illuminate and AUTO will be  displayed        Turn the temperature control dial to the left    or right to set the desired temperature     Adjust the temperature display to about  75  F  24  C  for normal operation     The temperature of the passenger compart   ment will be maintained automatically  Air  flow distribution and fan speed are also con   
350. nal injury   For example  do not change the front  seats by placing material near the seat   backs or by installing additional trim  material  such as seat covers  around  the side air bag     e Work around and on the side air bag  and curtain air bag systems should be  done by a NISSAN dealer  Installation  of electrical equipment should also be  done by a NISSAN dealer  The SRS wir   ing harnesses  should not be modified  or disconnected  Unauthorized electri   cal test equipment and probing devices  should not be used on the side air bag  or curtain air bag system       The SRS wiring harness connectors are  yellow and orange for easy identification     When selling your vehicle  we request that you  inform the buyer about the side air bag and  curtain air bag systems and guide the buyer to  the appropriate sections in this Owner s Manual     Seat belts with pretensioners  front  seats     A WARNING        The pretensioners cannot be reused af   ter activation  They must be replaced  together with the retractor and buckle  as a unit     1 50 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system        If the vehicle becomes involved in a  collision but a pretensioner is not acti   vated  be sure to have the pretensioner  system checked and  if necessary  re   placed by your NISSAN dealer         No unauthorized changes should be  made to any components or wiring of  the pretensioner system  This is to pre   vent damage to or accidental activation  of the pretensione
351. nd    prompts you to enter more               six six two       C  fl e  SU  e SM  The system repeats the numbers and e M  prompts you to enter more  es           six two zero zero                LHA1160      Say  pound  for          Say  star  for          avail  CONTROL BUTTONS  able when using the    Special Number    com   mand and the    Send    command during a The control buttons for the Bluetooth   Hands   call   Free Phone System are located on the steering      2   wheel   See  List of voice commands  and  Special    number    in this section for more information  C4    Example  1 555 1212  123    PHONE SEND    Press the  4 button to initiate a        VR session or answer an incoming  i ne tive tive tive one two one two Star   One five five f t t t call    one two three         Say    plus    for          available only when using  the    Special Number    command          Say    pause    for a 2 second pause  available  only when storing a phone book number      4 108 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    You can also use the f   button  to interrupt the system feedback  and give a command at once  See     List of voice commands    and     During a call    in this section for  more information       PHONE END  While the voice recognition sys   tem is active  press and hold  the 4   button for 5 seconds to  quit the voice recognition system  at any time     TUNING SWITCH   While using the voice recognition  system  tilt the tuning switch up
352. nd Refill  With oil filter change 5 1 8 at 4 1 4 qt 48   Engine oil with API Certification Mark  2   3  Without oil filter change 4 3 4 qt 4gt 4 5   Viscosity SAE 5W 30  2   3  Cooling system  With reservoir 2 3 8 gal 2 gal 9 0 Pre diluted Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze Coolant  blue  or equivalent  CVT fluid See a NISSAN dealer for service  Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS 2  4  Power steering fluid  PSF  Refill to the proper level according to the instructions in   Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent  8  the  Maint d do it  If  section   Brake fluid bep d o pcd Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid  5 or equivalent DOT 3    Multi purpose grease    NLGI No  2  Lithium Soap base        Air conditioning system refrigerant    HFC 134a  R 134a   6       Air conditioning system oil    Genuine NISSAN A C System Oil Type S or equivalent  6       Windshield washer fluid              1 1 4 gal 1 gal 4 5      For further details  see  Fuel recommendation  in this section      2  For further details  see  Engine oil and oil filter recommendation  in this section      8  NISSAN recommends Genuine NISSAN Ester Engine Oil available at a NISSAN dealer     Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner  amp  Antifreeze or  equivalent     4  Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS 2  Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS 2 will damage the CVT  which is not covered by  the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty      5  Available in mainland USA through a NISSAN de
353. nd becoming locked in the  trunk where they could be seriously in   jured  Keep the car locked  with the rear  seatback and trunk lid securely latched  when not in use  and prevent children s  access to car keys     EXHAUST GAS  carbon monoxide     A WARNING        Do not breathe exhaust gases  they  contain colorless and odorless carbon  monoxide  Carbon monoxide is danger   ous  It can cause unconsciousness or  death     5 2 Starting and driving        If you suspect that exhaust fumes are  entering the vehicle  drive with all win   dows fully open  and have the vehicle  inspected immediately     e Do not run the engine in closed spaces  such as a garage     e Do not park the vehicle with the engine  running for any extended length of time         Keep the rear vent windows  lift gates   doors and trunk lids  if so equipped   closed while driving  otherwise exhaust  gases could be drawn into the passen   ger compartment  If you must drive with  one of these open  follow these  precautions     1  Open all the windows     2  Set the         air recirculation but   ton to off and the fan control dial to  high to circulate the air         If electrical wiring or other cable con   nections must pass to a trailer through  the seal on the trunk lid or the body   follow the manufacturers recommen   dation to prevent carbon monoxide en   try into the vehicle         The exhaust system and body should be  inspected by a qualified mechanic  whenever     a  The vehicle is raised for se
354. nd others     Accelerator downshift      in D  Drive  position and manual  shift mode    For passing or hill climbing  depress the accel   erator pedal to the floor  This shifts the transmis   sion down into lower range  depending on the  vehicle speed     High fluid temperature protection  mode    This transmission has a high fluid temperature  protection mode  If the fluid temperature be   comes too high  for example  when climbing  steep grades in high temperature with heavy  loads  such as when towing a trailer   engine  power and  under some conditions  vehicle  speed will be decreased automatically to reduce  the chance of transmission damage  Vehicle  speed can be controlled with the accelerator  pedal  but the engine and vehicle speed may be  limited     Starting and driving 5 17    Fail safe    If the vehicle is driven under extreme con   ditions  such as excessive wheel spinning  and subsequent hard braking  the fail safe  system may be activated  The MIL may  come on to indicate the fail safe mode is  activated  see    Malfunction Indicator Light   MIL     in the    Instrument and controls    sec   tion  This will occur even if all electrical  circuits are functioning properly  In this  case  place the ignition switch in the OFF  position and wait for 10 seconds  Then  push the switch back to the ON position   The vehicle should return to its normal op   erating condition  If it does not return to its  normal operating condition  have a  NISSAN dealer check the tra
355. nds for the Vehicle Information   Phone and Navigation systems  With this setting  active  the system does not announce or display  the available commands at each step     When Alternate Command Mode is activated  an  expanded list of commands can be used after  pushing the TALK  amp  switch  Under this  mode  the screen for Standard Mode commands  is not available on the display  Please review the  expanded command list  available when this  mode is active  as some Standard Mode com   mands are replaced  Please see examples of  Alternate Command Mode screens     Please note that in this mode the recognition  success rate may be affected as the number of  available commands and ways of speaking each  command are increased  You can turn this mode  ON or OFF  When this mode is activated  the  Voice Recognition Settings will change to show  more options        8 00      Comfort  e    Language  amp  Units    Settings    Others             Voice Recognition             Camera      Image Viewer uo   1 5             Adjust comfort  amp  convenience settings                LHA1248    8 00    Settings  gt  Voice Recognition          User Guide       Alternate Command Mode     ON                               Guide the usage of Voice Recognition          LHA1331    Settings  gt  Voice Recognition 8 00      Command List    User Guide             Speaker Adaptation             Alternate Command Mode                   l Minimize Voice Feedback          Change the mode of Voice Recognition
356. ne   Provides more information  if available   about the menu selection currently high   lighted  for example  Cabin lighting when  unlocking doors      HOW TO USE THE STATUS  BUTTON    The STATUS button is used to display system  information  Three different split screens of infor   mation are available  Press the STATUS button  multiple times to cycle through these screens as  follows     Audio with Turn Information for Navigation      Audio with Fuel Economy Information     Audio  with Climate Control Information     Audio with  Turn Information for Navigation    4 20 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       8 00    Information         Fuel Economy   Weather Info         Maintenance Map Update         Where am 1                  Navigation Version     j      Traffic Info   Others    Show distance to empty and fuel economy             LHA1231             HOW TO USE THE INFO BUTTON    Press the INFO button  the display screen shows  vehicle and navigation information for your con   venience     The information shown on the screen should be a  guide to determine the condition of the vehicle   See the following for details        Information  gt  Fuel Economy 8 00    Distance To Empty       kkkk    miles             Fuel Econ    Avg  Fuel Econ    Reset Fuel Eco  30 MPG       Fuel Eco History     k k    Li  MPG                                  LHA1232       Fuel economy    Press the INFO button  then select the  Fuel  Economy  key using the NISSAN cont
357. nformation        Operation is subject to the following two con   ditions   1  this device may not cause interfer   ence  and  2  this device must accept any  interference  including interference that may  cause undesired operation of the device       This Class B digital apparatus meets all re   quirements of the Canadian Interference   Causing Equipment Regulations     4 106 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    BLUETOOTH   is a  trademark owned by      Bluetooth   Bluetooth SIG  Inc   and licensed to  Visteon   USING THE SYSTEM    The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allows  hands free operation of the Bluetooth   Phone  System     If the vehicle is in motion  some commands may  not be available so full attention may be given to  vehicle operation     Initialization    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized   which takes a few seconds  If the 44 button is  pressed before the initialization completes  the  system will announce    Hands free phone system  not ready    and will not react to voice commands     Operating tips    To get the best performance out of the NISSAN  Voice Recognition system  observe the following         Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as  possible  Close the windows to eliminate  surrounding noises  traffic noises  vibration  sounds  etc    which may prevent the system  from recognizing voice commands correctly       Wait until the tone sounds before speaking a
358. ng  left in the vehicle       The request switch is operational only  when the Intelligent Key has been de   tected by the Intelligent Key system     Lockout protection    To prevent the Intelligent Key from being acci   dentally locked in the vehicle  lockout protection  is equipped with the Intelligent Key     When the driver s side door is open  the doors  are locked  and then the Intelligent Key is put    inside the vehicle and all the doors are closed   the lock will automatically unlock and the door  buzzer sounds     NOTE     The doors may not lock when the Intelli   gent Key is in the same hand that is oper   ating the request switch to lock the door   Put the Intelligent Key in a purse  pocket or  your other hand     A CAUTION    The lockout protection may not function  under the following conditions       When the Intelligent Key is placed on  top of the instrument panel       When the Intelligent Key is placed on  top of the rear parcel shelf       When the Intelligent Key is placed in   side the glove box or a storage bin     e When the Intelligent Key is placed in   side the door pockets       When the Intelligent Key is placed on or  under the spare tire area       When the Intelligent Key is placed in   side or near metallic materials                                WPD0377       Unlocking doors  1  Carry the Intelligent Key   2  Push the door handle request switch  1      3  The hazard warning lights flash once and the  outside buzzer sounds once     4  Push th
359. ng a  top tether strap child restraint  consult your  NISSAN dealer for details     Anchor points  1  are located on the rear parcel  shelf     REAR FACING CHILD RESTRAINT  INSTALLATION USING LATCH    Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the  Child  safety  and  Child restraints  sections before in   stalling a child restraint     Follow these steps to install a rear facing child  restraint using the LATCH system     1  Position the child restraint on the seat  Al   ways follow the child restraint manufactur   er s instructions     1 24 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system             WRS0801       Rear facing web mounted   step 2      Secure the child restraint anchor attach     ments to the LATCH lower anchors  Check  to make sure the LATCH attachment is prop   erly attached to the lower anchors              WRS0802  Rear facing rigid mounted     step 2          LRS0673       Rear facing   step 3    3  For child restraints that are equipped with    webbing mounted attachments  remove any  additional slack from the anchor attach   ments  Press downward and rearward firmly  in the center of the child restraint with your  hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion  and seatback while tightening the webbing  of the anchor attachments        LRS0674       Rear facing     step 4    4  After attaching the child restraint  test it be     fore you place the child in it  Push it from side  to side while holding the child restraint near  the LATCH attachment pa
360. ng down     If the control unit detects something caught in the  moonroof as it tilts down  the moonroof will im   mediately tilt up     If the auto reverse function malfunctions and re   peats opening or tilting up the moonroof  keep  pushing the tilt down switch within 5 seconds  after it happens  the moonroof will fully close  gradually  Make sure nothing is caught in the  moonroof     AWARNING       In an accident you could be thrown from  the vehicle through an open moonroof   Always use seat belts and child  restraints       Do not allow anyone to stand up or  extend any portion of their body out of  the moonroof opening while the vehicle  is in motion or while the moonroof is  closing     A CAUTION      Remove water drops  snow  ice or sand  from the moonroof before opening         Do not place heavy objects on the  moonroof or surrounding area                 a    1  OPEN          A  PUSH  mir    S  x  a   2  CLOSE  a   WIC1445          Sunshade  To open the sunshade         To fully open the sunshade  push the switch     toward the open position until it reaches  the first detent       To fully open the sunshade and the moon   roof together  push the switch    toward the  open position until it reaches the second  detent     To close the sunshade         To fully close the sunshade  push the switch   2  toward the close position until it reaches  the second detent     e Pushing the switch  2  to the first detent will  close the moonroof only     If the moonroof does 
361. ng may occur with large quantities of data  such as for high bit rate data    files   Moves immediately to the If an unsupported compressed audio file has been given a supported extension like   MP3   or when play is prohibited by copyright protection  the  next song when playing player will skip to the next song     Songs do not play back in The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software  Therefore  the files might not play in the desired order   the desired order Random Shuffle may be active on the audio system or on the USB device     Music cuts off or skips       Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 61    Compressed Video Files  models with  Navigation System     Explanation of terms         DivX      DivX refers to the DivX   codec  owned by Div  Inc  used for a lossy compres   sion of video based on MPEG 4         AVI  AVI stands for Audio Video Interleave   It is standard file format originated by Micro   soft Corporation  A  divx encoded file can be  saved into the  avi file format for playback on  this system if it meets the requirements  stated in the table in this section  However   all  avi files are not playable on this system  since different encodings can be used other  than the DivX codec         ASF   ASF stands for Advanced Systems  Format  It is a file format owned by Microsoft  Corporation  Note  Only  asf files that meet  the requirements stated in the table in this  section can be played 
362. ng siese nez tnr nen peie es 4 133  Giving voice commands                  0 00  4 134    NISSAN Voice Recognition Alternate  Command Mode    ec 4 142    Using the system         Speaker Adaptation function                       Troubleshooting guide    CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS     COLOR  SCREEN WITHOUT NAVIGATION  SYSTEM  if so equipped        AWARNING i 5    3  e Positioning of the heating or air condi   tioning controls and display controls  should not be done while driving in or   der that full attention may be given to  the driving operation              ERE    BRIGHT            Do not disassemble or modify this sys  STATUS    tem  If you do  it may result in accidents   fire  or electrical shock             OFF          Do not use this system if you notice any  abnormality  such as a frozen screen or  lack of sound  Continued use of the  system may result in accident  fire or  electric shock  5  EHe   n ee       In case you notice any foreign object in om c pue  the system hardware  spill liquid on it   or notice smoke or smell coming from  it  stop using the system immediately  and contact your nearest NISSAN  dealer  Ignoring such conditions may    lead to accidents  fire or electrical  shock  LHA1146         SETTING          _   _______                        1  STATUS button  P  4 6  BRIGHT    brightness control  button  2  INFO button  P  4 6  BRIGHT    brightness control  button  3  NISSAN controller  P  4 5   gt  BACK  previous  button  P  4 5     SETTING button  P 
363. ng tires with those not originally  specified by NISSAN could affect the  proper operation of the TPMS     e Do not install a damaged or deformed  wheel or tire even if it has been re   paired  Such wheels or tires could have  structural damage and could fail with   out warning     e The use of retread tires is not    recommended     e For additional information regarding  tires  refer to  Important Tire Safety In   formation   US  or  Tire Safety Informa   tion   Canada  in the Warranty Informa   tion Booklet     Wheel balance    Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling  and tire life  Even with regular use  wheels can get  out of balance  Therefore  they should be bal   anced as required     Wheel balance service should be per   formed with the wheels off the vehicle   Spin balancing the wheels on the vehicle  could lead to mechanical damage         For additional information regarding  tires  refer to    Important Tire Safety  Information     US  or    Tire Safety Infor   mation     Canada  in the Warranty In   formation Booklet     Care of wheels      Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle  to maintain their appearance         Clean the inner side of the wheels when the  wheel is changed or the underside of the  vehicle is washed         Donotuse abrasive cleaners when washing  the wheels         Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or  corrosion  Such damage may cause loss of  pressure or poor seal at the tire bead         NISSAN recommends waxing the road  whee
364. ngine block  heater cord       Plug the engine block heater cord into a    grounded 3 wire  3 pronged extension cord       Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault    Interrupt  GFI  protected  grounded 110   volt AC  VAC  outlet       The engine block heater must be plugged in    for at least 2   4 hours  depending on outside  temperatures  to properly warm the engine  coolant  Use an appropriate timer to turn the  engine block heater on       Before starting the engine  unplug and prop     erly store the cord to keep it away from  moving parts     Starting and driving 5 29    MEMO    5 30 Starting and driving    6 In case of emergency    Emergency engine shut off             00sceseee eae 6 2 Push starting    sr three ket 6 10  Hazard warning flasher switch                ssssue 6 2 If your vehicle overheats        6    cece eee eee eese 6 10  FlattitG    esses rhe EY e CR ened REA UNDER Lus 6 3 Towing your vehicle             es sseesleesesseeese 6 11  Tire Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS             6 3 Towing recommended by NISSAN                6 12  Changing a flat tire    0 0 0       se eee eee eee eee 6 3 Vehicle recovery  freeing a stuck vehicle           6 13    J  inp startilig 3 idees ners g raet goat rh pRSe TIGE 6 8       EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF    To shut off the engine in an emergency situation  while driving  perform the following procedure         Rapidly push the push button ignition switch 3  consecutive times in less than 1 5 seconds  or        Pus
365. not close    Have your NISSAN dealer check and repair the  moonroof     REAR POWER SUN SHADE  if so  equipped                                WIC1443    The rear sun shade operates when the ignition  switch is in the ACC or ON position        The rear sun shade switch is located on the front  console       To raise the sun shade  push the upper side  of the switch          To lower the sun shade  push the lower side  of the switch            The switch need not be held down     Instruments and controls 2 49    A CAUTION        Do not place objects  such as newspa   pers  handkerchiefs  etc   on the screen  inlet port  Doing so may entangle these  objects in the screen when it is extend   ing or retracting  causing improper op   eration or damage to the screen     e Do not push the sun shade arm with  your hands  etc   as this may deform it   Improper operation or damage to the  Screen may result     e Do not hang any object on the arm rail  as this may result in improper operation  or damage the screen       Do not forcefully pull the screen  Doing  so may elongate the screen  Improper  operation or damage to the screen may  result       To avoid personal injury  keep your  hands  fingers and head away from the  sun shade arm  arm rail and screen inlet  port       Do not allow children near the rear sun  shade system  They could be injured       Do not pull or push the rear sun shade   This could cause improper operation or  damage it     2 50 Instruments and controls    INTER
366. nsmission and  repair if necessary     5 18 Starting and driving    AWARNING    When the high fluid temperature protec   tion mode or fail safe operation occurs   vehicle speed may be gradually reduced   The reduced speed may be lower than  other traffic  which could increase the  chance of a collision  Be especially care   ful when driving  If necessary  pull to the  side of the road at a safe place and allow  the transmission to return to normal op   eration  or have it repaired if necessary     PARKING BRAKE    AWARNING      Be sure the parking brake is fully re   leased before driving  Failure to do so  can cause brake failure and lead to an  accident       Do not release the parking brake from  outside the vehicle       Do not use the shift selector in place of  the parking brake  When parking  be  sure the parking brake is fully engaged     e Do not leave children unattended in a  vehicle  They could release the parking  brake and cause an accident     CRUISE CONTROL            LSD0158                     ACCEL RES       COAST SET        tO               WSD0231          To engage  Firmly depress the parking brake   To release   1  Firmly apply the foot brake     2  Move the shift selector to the P  Park  posi   tion    3  Firmly depress the parking brake pedal and it  will release     4  Before driving  be sure the brake warning  light goes out     Ie    CANCEL switch  ACCEL RES switch  COAST SET switch  ON OFF switch    PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE  CONTROL         f the cru
367. nt notches  1  must be installed  in the hole with the lock knob  2        Push and hold the lock knob and push the    head restraint down       Properly adjust the head restraint before an    occupant uses the seating position     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 9                SPA1025  Front seat Active Head Restraints       The Active Head Restraint moves forward utiliz   ing the force that the seatback receives from the  occupant in a rear end collision  The movement  of the head restraint helps support the occu   pant   s head by reducing its backward movement  and helping absorb some of the forces that may  lead to whiplash type injuries     Active Head Restraints are effective for collisions  at low to medium speeds in which it is said that  whiplash injury occurs most     Active Head Restraints operate only in certain  rear end collisions  After the collision  the head  restraints return to their original position     Adjust the Active Head Restraints properly as  described in this section     1 10 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    SEAT BELTS             AF  qu    Sit upright and well back                                                                                                                                           X     Sss0136       PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT  USAGE    If you are wearing your seat belt properly ad   justed and you are sitting upright and well back in  your seat with both feet on t
368. ntelligent Key     keys  request button  P  3 4  3 2  3 2   3 2    Mirrors  P  3 25    Tire pressure  P  8 32    Flat tire  P  6 3    Tire chains  P  8 40    Headlight and turn signal switch    P  2 30    Replacing bulbs  P  8 30    Fog light switch  if so equipped     P  8 27     See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     Illustrated table of contents 0 3    EXTERIOR REAR                            WII0156          0 4    Illustrated table of contents    IRUN    D    7     8   9     Rear window defroster switch  P  2 29   Interior trunk lid release  P  3 19    Trunk lid  P  3 17    Vehicle loading  P  9 12    Exterior trunk lid release request button   P  3 12    Replacing bulbs  P  8 30    Fuel filler cap  fuel recommendation    P  3 20  P  9 3    Fuel filler door  P  3 20    Child safety rear door locks  P  3 6     See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     PASSENGER COMPARTMENT       5 6    Mes fer  E K n  ERR di ia A EIS  SZ    M  ml  11 10 9 8 7       WII0126          Interior trunk access  P  1 5    Moonroof  if so equipped   P  2 46   Sun visors  P  3 24    Interior lights  illuminated entry  P  2 50   HomeLink   universal transceiver    if so equipped   P  2 53    Interior mirrors  P  3 25    Glove box  P  2 41    Cup holders  P  2 40    Console box  P  2 41    10  Front seat  P  1 2    11  Rear seat  P  1 5    See the page number indicated in paren   theses for operating details     IAUN    c o0u9o    Ill
369. ntinuously   Park  position  OFF position   y  p p    The shift  P  warning light appears on the The ignition switch is placed in the OFF Move the shift selector to the P  Park   display and the outside chime sounds position and the shift selector is not in the P   position   continuously   Park  position   When closing the door with the inside lock   The outside chime sounds for approximately   The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or Carry the Intelligent Key with you   knob placed in the LOCK position 3 seconds and all the doors unlock  trunk   The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle or Carry the Intelligent Key with you   trunk     When pushing the door handle request The outside chime sounds for approximately Adoor isnot closed l Close the d    ee ien  The door handle request switch is pushed f Push the door handle request switch after  before the door is closed  the door is closed   When closing the trunk lid me outside chime sounds for approximately The Intelligent Key is inside the trunk  Carry the Intelligent Key with you   seconds and the trunk lid opens        3 16 Pre driving checks and adjustments    HOOD       or                 Vm eC             HES  NS        LRS2008             Pull the hood lock release handle located  below the driver side instrument panel  The  hood will spring up slightly     2 Push the lever at the front of the hood to the  side as illustrated with your fingertips and  raise the hood     When closing the hood  lower it slowly and m
370. nts  If the child restraint is  not secured properly  the child could be  seriously injured in a collision or a sud   den stop     SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE        To clean the seat belt webbing  apply a  mild soap solution or any solution recom   mended for cleaning upholstery or carpet   Then wipe with a cloth and allow the seat  belts to dry in the shade  Do not allow the  seat belts to retract until they are completely  dry     If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt  guide of the seat belt anchors  the seat  belts may retract slowly  Wipe the shoulder  belt guide with a clean  dry cloth     Periodically check to see that the seat  belt and the metal components  such as  buckles  tongues  retractors  flexible wires  and anchors  work properly  If loose parts   deterioration  cuts or other damage on the  webbing is found  the entire seat belt as   sembly should be replaced     1 18 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    CHILD SAFETY    A  WARNING    Do not allow children to play with the seat  belts  Most seating positions are  equipped with Automatic Locking Retrac   tor  ALR  mode seat belts  If the seat belt  becomes wrapped around a child   s neck  with the ALR mode activated  the child can  be seriously injured or killed if the seat  belt retracts and becomes tight  This can  occur even if the vehicle is parked  Un   buckle the seat belt to release the child  If  the seat belt cannot be unbuckled or is  already unbuckled  release the child by  cutt
371. o   matically be turned off and the last radio station  played will come on     The FM stereo indicator ST will illuminate during  FM stereo reception  When the stereo broadcast  signal is weak  the radio will automatically change  from stereo to monaural reception     TUNE FOLDER  Tuning  knob     To manually tune the radio  turn the  TUNE FOLDER knob to the right or left        SEEK CAT and TRACK  tuning buttons         l         x          Press the SEEK CAT 4   button or the  TRACK P button to tune from high to low or  low to high frequencies and stop at the next  broadcasting station     SCAN tuning     Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad   casting station for 5 seconds  Pressing the  SCAN button again during this 5 second period  will stop scan tuning and the radio will remain  tuned to that station  If the SCAN button is not  pressed within 5 seconds  scan tuning moves to  the next station     1 to 6 Station memory operations     Twelve stations can be set for the FM band  6 for  FM1  6 for FM2  and six stations can be set for  the AM band     1  Choose the radio band AM  FM1 or FM2  using the AM FM select button     2  Tune to the desired station using manual   SEEK or SCAN tuning  Press and hold any  of the desired station memory buttons  1      6  until a beep sound is heard     4 66 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    3  The channel indicator will then come on and  the sound will resume  Programming is now  complete     4  Other 
372. o and video files on  the storage device can be played through the  vehicle s audio system and center display screen     When there are both audio and movie files in the  USB memory  the mode select screen is dis   played  Use the touchscreen or the NISSAN con   troller to select the preferred type of file  When  there is only type of file in the USB memory  that  audio or movie operation screen is displayed and  starts to play     When you play a file with limited playing time  the  confirmation screen will be displayed before  starting to play the file  Confirm the playing time  and select  yes  to start playing     Audio file operation  DISC  AUX button     Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC  position and press the DISC AUX button to  switch to the USB input mode  If another audio  source is playing and a USB memory device is  inserted  press the DISC AUX button repeatedly  until the center display changes to the USB  memory mode     If the system has been turned off while the USB  memory was playing  push the ON OFF VOL  control knob to restart the USB memory     PP   pp    SEEK CAT and TRACK   Reverse or Fast Forward   buttons                 Press and hold the SEEK CAT M4  rewind   button or TRACK FP  fast forward  button for  1 5 seconds while an audio file on the USB  device is playing to reverse or fast forward the  track being played  The track plays at an in   creased speed while reversing or fast forwarding     When the button is released  the audio file r
373. o turn  on or turn off the driver s seat moving backward  for easy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFF  position and the driver s door is opened  After  getting into the vehicle and placing the ignition  switch in the ACC position  the driver s seat  moves to the previous position     Return All Settings to Default  Select to  change all the comfort systems to their default  settings        Settings  gt  Language  amp  Units 8 00                Select Language English             Select Units US                                  LHA1250    Settings  gt  Select Language 8 00             English          Frangais             Espanol                               LHA1251       Language  amp  Units     Use the NISSAN controller to select the    Lan   guage  amp  Units    key  Select which setting you  want to change using the NISSAN controller and  selecting either the    Select Language  key or the     Select Units    key     Select Language     Select the    English    key or the    Frangais    key to  change the language shown on the display     If you select the    Frangais    key  French language  will be displayed  so please use the French Own   er s Manual  To obtain a French Owner s Manual   please see  Owner s Manual Service Manual Or   der Information  in the  Technical and consumer  information  section     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 29       Settings  gt  Select Units 8 00                US    Metric                          
374. oad    limit  1     Locate the statement  The combined  weight of occupants and cargo  should never exceed XXX lbs or XXX  kg  on your vehicle s placard     Determine the combined weight of  the driver and passengers that will be  riding in your vehicle       Subtract the combined weight of the    driver and passengers from XXX lbs  or XXX kg     The resulting figure equals the avail   able amount of cargo and luggage  load capacity  For example  if the  XXX amount equals 1 400 lbs  and  there will be five 150 Ib  passengers  in your vehicle  the amount of avail   able cargo and luggage load capac   ity is 650 Ibs   1 400 750  5 X 150     650 lbs  or  640 340  5 X 70     300 kg      5  Determine the combined weight of  luggage and cargo being loaded on  the vehicle  That weight may not  safely exceed the available cargo and  luggage load capacity calculated in  Step 4     6  If your vehicle will be towing a trailer   load from your trailer will be trans   ferred to your vehicle  Consult this  manual to determine how this re   duces the available cargo and lug   gage load capacity of your vehicle     Before driving a loaded vehicle  confirm  that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle  Weight Rating  GVWR  or the Gross Axle  Weight Rating  GAWR  for your vehicle   See  Measurement of weights  later in  this section     Also check tires for proper inflation pres   sures  See the Tire and Loading Informa   tion label     LOADING TIPS        The GVW must not exceed GVWR  or GAWR as 
375. ocedure should be carried out to im   prove the recognition response for the speaker  See  Voice Adaptation  VA  mode  in this section    1  Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored  This can be confirmed by  using the  List Names  command  See    Phonebook    in this section     2  Replace one of the names being confused with a new name        Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 117    BLUETOOTH   HANDS FREE PHONE  SYSTEM WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM   if so equipped     AWARNING    e Use a phone after stopping your vehicle  in a safe location  If you have to use a  phone while driving  exercise extreme  caution at all times so full attention may  be given to vehicle operation         If you are unable to devote full attention  to vehicle operation while talking on  the phone  pull off the road to a safe  location and stop your vehicle     A CAUTION    To avoid discharging the vehicle battery   use a phone after starting the engine              nEeD  S        microphone location                 e Bluetooth            ill    WHA1350          Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth    Hands Free Phone System  If you have a com   patible Bluetooth   enabled cellular phone  you  can set up the wireless connection between your  cellular phone and the in vehicle phone module   With Bluetooth   wireless technology  you can    4 118 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    make or receive a hand
376. ock switch to  the   position  UNLOCK  for more than  5 seconds        3 6 Pre driving checks and adjustments    4  When activated  the hazard indicator will  flash twice  When deactivated  the hazard  indicator will flash once     5  The ignition switch must be placed in the  OFF and ON position again between each  setting change     When the automatic door unlock system is deac   tivated  the doors do not unlock when the ignition  switch is placed in the OFF position  To unlock  the door manually  use the inside lock knob or the  power door lock switch  driver s or front passen   ger s side                   amp   eb  T    CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCK    Child safety locks help prevent the rear doors  from being opened accidentally  especially when  small children are in the vehicle                 The child safety lock levers are located on the  edge of the rear doors     When the lever is in the unlock position  2  the  door can be opened from the outside or the  inside    When the lever is in the LOCK position  1    the door can be opened only from the out   side     NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY      AWARNING    e Radio waves could adversely affect  electric medical equipment  Those who  use a pacemaker should contact the  electric medical equipment manufac   turer for the possible influences before  use         The Intelligent Key transmits radio  waves when the buttons are pressed   The FAA advises the radio waves may  affect aircraft navigation and communi   cation systems  
377. of opera   tion     3 10 Pre driving checks and adjustments    Locking doors    1  Move the shift selector to the    P    position   Place the ignition switch in the LOCK posi   tion  Make sure the Intelligent Key is not left  in the vehicle     2  Close all doors     3  Push any door handle request switch  1   while carrying the Intelligent Key with you     4  All doors and the trunk will lock     5  The hazard warning lights flash twice and  the outside buzzer sounds twice     NOTE         Doors lock with the door handle request  switch when the ignition switch is placed in  the ON position       Doors lock with the door handle request  switch while the ignition switch is not in the  LOCK position         Doors do not lock by pushing the door  handle request switch while any door is  open  However  doors lock with the me   chanical key even if any door is open       Doors do not lock with the door handle  request switch with the Intelligent Key inside  the vehicle and a beep sounds to warn you   However  when an Intelligent Key is inside  the vehicle  doors can be locked with an   other Intelligent Key     A CAUTION    e After locking the doors using the re   quest switch  make sure that the doors  have been securely locked by operating  the door handles or the trunk opener  switch       When locking the doors using the re   quest switch  make sure to have the  Intelligent Key in your possession be   fore operating the request switch to  prevent the Intelligent Key from bei
378. oicetag requested matches what was originally stored  See    Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone System with Navigation  wrong voicetag in the phonebook  System  in this section     2  Replace one of the voicetags being confused with a different voicetag        4 152 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    5 Starting and driving    Precautions when starting and driving                 5 2  Exhaust gas  carbon monoxide                0 4  5 2  Three way catalyst          sisse 5 2  Tire Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS            5 3  Avoiding collision and rollover               00008 5 5  Off road recovery          05s cece eee eee 5 6  Rapid air pressure loss          00    cece eee 5 6  Drinking alcohol drugs and driving                  5 7   Push Button Ignition Switch                      00  5 7  Operating range    5 8  Push button ignition switch positions               5 8  Emergency engine shut off                   000  5 9  NISSAN Intelligent Key   battery discharge          5 9  NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system               5 10   Before starting the engine               0e cee eee ee 5 11   Starting the engine                    0c eee eee 5 11   Driving the vehicle           0 0 0 e cece eee eee ee 5 12  Continuously Variable Transmission  CVT          5 12   Parking  brake s csrass cndecawee wie dessus enacting    nace 5 18   Cr  ise control    vies atin des bakes beaded sehen EYE 5 19    Precautions on cruise control             0  005 5 19
379. ols   key on the display when it appears  The system  will respond by speaking  Changing to manual  operation  Please use manual controls to con   tinue      For the voice commands for the navigation sys   tem  refer to the Navigation System Owner s  Manual of your vehicle     For vehicles in the U S   the factory default setting  is the Standard Mode  See  Standard Mode  in  this section  For vehicles in Canada  the factory  default setting is the Alternate Command Mode   See  Alternate Command Mode  in this section     4 130 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITION  STANDARD MODE    The Standard Mode enables control of naviga   tion  phone and vehicle information  With this  setting active  commands that are available are  always shown on the display and announced by  the system     Displaying user guide    If you use the NISSAN Voice Recognition system  for the first time or you do not know how to  operate it  you can display the User Guide for  confirmation     You can confirm how to use voice commands by  accessing a simplified User Guide  which con   tains basic instructions and tutorials for several  voice commands        Information  gt  User Guide 8 00    Getting Started          Let s Practice       Using the Address Book          Finding a Street Address       Placing Calls       Help on Speaking                LHA1326    1  Press the INFO button on the instrument  panel     2  Select the    Others    key        3  Se
380. om  its fully retracted position  firmly pull  the belt and release it  Then  smoothly pull the belt out of the re   tractor     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 15                WRS0138     3  Position the lap belt portion low and snug  on the hips as shown      4  Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the  retractor to take up extra slack  Be sure the  shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder  and across your chest        The front passenger seat and the rear seating  positions three point seat belts have two modes  of operation         Emergency Locking Retractor  ELR       Automatic Locking Retractor  ALR     The Emergency Locking Retractor  ELR  mode  allows the seat belt to extend and retract to allow  the driver and passengers some freedom of  movement in the seat  The ELR locks the seat belt  when the vehicle slows down rapidly or during  certain impacts     The Automatic Locking Retractor  ALR  mode   child restraint mode  locks the seat belt for child  restraint installation     When the ALR mode is activated  the seat belt  cannot be extended again until the seat belt  tongue is detached from the buckle and fully  retracted  The seat belt returns to the ELR mode  after the seat belt fully retracts  See  Child re   straints  later in this section for more information     The ALR mode should be used only for  child restraint installation  During normal  seat belt use by an occupant  the ALR mode  should not be activated  If it is acti
381. omatically return to the  LOCK position when any door is either opened or  closed with the switch in the OFF position     Starting and driving 5 7    The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition  switch position cannot be switched to OFF until  the shift selector is moved to the P  Park  posi   tion     When the ignition switch cannot be pushed to   ward the OFF position  proceed as follows     1  Move the shift selector into the P  Park   position     2  Push the ignition switch  The ignition switch  position will change to the ON position     3  Push the ignition switch again to the OFF  position     The shift selector can be moved from the P   Park  position if the ignition switch is in  the ON position and the brake pedal is  depressed     If the battery of the vehicle is discharged   the push button ignition switch cannot be  moved from the LOCK position     Some indicators and warnings for operation are  displayed on the vehicle information display  See     Vehicle information display    in the    Instruments  and controls    section of this manual     5 8 Starting and driving                      WSD0191       OPERATING RANGE    The Intelligent Key functions can only be used  when the Intelligent Key is within the specified  operating range     When the Intelligent Key battery is almost dis   charged or strong radio waves are present near  the operating location  the Intelligent Key sys   tem s operating range becomes narrower and  may not function properly     I
382. ommend the use of tire  dressings  Tire manufacturers apply a coating to  the tires to help reduce discoloration of the rub   ber  If a tire dressing is applied to the tires  it may  react with the coating and form a compound  This  compound may come off the tire while driving and  stain the vehicle paint     If you choose to use a tire dressing  take the  following precautions         Use a water based tire dressing  The coat   ing on the tire dissolves more easily than  with an oil based tire dressing     7 4 Appearance and care        Apply a light coat of tire dressing to help    prevent it from entering the tire  tread grooves  where it would be difficult to  remove      Wipe off excess tire dressing using a dry  towel  Make sure the tire dressing is com   pletely removed from the tire tread grooves     Allow the tire dressing to dry as recom   mended by the tire dressing manufacturer     CLEANING INTERIOR    Occasionally remove loose dust from the interior  trim  plastic parts and seats using a vacuum  cleaner or soft bristled brush  Wipe the vinyl and  leather surfaces with a clean  soft cloth damp   ened in mild soap solution  then wipe clean with a  dry  soft cloth     Regular care and cleaning is required in order to  maintain the appearance of the leather     Before using any fabric protector  read the manu   factures recommendations  Some fabric pro   tectors contain chemicals that may stain or  bleach the seat material     Use a cloth dampened only with water to 
383. on       Press the ENTER button to show the list of  preset stations     XM  if so equipped        Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the preset station       Tilt up down for more than 1 5 seconds to  go to the next or previous category         Press the ENTER button to show the XM  Menu     iPod    if so equipped        Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the track number       Press the ENTER button to show the iPod  Menu     CD       Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the track number       Tilt up down for more than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the folder number  if  playing compressed audio files          Press the ENTER button to show the CD  Menu     DVD  if so equipped        Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the track number       Tilt up down for more than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the title number         Press the ENTER button to select an item  from the DVD display       When the transparent operation menu ap   pears  the switch will control the menu     USB  if so equipped        Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the track number       Tilt up down for more than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the folder number         Press the ENTER button to show the USB  Menu     Bluetooth   Audio  if so equipped        Tilt up down for less than 1 5 seconds to  increase or decrease the track number     AUX
384. on   NOTE     The    Transfer Entry    command is not avail   able when the vehicle is moving     Main Menu     Phonebook       Say a Name     List Names           Record Name          For phones that support automatic download of the  phonebook  PBAP Bluetooth   profile   the     Phonebook    command is used to manage entries  in the vehicle phonebook  You can say the name of  an entry at this menu to initiate dialing of that entry     The phonebook stores up to 1000 names for  each phone connected to the system     When a phone is connected to the system  the  phonebook is automatically downloaded to the  vehicle  This feature allows you to access your  phonebook from the Bluetooth   system and call  contacts by name  You can record a custom  voice tag for contact names that the system has  difficulty recognizing  For more information see     Record name    in this section     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 113    NOTE     Each phone has its own separate phone   book  You cannot access Phone A   s phone   book if you are currently connected with  Phone B        List Names          Use the List Names command to hear all the  names and locations in the phone book     The system recites the phone book entries but  does not include the actual phone numbers   When the playback of the list is complete  the  system goes back to the main menu     You can stop the playback of the list at any time  by pressing the      button on the steering  wheel  Th
385. on as possible if the warning sound is heard     Key reminder chime    A chime sounds if the driver s door is opened  while the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or  OFF position or placed in the OFF or LOCK  position with the Intelligent Key left in the Intelli   gent Key port  Make sure the ignition switch is  placed in the LOCK position  and take the Intel   ligent Key with you when leaving the vehicle     Light reminder chime    With the ignition switch placed in the OFF posi   tion  a chime sounds when the driver s door is  opened if the headlights or parking lights are on     Turn the headlight control switch off before leav   ing the vehicle     NISSAN Intelligent Key   door buzzer    The Intelligent Key door buzzer sounds if the  Intelligent Key is left inside the vehicle when  locking the doors  When the buzzer sounds  be  sure to check both the vehicle and the Intelligent  Key  See    NISSAN Intelligent Key      in the    Pre   driving checks and adjustments    section     VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY                WIC1102          WIC1406       The vehicle information display  1  is located on  the bottom of the speedometer  It displays such  items as         Intelligent Key operation information      some indicators and warnings      other information    For details about the Intelligent Key  see     NISSAN Intelligent Key      in the  Pre driving  checks and adjustments    section     HOW TO USE THE VEHICLE  INFORMATION DISPLAY    Press the button  located on 
386. on regarding this item     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Navigation Version    Refer to the separate Navigation System Own   er s Manual for information regarding this item     Other options    For Voice Recognition settings  refer to  NISSAN  Voice Recognition system  in this section     For GPS Position  refer to the separate Naviga   tion System Owner s Manual     4 23       Settings 8 00         Navigation   Volume  amp  Beeps         Audio Display             mone           Bluetooth   Others    Adjust navigation settings             LHA1236       Settings  gt  Display 8 00             Display Adjustment          Color Theme                            LHA1237       Settings  gt  Display Adjustment 8 00  Display     3  Brightness    X Contrast      Background Color              1 4                      WHA1502       HOW TO USE THE SETTING  BUTTON    When the SETTING button is pressed  the Set   tings screen will appear on the display  You can  select and or adjust several functions  features  and modes that are available for your vehicle  Use  the NISSAN controller to select each item to be  set     4 24 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Display settings    Select the  Display  key  On the screen above   select the  Display Adjustment  key  The Display  Adjustment screen will appear        Settings  gt  Display Adjustment 8 00       Display    3  Brightness    Contrast      Backgroud Color    C    gt   Push X
387. ont or rear GAW must  not exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating   GAWR  shown on the F M V S S  C M V S S   certification label                 9 18 Technical and consumer information    Towing capacities are calculated assuming a  base vehicle with driver and any options required  to achieve the rating  Additional passengers   cargo and or optional equipment  such as the  trailer hitch  will add weight to the vehicle and  reduce your vehicle s maximum towing capacity  and trailer tongue load     The vehicle and trailer need to be weighed to  confirm the vehicle is within the GVWR  Front  GAWR  Rear GAWR  Gross Combined Weight  Rating  GCWR  and Towing capacity     All vehicle and trailer weights can be measured  using platform type scales commonly found at  truck stops  highway weigh stations  building  supply centers or salvage yards     To determine the available payload capacity for  tongue load  use the following procedure     1  Locate the GVWR on the  F M V S S  C M V S S  certification label     2  Weigh your vehicle on the scale with all of  the passengers and cargo that are normally  in the vehicle when towing a trailer     3  Subtract the actual vehicle weight from the  GVWR  The remaining amount is the avail   able maximum tongue load     To determine the Gross Trailer Weight  weigh  your trailer on a scale with all equipment and  cargo  that are normally in the trailer when it is  towed  Make sure the Gross Trailer Weight is not  more than the Gross Trailer Weight 
388. ont wheels     When towing with the front wheels on  towing dollies       Place the ignition switch in the OFF  position  and secure the steering  wheel in a straight ahead position  with a rope or similar device       Move the shift selector to the N  Neu   tral  position     When towing CVT models with the rear  wheels on the ground  if you do not use  towing dollies   Always release the  parking brake     When towing CVT models with the front  wheels on the ground  dollies must be  used or place the vehicle on a flat bed  truck                 WCE0190       VEHICLE RECOVERY  freeing a stuck  vehicle     Pulling a stuck vehicle    AWARNING    To avoid vehicle damage  serious per   sonal injury or death when recovering a  stuck vehicle         Contact a professional towing service  to recover the vehicle if you have any  questions regarding the recovery  procedure     e Do not use the vehicle tie downs to tow  or free a stuck vehicle     e Only use devices specifically designed  for vehicle recovery and follow the  manufacturer s instructions       Always pull the recovery device straight  out from the front of the vehicle  Never  pull at an angle       Route recovery devices so they do not  touch any part of the vehicle except the  attachment point     If your vehicle is stuck in sand  snow  mud  etc   use  a tow strap or other device designed specifically  for vehicle recovery  Always follow the manufactur   er s instructions for the recovery device     Do not use the tie 
389. onvenience  both required and optional  scheduled maintenance items are described and  listed in your    NISSAN Service and Maintenance  Guide   You must refer to that guide to ensure  that necessary maintenance is performed on your  NISSAN at regular intervals     General maintenance    General maintenance includes those items which  should be checked during normal day to day op   eration  They are essential for proper vehicle op   eration  It is your responsibility to perform these  maintenance procedures regularly as prescribed     8 2 Maintenance and do it yourself    Performing general maintenance checks requires  minimal mechanical skill and only a few general  automotive tools     These checks or inspections can be done by you   a qualified technician  or  if you prefer  a NISSAN  dealer     Where to go for service    If maintenance service is required or your vehicle  appears to malfunction  have the systems  checked and corrected by a NISSAN dealer     NISSAN technicians are well trained specialists  who are kept up to date with the latest service  information through technical bulletins  service  tips  and in dealership training programs  They  are completely qualified to work on NISSAN ve   hicles before they work on your vehicle  rather  than after they have worked on it     You can be confident that a NISSAN dealer s  service department performs the best job to meet  the maintenance requirements on your vehicle      in a reliable and economical way     GENERAL MA
390. oors  and will help keep out  intruders         Before opening any door  always look  for and avoid oncoming traffic         Do notleave children unattended inside  the vehicle  They could unknowingly ac   tivate switches or controls  Unattended  children could become involved in seri   ous accidents        ONO    Or  Go MS          LPD0461          Driver s side    LOCKING WITH KEY    The power door lock system allows you to lock or  unlock all doors at the same time     Turning the key toward the front  1  of the vehicle  locks all doors     Turning the key one time toward the rear  2  of the  vehicle unlocks that door  From that position   returning the key to neutral  3   where the key can  only be removed and inserted  and turning it  toward the rear again within 60 seconds unlocks  all doors  2      Opening and closing windows    The driver s door key operation allows you to  open and close windows equipped with auto   matic operation at the same time       To open the windows  turn the driver s door  key toward the rear of the vehicle for longer  than 1 second after the door is unlocked         To close the windows  turn the driver s door  key toward the front of the vehicle for longer  than 1 second after the door is locked     Windows stop when the key cylinder is released                          WPD0291          Inside lock  LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK  KNOB    To lock the door without the key  move the inside  lock knob to the lock position  f  then close the  door  
391. or  cable  and USB port to dry completely  before connecting the USB device   Wait for  24 hours or more until it is dry   If the con   nector and USB port are exposed to fluids  other than water  evaporative residue may  cause a short circuit between the connector  pins and USB port  In this case  replace the  cable and USB port  Otherwise damage to  the USB device and a loss of function may  occur     a checkmark to be displayed on and off   flickering   Always make sure that the  iPod   is connected properly     An iPod   nano  1st Generation  may remain  in fast forward or rewind mode if it is con   nected during a seek operation  In this case   please manually reset the iPod       An iPod   nano  2nd Generation  will con   tinue to fast forward or rewind if it is discon   nected during a seek operation     recognized by the in vehicle audio system     It is necessary to set up the wireless con   nection between a compatible Bluetooth    audio device and the in vehicle Bluetooth    module before using the Bluetooth   audio     Operating procedure of the Bluetooth   au   dio will vary depending on the devices  Make  sure how to operate your audio device be   fore using it with this system     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 53    The Bluetooth   audio may be stopped un   der the following conditions         Receiving a call on the Hands Free  Phone System         Checking the connection to the hands   free phone     Do not place the Bluetooth
392. or more  trailers with a brake  system must be used                 p    Q  a  N                 gt     FA          LTIO164    The Gross Combined Weight Rating  GCWR   equals the combined weight of the towing vehicle   including passengers and cargo  plus the total  trailer load  Towing loads greater than these or  using improper towing equipment could ad   versely affect vehicle handling  braking and per   formance        The ability of your vehicle to tow a trailer is not  only related to the maximum trailer loads  but also  the places you plan to tow  Tow weights appro   priate for level highway driving may have to be  reduced for low traction situations  for example   on slippery boat ramps      Temperature conditions also can affect towing   For example  towing a heavy trailer in high outside  temperatures on graded roads can affect engine  performance and cause overheating  The trans   mission high fluid temperature protection mode   which helps reduce the chance of transmission  damage  could activate and automatically de   crease engine power  Under some conditions   engine and vehicle speed could be reduced  Plan  your trip carefully to account for trailer and vehicle  load  weather  and road conditions     AWARNING    Overheating can result in reduced engine  power and lower vehicle speed  Also   when the high temperature mode oper   ates  engine and vehicle speed may be  gradually reduced  On highways  the re   duced speed may be lower than other traf   fic which c
393. orrect ignition timing may result in spark  knock  after run and or overheating  which may  cause excessive fuel consumption or engine  damage  If any of the above symptoms are en   countered  have your vehicle checked at a  NISSAN dealer     However  now and then you may notice  light spark knock for a short time while  accelerating or driving up hills  This is not a  cause for concern  because you get the  greatest fuel benefit when there is light  spark knock for a short time under heavy  engine load        API certification mark          API service symbol          LTI2024       ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER  RECOMMENDATIONS    Selecting the correct oil    It is essential to choose the correct grade  quality  and viscosity engine oil to ensure satisfactory  engine life and performance  See  Capacities  and recommended fuel lubricants  earlier in this  section  NISSAN recommends the use of an  energy conserving oil in order to improve fuel  economy     Select only engine oils that meet the American  Petroleum Institute  API  certification or Interna   tional Lubricant Standardization and Approval    Committee  ILSAC  certification and SAE vis   cosity standard  These oils have the API certifica   tion mark on the front of the container  Oils which  do not have the specified quality label should not  be used as they could cause engine damage     Oil additives    NISSAN does not recommend the use of oil  additives  The use of an oil additive is not neces   sary when the proper o
394. ose not originally  specified by NISSAN could affect the  proper operation of the TPMS       Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol  tire sealant into the tires  as this may  cause a malfunction of the tire pressure  sensors     CHANGING A FLAT TIRE    If you have a flat tire  follow the instructions be   low     Stopping the vehicle    1  Safely move the vehicle off the road and  away from traffic     2  Turn on the hazard warning flashers     3  Park on a level surface and apply the parking  brake  Move the shift selector to P  Park      4  Turn off the engine     5  Raise the hood to warn other traffic and to  signal professional road assistance person   nel that you need assistance     6  Have all passengers get out of the vehicle  and stand in a safe place  away from traffic  and clear of the vehicle     In case of emergency 6 3    AWARNING      Make sure the parking brake is securely  applied and the CVT is shifted into P   Park        Never change tires when the vehicle is  on a slope  ice or slippery areas  This is  hazardous       Never change tires if oncoming traffic is  close to your vehicle  Wait for profes   sional road assistance     6 4 In case of emergency        eo  m wv    WCE0044             LCE0199             Blocking wheels    Place suitable blocks  1  at both the front and  back of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire   2  to prevent the vehicle from moving when it is  jacked up     A  WARNING    Be sure to block the wheel as the vehicle  may 
395. ou     2  When the door is closed with the Intelligent  Key left outside the vehicle and the ignition    switch is placed in the ACC or ON position   A chime will also sound     Parking brake warning    This warning illuminates when the parking brake  is set and the vehicle is driven     SHIFT P warning    This warning illuminates when the ignition switch  is pushed to stop the engine with the shift selec   tor in any position except in the P  Park  position     If this warning illuminates  the ignition switch is in  the OFF position  Move the shift selector to the P   Park  position or push the ignition switch to the  ON position     An inside warning chime will also sound   If the shift selector is moved to the P  Park     position  the Push warning will appear  Refer to     Push warning    in this section     For additional information about Intelligent Key   see    NISSAN Intelligent Key      in the    Pre   driving checks and adjustments    section     Engine start operation indicator    This indicator illuminates when the ignition switch  is in the LOCK  OFF  ACC or ON position with  the shift selector in the P  Park  position     This indicator means that the engine will start by  pushing the push button ignition switch with the  brake pedal depressed     NISSAN Intelligent Key   insertion indica   tor    This indicator illuminates when the Intelligent Key  needs to be inserted into the Intelligent Key port    For example  the Intelligent Key battery is dis   charged  
396. ou can also speak  800 662 6200   10  continuous digits  or  662 6200   7 con   tinuous digits   if the area code is not nec   essary  However  the 3 3 4 digit grouping is  recommended for improved recognition   See    How to speak numbers    in this section     4 140 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    You can only say a phone number using the  3 3 4 grouping  7 digits  and 10 digits using  this command  Please use the  International  Call  command for all other formats  and  when special characters such as star       pound      and plus     need to be entered     If you say  Change Number  during phone  number entry  the system will automatically  request that you repeat the number using  the 3 3 4 format  In this case please say the  area code first and then follow the prompts     Do not add a  1  in front of the area code  when speaking phone numbers     If the system does not recognize your com   mand  please try repeating the command  using a natural voice  Speaking too slowly or  too loudly may further decrease recognition  performance           n    Y          WHA1332       8 00    Voice Recognition           54 Phone J   39 Navigation J     4 Information J Practice     49 Audio J   99 Help J                                                 To exit  hold the TALK switch       LHA1333       Voice Recognition  gt  Phone Yall 8 00       Phone     Sw              44 Dial Number           9 Vehicle Phonebook           4 Handset Phonebook         
397. ould increase the chance of a  collision  Be especially careful when driv   ing  If the vehicle cannot maintain a safe  driving speed  pull to the side of the road  in a safe area and allow the engine to cool  or the transmission to return to normal  operation  See    If your vehicle overheats     in the    In case of emergency    section of  this manual                                   A CAUTION  Vehicle damage resulting from improper Total trailer load Tongue load  towing procedures is not covered by  NISSAN warranties     CJ   C  O  O  oe  IN   d 100   10 to 15   Total trailer load          2 9   WTI0160             Tongue load    Keep the tongue load between 10   15 percent of  the total trailer load or use the trailer tongue load  specified by the trailer manufacturer  The tongue  load must be within the maximum tongue load  limits shown in the following    Towing  Load Specification  chart  If the tongue load be   comes excessive  rearrange cargo to allow for  proper tongue load     Technical and consumer information 9 17                Gross vehicle weight    Eu  77 7  Gross axle weight  TI1012M    Maximum Gross Vehicle Weight   GVW  maximum Gross Axle Weight   GAW     The GVW of the towing vehicle must not exceed  the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  GVWR   shown on the F M V S S  C M V S S  certification  label  The GVW equals the combined weight of  the unloaded vehicle  passengers  luggage   hitch  trailer tongue load and any other optional  equipment  In addition  fr
398. ow open flames or sparks  near the vehicle when refueling     e Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank  after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off  automatically  Continued refueling may  cause fuel overflow  resulting in fuel  spray and possibly a fire       Use only an original equipment type    fuel filler cap as a replacement  It has a  built in safety valve needed for proper  operation of the fuel system and emis   sion control system  An incorrect cap  can result in a serious malfunction and    possible injury  It could also cause    the ene Malfunction Indicator Light    SOON   MIL  to come on     Never pour fuel into the throttle body to  attempt to start your vehicle     Do not fill a portable fuel container in  the vehicle or trailer  Static electricity  can cause an explosion of flammable  liquid  vapor or gas in any vehicle or  trailer  To reduce the risk of serious  injury or death when filling portable fuel  containers       Always place the container on the  ground when filling         Do not use electronic devices when  filling       Keep the pump nozzle in contact  with the container while you are fill   ing it        Useonly approved portable fuel con   tainers for flammable liquid     A CAUTION    e Do not use E 15 or E 85 fuel in your    vehicle  For further information see the     Fuel Recommendation    in the    Techni   cal and consumer information    section  of this manual     The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning will ap   pear if the fuel filler cap is not properly
399. ower rpm than  usual  This is not a malfunction                 WSD0236       Shift lock release    If the battery charge is low or discharged  the  shift selector may not be moved from the P  Park   position even with the brake pedal depressed  and the shift selector button pressed     It will be necessary to jump start or have your  battery charged  see    Jump starting    in the    In  case of emergency    section  Contact your  NISSAN dealer or a professional towing service     To move the shift selector  complete the following  procedure     1  Press the ignition switch to the LOCK posi   tion     2  Apply the parking brake     3  Using a protective cloth on the tip of a3 mm  screwdriver  remove the shift lock release  cover          f available  a plastic trim tool can also be  used     4  Insert the small screwdriver in the shift lock  release slot and push down     5  Move the shift selector to the N  Neutral   position while holding down the shift lock  release     6  Push the ignition switch to the ON position  to unlock the steering wheel  Now the ve   hicle may be moved to the desired location     If the shift selector cannot be moved out of P   Park   have a NISSAN dealer check the trans   mission as soon as possible     AWARNING    If the shift selector cannot be moved from  the P  Park  position while the engine is  running and the brake pedal is depressed   the stop lights may not work  Malfunction   ing stop lights could cause an accident  injuring yourself a
400. ower the temperature before    If the cable is damaged  insulation cut  con   nectors cracked  contamination such as liq   uids  dust  dirt  etc  in the connectors   do  not use the cable  Replace the cable with a  new one     Do not put a USB device in a location where  static electricity occurs  electrical noise is  generated or hot air from the air conditioner  blows directly on it  Doing so may cause the  data stored on the USB device to be cor   rupted     An incorrect song title may appear when the  Play Mode is changed while using an iPod    nano  2nd Generation      Audiobooks may not play in the same order  as they appear on an iPod       Large video files cause slow responses in an  iPod    The vehicle center display may mo   mentarily black out  but will soon recover     If an iPod   automatically selects large video  files while in the shuffle mode  the vehicle  center display may momentarily black out     Notes for iPod   use  but will soon recover     use   Bluetooth   streaming audio  if so    equipped         Some Bluetooth   audio devices may not be    iPod   is a trademark of Apple Inc   registered in        During cold weather or rainy days  the player the US  and othe  r countries     may malfunction due to humidity  If this oc     curs  remove the USB device and dehumidify     Improperly plugging in the iPod   may cause    or ventilate the USB player completely     Do not connect a USB device if a connector   cable or USB port is wet  Allow the connec   t
401. p the brake pedal         Push the ON OFF switch off  The CRUISE  indicator light in the instrument panel goes  out     BREAK IN SCHEDULE    A CAUTION    During the first 1 200 miles  2 000 km    follow these recommendations to obtain  maximum engine performance and en   sure the future reliability and economy of  your new vehicle  Failure to follow these  recommendations may result in short   ened engine life and reduced engine  performance         Avoid driving for long periods at constant  Speed  either fast or slow  and do not run the  engine over 4 000 rpm     Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear   Avoid quick starts     Avoid hard braking as much as possible     Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles   800 km   Your engine  axle or other parts  could be damaged     FUEL EFFICIENT DRIVING TIPS    Follow these easy to use Fuel Efficient Driving  Tips to help you achieve the most fuel economy  from your vehicle     1  Use Smooth Accelerator and Brake  Pedal Application        Avoid rapid starts and stops        Use smooth  gentle accelerator and  brake application whenever possible        Maintain constant speed while commut   ing and coast whenever possible    2  Maintain Constant Speed        Lookahead to try and anticipate and mini   mize stops    e Synchronizing your speed with traffic  lights allows you to reduce your number  of stops        Maintaining a steady speed can minimize  red light stops and improve fuel efficiency    3  Use Air Conditioning 
402. pable of playing audio files  the  device can be connected to the vehicle   s audio  system so that the audio files on the device play  through the vehicle   s speakers     4 98 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems          Settings  gt  Bluetooth Go dm vu 8 00                  Bluetooth       Connect Bluetooth       Connected Devices       Edit Bluetooth Info          Replace Connected Phone       i                LHA1316       Connecting Bluetooth   audio    To connect your Bluetooth   audio device to the  vehicle  follow the procedure below     1  Press the SETTING button on the instru   ment panel     2  Select the  Bluetooth  key   3  Select the  Connect Bluetooth  key              Settings  gt  Bluetooth   o dim vu 8 00    E     d Are you connecting a Bluetooth device to     use with the handsfree phone system    q For audio devices  please select  No     H                                     J  Cancel      16      Yes N No                2 5       LHA1317       Settings  gt  Connect Bluetooth 8 00     0000               Start connecting your Bluetooth    C y asco device  The PIN is 0000     C   CTT OST    Please input passkey                      LHA1351    Bluetooth Audio       Artist  XXXXXXXXXX    Album  XXXXXXXXXX   Track  XXXXXXXXXX    Shuffle OFF  Repeat OFF    0 11       Menu    Play   Pause          SAA2510       4  A screen will appear asking if you are con   necting the device to use with the hands   free phone system  Select the    No
403. perly  This could  adversely affect vehicle handling per   formance  and the indicator may  flash or the f indicator light may  illuminate         If brake related parts such as brake  pads  rotors and calipers are not  NISSAN recommended or are extremely  deteriorated  the VDC system may not  operate properly and the f indica   tor light may illuminate        If engine control related parts are not  NISSAN recommended or are extremely  deteriorated  the f indicator light  may illuminate     e When driving on extremely inclined sur   faces such as higher banked corners   the VDC system may not operate prop   erly and the fl indicator may flash or  the ff indicator light may illuminate   Do not drive on these types of roads       When driving on an unstable surface  such as a turntable  ferry  elevator or  ramp  the indicator may flash or  the fl indicator light may illuminate   This is not a malfunction  Restart the  engine after driving onto a stable  surface        If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN  recommended ones are used  the VDC  system may not operate properly and  the ft indicator may flash or  the ff indicator light may illuminate    e The VDC system is not a substitute for    winter tires or tire chains on a snow  covered road     Starting and driving 5 27    COLD WEATHER DRIVING    FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCK    To prevent a door lock from freezing  apply de   icer through the key hole  If the lock becomes  frozen  heat the key before inserting it into the k
404. ping  the engine over a short period of time may  make the vehicle more difficult to start     5  To stop the engine  shift the shift selector to  the P  Park  position and push the ignition  switch to the OFF position     Starting and driving 5 11    NOTE     Care should be taken to avoid situations  that can lead to potential battery discharge  and potential no start conditions such as     1  Installation or extended use of electronic  accessories that consume battery power  when the engine is not running  Phone char   gers  GPS  DVD players  etc      2  Vehicle is not driven regularly and or only  driven short distances  In these cases  the  battery may need to be charged to maintain  battery health     5 12 Starting and driving    DRIVING THE VEHICLE                                           LSD0238          CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE  TRANSMISSION  CVT     AWARNING    Do not depress the accelerator pedal  while shifting from P  Park  or N  Neu   tral  to R  Reverse   D  Drive   Ds  Drive  Sport  or  M  Manual shift mode  Al   ways depress the brake pedal until  shifting is completed  Failure to do so  could cause you to lose control and  have an accident     Cold engine idle speed is high  so use  caution when shifting into a forward or  reverse gear before the engine has  warmed up     Do not downshift abruptly on slippery  roads  This may cause a loss of control     Never shift to P  Park  or R  Reverse   while the vehicle is moving  This could  cause an accident     Except
405. ppear  contact a NISSAN  dealer                  z09     DOL          Type A    WIC1435                 z007    zo             WIC1436    Type B  HEADLIGHT CONTROL SWITCH    Lighting       When turning the switch to the D   posi   tion  the front parking  tail  license plate and  instrument panel lights come on       When turning the switch to the     posi   tion  the headlights come on and all the other  lights remain on        A CAUTION    Use the headlights with the engine run   ning to avoid discharging the vehicle  battery                 LIC1086       Autolight system    The autolight system allows the headlights to be  set so they turn on and off automatically  The  autolight system can       Turn on the headlights  front parking  tail   license plate and instrument panel lights au   tomatically when it is dark         Turn off all the lights when it is light       Keep all the lights on for a period of time after  you place the ignition switch in the OFF  position and all doors are closed     Instruments and controls 2 31    To turn on the autolight system     1  Place the headlight switch in the AUTO po   sition  1      2  Place ignition in the ON position     3  The autolight system automatically turns the  headlights on and off     Initially  if the ignition switch is placed in the OFF  position and a door is opened and left open  the  headlights remain ON for a period of time  If  another door is opened while the headlights are  on  then the timer is reset     To 
406. pped with the Intelligent Key     When all doors are locked and the trunk lid is  closed with the Intelligent Key inside the trunk   the outside buzzer will sound and the trunk will  open     HOW TO USE THE REMOTE  KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION    The remote keyless entry function can operate all  door locks using the remote keyless function of  the Intelligent Key  The remote keyless function  can operate at a distance of 33 ft  10 m  away  from the vehicle  The operating distance de   pends upon the conditions around the vehicle     The remote keyless entry function will not func   tion under the following conditions       When the Intelligent Key is not within the  operational range       When the doors or the trunk are open or not  closed securely       When the Intelligent Key battery is dis   charged   A CAUTION    When locking the doors using the Intelli   gent Key  be sure not to leave the key in  the vehicle                       WPD0359       Locking doors    1     Place the ignition switch in the LOCK posi   tion       Close all doors       Press the    button on the Intelligent  Key       The hazard warning lights flash twice and    the horn beeps once       All doors will be locked     A CAUTION    After locking the doors using the Intelli   gent Key  be sure that the doors have been  securely locked by operating the door  handles     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 13       a  d             WPD0360       Unlocking doors    1  Press the uj  Key        button on the
407. procedure is only a  general guide  The vehicle must be driven as  appropriate based on the conditions of the ve   hicle  road and traffic     AWARNING    The following actions can increase the  chance of losing control of the vehicle if  there is a sudden loss of tire air pressure   Losing control of the vehicle may cause a  collision and result in personal injury     e The vehicle generally moves or pulls in  the direction of the flat tire       Do not rapidly apply the brakes      Do not rapidly release the accelerator  pedal    e Do not rapidly turn the steering wheel     1  Remain calm and do not over react     2  Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel  with both hands and try to hold a straight  course     3  When appropriate  slowly release the accel   erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle     4  Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe location  off the road and away from traffic if possible     5  Lightly apply the brake pedal to gradually  stop the vehicle     6  Turn on the hazard warning flashers and  either contact a roadside emergency service  to change the tire or see  Changing a flat  tire  in the  In case of emergency    section of  this manual     DRINKING ALCOHOL DRUGS AND  DRIVING    AWARNING    Never drive under the influence of alcohol  or drugs  Alcohol in the bloodstream re   duces coordination  delays reaction time  and impairs judgement  Driving after  drinking alcohol increases the likelihood  of being involved in an accident injuring  yoursel
408. ptions  available  Press the 4  button on the steering  wheel to mute the receiving voice and enter com   mands          Help      The system announces the avail   able commands          Go back Correction      The system an   nounces  Go back   ends the VR session  and returns to the call          Cancel Ouit      The system announces   Cancel   ends the VR session and returns  to the call         Send Enter Call Dial      Use the Send    command to enter numbers      or         during  a call  For example  if you were directed to  dial an extension by an automated system     Say   Send one two three four      The system acknowledges the command  and sends the tones associated with the  numbers  The system then ends the VR ses     sion and returns to the call  Say  star  for       Say  pound  for                  Transfer call      Use the Transfer Call com   mand to transfer the call from the  Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone System to  the cellular phone when privacy is desired     The system announces     Transfer call  Call  transferred to privacy mode     The system  then ends the VR session     To reconnect the call from the cellular phone  to the Bluetooth   Hands Free System   press the f  button          Mute        Use the Mute command to mute  your voice so the other party cannot hear it   Use the mute command again to unmute  your voice     NOTE     If a call is ended or the cellular phone  network connection is lost while the Mute  feature is on  the Mute feature wi
409. quipped     The HomeLink   Universal Transceiver provides  a convenient way to consolidate the functions of  up to three individual hand held transmitters into  one built in device     HomeLink   Universal Transceiver         Will operate most Radio Frequency  RF   devices such as garage doors  gates  home  and office lighting  entry door locks and se   curity systems          s powered by your vehicle s battery  No  separate batteries are required  If the vehi   cle s battery is discharged or is discon   nected  HomeLink   will retain all program   ming     When the HomeLink   Universal Trans   ceiver is programmed  retain the original  transmitter for future programming proce   dures  Example  new vehicle purchases    Upon sale of the vehicle  the programmed  HomeLink   Universal Transceiver buttons  should be erased for security purposes  For  additional information  refer to    Program   ming HomeLink      later in this section     AWARNING    Do not use the HomeLink   Universal  Transceiver with any garage door  opener that lacks safety stop and re   verse features as required by federal  safety standards   These standards be   came effective for opener models  manufactured after April 1  1982   A ga   rage door opener which cannot detect  an object in the path of a closing garage  door and then automatically stop and  reverse  does not meet current federal  safety standards  Using a garage door  opener without these features in   creases the risk of serious injury or  d
410. r   eight oh oh   500  700  and 900 are also  supported     Examples       1 800 662 6200         One eight zero zero six six two six two  zero zero          One eight hundred six six two six two  zero zero     Improving Recognition of Phone numbers     You can improve the recognition of phone num   bers by saying the phone number in three groups  of numbers  For example  when you try to call  800 662 6200  say  eight zero zero  first  and  the system will then ask you for the next three  digits  Then  say  six six two   After recognition   the system will then ask for the last four digits     Say   six two zero zero   Using this method of  phone digit entry can improve recognition perfor   mance     NOTE     When speaking a house number  speak the  number    0    as    zero    or    oh     If the letter   O  is included in the house number  it will  not be recognized as    0    even if you speak     oh    instead of    zero        Settings menu    The content of the Settings Menu differs when  the system is in the Alternate Command Mode     Command List     Displays the command list for Alternate Com   mand Mode     User Guide     The user guide provides basic instructions for  using Voice Recognition and accessing some  voice commands     NOTE     The user guide can also be accessed from  within the INFO menu after pressing the  INFO button     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 149    Speaker Adaptation     Starts a system training procedure to 
411. r  as soon as possible         Keep used engine oil out of reach of    children     A CAUTION    Be careful notto burn yourself  The engine  oil may be hot     7     10     Clean and reinstall the drain plug and a new  washer  Securely tighten the drain plug with  a wrench  Do not use excessive force     Drain plug tightening torque   22   29 ft Ib  29   39 N m     Refill engine with recommended oil through  the oil filler opening  then install the oil filler  cap securely     See    Capacities and recommended  fuel lubricants  in the    Technical and con   sumer information    section of this manual for  drain and refill capacity     The drain and refill capacity depends on the  oil temperature and drain time  Use these  specifications for reference only  Always use  the dipstick to determine when the proper  amount of oil is in the engine     Start the engine  Check for leakage around  the drain plug and oil filter  Correct as re   quired     Turn the engine off and wait more than  10 minutes  Check the oil level with the  dipstick  Add engine oil if necessary     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 11       A        EN  UM    Gn                   LDI0642    CHANGING ENGINE OIL FILTER    1  Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply  the parking brake        2  Turn the engine off   3  Place a large drain pan under the oil filter        4  Loosen the oil filter   with an oil filter  wrench by turning it counterclockwise  Then  remove the oil filter by turning it by hand    
412. r  reverse  When the self test occurs  you may hear  a  clunk  noise and or feel a pulsation in the brake  pedal  This is normal and does not indicate a  malfunction  If the computer senses a malfunc   tion  it switches the ABS off and illuminates the  ABS warning light on the instrument panel  The  brake system then operates normally  but without  anti lock assistance     If the ABS warning light illuminates during the  self test or while driving  have the vehicle  checked by a NISSAN dealer     Normal operation    The ABS operates at speeds above 3   6 MPH  5    10 km h   The speed varies according to road  conditions     Starting and driving 5 25    When the ABS senses that 1 or more wheels are  close to locking up  the actuator rapidly applies  and releases hydraulic pressure  This action is  similar to pumping the brakes very quickly  You  may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a  noise from under the hood or feel a vibration from  the actuator when it is operating  This is normal  and indicates that the ABS is operating properly   However  the pulsation may indicate that road  conditions are hazardous and extra care is re   quired while driving     5 26 Starting and driving    VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL  VDC   SYSTEM    The Vehicle Dynamic Control  VDC  system uses  various sensors to monitor driver inputs and ve   hicle motion  Under certain driving conditions   the VDC System helps to perform the following  functions         Controls brake pressure to reduce wh
413. r  system   See  SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG  WARNING LIGHT    in this section for more de   tails   If the operation of the supplemental air bag  warning light indicates there is a malfunction   have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer     When selling your vehicle  we request that you  inform the buyer about the pretensioner system  and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections  in this Owner s Manual                 WRS0895          LRS0100       1  SRS Air Bag Warning Labels  located   on the sun visors   SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG  WARNING LABELS    Warning labels about the supplemental front   impact air bag system are placed in the vehicle as  shown in the illustration     SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG  WARNING LIGHT    The supplemental air bag warning light   displaying Pf in the instrument panel  moni   tors the circuits for the air bag systems  preten   sioners and all related wiring     When the ignition switch is placed in the ON or  START position  the supplemental air bag warn   ing light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then  turns off  This means the system is operational     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 51    If any of the following conditions occur  the front  air bag  side air bag  curtain air bag and preten   sioner systems need servicing       The supplemental air bag warning light re   mains on after approximately 7 seconds       The supplemental air bag warning light  flashes intermittently       The supplemental air bag warning light
414. r decreasing the  hours     Offset  minute      Adjust the time by increasing or decreasing the  minutes     Daylight Savings Time     When this item is enabled  indicator light illumi   nated   daylight savings time is on  To turn off the  daylight savings time  touch the  ON  key  the  amber indicator light will go out        Settings  gt  Time Zone 8 00    Pacific             Mountain          Central             Eastern                Atlantic          Newfoundland                      LHA1243       Time Zone     Select the  Time Zone  key  the Time Zone  screen will appear     Select one of the following zones  depending on  the current location  by selecting the correct time  zone key to enable that time zone  indicator light  will illuminate for that location        Pacific       Mountain      Central      Eastern  e    Atlantic        Newfoundland      Hawaii      Alaska    After selection settings  press the BACK button  or any other mode button to accept the changes              Settings    Others 8 00    Comfort  e  Language  amp  Units e       Voice Recognition             Camera         Image Viewer       Adjust comfort  amp  convenience settings                LHA1248       Others settings    Select the    Others    key using the NISSAN con   troller  Voice recognition  language and units set   ting screen will be displayed     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 27       Settings  gt  Comfort 8 00            Auto Interior Illumination
415. r extended periods of time  with the engine stopped  This could result  in a discharged battery     PERSONAL LIGHTS                                        00 w 000 000  9  o  c gt        WIC1476 LIC1413 WIC1494   CONSOLE LIGHT To turn on the personal lights  press and release Models without moonroof       the switch  1    The console light will turn on whenever the park     ing lights or headlights are illuminated  To turn the personal lights off  press and release   the switch  1      The console light brightness can be adjusted  with the illumination brightness control     Instruments and controls 2 51             2 52       00  00    o    Models with moonroof    Instruments and controls    WIC1494                ON DOOR OFF    Ex o n                          LIC1409  Models with dual panel moonroof       MAP LIGHTS    To turn the map lights on  press the switches  To  turn them off  press the switches again     A CAUTION    Do not use for extended periods of time  with the engine stopped  This could result  in a discharged battery     TRUNK LIGHT    The light illuminates when the trunk lid is opened   When the trunk lid is closed  the light goes off     The light will go off after a period of time if the  trunk lid is left open  unless the ignition switch is  in the ON position     For bulb replacement procedures  refer to    Exte   rior and interior lights    in the    Maintenance and  do it yourself    section of this manual     HOMELINK   UNIVERSAL  TRANSCEIVER  if so e
416. r lock release    5 17  Control panel buttons           sss  4 16   Brightness contrast button           4 15  4 31   Enterbutton            less 4 4  4 16   Setting button            4 9  4 24   Without navigation system        a a   4 4  Controls   Audio controls  steering wheel          4 102   Heater and air conditioner   controls   ux hak m s 4 42  4 45  Coolant   Capacities and recommended   fuel lubricants            less 9 2   Changing engine coolant            8 9   Checking engine coolantlevel           8 9   Engine coolant temperature gauge       2 5  Corrosion protection             00  7 6  Cruise control    2    2 0 00  a a 5 19    10 2    Gup holders  aia kx E 2 40  2 41    Daytime running light system  Canada only    2 33  Defroster switch  Rear window and outside mirror defroster    SWIGOD ais 2 bees eke es UAE 2 29  Digital Versatile Disc  DVD  player          4 84  Dimensions and weights               9 8  Dimmer switch for instrument panel        2 33  Display controls   see control panel buttons           4 4  4 16  Distance to empty               4 7  4 21  DoorlOcks s  sra 4 4 E g ahat be ai 3 4  Drive belt  sus cm eds ee ES 8 17  Drive positioner  Automatico             3 28  Driving   Cold weather driving              5 28   Driving with Continuously Variable   Transmission  CVT            04  5 12   Precautions when starting and driving       5 2   E  Economy fuel    i cler ew 5 22  Emission control information label          9 10  Emission control s
417. r s  Manual for details  You can also visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth or call the  NISSAN Consumer Affairs Department for  instructions on connecting recommended  cellular phones     When the connecting is complete  the  screen will return to the Bluetooth   settings  Screen     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 121          Phone  gt  vehicle Phonebook   dili Ful 8 00                   Add New                                           LHA1320       S       ettings  gt  Edit vehicle Pho   Bo Mui 8 00                        Copy from Call History       Copy from the Handset          Enter Number by Keypad                   LHA1321             Phone  gt  vehicle Phonebook  o dili Yul sack     V                            Entry               Name             Number       XXX XXXX             Type Ej  7 Voicetag                                  LHA1381       VEHICLE PHONEBOOK    This vehicle has two phonebooks available for  your use  Depending on your phone  the system  may automatically download your entire cell  phone   s phonebook into the    Handset Phone   book     For the details on downloading your  phonebook  see    Handset phonebook    in this  section  If your phonebook does not automati   cally download  you may set up the vehicle  phonebook for up to 40 entries  This phonebook  allows you to record a name to speak while using  voice recognition     1  Push the PHONE button and select the    Ve   hicle Phonebook    key     2  Select the
418. rd or sharp object  If the  glass screen breaks  do not touch it   Doing so could result in an injury     e To clean the display  never use a rough  cloth  alcohol  benzine  thinner or any  kind of solvent or paper towel with a  chemical cleaning agent  They will  scratch or deteriorate the panel     e Do not splash any liquid such as water  or car fragrance on the display  Contact  with liquid will cause the system to  malfunction     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 17    To help ensure safe driving  some functions can   not be operated while driving     The on screen functions that are not available  while driving will be    grayed out    or muted     Park the vehicle in a safe location and then oper   ate the navigation system     AWARNING    e ALWAYS give your full attention to  driving       Avoid using vehicle features that could  distract you  If distracted  you could  lose control of your vehicle and cause  an accident        Settings         Navigation      Volume  amp  Beeps       Audio Display       Phone Clock             Bluetooth Others          Adjust navigation settings          LHA1227    Settings  gt  Volume  amp  Beeps    8 00          Ringtone     Jeccec ececes    gt     Incoming Call C   T PM PHO   Outgoing Call  lt   O i     OS   Switch Beeps     ON      2 7  6                                                        Use volume knob to adjust during playback          LHA1228       Touch screen operation    With this system  t
419. re to increase the cold tire  inflation pressure may result in  tire failure  loss of control and  possible injury  After such use   readjust tire pressure     e For additional information re   garding tires  refer to    Important  Tire Safety Information     US  or     Tire Safety Information      Canada  in the Warranty Infor   mation Booklet     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 33       TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION  RENSEIGNEMENTS SUR LES PNEUS ET LE CHARGEMENT    FRONT   SEATING CAPACITY   TOTAL   fini   x   NOMBRE DE PLACES REAR           E ARRIERE    and cargo should never exceed XX kg or XX Ibs                          O The combined weight of occupants  Le poids total des occupants et du chargement ne doit  jamais d  passer XXX kg ou XXX Ibs              COLD TIRE PRESSURE  PRESSION DES PNEUS A FROID    XXX kPa  XX psi  XXX kPa  XX psi  XXX kPa  XX psi    S MANUAL IONA    DIMENSIONS   0  P XXX   XXR XX  P XXX   XX R XX    oet as   T XXX XX D XX                     LDI2000       Tire and loading information label     Q  Seating capacity  The maximum num   ber of occupants that can be seated  in the vehicle       Vehicle load limit  See loading infor   mation in the    Technical and con   sumer information    section      S  Original tire size  The size of the tires  originally installed on the vehicle at  the factory     8 34 Maintenance and do it yourself     4  Cold tire pressure  Inflate the tires to  this pressure when the tires are cold   Tires are considered COLD
420. rec    ommended or equivalent ones     A  WARNING    Be sure the engine and ignition switch are  off and that the parking brake is engaged  securely     A CAUTION    Be sure to use the correct socket to re   move the spark plugs  An incorrect socket  can damage the spark plugs     If replacement is required  see your NISSAN  dealer for assistance     AIR CLEANER                         LDI2072             The air cleaner filter should not be cleaned and  reused  Replace it according to the maintenance  log shown in the    NISSAN Service and Mainte   nance Guide   When replacing the filter  wipe the  inside of the air cleaner filter housing and the  cover with a damp cloth     To remove the air cleaner filter         Unlatch the clips and move the air cleaner  cover upward         Remove the air cleaner filter         Wipe the inside of the air cleaner filter hous   ing and cover with a damp cloth     A  WARNING        Operating the engine with the air  cleaner removed can cause you or oth   ers to be burned  The air cleaner not  only cleans the air  it stops the flame if  the engine backfires  If it isn t there  and  the engine backfires  you could be  burned  Do not drive with the air cleaner  removed  and be careful when working  on the engine with the air cleaner  removed     e Never pour fuel into the throttle body or  attempt to start the engine with the air  cleaner removed  Doing so could result  in serious injury     IN CABIN MICROFILTER    The in cabin microfilter re
421. receive all of  the necessary data     The satellite radio mode will be skipped unless an  optional satellite receiver and antenna are in   stalled and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio service  subscription is active  Satellite radio is not avail   able in Alaska  Hawaii and Guam     Satellite radio performance may be affected if  cargo carried on the roof blocks the satellite radio  signal     If possible  do not put cargo over the satellite  antenna     A build up of ice on the satellite radio antenna can  affect satellite radio performance  Remove the  ice to restore satellite radio reception     XM    is a registered trademark of SiriusXM Sat   ellite Radio  Inc        COMPACT                LHAO0099          AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS    Compact disc  CD  player  models  without Navigation System     A CAUTION    e Do not force a compact disc into the CD  insert slot  This could damage the CD  and or CD changer player     e Trying to load a CD with the CD door  closed could damage the CD and or CD  changer     e Only one CD can be loaded into the CD  player at a time         Only use high quality 4 7 in  12 cm   round discs that have the    COMPACT  disc DIGITAL AUDIO  logo on the disc  or packaging         During cold weather or rainy days  the  player may malfunction due to the hu   midity  If this occurs  remove the CD  and dehumidify or ventilate the player  completely       e The player may skip while driving on  rough roads     The CD player sometimes cannot func   tion
422. replace  Step 2 with the cycling procedure noted in  the    Programing HomeLink   for Canadian  customers and gate openers    section     3  Press and hold the programmed  HomeLink   button and observe the indica   tor light     e if the indicator light  1  is  solid continuous  programming is  complete and your device should acti   vate when the HomeLink   button is  pressed and released          f the indicator light  D blinks rapidly for  two seconds and then turns to a  solid continuous light  continue  with Steps 4 6 for a rolling code device   A second person may make the following  steps easier  Use a ladder or other device     Do not stand on your vehicle to perform  the next steps       At the receiver located on the garage door  opener motor in the garage  locate the     learn    or    smart    button  the name and color  of the button may vary by manufacturer but it  is usually located near where the hanging  antenna wire is attached to the unit   If there  is difficulty locating the button  reference the  garage door opener s manual       Press and release the    learn    or    smart    but   ton       Return to the vehicle and firmly press and  hold the trained HomeLink   button for two  seconds and release  Repeat the   press hold release  sequence up to 3  times to complete the training process   HomeLink   should now activate your rolling  code equipped device       If you have any questions or are having diffi   culty programming your HomeLink   but   tons  r
423. res should be checked  when the tires are cold  The tires are  considered COLD after the vehicle has  been parked for 3 or more hours  or driven  less than 1 mile  1 6 km  at moderate  speeds     Set the tire pressure to the normal cold  tire inflation pressure when the vehicle  speed or load is reduced     Incorrect tire pressure  including un   der inflation  may adversely affect  tire life and vehicle handling     A WARNING    e Improperly inflated tires can fail  suddenly and cause an accident     e The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating   GVWR  is located on the  F M V S S  C M V S S  certifica   tion label  The vehicle weight ca   pacity is indicated on the Tire and  Loading Information label  if so  equipped   Do not load your ve   hicle beyond this capacity  Over   loading your vehicle may result in  reduced tire life  unsafe operat   ing conditions due to premature  tire failure  or unfavorable han   dling characteristics and could  also lead to a serious accident   Loading beyond the specified ca   pacity may also result in failure of  other vehicle components     e Before taking a long trip  or  whenever you heavily load your  vehicle  use a tire pressure gauge  to ensure that the tire pressures  are at the specified level     e Increase the cold tire inflation  pressure as indicated in  Check   ing tire pressure  later in this sec   tion when using the tires speci   fied by NISSAN above 100 MPH   162 km h  where it is legal to do  so  on a race track for example    Failu
424. rized position    Set the shift selector to the P  Park  position   then         Within 45 seconds of opening the driver s  door  push the memory switch  1 or 2  or        Place the ignition switch in the ON position  and push the memory switch  1 or 2      The driver s seat  steering column  and outside  mirrors will move to the memorized position with  the indicator light blinking  and then the light will  stay on for approximately 5 seconds     ENTRY EXIT FUNCTION    This system is designed so that the driver s seat  and automatic operation steering column will au   tomatically move when the shift selector is in the  P  Park  position  This allows the driver to get into  and out of the driver s seat more easily     3 30 Pre driving checks and adjustments    The driver s seat will slide backward and the  steering wheel will move up when the driver s  door is opened and the ignition switch is in the  LOCK position     The driver s seat and steering wheel will return to  the previous position when the driver s door is  closed and the ignition switch is pushed     The entry exit function can be adjusted or can   celed  See  Comfort  amp  Convenience settings   and  Comfort settings  in the  Monitor  climate   audio  phone and voice recognition systems   section of this manual     Restarting the entry exit function    If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse  opens  the entry exit function will be disabled   Drive the vehicle over 25 MPH  40 km h  to  restart the ent
425. rmation display  one or more of  your tires is significantly under inflated  If  equipped  the system also displays pres   sure of all tires  except the spare tire  on  the display screen by sending a signal  from a sensor that is installed in each  wheel     The TPMS will activate only when the  vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH   25 km h   Also  this system may not de   tect a sudden drop in tire pressure  for  example a flat tire while driving      For more details  refer to    Low tire pres   sure warning light    in the    Instruments and  controls    section     Tire pressure informa   tion    in the    Monitor  climate  audio  phone  and voice recognition    section     Tire  Pressure Monitoring System  TPMS     in  the    Starting and driving    section  and     Flat tire    in the    In case of emergency     section     Tire inflation pressure    Check the tire pressures  including the  spare  often and always prior to long dis   tance trips  The recommended tire pres   sure specifications are shown on the  F M V S S  C M V S S  certification label  or the Tire and Loading Information label  under the  Cold Tire Pressure    heading   The Tire and Loading Information label is  affixed to the driver side center pillar  Tire  pressures should be checked regularly  because       Most tires naturally lose air over time         Tires can lose air suddenly when  driven over potholes or other objects  or if the vehicle strikes a curb while  parking     The tire pressu
426. rn how to  store entries     When prompted by the system  say the name of  the phone book entry you wish to call  The system  acknowledges the name     If there are multiple locations associated with the  name  the system asks you to choose the loca   tion     Once you have confirmed the name and location   the system begins the call      Speak Digits     When prompted by the system  say the number  you wish to call  Refer to    How to say numbers     and    Making a call by entering a phone number     in this section for more details        Special Number          For dialing more than 10 digits or any special  characters  say    Special Number     When the  system acknowledges the command  the system  will prompt you to speak the number        Redial           Use the Redial command to call the last number  that was dialed     The system acknowledges the command  re   peats the number and begins dialing     If a redial number does not exist  the system  announces     There is no number to redial    and  ends the VR session        Call Back          Use the Call Back command to dial the number of  the last incoming call within the vehicle     The system acknowledges the command  re   peats the number and begins dialing     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 111    If a call back number does not exist  the system  announces     There is no number to call back    and  ends the VR session     During a call    During a call there are several command o
427. roller to  display Distance to Empty  Average Fuel  Economy and Fuel Economy History     Distance to empty  MI or km     The Distance to Empty  DTE  mode provides you  with an estimation of the distance that can be  driven before refueling  The DTE is constantly  calculated based on the amount of fuel in the fuel  tank and the actual fuel consumption  The display  is updated every 30 seconds  When the fuel level  is low  the DTE display will change to         NOTE         If the amount of fuel added while the  ignition switch is OFF is small  the dis   play just before the ignition switch is  placed in the OFF position may con   tinue to be displayed     e When driving uphill or rounding curves   the fuel in the tank shifts  which may  momentarily change the display     Average fuel economy  MPG or L 100 km     The Average Fuel Economy is calculated based  on fuel consumption since the last reset  The  display is updated every 30 seconds and 1 3 mi   500 m   After a reset or connecting the battery    kk ox    cables  the display might show          Resetting fuel economy    The average fuel economy calculation can be  reset to O  Press the INFO button and select the   Fuel Economy  key  then select the  Reset Fuel  Eco  key using the NISSAN controller        Information  gt  Fuel Eco History 8 00                                                                               Reset Interval Latest                   LHA1233       Fuel economy record    Press the INFO button  then
428. rough the access panel be   tween the rear seats  as shown  To open the trunk  lid from the rear seat       Fold down the center arm rest       Insert the mechanical key into the trunk com   partment access lid lock  Fold down the  trunk compartment access lid  For more in   formation on the mechanical key  see     NISSAN Intelligent Key     in this section       Pull the rear seat trunk release handle  1      To close  push the trunk lid down securely     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 19    FUEL FILLER DOOR             WPD0454       OPENING THE FUEL FILLER DOOR    The fuel filler door automatically unlocks when  the driver s door is unlocked     1     Unlock the fuel filler door using one of the  following operations       Unlock the driver s door with the keyfob         Push the power door lock switch to the  unlock position         Push the door handle request switch     To open the fuel filler door  push the right  side of the fuel filler door to release     3 20 Pre driving checks and adjustments    To lock  close the fuel filler door securely and  lock the doors     NOTE     The fuel filler door will unlock using the  key only when all doors are unlocked  Un   locking the driver s door will not unlock the  fuel filler door     FUEL FILLER CAP    A  WARNING    e Gasoline is extremely flammable and  highly explosive under certain condi   tions  You could be burned or seriously  injured if it is misused or mishandled   Always stop the engine and do not  smoke or all
429. rs  Tampering with  the pretensioner system may result in  serious personal injury       Work around and on the pretensioner  system should be done by a NISSAN  dealer  Installation of electrical equip   ment should also be done by a NISSAN  dealer  Unauthorized electrical test  equipment and probing devices should  not be used on the pretensioner system         If you need to dispose of a pretensioner  or scrap the vehicle  contact a NISSAN  dealer  Incorrect disposal procedures  could cause personal injury     The pretensioner system may activate with the  supplemental air bag system in certain types of  collisions  Working with the seat belt retractor   the pretensioner helps tighten the seat belt when    the vehicle becomes involved in certain types of  collisions  helping to restrain front seat occu   pants     The pretensioner is encased within the seat belt  retractor  These seat belts are used the same way  as conventional seat belts     When a pretensioner activates  smoke is re   leased and a loud noise may be heard  This  smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire   Care should be taken not to inhale it  as it may  cause irritation and choking  Those with a history  of a breathing condition should get fresh air    promptly     After pretensioner activation  load limiters allow  the seat belt to release webbing  if necessary  to  reduce forces against the chest     The supplemental air bag warning light 2 is    used to indicate malfunctions in the pretensione
430. ruise control is automatically canceled if         you depress the brake pedal while pushing  the ACCEL RES or SET COAST switch   The preset speed is deleted from memory       the vehicle slows down more than 8 MPH   13 km h  below the set speed         you move the shift selector to N  Neutral    5 20 Starting and driving    To reset at a faster cruising speed  use one  of the following three methods         Depress the accelerator pedal  When the  vehicle attains the desired speed  push and  release the COAST SET switch         Push and hold the ACCEL RES switch   When the vehicle attains the speed you de   sire  release the switch         Push and release the ACCEL RES switch   Each time you do this  the set speed in   creases by about 1 MPH  1 6 km h      To reset at a slower cruising speed  use one  of the following three methods         Lightly tap the brake pedal  When the ve   hicle attains the desired speed  push the  COAST SET switch and release it         Push and hold the COAST SET switch  Re   lease the switch when the vehicle slows to  the desired speed         Push and release the COAST SET switch   Each time you do this  the set speed de   creases by about 1 MPH  1 6 km h      To resume the preset speed  push and re   lease the ACCEL RES switch  The vehicle re   turns to the last set cruising speed when the  vehicle speed is over 25 MPH  40 km h      To turn off the cruise control  use one of the  following three methods         Push the CANCEL button       Ta
431. rupt starting and braking when  the cup holder is being used to prevent  spilling the drink  If the liquid is hot  it  can scald you or your passenger     e Use only soft cups in the cup holder   Hard objects can injure you in an  accident     2 40 Instruments and controls       To open the front cup holders  push the cup  holder lid  To close  lower the cup holder lid and  push down until it clicks in place     The rear cup holders are located in the fold down  armrest in the rear seat back                 LIC0423    Rear    To open the cup holders on the rear fold down    armrest  lift the cup holder lid  To close  lower the  lid                          WIC1216    Soft bottle holder  Soft bottle holder    A CAUTION      Do not use bottle holder for any other  objects that could be thrown about in  the vehicle and possibly injure people  during sudden braking or an accident       Do not use bottle holder for open liquid  containers        I             LIC1396       WIC1120          GLOVE BOX    Open the glove box by pulling the handle  Use the  mechanical key when locking  1  or unlocking  2   the glove box     AA WARNING    Keep glove box lid closed while driving to  help prevent injury in an accident or a  sudden stop     CONSOLE BOX  Upper half    Pull up on the driver s side latch to open the  upper half of the console box     The upper half of the console box may be used for  storage of cellular phones  An access hole is  provided at the front of the upper half of the
432. rvice     b  You suspect that exhaust fumes are  entering into the passenger  compartment     c  You notice a change in the sound of  the exhaust system     d  You have had an accident involving  damage to the exhaust system  un   derbody  or rear of the vehicle     THREE WAY CATALYST    The three way catalyst is an emission control  device installed in the exhaust system  Exhaust  gases in the three way catalyst are burned at  high temperatures to help reduce pollutants     AWARNING    The exhaust gas and the exhaust sys   tem are very hot  Keep people  animals  or flammable materials away from the  exhaust system components     Do not stop or park the vehicle over  flammable materials such as dry grass   waste paper or rags  They may ignite  and cause a fire     A CAUTION    Do not use leaded gasoline  Deposits  from leaded gasoline will seriously re   duce the three way catalyst   s ability to  help reduce exhaust pollutants     Keep your engine tuned up  Malfunc   tions in the ignition  fuel injection  or  electrical systems can cause overrich  fuel flow into the three way catalyst   causing it to overheat  Do not keep driv   ing if the engine misfires  or if notice   able loss of performance or other un   usual operating conditions are  detected  Have the vehicle inspected  promptly by a NISSAN dealer    Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel  level  Running out of fuel could cause  the engine to misfire  damaging the  three way catalyst     e Do not race the engine wh
433. ry exit function  You can also restart  the entry exit function using the following proce   dure     1  Connect the battery cable or replace the  fuse     2  Open and close the driver s door more than  2 times with the ignition switch in the LOCK  position     The entry exit function should now work properly     SYSTEM OPERATION    The automatic drive positioner system will not  work or will stop operating under the following  conditions         When the vehicle speed is above 4 MPH   7 km h          When any of the memory switches are  pushed while the automatic drive positioner  is operating        When the adjusting switch for the driver s  seat is turned on while the automatic drive  positioner is operating         When the seat has been already moved to  the memorized position         When no seat position is stored in the  memory switch         When the shift selector is moved from P   Park  to any other position         When the driver s door remains open more  than 45 seconds and the ignition switch is  not in the ON position     The automatic drive positioner system can be  adjusted and canceled for vehicles with naviga   tion system  See  Comfort  amp  convenience set   tings  and  Comfort settings  in the  Monitor   climate  audio  phone and voice recognition sys   tems  section of this manual     4 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice    recognition systems    Control panel buttons     color screen without    Navigation System  if so equipped               sis
434. ry or death in a  collision                 LRS2000    The illustration shows the seating positions  equipped with head restraints  All of the head  restraints are adjustable        A Indicates the seating position is equipped with  a head restraint       Indicates the seating position is not equipped  with a head restraint     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 7                                 4  2  3       LRS0887 WRS0134 LRS0888  Components Adjustment To raise the head restraint  pull it up     Head restraint Adjust the head restraint so the center is level      Adjustment notches with the center of the seat occupant s ears     1  2   3  Lock knob  4  Stalks    1 8 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system          i    LRS0889                      LRS0890             LRS0891       To lower  push and hold the lock knob and push  the head restraint down     Removal    Use the following procedure to remove the ad   justable head restraints     1     Pull the head restraint up to the highest  position     2  Push and hold the lock knob     3  Remove the head restraint from the seat     4  Store the head restraint properly so it is not    loose in the vehicle     Reinstall and properly adjust the head re   straint before an occupant uses the seating  position     Install    1     Align the head restraint stalks with the holes  in the seat  Make sure the head restraint is  facing the correct direction  The stalk with  the adjustme
435. ry when you have  lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate  from  If you still have a key  your NISSAN dealer  can duplicate it     ACAUTION    Listed below are conditions or occur   rences which will damage the Intelligent  Key       Do not allow the Intelligent Key  which  contains electrical components  to  come into contact with water or salt  water  This could affect the system  function     e Do not drop the Intelligent Key       Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply  against another object       Do not change or modify the Intelligent  Key     e Wetting may damage the Intelligent  Key  If the Intelligent Key gets wet  im   mediately wipe until it is completely dry       Do not place the Intelligent Key for an  extended period in an area where tem   peratures exceed 140 F  60 C      e Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a  key holder that contains a magnet       Do not place the Intelligent Key near  equipment that produces a magnetic  field  such as a TV  audio equipment and  personal computers        VS          SPA1951       Mechanical key    The Intelligent Key contains the mechanical key   which can be used in case of a discharged bat   tery     To remove the mechanical key  release the lock  knob on the back of the Intelligent Key     To install the mechanical key  firmly insert it into  the Intelligent Key until the lock knob returns to  the lock position     The mechanical key can be used for operation in  the same way as an ordinary key     ACAUTIO
436. s          2  The word  radial           The word  radial  is shown if the tire has    radial structure    Manufacturer or brand name  Manufacturer or brand name is shown   Other Tire related Terminology    In addition to the many terms that are  defined throughout this section  Intended  Outboard Sidewall is  1  the sidewall that  contains a whitewall  bears white lettering  or bears manufacturer  brand  and or  model name molding that is higher or  deeper than the same molding on the  other sidewall of the tire  or  2  the out   ward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical  tire that has a particular side that must  always face outward when mounted on a  vehicle     TYPES OF TIRES    A  WARNING    e When changing or replacing tires  be  sure all four tires are of the same type   i e   Summer  All Season or Snow  and  construction  A NISSAN dealer may be  able to help you with information about  tire type  size  speed rating and  availability     e Replacement tires may have a lower  speed rating than the factory equipped  tires  and may not match the potential  maximum vehicle speed  Never exceed  the maximum speed rating of the tire         For additional information regarding  tires  refer to    Important Tire Safety In   formation   US  or  Tire Safety Informa   tion   Canada  in the Warranty Informa   tion Booklet     All season tires    NISSAN specifies All Season tires on some mod   els to provide good performance all year  includ   ing snowy and icy road conditions  All S
437. s  screen is dis   played  press the PHONE button on the  instrument panel to hang up  If any other  screen is currently displayed  press the  PHONE button to display the  Call in Prog   ress  screen first  then press the PHONE  button again to hang up           Settings  gt  Phone Go dm Yu 8 00                Edit Vehicle Phonebook       Delete Phonebook       Download Handset Phonebook             Volume  amp  Ringtone          Auto Downloaded                Add or edit phonebook entries             LHA1319       PHONE SETTINGS    To set up the Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System to your preferred settings  press the SET   TING button on the instrument panel and select  the  Phone  key on the display     Edit Vehicle Phonebook    See  Vehicle Phonebook    in this section for add   ing  editing and deleting contacts in the vehicle  phonebook     Delete Phonebook   Delete a phonebook stored on the system     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 127    Download Handset Phonebook    See    Handset Phonebook    in this section for  adding  editing and deleting contacts in the  handset phonebook           Settings  gt  Volume  amp  Ringto   Bo dH Fal 8 00    qoeceee eee       5  ITT    zo    Outgoing Call     CRIT          Automatic Hold                  Ringtone       Incoming Call                                                ig    1 5    Vehicle Ringtone                      LHA1325       Settings  gt  Bluetooth  o i Yul 8 00                Bluetoot
438. s are closed       shift selection lever is in P  Park      The battery saver feature will be cancelled if any  of the following occur       any door is opened       shift selection lever is moved out of P  Park        ignition switch changes position    ON  Normal operating position      This position turns on the ignition system and  electrical accessories     A CAUTION    Do not leave the vehicle with the ignition  switch in ACC or ON positions when the  engine is not running for an extended pe   riod  This can discharge the battery     EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF    To shut off the engine in an emergency situation  while driving  perform the following procedure         Rapidly push the push button ignition switch 3  consecutive times in less than 1 5 seconds  or        Push and hold the push button ignition switch  for more than 2 seconds                       WSD0232             NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY    BATTERY DISCHARGE    If the battery of the Intelligent Key is almost dis   charged  the guide light  A  of the Intelligent Key  port blinks and the indicator appears on the ve   hicle information display  See    Vehicle informa   tion display    in the    Instruments and controls     section     In this case  inserting the Intelligent Key into the  port  8  allows you to start the engine  Make sure  the Intelligent Key is placed in the correct direc   tion  The front side faces upward and the key ring  side faces downward as illustrated     Starting and driving 5 9        
439. s free telephone call with  your cellular phone in the vehicle     Once your cellular phone is connected to the  in vehicle phone module  no other phone con   necting procedure is required  Your phone is  automatically connected with the in vehicle    phone module when the ignition switch is placed  in the ON position with the connected cellular  phone turned on and carried in the vehicle     You can register up to 5 different Bluetooth    cellular phones to the in vehicle phone module   However  you can talk on only one cellular phone  at a time     NISSAN Voice Recognition system supports the  phone commands  so dialing a phone number  using your voice is possible  For more details  see     NISSAN Voice Recognition System    in this sec   tion     Before using the Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System  refer to the following notes         Set up the wireless connection between a  cellular phone and the in vehicle phone  module before using the hands free phone  System         Some Bluetooth   enabled cellular phones  may not be recognized by the in vehicle  phone module  Please visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth for a recom   mended phone list and connecting         You will not be able to use a hands free  phone under the following conditions         Your vehicle is outside of the cellular ser   vice area         Your vehicle is in an area where it is  difficult to receive cellular signal  such as  in a tunnel  in an underground parking  garage  near a tall building or in a
440. s needed  especially  in sharp turns and at low speeds     AWARNING    If the engine is not running or is turned off  while driving  the power assist for the  steering will not work  Steering will be  harder to operate     5 24 Starting and driving    BRAKE SYSTEM    The brake system has two separate hydraulic  circuits  If one circuit malfunctions  you will still  have braking at 2 wheels     BRAKE PRECAUTIONS  Vacuum assisted brakes    The brake booster aids braking by using engine  vacuum  If the engine stops  you can stop the  vehicle by depressing the brake pedal  However   greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will be  required to stop the vehicle and stopping dis   tance will be longer     Using the brakes    Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal while  driving  This will overheat the brakes  wear out the  brake pads faster  and reduce gas mileage     To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the  brakes from overheating  reduce speed and  downshift to a lower gear before going down a  slope or long grade  Overheated brakes may  reduce braking performance and could result in  loss of vehicle control     AWARNING      While driving on a slippery surface  be  careful when braking  accelerating or  downshifting  Abrupt braking or accel   erating could cause the wheels to skid  and result in an accident         If the engine is not running or is turned  off while driving  the power assist for  the brakes will not work  Braking will be  harder     Wet brakes    When 
441. s retain new vehicle appearance  Polishing is  recommended to remove built up wax residue  and to avoid a weathered appearance before  re applying wax     A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the  proper product         Wax your vehicle only after a thorough wash   ing  Follow the instructions supplied with the  wax         Do not use a wax containing any abrasives   cutting compounds or cleaners that may  damage the vehicle finish     Machine compounding or aggressive polishing  on a base coat clear coat paint finish may dull the  finish or leave swirl marks     REMOVING SPOTS    Remove tar and oil spots  industrial dust  insects   and tree sap as quickly as possible from the  surface of the paint to avoid lasting damage or  staining  Special cleaning products are available  at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessory  store     UNDERBODY    In areas where road salt is used in winter  it is  necessary to clean the underbody regularly in  order to prevent dirt and salt from building up and  causing the acceleration of corrosion on the un   derbody and suspension  Before the winter pe   riod and again in the spring  the underseal must  be checked and  if necessary  retreated        Ot     x          WAI0007       GLASS    When cleaning the rear window  it may be easier  to clean if the high mounted stop light  if so  equipped  is removed first     Be careful when removing the high mounted  stop light to reduce the risk of damaging the  high mounted stop light wires   
442. s section     Reverse tilt down feature  if so  equipped    The reverse tilt down feature will turn both out   side mirror surfaces downward to provide better    rear visibility close to the vehicle when the small  switch is in either the L or R position     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 27    NOTE     If the outside mirror control switch is in the  neutral position  neither mirror will turn  downward when the shift selector is moved  to R  Reverse      Move the shift selector to R  Reverse   Both  mirrors will turn downward     The mirror surfaces will return to their original  position when any of the following have occurred         The shift selector is moved to any position  other than R  Reverse          Theoutside mirror control switch is set to the  neutral or center position         The ignition switch is placed in the OFF  position     3 28 Pre driving checks and adjustments                   MPA0008       Foldable outside mirrors  Pull the outside mirror toward the door to fold it   Heated mirrors  if so equipped     The electric control type outside mirrors can be  heated to defrost  defog  or de ice for improved  visibility  Push the rear window defogger switch  to activate the heating function  Push the switch  again to deactivate  or the heating function will  automatically turn off after approximately 15 min   utes     AUTOMATIC DRIVE POSITIONER  if  so equipped     The automatic drive positioner system has two  features       Memory storage function    
443. s something that your NISSAN  dealer cannot assist you with or you would like to  provide NISSAN directly with comments or  questions  please contact the NISSAN Con   sumer Affairs Department using our toll free  number     For U S  customers  1 800 NISSAN 1   1 800 647 7261     For Canadian customers  1 800 387 0122    The Consumer Affairs Department will ask for the  following information         Your name  address  and telephone number        Vehicle identification number  attached to the  top of the instrument panel on the driver s  side         Date of purchase       Current odometer reading       Your NISSAN dealer s name      Your comments or questions    OR    You can write to NISSAN with the information at     For U S  customers  Nissan North America  Inc   Consumer Affairs Department  P O  Box 685003  Franklin  TN 37068 5003  or via e mail at   nnaconsumeraffairs nissan usa com    For Canadian customers  Nissan Canada Inc   5290 Orbitor Drive  Mississauga  Ontario L4W 4Z5  or via e mail at   information centre nissancanada com    If you prefer  visit us at   www nissanusa com  for U S  customers  or  www nissan ca  for Canadian customers     We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle     Table of  Contents    Illustrated table of contents   Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system  Instruments and controls   Pre driving checks and adjustments   Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition syste
444. s traction  limits  The road surface may be slippery     Turn signal hazard indicator    lights    The appropriate light flashes when the turn signal  Switch is activated     Both lights flash when the hazard switch is turned  on      S Vehicle Dynamic Control   VDC  OFF indicator light   This indicator light comes on when the Vehicle   Dynamic Control off switch is pushed to OFF     This indicates the Vehicle Dynamic Control has  been turned off     Push the Vehicle Dynamic Control off switch  again or restart the engine and the system will be  reactivated  See  Vehicle Dynamic Control   VDO  system  in the  Starting and driving  sec   tion of this manual     The Vehicle Dynamic Control light also comes on  when you push the push button ignition switch to    the ON position  The light will turn off after about  2 seconds if the system is operational  If the light  stays on or comes on along with the f indi   cator light while you are driving  have the Vehicle  Dynamic Control system checked by a NISSAN  dealer     While the Vehicle Dynamic Control system is  operating  you might feel slight vibration or hear  the system working when starting the vehicle or  accelerating  but this is normal     AUDIBLE REMINDERS  Brake pad wear warning    The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings   When a disc brake pad requires replacement  it  makes a high pitched scraping sound when the  vehicle is in motion  whether or not the brake  pedal is depressed  Have the brakes checked as  so
445. se     4  When appropriate  slowly release the accel   erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle     5  If there is nothing in the way  steer the ve   hicle to follow the road while vehicle speed  is reduced  Do not attempt to drive the ve   hicle back onto the road surface until vehicle  speed is reduced     6  When it is safe to do so  gradually turn the  steering wheel until both tires return to the  road surface  When all tires are on the road  surface  steer the vehicle to stay in the ap   propriate driving lane          f you decide that it is not safe to return the  vehicle to the road surface based on vehicle   road or traffic conditions  gradually slow the  vehicle to a stop in a safe place off the road     5 6 Starting and driving    RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSS    Rapid air pressure loss or a    blow out    can occur  if the tire is punctured or is damaged due to  hitting a curb or pothole  Rapid air pressure loss  can also be caused by driving on under inflated  tires     Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handling  and stability of the vehicle  especially at highway  speeds     Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by maintain   ing the correct air pressure and visually inspect  the tires for wear and damage  See    Wheels and  tires    in the    Maintenance and do it yourself     section of this manual  If a tire rapidly loses air  pressure or    blows out    while driving  maintain  control of the vehicle by following the procedure  below  Please note that this 
446. se 4 4  How to use the NISSAN controller                 4 5  How to select menus on the screen                4 6  How to use the STATUS button                   4 6  How to use the INFO button                00005 4 6  How to use the SETTING button                  4 9  XH   OFF button    n on 0c cece cecccceeeeeees 4 15   Control panel buttons     color screen with   Navigation System  if so equipped               ise  4 16  How to use the NISSAN controller                4 17  How to use the touch screen              uuuue  4 17  How to select menus on the screen               4 19  How to use the STATUS button                  4 20  How to use the INFO button                005  4 20  How to use the SETTING button                 4 24  XH   OFF button          0c cece ceccccceeeeees 4 31   Image viewer  if so equipped               eee eens 4 32  Using the image viewer         0 000 eces eee eee 4 32   RearView Monitor  if so equipped               ssss  4 34    How to read the displayed lines                   4 35    How to park with predicted course lines            4 35  Difference between predicted and actual  distanCeS   ise x RR ute dug 4 37  How to adjust the screen    4 39  Operating tips    eese pee metae ce ene 4 39  Vents  serapah n Sara Reet hoagie cmeuels tan wee tee 4 40  Heater and air conditioner  automatic   Type A         4 41  Automatic operation          0  000 cece eee eee 4 42  Manual operatios   ecc teer RP IR IPC ies 4 43  Operatindtlps  ereitea 
447. seat should  be upright  Always sit well back in the  seat with both feet on the floor and  adjust the seat properly  See    Precau   tions on seat belt usage  later in this  section     After adjustment  gently rock in the seat  to make sure it is securely locked     Do not leave children unattended inside  the vehicle  They could unknowingly ac   tivate switches or controls  Unattended  children could become involved in seri   ous accidents     1 2 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system        The seatback should not be reclined  any more than needed for comfort  Seat  belts are most effective when the pas   senger sits well back and straight up in  the seat  If the seatback is reclined  the  risk of sliding under the lap belt and  being injured is increased     A CAUTION    When adjusting the seat positions  be  sure not to contact any moving parts to  avoid possible injuries and or damage                    LRS2190       FRONT POWER SEAT ADJUSTMENT  Operating tips        The power seat motor has an auto reset  overload protection circuit  If the motor  stops during operation  wait 30 seconds   then reactivate the switch         Do not operate the power seat switch for a  long period of time when the engine is off   This will discharge the battery     See  Automatic drive positioner  in  Pre driving  checks and adjustments  for automatic drive po   sitioner operation     Forward and backward    Moving the switch forward or backward will slide  the sea
448. sing  the ENTER button  or    e Hold the 3 2 OFF button for approxi   mately 2 seconds and the message  resum   ing display  will appear and the  Display ON   key will be automatically turned on  no am   ber indicator      Background color     Select the  Background Color  key  the display  color changes between day and night     The new settings are automatically saved when  you exit the setting screen by pressing the BACK  button or any other mode button        E Settings  gt  Switch Beeps       Switch Beeps                            SHON oc  LO    SCC eins t            Beep when a button is pushed          LHA1305         Settings  gt  Camera       Predictive Course Lines                         SON oe  LO       SCC onset                When backing  display car width approximation       LHA1306       C Settings  gt  Clock 8 00       On screen Clock o ON         C125             Clock Format          Daylight Savings Time o ON       Time Zone                Adjust Clock    umm anne  dovom Muerte                Display clock in top right corner of display          LHA1307       Switch beeps settings  Select the    Switch Beeps    key to adjust the  switch beeps settings     With this option on  indicator light illuminated   a  beep will sound if any control panel button is  pressed     Camera settings    Select the    Camera    key  The Camera settings  screen will appear     When this option is on  indicator light illumi   nated   predictive course lines will be displayed
449. sired level  press the AUDIO control knob re   peatedly until the radio or CD display reappears   If the control knob is not pressed for approxi   mately 10 seconds  the radio or CD display will  automatically reappear     4 76 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       Settings 8 00         Navigation   Volume  amp  Beeps         Audio Display          Phone   Clock         Bluetooth    Adjust navigation settings      Others                LHA1236       Speed Sensitive Volume  SSV      To change the SSV mode from OFF to 5  press  the SETTING button  Then select the    Audio    key  using the NISSAN controller  then press the EN   TER button  the audio settings screen will be  displayed  Select the       key or         key to change  the SSV     While in this screen you can also adjust the other  audio settings by selecting the corresponding  key     Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the  desired level  press the BACK button        Settings  gt  Audio 8 00         Bass C     cccccccceg EC  Treble C     cccccccces    gt      a       cocccccceg  R gt     Fade  RJ    coccccceeg  F gt       speed Sensitive Vol     EAE EIL T      te      1 7          Balance    rc                                        Adjust bass                LHA1256    Settings  gt  Audio 8 00         Balance      LO ccccccceeg  P  Fade  R   CPI    F gt        Speed Sensitive Vol           teeeeen    gt                                         DivX Registration Code            
450. sliding open or closed  The moonroof  will stop at the desired position     Tilting the moonroof  To tilt the moonroof         To tilt the moonroof up  push and release the  tilt switch  3   When the moonroof is open  it  will automatically close and then tilt up         Totilt the moonroof down  push and release  the tilt switch  3  or push the switch  2   toward the close position until it reaches the  first detent     2 48 Instruments and controls        To tilt the moonroof down and close the  sunshade at the same time  push the switch   2  to the close position until it reaches the  second detent     Auto reverse function  when closing or  tilting down the moonroof     The auto reverse function can be activated when  the moonroof is closed or tilted down by auto   matic operation when the ignition switch is  placed in the ON position or for a period of time  after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF  position  Depending on the environment or  driving conditions  the auto reverse func   tion may be activated if an impact or load  similar to something being caught in the  moonroof occurs     AWARNING    There are some small distances immedi   ately before the closed position which  cannot be detected  Make sure that all  passengers have their hands  etc   inside  the vehicle before closing the moonroof     When closing     If the control unit detects something caught in the  moonroof as it moves to the front  the moonroof  will immediately open backward     When tilti
451. specified on the  F M V S S C M V S S  certification  label         Do not load the front and rear axle to  the GAWR  Doing so will exceed the  GVWR     A WARNING    e Properly secure all cargo with  ropes or straps to help prevent it  from sliding or shifting  Do not  place cargo higher than the seat   backs  In a sudden stop or colli   sion  unsecured cargo could  cause personal injury     e Do not load your vehicle any  heavier than the GVWR or the  maximum front and rear GAWRs   If you do  parts of your vehicle  can break  tire damage could oc   cur  or it can change the way your  vehicle handles  This could result  in loss of control and cause per   sonal injury     e Overloading not only can shorten  the life of your vehicle and the  tire  but can also cause unsafe  vehicle handling and longer brak   ing distances  This may cause a  premature tire failure which  could result in a serious accident  and personal injury  Failures  caused by overloading are not    covered by the  vehicle s  warranty   MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS    Secure loose items to prevent weight  shifts that could affect the balance of your  vehicle  When the vehicle is loaded  drive  to a scale and weigh the front and the rear  wheels separately to determine axle  loads  Individual axle loads should not ex   ceed either of the gross axle weight rat   ings  GAWR   The total of the axle loads  should not exceed the gross vehicle  weight rating  GVWR   These ratings are  given on the vehicle certification la
452. splay and announced by the system  You  can complete your desired operation by simply  following the prompts given by the system  Not all  NISSAN Voice Recognition options are available  while in Standard Mode     For advanced operation  you can change to an  Alternate Command Mode that enables the op   eration of the display and audio system through  NISSAN Voice Recognition  When this mode is  active  an expanded list of commands can be  spoken after pushing the TALK         switch on  the steering wheel  and the voice command  menu prompts are turned off     In Alternate Command Mode the recognition  success rate may be affected because the num   ber of available commands and the ways of  speaking each command are increased  See   NISSAN Voice Recognition Alternate Com   mand Mode    in this section     To improve the recognition success rate when  Alternate Command Mode is active  try using the  Speaker Adaptation Function available in that  mode  See  Speaker Adaptation Function  in this  section  Otherwise  it is recommended that Alter   nate Command Mode be turned off and Standard  Mode be used for the best recognition perfor   mance     While using the NISSAN Voice Recognition sys   tem for certain Phone and Navigation features   you can switch to using manual controls  touch   screen  NISSAN controller  steering wheel con   trols  and the information you have already en   tered by voice control will be retained  To switch  to manual controls  select the  Manual Contr
453. ss  the ENTER button to view a full screen version of  the image     Image requirements        Image type  JPEG  File extensions    jpg    jpeg  Maximum resolution  2048 x 1536  Maximum size  2 MB  Colors  32 768  15 bit     Maximum file name length  253 bytes  dis   play only shows first 8 characters     Maximum folders  500    Maximum images per folder  1024             8 00                         Settings                   LHA1310    Settings  gt  Slideshow Settings 8 00                Slideshow Speed 5 sec  Slideshow Order                      Order List                         LHA1311    Settings  gt  Slideshow Speed 8 00      No Auto Change             5 sec          10 sec             30 sec                60 sec                L             LHA1312       Viewing images in a slideshow    To view all of the images on the device in a slide   show  first enter the full screen mode while viewing  one of the images  The slideshow control buttons  are located on the right side of the screen     Select the play key to begin the slideshow   The images shown on the screen will periodically  change at a given interval of time  To skip through  the images without waiting for them to change  automatically  select the M   key to skip back   ward orthe PP key to skip forward  Select the  stop key M to end the slideshow and return  tothe full screen display of the image currently on  the screen     Slideshow settings    While in slideshow mode  select the  Settings   key  The Slides
454. ssemblies in  use during a collision be replaced un   less the collision was minor and the  belts show no damage and continue to  operate properly  Seat belt assemblies  not in use during a collision should also  be inspected and replaced if either  damage or improper operation is noted     All child restraints and attaching hard   ware should be inspected after any col   lision  Always follow the restraint  manufacturer s inspection instructions  and replacement recommendations   The child restraints should be replaced  if they are damaged     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 13    PREGNANT WOMEN    NISSAN recommends that pregnant women use  seat belts  The seat belt should be worn snug and  always position the lap belt as low as possible  around the hips  not the waist  Place the shoulder  belt over your shoulder and across your chest   Never run the lap shoulder belt over your ab   dominal area  Contact your doctor for specific  recommendations     INJURED PERSONS    NISSAN recommends that injured persons use  seat belts  Check with your doctor for specific  recommendations     THREE POINT TYPE SEAT BELT  WITH RETRACTOR    AWARNING        Every person who drives or rides in this  vehicle should use a seat belt at all  times     e Do not ride in a moving vehicle when  the seatback is reclined  This can be  dangerous  The shoulder belt will not  be against your body  In an accident   you could be thrown into it and receive  neck or other serious
455. sses 3 5   Trunk lid lock opener lever       n a  3 18  Loose fuel cap warning              2 25  3 20    10 4    Low fuel warning light            2 13  2 24  Low tire pressure warning light       2 12  Low windshield washer fluid warning light     2 24  Luggage  See vehicle loading information     9 12    Maintenance  Changing the maintenance interval    4 8  4 22  Displaying the maintenance notice    reminder  4 2 eu xg os 4 8  4 23  General maintenance              8 2  Inside the vehicle             00  8 3  Maintenance precautions               8 5  Outside the vehicle               sn 8 2  Resetting the maintenance interval    4 8  4 22  Seat belt maintenance             1 18  Setting   us ae dob keen d 4 8  4 22  Under the hood and vehicle           8 4  Malfunction indicator light                 2 15  Map lights   lt 2 za xs seme Rom hen 2 52  Map pocketie cs ccc  yet eo oy rens Peete aid 2 38  Meters and gauges               0  2 3  Instrument brightness control          2 33  Mirror  Automatic anti glare inside mirror            3 25  Outside mirror control           s  3 27  Outside  mirrors    aep mes 3 27  Vanity MINOR  4 sun cer G6 atk ERR 3 24  MOGNO ee dor i ME 2 46  N  NISSAN Intelligent Key              3 2  3 7    NISSAN vehicle immobilizer    System     vas doe a Be wd 2 27  3 3  5 10  NISSAN voice recognition system        4 130  o  Octane rating  See fuel octane rating             9 4  Odometer ic wack ie x Rx 2 4   Oil  Capacities and recommended  fue
456. stations are now considering broadcasting  RDS deta     RDS can display       Station call sign  such as  WHFR 98 3          Station name  such as  The Groove        Music or programming type such as  Clas   sical      Country   or  Rock      When the  Text  key is selected with the NISSAN  controller on the display while the radio is playing   additional information is displayed on the screen     If the station broadcasts RDS information  the  RDS icon is displayed     Compact disc  CD  player operation    Place the ignition in the ACC or ON position and  insert the compact disc into the slot with the label  side facing up  The compact disc will be guided  automatically into the slot and start playing     If the radio is already operating  it will automati   cally turn off and the compact disc will play     If the system has been turned off while the com   pact disc was playing  pressing the  VOL ON OFF control knob will start the compact  disc     DISC button     When the DISC button is pressed with the sys   tem off and a compact disc loaded  the system  will turn on and the compact disc will start to play     When the DISC button is pressed with a com   pact disc loaded with the radio playing  the radio  will automatically be turned off and the compact  disc will start to play     lt  lt        l   SEEK CAT and TRACK    buttons                 When the SEEK CAT 4 button is pressed  while a compact disc is playing  the track being  played returns to its beginning  Press se
457. stem or front end structure   This could affect proper operation of  the supplemental front air bag system     e Tampering with the front air bag system  may result in serious personal injury   Tampering includes changes to the  steering wheel and the instrument  panel assembly by placing material  over the steering wheel pad and above  the instrument panel or by installing  additional trim material around the air  bag system     e Modifying or tampering with the front  passenger seat may result in serious  personal injury  For example  do not  change the front seats by placing mate   rial on the seat cushion or by installing  additional trim material  such as seat  covers  on the seat that are not specifi   cally designed to assure proper air bag  operation  Additionally  do not stow any  objects under the front passenger seat  or the seat cushion and seatback  Such  objects may interfere with the proper  operation of the occupant classifica   tion sensor  pattern sensor      1 48 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system        No unauthorized changes should be  made to any components or wiring of  the seat belt system  This may affect the  front air bag system  Tampering with  the seat belt system may result in seri   ous personal injury       Work on and around the front air bag  system should be done by a NISSAN  dealer  Installation of electrical equip   ment should also be done by a NISSAN  dealer  The Supplemental Restraint  System  SRS  wiring shou
458. stricts the entry of air   borne dust and pollen particles and reduces  some objectionable outside odors  The filter is  located behind the glove box  Refer to the   NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide  for  change intervals     If replacement is required  see your NISSAN  dealer     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 19    WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES                                        WDIO0194          CLEANING    If your windshield is not clear after using the  windshield washer or if a wiper blade chatters  when running  wax or other material may be on  the blade or windshield     Clean the outside of the windshield with a washer  solution or a mild detergent  Your windshield is  clean if beads do not form when rinsing with clear  water     Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked  in a washer solution or a mild detergent  Then  rinse the blades with clear water  If your wind   shield is still not clear after cleaning the blades  and using the wiper  replace the blades     8 20 Maintenance and do it yourself    A CAUTION    Worn windshield wiper blades can dam   age the windshield and impair driver  vision     REPLACING  Replace the wiper blades if they are worn    D Lift the wiper arm away from the windshield      2  Push the release tab  then move the wiper  blade down the wiper arm to remove      S  Remove the wiper blade     4  Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper  arm until it clicks into place        A CAUTION    e After wiper blade replacement  return  
459. structions to remove any  slack              9  Check to make sure the child restraint is  properly secured prior to each use  If the  seat belt is not locked  repeat steps 3  through 8     9   PY   OFF    WRS0698 LRS0865  Forward facing     step 10  10  If the child restraint is installed in the front                Forward facing     step 8    8  After attaching the child restraint  test it be     fore you place the child in it  Push it from side  to side while holding the child restraint near  the seat belt path  The child restraint should  not move more than 1 inch  25 mm   from  side to side  Try to tug it forward and check  to see if the belt holds the restraint in place   If the restraint is not secure  tighten the seat  belt as necessary  or put the restraint in    passenger seat  place the ignition switch in  the ON position  The front passenger air bag  status light 7   should illuminate  If this  light is not illuminated  see  Front passenger  air bag and status light    in this section   Move the child restraint to another  seating position  Have the system  checked by a NISSAN dealer     another seat and test it again  You may need  to try a different child restraint  Not all child  restraints fit in all types of vehicles     After the child restraint is removed and the seat  belt is fully retracted  the ALR mode  child re   straint mode  is canceled     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 33             LRS0243          INSTALLING TOP 
460. sun visor before return   ing the extension to its original  position     e Do not pull the extension sun visor  forcedly downward                    WPD0324       VANITY MIRRORS    To access the vanity mirror  pull the sun visor  down and flip open the mirror cover  The vanity  mirror will illuminate when the mirror cover is  open     MIRRORS    AUTOMATIC ANTI GLARE  REARVIEW MIRROR    The inside mirror is designed so that it automati   cally dims during night time conditions and ac   cording to the intensity of the headlights of the  vehicle following you  The automatic anti glare  feature is activated when the ignition switch is  placed in the ON position     NOTE     Do not hang any objects over the sensors   D or apply glass cleaner to the sensors   Doing so will reduce the sensitivity of the  sensors  resulting in improper operation                    WPD0446          Type A  Type A  The indicator light  2  will illuminate when the  automatic anti glare feature is operating     With the ignition switch placed in the ON posi   tion  press the    button as described       To turn off the anti glare feature  press    the        button  The indicator light will turn  off         To turn on the anti glare feature  press    the    button again  The indicator light  will turn on     For information on the compass display  if so  equipped   see    Compass display    in the    Instru   ments and controls    section of this manual     Pre driving checks and adjustments 3 25      
461. t    MP3 WMA CD     All Disc Repeat     1 Disc Repeat     1 Folder  Repeat     1 Track Repeat     All Disc Random      1 Disc Random     1 Folder Random     All Disc  Repeat    All Disc Repeat  All discs loaded will be re   peated    1 Disc Repeat  The disc that is currently playing  will be repeated    1 Track Repeat  The track that is currently playing  will be repeated    1 Folder Repeat  The folder that is currently being  accessed will be repeated    All Disc Random  All discs loaded will be played  in a mixed order    1 Disc Random  The tracks on the disc that is  currently playing will be played in a mixed order   1 Folder Random  The tracks in the folder that is  currently being accessed will be played in a  mixed order     SCAN button     While listening to a CD  press the SCAN button  to preview the first 10 seconds of each track on  the CD playing  Pressing the SCAN button again  during this 10 second period stops the scan and  the CD remains on that track        Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 67       CD EJECT           Current Selected disc         Press the   button  then press the slot  number  1     6  for the desired disc  The  compact disc will be ejected  If no slot num   ber  1     6  is pressed  the current loaded  disc will be ejected  If the ejected disc is not  removed within 15 seconds  the disc will  reload     All discs         Press and hold the  amp  button for more  than 1 5 seconds  The compact discs will be  ejec
462. t  may become overheated     Do not place anything hard or heavy on  the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar  objects  This may result in damage to  the climate controlled seat     Any liquid spilled on the seat should be  removed immediately with a dry cloth    The climate controlled seat has an air  filter  Do not operate the climate con   trolled seat without an air filter  This  may result in damage to the system     When cleaning the seat  never use  gasoline  benzine  thinner  or any simi   lar materials     If any malfunctions are found or the  climate controlled seat does not oper   ate  turn the switch off and have the  system checked by your NISSAN dealer     HEATED STEERING WHEEL  if so  equipped                         LIC0421       The heated steering wheel system is designed to  operate only when the surface temperature of the  steering wheel is below 68 F  20 C      Push the heated steering wheel switch to warm  the steering wheel after the engine starts  The  indicator light will come on     If the surface temperature of the steering wheel is  below 68 F  20 C   the system will heat the  steering wheel and cycle off and on to maintain a  temperature above 68 F  20 C   The indicator  light will remain on as long as the system is on     Push the switch again to turn the heated steering  wheel system off manually  The indicator light will  go off     NOTE     If the surface temperature of the steering  wheel is above 68 F  20 C  when the switch  is turned on 
463. t ex   ceed a 12 volt  120W  10A  power draw     Do not use double adapters or more  than one electrical accessory     Use power outlets with the engine run   ning to avoid discharging the vehicle  battery     Avoid using power outlets when the air  conditioner  headlights or rear window  defroster is on     Before inserting or disconnecting a  plug  be sure the electrical accessory  being used is turned OFF     Push the plug in as far as it will go  If  good contact is not made  the plug may  overheat or the internal temperature  fuse may open    When not in use  be sure to close the  cap  Do not allow water or any other  liquid to contact the outlet     STORAGE             LIC1393       MAP POCKETS          LIC0016                   w 2     o    dC ae 3              2     3A                             WIC1551          SEATBACK POCKETS    The seatback pockets are located on the back of  the driver s and passenger s seats  The pockets  can be used to store maps     SUNGLASSES HOLDER    To open the sunglasses holder  push and release     Only store one pair of sunglasses in the holder     AWARNING    Keep the sunglasses holder closed while  driving to prevent an accident     ACAUTION    e Do not use for anything other than  sunglasses         Do not leave sunglasses in the sun   glasses holder while parking in direct  sunlight  The heat may damage the  sunglasses     Instruments and controls 2 39                         LIC1395  Front    CUP HOLDERS    A CAUTION      Avoid ab
464. t forward or backward to the desired  position     Reclining    Move the recline switch backward until the de   sired angle is obtained  To bring the seatback  forward again  move the switch forward and  move your body forward  The seatback will move  forward     The reclining feature allows adjustment of the  seatback for occupants of different sizes for  added comfort and to help obtain proper seat  belt fit  See  Precautions on seat belt usage  later  in this section  Also  the seatback can be reclined  to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is  stopped and the shift selector is in P  Park      Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 3          LRS2191          Seat lifter  driver s seat     Push the front or rear end of the switch up or  down to adjust the angle and height of the seat  cushion                 LRS0862  Manual  if so equipped  Power  if so equipped   Lumbar support  driver s seat     The lumbar support feature provides lower back  support to the driver  Move the lever up or down   manual  or move the switch forward or backward   power  to adjust the seat lumbar area     1 4 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system       LRS2192          Interior trunk access    For models without a rear center console  the  trunk can be accessed from the passenger side  of the rear seat for loading and unloading  as  shown        Press down on the button on the rear parcel  shelf        Fold down the passenger side seatback   
465. t steps 1 and 2     4  Restart the engine while holding the device   which may have caused the interference   separate from the registered key     If the no start condition re occurs  NISSAN rec   ommends placing the registered key on a sepa   rate key ring to avoid interference from other  devices     BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE    Make sure the area around the vehicle is  clear     Check fluid levels such as engine oil  cool   ant  brake fluid  and window washer fluid as  frequently as possible  or at least whenever  you refuel     Check that all windows and lights are clean     Visually inspect tires for their appearance  and condition  Also check tires for proper  inflation     Lock all doors   Position seat and adjust head restraints   Adjust inside and outside mirrors     Fasten seat belts and ask all passengers to  do likewise     Check the operation of warning lights when  the ignition switch is pushed to the ON  position  See    Warning indicator lights and  audible reminders    in the    Instruments and  controls    section of this manual     STARTING THE ENGINE    1   2     Apply the parking brake     Move the shift selector to P  Park  or N   Neutral   P  Park  is recommended     The starter is designed not to operate if  the shift selector is in any of the driving  positions       Push the ignition switch to the ON position     Depress the brake pedal and push the igni   tion switch to start the engine     To start the engine immediately  push and  release the ign
466. t yourself 8 27    FRONT PARK TURN SIDEMARKER EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS          LIGHT Wattage  W  Bulb No    Bulb replacement requires the removal of the Headlight assembly    A d replacement is required  High  Halogen  65 9005  HB3   See your cae  Low  Halogen   if so equipped  55 H11  FOG LIGHTS  if so equipped  Low  Xenon   if so equipped  35 D2S    F Park Turn 3457NAK  Replacing the fog light bulb Side marker WY5W  If replacement is required  see your NISSAN Front fog light  if so equipped  H11  dealer  Front personal map lights      Glove box light    158  A CAUTION Vanity mirror light i          Step light   194     High pressure halogen gas is sealed   TET  inside the halogen bulb  The bulb may dad ite S  break if the glass envelope is scratched Poor switohiillumination     or the bulb is dropped  High mountsd stop light  Trunk light    When handling the bulb  do not touch R   bination light    the glass envelope EE A    Tail Stop      Use the same number and wattage as Turn signal  originally installed as shown in the Backup  reversing   chart  Sidemarker     Do notleave the bulb out of the fog light License plate light  for a long period of time as dust  mois  Foot well light    ture and smoke may enter the fog light  body and affect the performance of the  fog light    See a NISSAN dealer for replacement     Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest parts information     8 28 Maintenance and do it yourself          Headlight assemb
467. tall a forward facing child  restraint in the front seat  see   Forward facing child restraint in   stallation using the seat belts  later  in this section         Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air  Bag System  never install a rear   facing child restraint in the front  seat  An inflating air bag could seri   ously injure or kill a child  A rear   facing child restraint must only be  used in the rear seat         Be sure to purchase a child restraint  that will fit the child and vehicle   Some child restraints may not fit  properly in your vehicle       Child restraint anchor points are de   signed to withstand loads from child  restraints that are properly fitted         Never use the anchor points for adult  seat belts or harnesses       A child restraint with a top tether  strap should not be used in the front  passenger seat       Keep seatbacks as upright as pos   sible after fitting the child restraint       Infants and children should always  be placed in an appropriate child re   straint while in the vehicle     e When the child restraint is not in use   keep it secured with the LATCH system  or a seat belt  In a sudden stop or colli   sion  loose objects can injure occu   pants or damage the vehicle     ACAUTION    A child restraint in a closed vehicle can  become very hot  Check the seating sur   face and buckles before placing a child in  the child restraint     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    This vehicle is equipped with a universa
468. te switches or controls and become  trapped in a window  Unattended chil   dren could become involved in serious  accidents     The power windows operate when the ignition  switch is placed in the ON position  or for a  period of time after the ignition switch is placed in  the OFF position  If the driver s or passenger s  door is opened during this period of time  the  power to the windows is canceled           WIC1124            Window lock button   Power door lock switch   Front passenger s side automatic win   dow switch   Right rear passenger s side window  switch   Left rear passenger s side window  switch   Driver s side automatic window switch    Instruments and controls 2 43       Driver s side power window switch    The driver s side control panel is equipped with  switches to open or close all of the windows     To open a window  push the switch to the first  detent and continue to hold down until the de   sired window position is reached  To close a  window  pull the switch to the first detent and  continue to hold up until the desired window  position is reached     2 44 Instruments and controls             WIC1265    V  Delos    LICO718             Front passenger s power window  switch    The passenger s window switch operates only  the corresponding passenger   s window  To open  the window  push the switch to the first detent  and continue to hold it down until the desired  position is reached  1   To close the window  pull  the switch to the first detent and
469. ted one by one  If a disc is not removed  within 15 seconds or the  amp  button is  pressed again during the eject sequence   the entire disc eject sequence will be can   celed     When this button is pressed while a compact  disc is being played  the compact disc will eject  and the last source will be played     CD IN indicator     The slot numbers  1     6  will illuminate if CDs  have been loaded into the changer in CD mode  only     AUX IN jack    The AUX IN jack is located on the CD changer   The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any stan   dard analog audio input  such as from a portable  cassette tape player  MP3 player or a laptop  computer     Press the AUX button to play a compatible device  when it is plugged into the AUX IN jack     4 68 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       e                                     e   Q  9  0                     L FMAM   DISC               RPT  SCAN RDM                   TONS  AUX L    SEEK TRACK poi SZ          11 10 9 8 6 5    CD eject button TRACK button  VOL ON OFF control knob SEEK CAT button  Station select  1   6  buttons DISC button    TUNE FOLDER and AUDIO control  knob  Bass  Treble  Fade and Balance   AUX button     cr ca  o ST              RPT RDM button  SCAN button  FM AM button     No satellite radio reception is available  when the AUX button is pressed to ac   cess Satellite radio stations unless op   tional satellite receiver and antenna are  installed and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio  ser
470. telligent Key                        00  3 2  NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys           3 3   bo ET 3 4  Locking With Key  sse eterne rm ne 3 4  Locking with inside lock knob               iussus 3 5  Locking with power door lock switch               3 5  Automatic door locks           ssssseeseeseese 3 6  Child safety rear door lock            sssssesueuee 3 6   NISSAN Intelligent Key           lesse eese 3 7  Operating range  idae tined iaaea EEE 3 8  Door locks unlocks precaution                000  3 9  NISSAN Intelligent Key   Operation               3 10  How to use the remote keyless entry  TUDCUOD  idisse cod ed ded  aay  ee E G ted 3 13  Warning sigrials     sener kem mrt 3 15  Troubleshooting guide               eesseessees 3 16   aM UE 3 17   TUNK lid ETT 3 17    Opener operation               00  else 3 18  Interior trunk lid release             0 00  cece eee 3 19  Secondary trunk lid release  if so equipped         3 19  Fuel tfillerdoot  124 aco tease pr ears sean 3 20  Opening the fuel filler door                    4  3 20  F  el filler Gap   oce eee Ub pe 3 20  Tilt telescopic steering           6 0 cece eee eee uss 3 22  Manual operation  if so equipped                  3 23  Automatic operation  if so equipped                3 23  SUA VISOIS  sero hieeRRE takina pneg DE PUE 3 24  Vanity milf OIS     oceed rei ie pen eese cec evi ies 3 24  luli PEE 3 25  Automatic anti glare rearview mirror               3 25  Outside MIMOS  4  unpsse rae eR RERROC E
471. temperatures the washer solu   tion may freeze on the windshield and  obscure your vision which may lead to an  accident  Warm the windshield with the  defroster before you wash the windshield     A CAUTION    Do not operate the washer continu   ously for more than 30 seconds     Do not operate the washer if the  windshield washer fluid reservoir is  empty     Do not fill the windshield washer fluid  reservoir with washer fluid concen   trates at full strength  Some methyl al   cohol based washer fluid concentrates  may permanently stain the grille if  spilled while filling the windshield   washer fluid reservoir     Pre mix washer fluid concentrates with  water to the manufacturer   s recom   mended levels before pouring the fluid  into the windshield washer fluid reser   voir  Do not use the windshield washer  fluid reservoir to mix the washer fluid  and water     REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE  MIRROR  if so equipped   DEFROSTER SWITCH       LIC1387          Type A  To defrost the rear window glass and outside  mirrors  if so equipped   start the engine and  push the rear window defroster switch on  The  rear window defroster indicator light on the  switch comes on  Push the switch again to turn  the defroster off     The rear window defroster automatically turns off  after approximately 15 minutes   A CAUTION    When cleaning the inner side of the rear  window  be careful not to scratch or dam   age the rear window defroster     O Uy  REAR    LIC1388          Type B  NOTE   The 
472. tenance and do it yourself          WDI0394       Example    TIRE LABELING    Federal law requires tire manufacturers to  place standardized information on the  sidewall of all tires  This information iden   tifies and describes the fundamental  characteristics of the tire and also pro   vides the tire identification number  TIN   for safety standard certification  The TIN  can be used to identify the tire in case of a  recall        7  H  Tire speed rating  You should not  drive the vehicle faster than the tire    P215 65R15 95H speed rating     15  t             WDI0395  Example    Tire size  example  P215 65R15 95H  4  R  The    R    stands for radial     1  P  The  P  indicates the tire is de  5  Two digit number  15   This number    signed for passenger vehicles  not all is the wheel or rim diameter in inches   tires have this information   6  Two  or three digit number  95   This  2  Three digit number  215   This num  number is the tire s load index  It is a  ber gives the width in millimeters of measurement of how much weight  the tire from sidewall edge to side  each tire can support  You may not  wall edge  find this information on all tires be     3  Two digit number  65   This number  caise iis Not required bylaw     known as the aspect ratio  gives the  tire   s ratio of height to width     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 37       XX    XX  t t  2 3       t  4    Example     2  TIN  Tire Identification Number  for a  new tire  example  DOT XX XX XXX  XXXX     1 
473. th  The child re   straint should not move more than 1 inch   25 mm   from side to side  Try to tug it  forward and check to see if the LATCH at   tachment holds the restraint in place  If the  restraint is not secure  tighten the LATCH  attachment as necessary  or put the restraint  in another seat and test it again  You may  need to try a different child restraint or try  installing by using the vehicle seat belt  if  applicable   Not all child restraints fit in all  types of vehicles     Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 25    5  Check to make sure the child restraint is  properly secured prior to each use  If the  child restraint is loose  repeat steps 1  through 4              WRS0256          REAR FACING CHILD RESTRAINT  INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT  BELTS    1 26 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system    AWARNING    The three point seat belt with Automatic  Locking Retractor  ALR  must be used  when installing a child restraint  Failure to  use the ALR mode will result in the child  restraint not being properly secured  The  restraint could tip over or be loose and  cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or  collision  Also  it can change the opera   tion of the front passenger air bag  See     Front passenger air bag and status light     later in this section        WRS0256          Rear facing   step 1  Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the  Child  safety  and  Child restraints  sections before in   stalling a c
474. th de   fects or other reproductive harm  In addi   tion  certain fluids contained in vehicles  and certain products of component wear  contain or emit chemicals known to the  State of California to cause cancer and  birth defects or other reproductive harm     CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE  ADVISORY    Some vehicle parts  such as lithium batter   ies  may contain perchlorate material  The  following advisory is provided     Perchlorate  Material   special handling may apply  See  www dtsc ca gov hazardouswaste perchlorate         BLUETOOTH   is a  trademark owned by  Bluetooth SIG  Inc   and licensed to  Visteon and Clarion       Bluetooth      SiriusXM Satellite  Radio requires  subscription  sold  separately  Not  available in Alaska   Hawaii or Guam   For more  information  visit  WWNW siriusxm com        Siriusxm         2012 NISSAN NORTH AMERICA  INC     All rights reserved  No part of this Owner s  Manual may be reproduced or stored in a retrieval  system  or transmitted in any form  or by any  means  electronic  mechanical  photocopying   recording or otherwise  without the prior written  permission of Nissan North America  Inc     NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM    NISSAN CARES       Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs  Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealer are  our primary concerns  Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs     However  if there i
475. the  player may malfunction due to the hu   midity  If this occurs  remove the  CD DVD and dehumidify or ventilate  the player completely     The player may skip while driving on  rough roads     The CD DVD player sometimes cannot  function when the passenger compart   ment temperature is extremely high   Decrease the temperature before use     Only use high quality 4 7 in  12 cm   round discs that have the   COMPACT  disc DIGITAL AUDIO  or  DVD Video   logo on the disc or packaging     Do not expose the CD DVD to direct  sunlight     CDs DVDs that are of poor quality   dirty  scratched  covered with finger   prints  or that have pinholes may not  work properly     e Recordable compact discs  DVD R   DVDER DL     e Rewritable compact discs   DVD RW  DVD RW DL     Do not use the following CDs DVDs as  they may cause the CD DVD player to  malfunction         3 1 in  8 cm  discs   e CDs DVDs that are not round  e CDs DVDs with a paper label  e    CDs DVDs that are  warped   scratched  or have abnormal edges        This audio system can only play pre   recorded CDs DVDs  It has no capa   bilities to record or burn CDs DVDs     If the CD DVD cannot be played  one of  the following messages will be dis   played     CD DVD combination player  models  with Navigation System   e Do not force a disc into the CD DVD    insert slot  This could damage the  CD DVD player     e The following CDs DVDs are not guar   anteed to play         Copy control compact discs  CCCD   e Recordable compa
476. the instru   ment panel just behind the steering wheel  to  display the following modes     MPG     MPG MPH     Time Miles     Range      Tire Pressure     Exterior Temperature     Setting      Warning                Instruments and controls 2 17       MPG        Ava 18 1          LIC2171       LIC2172       TIME 20 38    333 3    miles                Fuel economy mode    The fuel economy mode can be selected to dis   play the instant fuel economy since the last reset     2 18 Instruments and controls    Average speed mode    The average speed mode can be selected to  display the average miles per gallon and miles per  hour since the last reset     LIC2173  Time Miles  km  mode    The time miles  km  mode can be selected to  show the time and distance driven since the last  reset        RANGE  21 miles          LIC2174    TIRE PRESSURES PSI    kkk kkk kkk kkk             LIC2175       Range mode    The range mode can be selected to give you an  estimation of the distance that can be driven  before refueling  The range is constantly calcu   lated based on the amount of fuel in the fuel tank  and the actual fuel consumption     Tire pressure mode    The tire pressure mode displays the tire pressure  information for your tires in the    area of the  vehicle information display     The order of tire pressure figures displayed on  the screen does not correspond with the actual  order of the tire position     If the vehicle has been off for awhile  the pres   sures will not be disp
477. the setting screen by pressing the BACK  button or any other mode button     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 25       Settings  gt  Color Theme 8 00       Black                                                          LHA1240       Settings  gt  Clock 8 00    On screen Clock                l Clock Format  24h     Offset  hour   a   Offset  min   4                                  Daylight Savings Time    Eastern    1 6             Time Zone             LHA2563       Color theme     Select the  Display  key  then select the  Color  Theme  key  The Color Theme select screen will  appear     Select the key for the desired color  The appear   ance of the background  arrows and bars will  change for all screens accordingly  You can  choose a black  blue or red color theme     Clock    The following display will appear after pressing  the SETTING button  then selecting the  Clock   key using the NISSAN controller     On screen Clock     When this item is enabled  indicator light illumi   nated   a clock is always displayed in the upper  right corner of the screen     This clock will indicate the time almost exactly  because it is always adjusted by the GPS system     4 26 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    Clock Format  24h      When this item is enabled  indicator light illumi   nated   the clock format will change from the  default 12 hour display to a 24 hour display     Offset  hour      Adjust the time by increasing o
478. the steering wheel     NOTE     If you do not wish to take the call when you    hear the ring tone  press the     button  on the steering wheel     For additional command options  see  List of  voice commands  later in this section     LIST OF VOICE COMMANDS    Main Menu     Call        Phonebook          Recent Calls          Connect Phone        Help       When you press and release the C  button on  the steering wheel  you can choose from the  commands on the Main Menu  The following  pages describe these commands and the com   mands in each sub menu     Remember to wait for the tone before  speaking     After the main menu  you can say  Help  to hear  the list of commands currently available any time  the system is waiting for a response     If you want to end an action without completing it   you can say  Cancel  or  Quit  at any time the  system is waiting for a response  The system will  end the VR session  Whenever the VR session is  cancelled  a double beep is played to indicate  you have exited the system        If you want to go back to the previous command   you can say  Go back    or  Correction  any time  the system is waiting for a response      Call     Main Menu   Call    Speak name         Phone Number        Speak Digits      Special Number           Redial            Call Back            Speak name          If you have stored entries in the phonebook  you  can dial a number associated with a name and  location     See    Phonebook    in this section to lea
479. the tire is inflated to the rec   ommended pressure  the vehicle must be  driven at speeds above 16 MPH  25 km h   to activate the TPMS and turn off the low  tire pressure warning light  Use a tire pres   sure gauge to check the tire pressure     The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning is active  as long as the low tire pressure warning light  remains illuminated     For additional information  see  Vehicle informa   tion display  in the  Instruments and controls   section and  Tire Pressure Monitoring System   TPMS   in the  Starting and driving  section and  in the  In case of emergency  section     TPMS malfunction     If the TPMS is not functioning properly  the low  tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi   mately 1 minute when the ignition switch is  placed in the ON position  The light will remain on  after the 1 minute  Have the system checked by a  NISSAN dealer  The CHECK TIRE PRESSURE  warning does not appear if the low tire pressure  warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS mal   function     For additional information  see  Tire Pressure  Monitoring System  TPMS     in the    Starting and  driving  section and  Tire pressure  in the  Main   tenance and do it yourself    section in this  manual     AA WARNING    e Radio waves could adversely affect  electrical medical equipment  Those  who use a pacemaker should contact  the electric medical equipment manu   facturer for the possible influences be   fore use         If the light does not illuminate with the
480. the vehicle and pushing the ignition  Switch to the ACC position  the steering wheel  moves to the previous position     Slide Driver Seat Back on Exit  Select to turn  on or turn off the driver s seat moving backward  for easy exit when the ignition switch is in the OFF  position and the driver s door is opened  After  getting into the vehicle and pushing the ignition  switch to the ACC position  the driver s seat  moves to the previous position     Return All Settings to Default  Select to  change all the comfort and convenience systems  to their default settings     4 14 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems                                     Settings    Language   Units 12 00  n n  i Select Language H  E Select Units B        2  Select language  LHA0934       Language   Units    Use the NISSAN controller to select the    Lan   guage   Units    key  Select which setting you want  to change using the NISSAN controller                                      Settings  gt  Select Language 12 00  R R  t  Engish       Fran  ais       eva      i          Select system language  LHA0935    Settings  gt  Select Units       US          Metric                      divonn       ommo inniti    LHA0936             Select Language     Select the    English    key  the    Frangais    key or the     Espa  ol    key to change the language shown on  the display     Select Units     Select the  US   mi    F  MPG  key or the  Metric    km    C  L 100 km  key to change the
481. the vehicle is washed or driven through  water  the brakes may get wet  As a result  your  braking distance will be longer and the vehicle  may pull to one side during braking     To dry the brakes  drive the vehicle at a safe  speed while lightly pressing the brake pedal to  heat up the brakes  Do this until the brakes return  to normal  Avoid driving the vehicle at high  speeds until the brakes function correctly     Parking brake break in    Break in the parking brake shoes whenever the  effect of the parking brake is weakened or when   ever the parking brake shoes and or drum rotors  are replaced  in order to assure the best brake  performance     This procedure is described in the vehicle service  manual and can be performed by a NISSAN  dealer     ANTI LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM   ABS     AWARNING        The Anti lock Braking System  ABS  is a  sophisticated device  but it cannot pre   vent accidents resulting from careless  or dangerous driving techniques  It can  help maintain vehicle control during  braking on slippery surfaces  Remem   ber that stopping distances on slippery  surfaces will be longer than on normal  surfaces even with ABS  Stopping dis   tances may also be longer on rough   gravel or snow covered roads  or if you  are using tire chains  Always maintain a  safe distance from the vehicle in front  of you  Ultimately  the driver is respon   sible for safety       Tire type and condition may also affect  braking effectiveness       When replacing tires  install
482. then come on and  the sound will resume  Programming is now  complete     4  Other buttons can be set in the same man   ner     If the battery cable is disconnected  or if the fuse  opens  the radio memory will be canceled  In that  case  reset the desired stations     List  AM and FM     Select the  List  key using the NISSAN controller  or touchscreen to see a list of the presets in the  AM  FM1 or FM2 preset banks        XM3  gt  Favorite Artists 8 00    Alert                            None  Add Current Artist   None  Add Current Artist              None  Add Current Artist        None  Add Current Artist   None  Add Current Artist                    LHA1375  Menu  SiriusXM Satellite Radio  if so  equipped     Select the    Menu    key using the NISSAN control   ler or touchscreen to see a list of options            Preset List     Displays the list of presets   Press and hold the touchscreen or ENTER  button on the NISSAN controller to save a  preset         Customize Channel List     deselect chan   nels to skip while using the TUNE FOLDER  knob         Favorite Artist  amp  Songs        Tags the current artist or song playing on  SiriusXM Satellite Radio as a favorite         Turn the Alert ON to indicate whenever a  favorite artist or song is playing on Sirius  XM Satellite Radio  The audio system  must be playing Sirius XM Satellite Radio  for this feature to work         Delete a favorite artist or song         Categories     Displays a category list for  SiriusXM S
483. ther  position     keeping the indicator light in view  at all times     If you have any questions or are having difficulty  programming your HomeLink   buttons  refer to  the HomeLink   web site at  www homelink com  or call 1 800 355 3515     2 56 Instruments and controls    CLEARING THE PROGRAMMED  INFORMATION    The following procedure clears the programmed  information from both buttons  Individual buttons  cannot be cleared  However  individual buttons  can be reprogrammed  see    Reprogramming a  single HomeLink   button    in this section     To clear all programming     1  Press and hold the two outer HomeLink    buttons until the indicator light begins to  flash in approximately 10 seconds  Do not  hold for longer than 20 seconds     2  Release both buttons     HomeLink   is now in the programming mode  and can be programmed at any time beginning  with    Programming HomeLink        Step 1     REPROGRAMMING A SINGLE  HOMELINK   BUTTON    To reprogram a HomeLink   Universal Trans   ceiver button  complete the following     1  Press and hold the desired HomeLink   but   ton  DO NOT release the button     2  The indicator light will begin to flash after  20 seconds  Without releasing the  HomeLink   button  proceed with    Pro   gramming HomeLink        Step 1     For questions or comments  contact HomeLink    at  www homelink com or 1 800 355 3515     The HomeLink   Universal Transceiver button  has now been reprogrammed  The new device  can be activated by pushing th
484. thorized repair shop     The engine oil pressure warning light is not  designed to indicate a low oil level  Use the  dipstick to check the oil level  See  Engine oil  in  the  Maintenance and do it yourself  section of  this manual     2 12 Instruments and controls    A CAUTION    Running the engine with the engine oil  pressure warning light on could cause se   rious damage to the engine almost imme   diately  Such damage is not covered by  warranty  Turn off the engine as soon as it  is safe to do so      o  Low tire pressure warning light    Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  Monitoring System  TPMS  that monitors the tire  pressure of all tires except the spare     The low tire pressure warning light warns of low  tire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is not  functioning properly     After the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  this light illuminates for about 1 second  and turns off     Low tire pressure warning     If the vehicle is being driven with low tire  pressure  the warning light will illuminate   A CHECK TIRE PRESSURE warning also  appears in the vehicle information display     When the low tire pressure warning light  illuminates  you should stop and adjust the  tire pressure of all 4 tires to the recom   mended COLD tire pressure shown on the  Tire and Loading Information label located  in the driver s door opening  The low tire  pressure warning light does not automati   cally turn off when the tire pressure is ad   justed  After 
485. tion  see  Capacities and  recommended fuel lubricants  in the  Technical  and consumer information  section     RECOMMENDED ENGINE OIL       Engine oil with API Certification Mark      Viscosity SAE 5W 30    See  Engine oil and oil filter recommendation  in  the  Technical and consumer information  sec   tion of this manual     COLD TIRE PRESSURE     See Tire and Loading Information label     The label is typically located on the driver side  center pillar or on the driver s door  For additional  information  see  Wheels and tires  in the  Main   tenance and do it yourself    section of this  manual     RECOMMENDED NEW VEHICLE  BREAK IN PROCEDURE     During the first 1 200 mi  2 000 km  of vehicle  use  follow the recommendations outlined in the     Break in schedule  information found in the   Starting and driving  section of this manual  Fol   low these recommendations for the future reli   ability and economy of your new vehicle  Failure  to follow these recommendations may result in  vehicle damage or shortened engine life     Printing   February 2013  12   Publication No   OM3E OA35U1          Printed in U S A  A35 D          
486. tion initialization is completed     BEFORE STARTING    To get the best recognition performance from  Voice Recognition  observe the following         Theinterior of the vehicle should be as quiet  as possible  Close the windows to eliminate  the surrounding noises  traffic noise and vi   bration sounds  etc    which may prevent the  system from correctly recognizing the voice  commands       Wait until the tone sounds before speaking a  command         Speak in a natural conversational voice with   out pausing between words         Ifthe air conditioner is set to  Auto   the fan  speed is automatically lowered so that your  commands can be recognized more easily     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 133           n                WHA1332       8 00    Voice Recognition           54 Phone J   39 Navigation J     4 Information j Practice     49 Audio   99 Help J                                              To exit  hold the TALK switch          LHA1333       GIVING VOICE COMMANDS    1  Pressthe    amp   ing wheel     Switch located on the steer     2  A list of commands appears on the screen   and the system announces   Would you like  to access Phone  Navigation  Information   Audio or Help      3  After the tone sounds and the icon on the                screen changes from    to B  a command       speak    4  Continue to follow the voice menu prompts    and speak after the tone sounds until your  desired operation is completed     4 134 Monitor  
487. tion keys    When the DVD is playing without the operation  screen being shown  you may use the touch   screen to select items from the displayed video   You may also use the NISSAN controller to select  an item from the displayed video  When the op   eration screen is being shown  use the NISSAN  controller or the touchscreen to select an item  from the displayed menus     NN PAUSE     Select the Il     key to pause the DVD  To re   sume playing the DVD  use the 9 key     De ne    Select the P key to start playing the DVD or  resume playing the DVD after it has been paused     E E STOP     Select the M key to stop playing the DVD        PP   P    NEXT PREVIOUS  CHAPTER    Select the PI key to skip the chapter s  of the  disc forward  Select the M   key to skip the  chapter s  of the disc backward  The chapters  will advance forward or backward the number of  times the respective key is touched or selected  with the NISSAN controller      4    P  CM SKIP     This function is only for DVD VIDEO and DVD     VR  Selectthe I gt  or   l key to fast forward  or rewind a set interval of time based on the CM  settings  For more information  see    DVD set   tings    in this section              Top Menu     When the    Top Menu    key is selected while the  DVD is playing  the top menu specific to each  disc will be displayed  For details  see the instruc   tions attached to the disc     DVD settings  Select the    Settings    key to adjust the following  settings     e Key  DVD VIDE
488. top few rows of wires on the rear win   dow are not part of the rear window de     froster system  These wires make up the  antenna for the audio system     Instruments and controls 2 29    HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL  SWITCH    XENON HEADLIGHTS  if so  equipped     A WARNING   NHIGH VOLTAGE    e When xenon headlights are on  they  produce a high voltage  To prevent an  electric shock  never attempt to modify  or disassemble  Always have your xe   non headlights replaced at a NISSAN  dealer         Xenon headlights provide considerably  more light than conventional head   lights  If they are not correctly aimed   they might temporarily blind an oncom   ing driver or the driver ahead of you and  cause a serious accident  If headlights  are not aimed correctly  immediately  take your vehicle to a NISSAN dealer  and have the headlights adjusted  correctly     When the xenon headlight is initially turned on  its  brightness or color varies slightly  However  the  color and brightness will soon stabilize     2 30 Instruments and controls        The life of xenon headlights will be  shortened by frequent on off opera   tion  It is generally desirable not to turn  off the headlights for short intervals   for example  when the vehicle stops at  a traffic signal          If the xenon headlight bulb is close to  burning out  the brightness will drasti   cally decrease  the light will start blink   ing  or the color of the light will be   come reddish  If one or more of the  above signs a
489. tor  Location mark    A WARNING    e Tires should be periodically in     spected for wear  cracking  bulg   ing or objects caught in the tread   If excessive wear  cracks  bulging  or deep cuts are found  the tire s   should be replaced     The original tires have built in  tread wear indicators  When the  wear indicators are visible  the  tire s  should be replaced     Tires degrade with age and use   Have tires  including the spare   over 6 years old checked by a  qualified technician because  some tire damage may not be ob   vious  Replace the tires as neces   sary to prevent tire failure and  possible personal injury     Improper service of the spare tire  may result in serious personal in   jury  If it is necessary to repair the  spare tire  contact a NISSAN  dealer     For additional information re   garding tires  refer to    Important  Tire Safety Information     US  or     Tire Safety Information      Canada  in the Warranty Infor   mation Booklet     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 41    Replacing wheels and tires    When replacing a tire  use the same size  tread  design  speed rating and load carrying capacity  as originally equipped  Recommended types and  sizes are shown in    Wheels and tires    in the     Technical and consumer information    section of  this manual     AWARNING    e The use of tires other than those recom   mended or the mixed use of tires of  different brands  construction  bias   bias belted or radial   or tread patterns  can adversely aff
490. tor into a driving gear     3  Release the foot brake  then gradually start  the vehicle in motion     Starting and driving 5 13    4  Stop the vehicle completely before shifting  the shift selector to the P  Park  position     The CVT is designed so the foot brake  pedal MUST be depressed before shifting  from P  Park  to any drive position while  the ignition switch is in the ON position     The shift selector cannot be moved out of P   Park  and into any of the other gear posi   tions if the ignition switch is pushed to the  LOCK position     5 14 Starting and driving          OSOSOSO       Q  ege9  f          WSD0242       To move the shift selector     Press the button while depressing the  Ld brake pedal      gt  Press the button to shift    p   Shift without pressing button       Shifting    After starting the engine  fully depress the brake  pedal and move the shift selector from P  Park  to  any of the desired shift positions     A  WARNING    Apply the parking brake if the shift selec   tor is in any position while the engine is  not running  Failure to do so could cause  the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll  away and result in serious personal injury  or property damage     P  Park      A CAUTION    To prevent transmission damage  use the  P  Park  or R  Reverse  position only when  the vehicle is completely stopped     Use the P  Park  shift selector position when the  vehicle is parked or when starting the engine   Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped 
491. trolled automatically     A visible mist may be seen coming from the  vents in hot  humid conditions as the air is  cooled rapidly  This does not indicate a mal   function       You can individually set driver s and front    passenger s side temperature using each  temperature control dial  When the DUAL  button or passenger s side temperature dial  is turned  the DUAL indicator will come on   To turn off the passenger s side temperature  control  press the DUAL button     Heating  A C OFF     The air conditioner does not activate  When you  need to heat only  use this mode       Press the A C button   A C OFF will be    displayed and A C indicator will turn off      2  Turn the temperature control dial to set the    desired temperature     The temperature of the passenger compart   ment will be maintained automatically  Air  flow distribution and fan speed are also con   trolled automatically     Do not set the temperature lower than the  outside air temperature  Otherwise  the sys   tem may not work properly         Notrecommended if windows fog up   Dehumidified defrosting or defogging    1  Press the wy front defroster button on      The indicator light on the button will come  on        Turn the temperature control dial to set the    desired temperature     To quickly remove ice from the outside of the  windows  use the fan speed control dial to  set the fan speed to maximum     As soon as possible after the windshield is  clean  press the AUTO button to return to  the a
492. try    Edit Name                         INFORMATION                                                                                                             LHA1382      Editing the Vehicle Phonebook    1  Push the PHONE button and select the    Ve   hicle Phonebook    key     LHA1383       4  Select the desired item to change   The following editing items are available         Entry      2  Select the desired entry from the displayed    list       Select the  Edit  key     Changes the displayed number of the se   lected entry     Name  Edit the name of the entry using the keypad  displayed on the screen     Number  Edit the phone number using the keypad  displayed on the screen         Type    Select the icon from the icon list     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 123        Voicetag  Confirm and store the voicetag  Voicetags  allow easy dialing using the NISSAN Voice  Recognition system  For more information   see    NISSAN Voice Recognition System    in  this section     To delete an entry  select the    Delete    key at  step 3     HANDSET PHONEBOOK    Many phones will support an automatic down   load of the cellular phone   s phonebook  Since  this method allows for up to 1000 numbers to be  stored and entries are automatically assigned  voice tags by the system  this is a useful function  for easy dialing supported by the Voice Recogni   tion system           Settings  gt  Phone Go am vu 8 00                Edit Vehicle Phonebook       
493. ttings  screen will appear     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 9       Settings  gt  Display  Auto Day  12 00    123456789    Display  Brightness          Contrast    Background Color          co TIMI e    Push ENTER to adjust brightness             doorn an          LHA0930       Push DAY NIGHT button to resume display          WHA0823       Brightness contrast     Select the    Brightness    key or the    Contrast    key  to adjust the brightness or contrast of the map  background  Use the NISSAN controller to adjust  the brightness to darker or brighter and the con   trast to lower or higher     The new settings are automatically saved when  you exit the setting screen by pressing the BACK  button or any other mode button     Display off     Select the    Display ON    key  The amber indicator  next to    Display ON    turns off and the message  above will be displayed briefly  When the audio   HVAC  Heater and air conditioner   or any mode  button on the control panel is operated  the dis   play turns on for that operation  If one of the  control panel buttons is pressed  the display will  not automatically turn off until that operation is  finished  Otherwise  the screen turns off auto   matically after 5 seconds     4 10 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    To turn the screen on         Press the SETTING button  select the    Dis   play  key and then select the  Display ON   key  Then set the screen to on by pres
494. ttom of the  steering wheel with one hand  Move your  hand in the direction in which you want the  trailer to go  Make small corrections and  back up slowly  If possible  have someone  guide you when you are backing up     Always block the wheels on both vehicle and  trailer when parking  Parking on a slope is not  recommended  however  if you must do so     A CAUTION    If you move the shift selector to the P   Park  position before blocking the  wheels and applying the parking brake   transmission damage could occur     1   2     4   5   6     Apply and hold the brake pedal     Have someone place blocks on the downhill  side of the vehicle and trailer wheels     After the wheel blocks are in place  slowly  release the brake pedal until the blocks ab   sorb the vehicle load     Apply the parking brake   Shift the transmission into P  Park      Turn off the engine     To drive away     1   9 22 Technical and consumer information    Start the vehicle     Moo      Apply and hold the brake pedal     Shift the transmission into gear   Release the parking brake     Drive slowly until the vehicle and trailer are  clear from the blocks       Apply and hold the brake pedal   Have someone retrieve and store the blocks     While going downhill  the weight of the  trailer pushing on the tow vehicle may de   crease overall stability  Therefore  to main   tain adequate control  reduce your speed  and use the manual shift mode  M5   Avoid  long or repeated use of the brakes when  descendin
495. tton     When the RPT RDM button is pressed while the  USB memory is playing  the play pattern can be  changed as follows     Repeat All     1 Folder Repeat     1 Track Repeat      All Random     1 Folder Random     Repeat All    4 88 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems             LHA2030          This USB device contains multisession contents     Please select item to play                    Play Movie Contents Play Audio Contents                   LHA1378       USB INTERFACE  models with  Navigation System     Connecting a device to the USB input  jack    A CAUTION    e Depending on size and shape of USB  device  the console lid may not fully  close  Do not force console lid closed  as this may damage USB device            Do not force the USB device into the  USB port  Inserting the USB device  tilted or up side down into the port may  damage the USB device and the port   Make sure that the USB device is con   nected correctly into the USB port    Some USB devices come with a Yl  mark as a guide  Make sure that the  mark is facing the correct direction be   fore inserting the device          Do not locate objects near the USB de   vice to prevent the objects from leaning  on the USB device and the port  Pres   sure from the objects may damage the  USB device and the port     The USB input jack is located in the center con   sole  Insert the USB device into the jack  1      When a compatible storage device is plugged  into the jack  compatible audi
496. turn the autolight system off  turn the switch to    the OFF  Pd    or   2 position     2 32 Instruments and controls                WHA1170             WIC1438       Be sure you do not put anything on top of  the autolight sensor located on the top side  of the instrument panel  The autolight sen   sor controls the autolight  if it is covered   the autolight sensor reacts as if it is dark  out and the headlights will illuminate  If  this occurs while parked with the engine  off and the ignition switch placed in the ON  position  your vehicle s battery could be   come discharged     Headlight beam select       To select the high beam function  push the  lever forward  The high beam lights come on  and the  O light illuminates        Pull the lever back to select the low beam      3  Pulling and releasing the lever flashes the  headlight high beams on and off     Battery saver system    If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position  while the headlight switch is in the  Dd   or     position  the headlights will turn off after  a period of time     A CAUTION    Even though the battery saver feature au   tomatically turns off the headlights after a  period of time  you should turn the head   light switch to the OFF position when the  engine is not running to avoid discharging  the vehicle battery     DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM   Canada only     The headlights automatically illuminate at a re   duced intensity when the engine is started with  the parking brake released  
497. u press the BACK button  2  during setup   the setup will be canceled and or the display will  return to the previous screen         Finish setup     In some screens pressing the BACK button  4   accepts the changes made during setup     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 5                                                                                                 1 2 3          _  EE  ESettings  gt  Time Zone 8 0  n UP    a     Pacific o ON E  z Mountain o ON z  Z  Central o ON    E Eastern o ON E  E Atlantic o ON z  Mi 178   Bown             Manually set the time zone                S   S         5 4 3  LHA1300             HOW TO SELECT MENUS ON THE  SCREEN    Vehicle functions are viewed on the center dis   play screen in menus  Whenever a menu selec   tion is made or menu item is highlighted  different  areas on the screen provide you with important  information  See the following for details     1  Header   Shows the path used to get to the current  screen  for example  press the SETTING  button  gt  then select the    Clock    key  then  select the    Time Zone    key      2  Menu Selections   Shows the options to choose within that  menu screen  for example  Pacific time zone   Mountain time zone  etc       3  UP DOWN Movement Indicator   Shows that the NISSAN controller may be  used to move UP DOWN on the screen and  select more options     4  Screen Count   Shows the number of menu selections avail   able for that screen  for example  
498. udio  phone and voice recognition systems    Troubleshooting guide     Symptom Cause and Countermeasure    Check if the CD USB device was inserted correctly    Check if the CD is scratched or dirty    Check if there is condensation inside the player  If there is  wait until the condensation is gone  about 1 hour  before using the player    If there is a temperature increase error  the player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature    If there is a mixture of music CD files  CD DA data  and compressed audio files on a CD  only the music CD files  CD DA data  will be played     Cannot play Files with extensions other than   MP3  or     WMA  cannot be played  In addition  the character codes and number of characters for folder names and  file names should be in compliance with the specifications     Check if the disc or file is generated in an irregular format  This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of the compressed audio file writ   ing application or other text editing applications    Check if the finalization process  such as session close and disc close  is done for the disc    Check if the CD USB device is protected by copyright     Poor sound quality Check if the CD is scratched or dirty     It takes a relatively long time   If there are many folders or file levels on the CD USB device  or if it is a multisession disc  some time may be required before the music starts playing   before the music starts    playing   The writing softw
499. ul 8 00                Device Name  XXXXXXXX Select       Device Address Edit  XXXXXXXX       Delete                               LHA1298             LHA0049       6  The Device Name and Device Address are    displayed on the screen  Select the    Select     key to make this device the active  Bluetooth   audio player  Select the    Edit     key to edit the details of the player  such as  Device Name  Select the    Delete    key to  delete the device     CD CARE AND CLEANING  e Handle a CD by its edges  Do not bend the    disc  Never touch the surface of the disc     Always place the discs in the storage case  when they are not being used     To clean a disc  wipe the surface from the  center to the outer edge using a clean  soft  cloth  Do not wipe the disc using a circular  motion     Do not use a conventional record cleaner or  alcohol intended for industrial use     A new disc may be rough on the inner and  outer edges  Remove the rough edges by  rubbing the inner and outer edges with the  side of a pen or pencil as illustrated     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 101                1 SOURCE 1  SOURCE  a a    2        L eee   Y Y     Ed        Sem       2a  V XQ    3 3                LHA1144 LHA2094  Type A Type B  1  Power on and SOURCE select switch 1  Power on and SOURCE select switch  2  Tuning switch 2  Menu control switch ENTER button  3  Volume control switch 3  Volume control switch    STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FOR  AUDIO CONTROL    The 
500. ule  no other phone connecting  procedure is required  Your phone is automatically  connected with the in vehicle phone module when    the ignition switch is placed in the ON position with  the previously connected cellular phone turned on  and carried in the vehicle     You can connect up to 5 different Bluetooth    cellular phones to the in vehicle phone module   However  you can talk on only one cellular phone  at a time     Before using the Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System  refer to the following notes         Set up the wireless connection between a  compatible cellular phone and the in vehicle  phone module before using the hands free  phone system         Some Bluetooth   enabled cellular phones  may not be recognized by the in vehicle  phone module  Please visit  www nissanusa com bluetooth for a recom   mended phone list and connecting instruc   tions         You will not be able to use a hands free  phone under the following conditions         Your vehicle is outside of the cellular ser   vice area         Your vehicle is in an area where it is  difficult to receive a cellular signal  such  as in a tunnel  in an underground parking  garage  near a tall building or in a moun   tainous area     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 105        Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it  from being dialed       When the radio wave condition is not ideal  or ambient sound is too loud  it may be  difficult to hear the other person s voice dur
501. ules     Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in   20 cm  away from the electronic con   trol system harnesses  Do not route the  antenna wire next to any harness     Adjust the antenna standing wave ratio  as recommended by the manufacturer     Connect the ground wire from the CB  radio chassis to the body     For details  consult a NISSAN dealer     4 104 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems    BLUETOOTH   HANDS FREE PHONE  SYSTEM WITHOUT NAVIGATION  SYSTEM  if so equipped     AWARNING    e Use a phone after stopping your vehicle  in a safe location  If you have to use a  phone while driving  exercise extreme  caution at all times so full attention may  be given to vehicle operation        If you are unable to devote full attention  to vehicle operation while talking on  the phone  pull off the road to a safe  location and stop your vehicle     A CAUTION    To avoid discharging the vehicle battery   use a phone after starting the engine                microphone location     e Bluetooth      Il           LHA1158       Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth    Hands Free Phone System  If you have a com   patible Bluetooth   enabled cellular phone  you  can set up the wireless connection between your  cellular phone and the in vehicle phone module   With Bluetooth   wireless technology  you can    make or receive a hands free telephone call with  your cellular phone in the vehicle     Once your cellular phone is connected to the in   vehicle phone mod
502. ure everyone in your vehicle  is in a seat and using a seat belt  properly     TERMS    It is important to familiarize yourself with  the following terms before loading your  vehicle         Curb Weight  actual weight of your  vehicle    vehicle weight including   standard and optional equipment  flu   ids  emergency tools  and spare tire  assembly  This weight does not in   clude passengers and cargo     9 12 Technical and consumer information    GVW  Gross Vehicle Weight    curb  weight plus the combined weight of  passengers and cargo     GVWR  Gross Vehicle Weight Rat   ing    maximum total combined  weight of the unloaded vehicle  pas   sengers  luggage  hitch  trailer  tongue load and any other optional  equipment  This information is lo   cated on the F M V S S  C M V S S   certification label     GAWR  Gross Axle Weight Rating     maximum weight  load  limit specified  for the front or rear axle  This informa     tion is located on the  F M V S S  C M V S S  certification  label     GCWR  Gross Combined Weight  rating    The maximum total weight  rating of the vehicle  passengers   cargo  and trailer         Vehicle Capacity Weight  Load limit     Total load capacity   maximum total  weight limit specified of the load   passengers and cargo  for the ve   hicle  This is the maximum combined  weight of occupants and cargo that  can be loaded into the vehicle  If the  vehicle is used to tow a trailer  the  trailer tongue weight must be in   cluded as part of the cargo lo
503. ustained  high temperature can cause the material of the  tire to degenerate and reduce tire life  and exces   sive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure   The grade C corresponds to a level of perfor   mance which all passenger car tires must meet  under the Federal Motor Safety Standard No   109  Grades B and A represent higher levels of  performance on the laboratory test wheel than  the minimum required by law     9 24 Technical and consumer information    A WARNING    The temperature grade for this tire is es   tablished for a tire that is properly inflated  and not overloaded  Excessive speed   under inflation  or excessive loading  ei   ther separately or in combination  can  cause heat build up and possible tire  failure     EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM  WARRANTY    Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the following  emission warranties     For USA  1  Emission Defects Warranty  2  Emissions Performance Warranty    Details of this warranty may be found with other  vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information  Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle   If you did not receive a Warranty Information  Booklet  or it is lost  you may obtain a replace   ment by writing to       Nissan North America  Inc   Consumer Affairs Department  P O  Box 685003  Franklin  TN 37068 5003    For Canada  Emission Control System Warranty    Details of this warranty may be found with other  vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information  Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle   I
504. ustrated table of contents 0 5    INSTRUMENT PANEL                                                                                                    2    u                      1918 17                   WIC1535          2     3     0 6    Side and center vents  P  4 40   Headlight fog light  if so equipped  turn  signal switch  P  2 30    Steering wheel switch for audio control  and Bluetooth   Hands Free Phone  System  P  4 102  4 104     Illustrated table of contents    o9 B    D    Meters and gauges  P  2 3     Driver supplemental air bag horn     P  1 37  P  2 34     Security indicator light  P  2 26   Cruise control main set switches     P  5 19     10     la    12     13   14     15     16     17     18   19     20   21   22     23     Shift paddles  if so equipped   P  5 15   Windshield wiper washer switch    P  2 28    Display screen Navigation system     if so equipped   P  4 16    Display screen Navigation system   controls  if so equipped   P  4 16   Front passenger supplemental air bag   P  1 51    Glove box  P  2 41    Display screen  models without  Navigation system   P  4 4    Climate controls  models without  Navigation system   P  4 41    Audio system controls  models without  Navigation system   P  4 47    Front passenger air bag status light   P  1 44    Audio system controls  P  4 47   Climate controls  models with Naviga   tion system   P  4 44    Shift selector  P  5 12    Hazard warning flasher switch  P  6 2   Ignition switch  behind the steering  wh
505. utomatic mode     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 45        When the Sg front defroster button is  pressed  the air conditioner will automati   cally be turned on at outside temperatures  above 36  F  2  C   The air recirculate mode  automatically turns off  allowing outside air  to be drawn into the passenger compart   ment to further improve the defogging per   formance     MANUAL OPERATION   Fan speed control   Turn the   fan speed control dial to manually  control the fan speed    Press the AUTO button to return to automatic  control of the fan speed     Air recirculation    Press the C amp  air recirculation button to recir     culate interior air inside the vehicle  The C2   indicator light on the button will come on     The air recirculation cannot be activated when  the air conditioner is in the Y front defrosting    mode or the      front defrosting and foot out   let mode     Fresh air intake    Press the  gt  fresh air intake button to draw  outside air into the passenger compartment     The  amp  gt  indicator light on the button will come on   Automatic intake air control    In the AUTO mode  the intake air will be controlled  automatically  To manually control the intake air   press the CS air recirculation button  To return  to the automatic control mode  press and hold  the    gt  air recirculation button or press and hold  the  gt  fresh air intake button for about 2 sec   onds  The indicator lights  both air recirculation and  
506. utput  from the device will be played through the display   when the vehicle is in the  P  Park position and  the parking brake engaged  and audio system     4 74 Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems       AUX    Menu                 Display Mode                                     LHA1367       AUX settings    Select the    Settings    key using the NISSAN con   troller and press the ENTER button     Choose one of the display modes by selecting  the    4   keyorthe  P  key        Normal   e Wide        Cinema    Additional features    For more information about the iPod   player  available with this system  see    iPod   player  operation without Navigation System    in this sec   tion     For more information about the USB interface  available with this system  see    USB interface   models without Navigation System     in this sec   tion           A  P  w   r                                    OOO  0         TONS   L FMAM   SAT  DISCAUX        SCAN ile I     STER TRACK     1 PUSH AUOD                                      11 10 9 8 7 6 5    WHA1365       TRACK button  SEEK CAT button  SAT  button     _RPT RDM button  0  SCAN button   1  FM AM button      CD eject button  VOL ON OFF control knob  Station select  1   6  buttons  TUNE FOLDER and AUDIO control  knob  Bass  Treble  Fade and Balance   DISC AUX button    22090uo0    Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 75        No satellite radio reception is available  when the S
507. vate switches or controls  Unattended    children could become involved in seri     e Safe parking procedures require that Dus accidenic     both the parking brake be set and the    transmission placed into P  Park   Fail  1  Firmly apply the parking brake    ure to do so could cause the vehicle to f    move unexpectedly or roll away and re  2  Move the shift selector to the P  Park  posi   sult in an accident  Make sure the shift tion     selector has been pushed as far forward  as it can go and cannot be moved without  depressing the foot brake pedal     3  To help prevent the vehicle from rolling into  traffic when parked on an incline  it is a good  practice to turn the wheels as illustrated     HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB        Turn the wheels into the curb and move the  vehicle forward until the curb side wheel  gently touches the curb     HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB     Turn the wheels away from the curb and  move the vehicle back until the curb side  wheel gently touches the curb     HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL  NO  CURB        Turn the wheels toward the side of the road  so the vehicle will move away from the cen   ter of the road if it moves       Place the ignition switch to the LOCK posi     tion     Starting and driving 5 23    POWER STEERING    The power assisted steering uses a hydraulic  pump  driven by the engine  to assist steering     If the engine stops or the drive belt breaks  you  will still have control of the vehicle  However   much greater steering effort i
508. vated  it  may cause uncomfortable seat belt ten   sion     A  WARNING    When fastening the seat belts  be certain  that the seatbacks are completely se   cured in the latched position  If they are  not completely secured  passengers may  be injured in an accident or sudden stop     1 16 Safety   Seats  seat belts and supplemental restraint system                WRS0139       Unfastening the seat belts     D Tounfasten the seat belt  press the button on  the buckle  The seat belt automatically re   tracts     Checking seat belt operation    Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat belt  movement by two separate methods         When the seat belt is pulled quickly from the  retractor       When the vehicle slows down rapidly     To increase your confidence in the seat belts   check the operation as follows         Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forward  quickly  The retractor should lock and re   strict further belt movement     If the retractor does not lock during this check or  if you have any questions about seat belt opera   tion  see a NISSAN dealer        Om          LRS0242    Shoulder belt height adjustment  front  seats        The shoulder belt anchor height should be ad   justed to the position best for you  See  Precau   tions on seat belt usage  earlier in this section  To  adjust  pull out the adjustment button  1  and  move the shoulder belt anchor to the desired  position     so the belt passes over the center of  the shoulder  The belt should be away 
509. veral  times to skip back through tracks  The compact  disc will go back the number of times the button  is pressed     When the TRACK P   button is pressed while  a compact disc is playing  the next track will start  to play from its beginning  Press several times to  skip through tracks  The compact disc will ad     vance the number of times the button is pressed    When the last track on the compact disc is  skipped through  the first track will be played      The NISSAN controller can also be used to se   ect tracks when a CD is playing     144     gt p    SEEK CAT and TRACK   Rewind and Fast  Forward  buttons                 Press and hold the SEEK CAT 4  rewind   button or the TRACK P  fast forward  button  while a compact disc is playing  the compact disc  will play while rewinding or fast forwarding  When  the button is released  the compact disc will  return to normal play speed     TUNE FOLDER knob    While playing an MP3 WMA CD  turn the  TUNE FOLDER knob right or left to scan forward  or backward through available folders     RPT RDM button     When the RPT RDM button is pressed while the  compact disc is playing  the play pattern can be  changed as follows     CD     Repeat All     1 Track Repeat     1 Disc Random      Repeat All    CD with compressed audio files     Repeat All    1 Folder Repeat     1 Track Repeat      1 Disc Random     1 Folder Random     Re   peat All    Repeat All  Normal play mode  All tracks will  constantly play in sequential order    1 Fo
510. vice subscription is active  Satellite  radio is not available in Alaska  Hawaii  and Guam    FM AM SAT RADIO WITH   COMPACT DISC  CD  PLAYER  if so   equipped     For all operation precautions  see  Audio opera   tion precautions  in this section     Audio main operation  VOL ON OFF control     Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON  position and push the VOL ON OFF control knob  while the system is off to call up the mode that  was playing immediately before the system was  turned off     To turn the system off  press the VOL ON OFF  control knob     Turn the VOL ON OFF control knob to adjust the  volume     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 69    This vehicle has Speed Sensitive Volume  SSV   for audio  The audio volume changes as the driv   ing speed changes     AUDIO control knob  Bass  Treble  Bal   ance and Fade      Press the AUDIO control knob to change the  mode as follows     Bass     Treble     Balance     Fade    To adjust Bass  Treble  Balance and Fade  press  the AUDIO control knob until the desired mode  appears in the display  Turn the tuning knob to  adjust Bass and Treble to the desired level  You  can also use the tuning knob to adjust Fade and  Balance modes  Fade adjusts the sound level  between the front and rear speakers and Balance  adjusts the sound between the right and left  speakers     Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the  desired level  press the AUDIO control knob re   peatedly until the radio or CD d
511. ving  sec   tion           BRAKE   or            Brake warning light    This light functions for both the parking brake and  the foot brake systems        Parking brake indicator    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  the light comes on when the parking  brake is applied     Low brake fluid warning light    When the ignition switch is placed in the ON  position  the light warns of a low brake fluid level   If the light comes on while the engine is running  with the parking brake not applied  stop the ve   hicle and perform the following     1  Check the brake fluid level  Add brake fluid  as necessary  See    Brake fluid    in the    Main   tenance and do it yourself    section of this  manual     2  If the brake fluid level is correct  have the  warning system checked by a NISSAN  dealer     AWARNING    e Your brake system may not be working  properly if the warning light is on  Driv   ing could be dangerous  If you judge it  to be safe  drive carefully to the nearest  service station for repairs  Otherwise   have your vehicle towed because driv   ing it could be dangerous     e Pressing the brake pedal with the en   gine stopped and or a low brake fluid  level may increase your stopping dis   tance and braking will require greater  pedal effort as well as pedal travel         If the brake fluid level is below the  MINIMUM or MIN mark on the brake  fluid reservoir  do not drive until the  brake system has been checked at a  NISSAN dealer     Anti lock Bra
512. witch are OFF     2  Open the engine hood        3  Remove the fuse box cover by pushing the  tab and lifting the cover up     4  Remove the fuse with the fuse puller  The  fuse puller is located in the center of the fuse  block in the passenger compartment                 WDI0452  5  If the fuse is open     replace it with a new    fuse  B      6  If a new fuse also opens  have the electrical  system checked and repaired by a NISSAN  dealer        Maintenance and do it yourself 8 23       eh                            fade           LDI0328             Fusible links    If the electrical equipment does not operate and  fuses are in good condition  check the fusible  links  If any of these fusible links are melted   replace with only Genuine NISSAN parts     PASSENGER COMPARTMENT    A CAUTION    Never use a fuse of a higher or lower  amperage rating than specified on the  fuse box cover  This could damage the  electrical system or cause a fire     8 24 Maintenance and do it yourself    If any electrical equipment does not operate   check for an open fuse     1  Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight  switch are OFF     2  Pull the fuse box cover to remove     3  Remove the fuse with the fuse puller              WDIO0452    Type A      If the fuse is open     replace it with an    equivalent good fuse  B      5  Push the fuse box cover to install     6  If a new fuse also opens  have the electrical    system checked and repaired by a NISSAN  dealer                       
513. with di   luted mild cleaning agent and then wipe  with a dry cloth     e Do not damage the camera as the moni   tor screen may be adversely affected     When the shift selector is shifted to the R   Reverse  position  the display screen auto   matically changes to the RearView Monitor  mode  However  the radio can be heard     It may take some time until the RearView  Monitor or the normal screen is displayed  after the shift selector has been shifted to R   Reverse  from another position or to an   other position from R  Reverse   Objects  may be distorted momentarily until the Rear   View Monitor screen is displayed com   pletely     When the temperature is extremely high or  low  the screen may not clearly display ob   jects  This is not a malfunction     When strong light directly enters the cam   era  objects may not be displayed clearly   This is not a malfunction     Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the  screen  This is due to strong reflected light  from the bumper  This is not a malfunction     The screen may flicker under fluorescent  light  This is not a malfunction     The colors of objects on the RearView Moni   tor may differ somewhat from those of the  actual object     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 39        Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a  dark place or at night  This is not a malfunc   tion          f dirt  rain or snow attaches to the camera   the RearView Monitor may not clearly display  objects  Clean
514. x mp3  XXXXXXX    XXXXXXX    XXXXXXX             WHAO0950       CD MP3 display mode    While listening to a CD or an MP3 WMA CD   certain text might be able to be displayed  when  CD encoded with text is being used      Depending on how the CD or MP3 WMA CD is  encoded  the following text might be able to be  displayed by selecting the    Text    key         Folder displays the name of the current  folder being accessed        File displays the name of the file currently  playing        Song displays the ID3 encoded tag of the  song name         Album displays the ID3 encoded tag of the  album name         Artist displays the ID3 encoded tag of the  artist s name         Disc displays the disc name of the CD cur   rently playing        Track displays the name of the song on the  CD currently playing     Some of this text or modes might not display  while playing a regular CD  Select the  Menu  key  with the NISSAN controller  then select the  Text   key to display the text for the CD     Press the BACK button to exit the CD text display  screen     FM AM SAT radio operation  FM AM band select     Pressing the FM AM button will change the band  as follows     AM     FM1     FM2     AM    When the FM AM button is pressed while the  ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position  the  radio will come on at the station last played     The last station played will also come on when  the VOL ON OFF control knob is pressed ON     If    compact disc is playing when the FM AM  button is
515. y     Lane change signal     2  Tosignal a lane change  move the lever up or  down to the point where the indicator light  begins to flash  but the lever does not latch     The turn signal will flash three times automati   cally     2 34 Instruments and controls    FOG LIGHT SWITCH  if so equipped     To turn the fog lights on  turn the headlight switch  to the   2 position  then turn the fog light  switch to the  0 position     To turn the fog lights on with the headlight switch in  the AUTO position  the headlights must be on  then    turn the fog light switch to the   0 position     To turn the fog lights off  turn the fog light switch  to the OFF position     The headlights must be on and the low beams  selected for the fog lights to operate  The fog  lights automatically turn off when the high beam  headlights are selected     To sound the horn  push near the horn icon of the  steering wheel     AWARNING    Do not disassemble the horn  Doing so  could affect proper operation of the  supplemental front air bag system  Tam   pering with the supplemental front air bag  system may result in serious personal  injury     HEATED SEATS  if so equipped           p  amp  e             LIC1543       The front seats are warmed by built in heaters   The switch is located on the center console     1  Start the engine     2  Push the LO or HI position of the switch  as  desired  The indicator light in the switch will  illuminate     The heater is controlled by a thermostat   automatica
516. y be present  Once the screen is  selected you have the option of skipping the  warning or viewing it in detail     Warnings can be present for issues such as an  open door or low fuel  For more information about  potential warnings see    Vehicle information dis   play warnings and indicators  later in this section     If more than one warning is active  the screen will  cycle between the active warnings every 8 sec   onds                                WARNING mum WARNING WARNING      boa 5 9 CHECK 13  OPEN TIRE PRESSURE  WARNING WARNING  NPUSH RELEASE   amp  oo SUNG 6 10 TIRE PRESSURES 14  BRAKE 2  WARNING    0 0  000 n   7 11  MILES SHIFT  WARNING   gt  4  LOW  a WASHER x     8 12  BRAKE 9  LIC2185  Vehicle information display warnings Low windshield washer fluid warning 8  Engine start operation indicator    and indicators  1  Door and trunk open warning  2  Push warning    3  Low fuel warning    No key warning  Parking brake warning    Shift P warning    NISSAN Intelligent Key   insertion indicator  NISSAN Intelligent Key   removal indicator      NISSAN Intelligent Key  battery discharge    indicator    Instruments and controls 2 23    12  Loose fuel cap warning   13  Check tire pressure warning  14  Tire pressure warning   Door and trunk open warning    This warning illuminates when a door or the trunk  has been opened when the engine is running     Push warning    After the Shift P warning illuminates  the Push  warning will illuminate if the ignition switch is  place
517. y requires  coolant  have it checked by a NISSAN  dealer     CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT    A NISSAN dealer can change the engine coolant   The service procedure can be found in the  NISSAN Service Manual     Improper servicing can result in reduced  heater performance and engine overheat   ing     A  WARNING        To avoid the danger of being scalded   never change the coolant when the en   gine is hot     e Never remove the radiator cap when the  engine is hot  Serious burns could be  caused by high pressure fluid escaping  from the radiator         Avoid direct skin contact with used  coolant  If skin contact is made  wash  thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner  as soon as possible     e Keep coolant out of the reach of chil   dren and pets     Engine coolant must be disposed of properly   Check your local regulations     Maintenance and do it yourself 8 9    ENGINE OIL             WDI0663                   WDIO0214       CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL    1  Parkthe vehicle on a level surface and apply  the parking brake     2  Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches  operating temperature     3  Turn  off the engine  Wait more than  10 minutes for the oil to drain back into  the oil pan     4  Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean  Re   insert it all the way     8 10 Maintenance and do it yourself    5  Remove the dipstick again and check the oil  level  It should be between the H  High  and  L  Low  marks  B   This is the normal oper   ating oil level range  If the oil 
518. ying and a USB memory device is inserted   press the AUX button repeatedly until the center  display changes to the USB memory mode     If the system has been turned off while the USB  memory was playing  push the ON OFF VOL  control knob to restart the USB memory     a lt     gt  gt    SEEK CAT and TRACK   Reverse or Fast Forward   buttons                 Press and hold the SEEK CAT 4  rewind   button or TRACK P  fast forward  button for  1 5 seconds while an audio file on the USB  device is playing to reverse or fast forward the  track being played  The track plays at an in   creased speed while reversing or fast forwarding   When the button is released  the audio file re   turns to normal play speed     Monitor  climate  audio  phone and voice recognition systems 4 87          a lt    Ppl   SEEK CAT and TRACK  buttons           Press the SEEK CAT button M   while an au   dio file on the USB device is playing to return to  the beginning of the current track  Press the    SEEK CAT button M   several times to skip  backward several tracks     Press the TRACK button  gt    while an audio  file on the USB device is playing to advance one  track  Press the TRACK button 9   several  times to skip forward several tracks  If the last  track in a folder on the USB device is skipped  the  first track of the next folder is played     Folder selection     To change to another folder in the USB memory   turn the TUNE FOLDER knob or choose a folder  displayed on the screen     RPT RDM bu
519. ys     To open the trunk lid  push the opener switch  down     To close the trunk lid  lower and push the trunk lid  down securely     NOTE     You can open the trunk lid with the Intelli   gent Key  Refer to    NISSAN Intelligent  Key  in this section                    LPD0186       Cancel switch    When the cancel switch located inside the glove  box is OFF  the trunk lid cannot be opened with  the trunk lid release switch or with the Intelligent  Key                                                              WIC1401    INTERIOR TRUNK LID RELEASE       AWARNING    Closely supervise children when they are  around cars to prevent them from playing  and becoming locked in the trunk where  they could be seriously injured  Keep the  car locked  with the rear seatback and  trunk lid securely latched when not in use   and prevent children   s access to car keys     The interior trunk lid release mechanism provides  a means of escape for children and adults in the  event they become locked inside the trunk     To open the trunk from the inside  pull the illumi   nated release handle until the lock releases and  push up on the trunk lid  The release handle is  made of a material that glows in the dark after a  brief exposure to ambient light     The handle is located inside the trunk compart   ment on the interior of the trunk lid                    LPD0459          SECONDARY TRUNK LID RELEASE   if so equipped   For models with a rear center console  the trunk  can be accessed th
520. ystem warranty         9 25  Engine   Before starting the engine           5 11   Block heater     42 ke 5 29   Capacities and recommended   fuel lubicants          ee eee 9 2   Changing engine coolant              8 9    Changing engine oil            ss  8 11  Changing engine oil filter                  8 12  Checking engine coolant level               8 9  Checking engine oil level             8 10  Engine compartment check locations        8 6  Engine coolant temperature gauge       2 5  Engine cooling system              8 7  Engineoil     ko a mm 8 10  Engine oil and oil filter recommendation     9 5  Engine oil pressure warning light         2 12  Engine oil viscosity              9 5  Engine serial number              9 10  Engine specifications                 9 7  Starting the engine               5 11  Enter buttons  os   sd ee ee 4 4  4 16  Event data recorders                9 26  Exhaust gas  Carbon monoxide            5 2  Extended storage switch              8 25  Eyeglass case         llle  2 39  F  Flashers  See hazard warning flasher switch    6 2  Flattire  o owners E are Rx E 6 3  Floor mat positioning aid                7 5  Fluid  Brake fluid ise Rx 8 13  Capacities and recommended  fuel lubricants   i  sss m khe 9 2  Continuously Variable Transmission   CVT  fluid    mr ned 8 12  Engine coolant            less 8 7  Engirieoll  i  doy a aa ng d 8 10  Power steering fluid                8 13  Windshield washer fluid               8 14    F M V S S  certi
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
Emerson 1098H-EGR Drawings & Schematics  取扱説明書 Instruction Manual    Binatone Acura 3000  User Guide - Welds Tracking System Software  TX-540XM  Mophie Powerstation  Lenovo 04X0169 notebook spare part  Omni-Vue ® – Install/User Manual  Safety Integrated    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file